Pioneer S-DV180 Operating Instructions
Operating Instructions HTZ180D VD DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD á à ¯¦ÃÂᣠXV -D V180 Speaker System | á à ¶µáÂÂá£ÃÂà ² S-D V180 HTZ181D VD DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD á à ¯¦ÃÂᣠXV -D V181 Speaker System | á à ¶µáÂÂá£ÃÂà ² S-D V585 HTZ280D VD DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD á à ¯¦ÃÂᣠXV -D V282 Speaker System | á à ¶µáÂÂá£ÃÂà ² S-D V280T / S-D V5SW HTZ280D VD-AP DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD á à ¯¦ÃÂᣠXV -D V282AP Speaker System | á à ¶µáÂÂá£ÃÂà ² S-D V280T / S-D V5SW HTZ282D VD DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD á à ¯¦ÃÂᣠXV -D V282 Speaker System | á à ¶µáÂÂá£ÃÂà ² S-D V282T / S-D V5SW HTZ282D VD-AP DVD/CD Receiver | DVD/CD á à ¯¦ÃÂᣠXV -D V282AP Speaker System | á à ¶µáÂÂá£ÃÂà ² S-D V282T / S-D V5SW HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 1 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (ser vicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated âÂÂdangerous voltageâ within the productâÂÂs enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. CAUTION: TO PREVENT THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE P ARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN IMPOR T ANT D3-4-2-1-1_A1_En î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ$(îÂÂ# îÂÂ!'îÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂ!"'îÂÂ*îÂÂ'îÂÂ%#%""îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî "îÂÂ#%îÂÂ)îÂÂ!'îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂî "%îÂÂ&îÂÂ"îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ-îÂÂ%îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ"îÂÂ!"'îÂÂ#îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ!,îÂÂîÂÂ"!'îÂÂîÂÂ!îÂÂ%îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî *îÂÂ'îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ$(îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ!îÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂ'îÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ$(îÂÂ# îÂÂ!'îÂÂîÂÂ&(îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ)îÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ"%î îÂÂîÂÂ"*îÂÂ%îÂÂ#"'îÂÂîÂÂ"%îÂÂî #"&îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ'îÂÂ'"îÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂ##îÂÂ!îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ&#îÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ!îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂîÂÂ!î "%î "îÂÂ&'(%îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ! î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂî î $!)îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ$î îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂî î !îÂÂîÂÂ!î îÂÂ%$,îÂÂ' îÂÂ(*%%!- îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ'( î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ$'î #î îÂÂ)$ îÂÂîÂÂ$*#)'- îÂÂ$' îÂÂ' îÂÂî $# îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ(*'î îÂÂ)îÂÂîÂÂ) îÂÂ)îÂÂî î %$,îÂÂ' îÂÂ(*%%!- î $!)îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ$î îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂ'îÂÂî îÂÂ,îÂÂîÂÂ' î îÂÂ)î ( îÂÂ*# ) î , !! îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ*(îÂÂî îÂÂ"îÂÂîÂÂ)( îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂ'îÂÂ&* ' îÂÂî î $!)îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî î $' îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂ,' ))îÂÂ# îÂÂ$# îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂ'îÂÂîÂÂ' îÂÂ%îÂÂ#îÂÂ! îÂÂî îÂÂî î î î î î î î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ# îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î VENTILATION CAUTION When installing this unit, make sure to leave space around the unit for ventilation to improve heat radiation (at least 10 cm at top, 10 cm at rear, and 10 cm at each side). WARNING Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation to ensure reliable operation of the product, and to protect it from overheating. To prevent fire hazard, the openings should never be blocked or covered with items (such as newspapers, table-cloths, curtains) or by operating the equipment on thick carpet or a bed. D3-4-2-1-7b_A_En WARNING To prevent a fire hazard, do not place any naked flame sources (such as a lighted candle) on the equipment. D3-4-2-1-7a_A_En CAUTION The ST ANDB Y/ON switch on this unit will not completely shut off all power from the AC outlet. Since the power cord ser ves as the main disconnect device for the unit, you will need to unplug it from the AC outlet to shut down all power . Therefore, make sure the unit has been installed so that the power cord can be easily unplugged from the AC outlet in case of an accident. To avoid fire ha zard, the power cord should also be unplugged from the AC outlet when left unused for a long period of time (for example, when on vacation). D3-4-2-2-2a_A_En HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 2 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
POWER-CORD CAUTION Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not pull out the plug by tugging the cord and never touch the power cord when your hands are wet as this could cause a short circuit or electric shock. Do not place the unit, a piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or pinch the cord. Never make a knot in the cord or tie it with other cords. The power cords should be routed such that they are not likely to be stepped on. A damaged power cord can cause a fire or give you an electrical shock. Check the power cord once in a while. When you find it damaged, ask your nearest PIONEER authorized ser vice center or your dealer for a replacement. S002*_En Operating Environment Operating environment temperature and humidity : 5 ðC to 35 ðC ( 41 ðF to 95 ðF); less than 85 %RH (cooling vents not blocked) Do not install this unit in a poorly ventilated area, or in locations exposed to high humidity or direct sunlight (or strong artificial light) D3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_En If the AC plug of this unit does not match the AC outlet you want to use, the plug must be removed and appropriate one fitted. Replacement and mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of this unit should be per formed only by qualified ser vice personnel. If connected to an AC outlet, the cut -off plug can cause severe electrical shock. Make sure it is properly disposed of after removal. The e quipment should be disconnected by removing the mains plug from the wall socket when left unused for a long period of time (for example, when on vacation). D3-4-2-2-1a_A1_En îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî î îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî CAUTION This product is a class 1 laser product, but this product contains a laser diode higher than Class 1. T o ensure continued safety , do not remove any covers or attempt to gain access to the inside of the product. Refer all servicing to qualified personnel. The following caution label appears on your unit. Location: top of the unit CLA SS 1 LA SER PR ODUCT D3-4-2-1-8*_C_En HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 3 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
4 En Thank you for buying this Pioneer product. Please read through th ese operating inst ructions so th at you wi ll know how to oper ate your model properly. Aft er you have finishe d reading the instr uctions, put them in a sa fe place for future re ferenc e. Contents 01 Speaker Setup Guide Home theater sound setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 5 spot/4 spot speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 3 spot/2 spot speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Preparing the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Preparation common to all models . . . . . . . 6 Preparation for the HTZ280DVD/ HTZ280DVD-AP/HTZ282DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Preparation only for the HTZ181DVD . . . . . . 7 Wall mounting the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Before mounti ng . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Attaching the brackets only for the HTZ180/ 181DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Additional notes on speaker placement . . . . . 8 02 Connecting up Basic connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 03 Controls and displays Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Putting the batteries in the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Using the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 04 Getting started Setting Speaker Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Setting the ch annel levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Using the on-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Playing discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Basic playback controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Resume and Last Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 DVD-Video disc menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus . . . . . . . 19 Listening to the radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Improving poor FM reception . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Reducing AM reception noise . . . . . . . . . . 20 Memorizing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Listening to station presets . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Listening to other sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Setting the sleep timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 05 Listening to y our system Selecting Listening mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Auto list ening mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Listening in surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Using Front Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Listening in stereo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Listening with headphones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Adjusting the bass and treble . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Using the SFC modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Boosting the bass level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Using the MP3 Expander . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Using the Voice Enhancer mode . . . . . . . . . . 24 Effective Sound (for optimum sound) . . . . . . 24 06 Disc playba ck features Scanning discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Playing in slow motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Playing a JPEG slideshow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Browsing DVD or Vide o CD/Super VCD discs with the Disc Navigator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Browsing Windows Media TM Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG-4 AAC, Di vX video/ WMV and JPEG files with the Disc Navigator . . . . . . . . 27 Using Playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Programming playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Listening to playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Clearing files from a playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Looping a section of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Using repeat play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Using random play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Creating a program list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Other functions available from the program menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Searching a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Switching subtit les . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Switching language/au dio channels . . . . . . . 30 Zooming the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Switching camera angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Displaying disc information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 4 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
5 En Engli sh Françai s Deut sch Ne derlan ds Italiano E spañol 07 USB playback and Recording Using the USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Recording the tracks of a music CD on a USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Recording all the tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Recording specific tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 08 Singing karaoke Singing kar aoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Changing the vocal mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Changing the backing track . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 09 Audio Settings and Video Adjust menus Audio Settings menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Audio DRC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Video Adjust menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 10 Initial Settings m enu Using the Initial Settings men u . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Video Output settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Language settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Display settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Options settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Speakers settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Parental Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 About DivX î VOD content . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Speaker Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 11 Other connections Connecting auxiliary audio components . . . . 40 Connecting using the component video output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 About progressive scan video . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Connecting us ing HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Switching the HDMI audio setting . . . . . . . 41 Resetting the HDMI connection . . . . . . . . . 42 About HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Connecting external antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Bluetooth î ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoyment of Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Wireless music play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Remote control operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Connecting Optional Bluetooth ADAPT ER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTER and Bluetooth wireless technology device . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Listening to Music Contents of Bluetooth wireless technology device with Your Sys tem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Clearing Pairing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 12 KURO LI NK Making the KURO LINK connection s . . . . . . . 45 KURO LINK Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Setting the KURO LINK mode . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Before using synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Synchronized amp mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Synchronized amp mode operations . . . . . . 46 Canceling synchroniz ed amp mode . . . . . . 46 13 Additional information Disc/content format playback compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Disc compatibility table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 About DVD R/DVD RW compat ibility . . . . 48 About DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 About WMV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 About MPEG-4 AAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 About WMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Using and taking care of discs . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 DVD Video regions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Installation and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Hints on installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Cleaning the pickup lens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Problems with condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Moving the system unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Widescreen TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Standard TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 TV system setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Frequency step setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Dimming the Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Setting the Key Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Trouble shooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 DVD/CD/Video CD player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 USB connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 HDMI connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Bluetooth connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Resetting the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Using the language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Country/Area code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 5 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Speaker Setup Guide 01 6 En Chapter 1 Speaker Setup Guide Home theater sound setup Depending on the size and cha racteristics o f your room, you can place your speake rs in one of two ways using this system. For the speaker configuration, see the Setup Guide. 5 spot/4 spot speaker layout This is a standard mult ichannel surrou nd sound speaker setup fo r optimal 5.1 channel home theater sou nd. 3 spot/2 spot speaker layout This setup is ideal when rear surround speaker placement isnâÂÂt possible or you want to avoid running long speaker cabl es in your listening area. Preparing the speakers Preparation common to all models Attaching non-skid pads ⢠Attach the small er non-skid pads to t he base of each of the speakers. The four large non-skid pads are for the subwoof er. U se the supplied adhesive to attach 3 or 4 pads to the base (flat surface) of each speaker. Preparation f or the HTZ2 80DVD/ HTZ280DVD-AP/HTZ 282DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP The layouts of the 5-sp ot speaker and 3-spot speaker are the same : Assembling t he speaker st ands ⢠Attach the speaker stand bases to the stems using the screws provided. Once you have aligned the stem and base, secure with the small screws at the points see the Setup Guide. Note that the speaker should face in the direction of the base of the isosceles triangle. CAUTION ⢠Be careful no t to tig hten scre ws excessively. ⢠If excessive force is used to tighten screws, the threads of screw and/or nut may be damaged. Use a middle-sized manual screwdriver during assembly. ⢠Do not use power screwdrivers or oversized screwdrivers that may exert ex cessive force on the screws and nuts. ⢠Confirm that no foreig n matter is stuck to the stand b ase or the ta ll speaker during assembly. ⢠If the unit is assembled with foreign matt er stuck between the stand base and the tall speaker the unit may not be assembled securely, re sulting i n tipping or f alling. ⢠Do not stand on the speaker stand base of the tall speaker to push or swing the speaker. The speaker may fall and break , or someone may be injured. P ay special attent ion to children. Securing your front and surround speaker s ⢠Secure each of the front and surround speakers using the plastic catch provided. Screw two supportin g hook s into the wall behind the speaker. Pass a thick cord around the hook s and through the plastic ca tch so that the speaker is stabilized (make sure to test t h at it sup ports the weight of the speaker). After installing, make sure the speaker is securely fixed. Plastic catch Sufficiently thick co rd HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 6 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Speaker Setup Guide 01 7 En Engli sh Françai s Deut sch Ne derlan ds Italiano E spañol Engli sh Françai s Deut sch Ne derlan ds Italiano E spañol CAUTION ⢠The plastic catch is not a m ounting fixture, and the speaker should not be hung directly from the wall u sing this cat ch. Always use a cord when stabilizin g the speaker. ⢠Pioneer discl aims all resp onsibility fo r any losses or damage resulting from improper assembly, installation, insufficient strength of the installation materials, misuse, or natural disasters. ⢠When placing this unit, ensure tha t it is firmly secured and avoid areas where it may be likely to fall and cause in jury in the event of a natu ral disaster (such as an earthquake). Preparation only for the HTZ181DVD Stack t he speakers a nd fix the brackets Each speaker is prov ided with a color-coded indicator on the model labe l o n t h e r e a r s i d e t o assist identific a tion. Refer to the color indicators and install the speakers correctly. As shown in the illustrati on, stack the speakers. 1 Align the bracket with the respective upper and lower screw holes as shown in each figure below and fasten the screws securely. 4 spot/3 spot speaker layout: 2 spot speaker layout: CAUTION ⢠Do not attempt to carry the speakers when they are connected with the bracket. D oing so may cause damage to the bracket o r worsen damage to the bracket and speakers in the event th ey are dropped. Wall mounting the speake rs For the HTZ180DVD, the fr ont and surround speaker have mountin g brackets. For the HTZ181DVD, the front, center and surround speaker have mountin g brackets. For the HTZ280DVD/280DVD-AP, the center an d surround speaker have m ounting holes. For the HTZ282DVD/HTZ282DVD-A P, only the center speaker has a mounting hole. Before mounting ⢠Remember th at the speaker system is heavy and that its weight could cause the screws to work loose, or the wall material to fail to s upport it, res ulting in the speaker Note 1 When using the Front S urround mode, do not stack the surround speakers, but place them beside the front speaker and face them about 60 degrees out ward from the front speaker to obtain the best sound effect. Screw Front speaker Bracket Front speaker Center speaker Left Green White Green Red Right 4 spot: Front speaker Surround speaker Left Blue White Gray Red Right 3 spot: Color indicator Model label Color indicator Model label Front speaker Center speaker Surround speaker Left Blue White Green Gray Red Green Right Screw Center speaker Front speaker Surround speaker Bracket HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 7 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Speaker Setup Guide 01 8 En falling. M ake sure that the wa ll you intend to mount the speakers on is strong en ough to support them. Do not mou nt on plywood or soft surface walls. ⢠Mounting screws are not suppli e d. Use screws suitable for the wal l material and support the weight of the speaker. CAUTION ⢠If you are unsure of the qualities and strength of the wall, consult a professional for advice. ⢠Pioneer is not respo nsible for any accidents or damage that result from improper instal lation. Attaching the brackets only for the HTZ180/181DVD ⢠Make sure to tighten the suppli ed screw as securely as possible when attachi n g the bracket to th e back of th e speaker. ⢠Please do n ot attach the brackets to the center speaker. Additional notes on speaker placement ⢠Install the main front left and right speakers at an equal distance from the TV. ⢠When using the 5 spo t speaker layout, install the s urround sp eakers sligh tly above ear level for optimu m effect. Precautions: ⢠When installing the cente r speaker on top of the TV, be sure to secure it with tape or some other s uitable mean s. Otherwise, the speaker may fall from the TV due to external shocks such as earthquakes, endangering those nearby or damaging the speaker. ⢠Make sure that all the bare spea ker wire is twisted together and in serted fully into the speaker terminal. If any of the bare speaker wire to uches the b ack panel it may ca use the power to cut off as a safety measure. ⢠The f ront, cent er and surrou nd speakers supplie d with this sys tem are magnetic ally shielded. However, depending on the installatio n location , color disto rtion may occur if the speaker is installed extremely close to the screen of a television set. If this case happens, turn th e power switch of the television set OFF, and turn it ON after 15 min. to 30 min. If the pro blem persists, place the speaker system away from the television set. ⢠The subwo ofer is not m agnetical ly shielded and so should not be placed nea r a TV or monitor. Magnetic storage media (such as floppy discs and tape or video cassettes) should also not be kept close to the subwo ofer. ⢠Do no t attach the c enter speaker (only of the HTZ180DVD) the fro nt (of the HTZ280/ 282DVD)/surround speaker (only of th e HTZ282DVD) and subwoofer to a wall or ceiling. They ma y fall off and cause injury. ⢠Do not place the surround speaker on the top of the f ront speaker, as it may injure someone in the even t that it falls (only for the HTZ280DVD). 5 mm to 7 mm Mounting screw (not supplied) 5 mm 10 mm B racket sc rew (su pplied) HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 8 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 9 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 2 Connecting up Basic connections For the best surround sound, setup your speakers as below . The front left and right speaker should be about 1.8 m to 2.7 m apart. The speakers in the illustration below are the HTZ180DVD. Important ⢠When connecting this system or changing connections, be sure to switch power off and disconnect the po wer cord from the wall socket. After completing all connec tions, connect the power cords to the wall socket. WARNING ⢠Pioneer bears no responsibi lity for accidents resulting from fault y assembly or installation, insuff icie nt mounti ng strength of walls, mou nting fixtures (or other buildi ng fixtures), mi suse or natura l disa ster s. 1 Assembl e the AM lo op ante nna. a. Bend the stand in the direction indicated by the arrow. b. Clip the loop onto th e stand. c. If you want to fix to a wall or other surface, perform step b after first sec uring the stand with screws. It is recommended that you dete rmine the reception strength before sec uring the stand with the screws. AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R Y P B P R L R FRONT CENTER L R SURROUND SUB WOOFER VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP Surround right (Grey) Front right (Red) Front left (White) Subwoofer (Purple) Center (Green) Surround left (Blue) Listening position TV To video input FM antenna AM loop antenna fig. a fig. b fig. c HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 9 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 10 En 2 Connect the AM and FM an tennas. 1 a. Pull off the protecti ve shields of both AM antenna wires. Connect one wire o f the AM loop ante nna to each AM antenna terminal. 2 For each terminal, pre ss down on the tab to open; insert the wire, then release to secure. b. Push th e FM antenna 3 plug onto the center pin of the FM antenna socket. 3-1 Connect each speaker. ⢠Connect the wires to the speaker. ⢠Twist and pull off the protective shields on each w ire. ⢠Match the color-cod ed wire with th e color indicato r on the label, t hen insert the c olor- coded wire into the red ( ) side and the other wire into the black (âÂÂ) side. HTZ180DV D only: When you select th e 3 spot speaker layout, follow steps a thr ough c below to set up the speakers. a. The base of each surround speaker fits into the ci rcular gro o ve on the top of the front speakers as shown. Note 1 ⢠Keep antenna cables away fr om the receiver and other cables. ⢠If reception with th e su pplied antenna is poor, see Impr oving poor FM receptio n on page 20 or Connecting external antenn as on page 42. ⢠Do not attach any antenn a other than the provided loop antenna, or an external an tenna as described on page 42. 2 ⢠D onâÂÂt let it come into contact with metal objects and a voi d placing near comp uters, televis ion sets or other electrical appliances. ⢠If radio reception is poor, you may be able improve it by re-inser ting each antenna wire into the opposite terminal. ⢠For best reception, do not untwist the AM loop an tenna wires or wrap them around the loop antenna. 3 To ensure optimum reception, make sure the FM antenna is fully extended and not coiled or hanging at the rear of the unit. 1 2 3 Color-coded wire (Connect to speaker) Color-coded connector (Connect to rear panel) Black (âÂÂ) Color -coded wire Red ( ) HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 10 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 11 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español b. Secure the speaker wire. After test ing for the slac k necessary to tur n the speaker (see the following step), use the groove provided to secure the speaker wire. c. Turn the speakers towards the closest wall, lining the arr ows up for optimal Front Surround. For Front Surro und mode, turn each surrou nd speaker so that the ï¢ arrow at the base is lined up with the ï¡ ( FRONT SURROUND ) arrow on the front speaker. For Extra Power mode, ha ve all the spea kers facing forward. See the Listening to y our system for more on using Front Surround an d Extra Power mo des. CAUTION ⢠To prevent accidents, make sure th e surround speaker is p laced securely on top of the front speaker. ⢠Ple ase donâÂÂt atta ch the speakers to the wall or speaker stands for 3 spot speaker layout. HTZ181DV D only : a. When connecting the center speakers, connect the Y-cable dual end to the two center speakers in the same way. When you select a 4-sp ot, 3-spot or 2-spot layout where the brackets are used for assembling, also follow step b below. b. When connections are compl eted, secure the speaker cables. Fix the cables to the groove in the brackets. 3-2 Connect each speaker terminals on the receiver. ⢠Connect the other end to the color-coded speaker terminals on th e rear of the receiver. Ma ke sure to inse rt comple tely. The small lug at the wire-en d of the speaker p l u g s h o u l d f a c e u p o r d o w n d e p e n d i n g o n whether itâÂÂs being plugged int o one of the upper or lower speaker terminals. Please make sure to co nnect correctly. Y -cable T o Main Unit Upper terminal Lower terminal 02_Connecting_up .fm 11 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂé æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 12 En CAUTION ⢠These speaker terminals carry HAZARDOUS LIVE voltage . To pr event the risk of electric shock when connecting or disconnecting the spe aker cables, disconnect the power cord before touching any uninsulated parts. ⢠Do not connect any speakers other than those supplied to this system. ⢠Do not connect the su ppli ed speakers to any amplifier other tha n the one supplied with this system. Connection t o any other amplifier may result in malfunct ion or fire. ⢠After connecting the pl ugs, pull lightly on the cables to make sure that the ends of the cables are securely co nnected to the terminals. Poor conne ctions can cr eate noise and interruptions on the sound. ⢠If the cableâÂÂs wires happen to be pushed out of the terminals, allowing the wires to come into contact with each other, it places an excessive additional load on the amp. This may cause th e amp to stop functioning, and m ay even damage th e amp. 4 Connect one end to a video input on your TV. ⢠Use the supplied video cable. 5 Connect the other end to the video output of the receiver. ⢠This unit is equipped with copy protection technology. Do not connect this unit to your TV via a VCR using A V cables, as the picture fro m this unit will not ap pear properly on you r TV. 6 Connect th e power cord. 1 ⢠Connect the power cord to AC inlet on the receiver. Connect the power cord to a wall socke t. Note 1 ⢠Do not use any power cord other than the one supplie d with this system. ⢠Do not use the supplied power cord for any pu rpose other than connecting to this system. AC IN To AC outlet 02_Connecting_up .fm 12 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂé æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 13 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 3 Controls and displays Front panel 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON (page 17, 32, 43, 50, 52 and 54) 2 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE (page 18, 32 and 53) 3 Function 4 ï¦ 5 ï§ 6 VOLUME /â (page 19) 7 Dis c tray (pag e 18) 8 Remote Sens or (page 15) 9D i s p l a y 10 USB interface (page 31) 11 MIC input jacks (page 33) 12 PHONES jack (page 23) Display 1 Decord indicators (pag e 22) DTS lights during playba ck of a DTS source . 2 PL II lights during 2 Dolby Pro Logic II decoding and 2 D li ghts dur ing playba ck of Dolby Digital sources. 2 PRGSVE (page 41) Lights when progressive scan video signal is given from the componen t video output termin al. 3 SOUND (page 23) Lights when the SFC modes, the tone controls (treble, bass or bass boost), MP3 Expander mode, Voice Enhancer mode are active. 4 F.SURR. (page 23) Lights when the Extra Power mode/Front surround mode is selected. 5 RPT and RPT -1 (page 28) RPT lights du ring repeat play. RPT-1 li ghts during repeat one-tr ack play. 6 PGM (page 27 and 29) Lights during program o r playlist playback. 7 Tuner indicators (pag e 20) Lights when a broadc ast is being received, Lights when a stere o FM broadcast is being received, Lights when FM mo no reception is selected. 8 RDM (page 28) Lights during random play. MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES ï¨ï OPEN /CLOSE ïµ ï ST ANDBY/ ON FUNCTION VOLUME ï¦ï§ MAIN SUB MIC PHONES USB 10 12 5 2 1 7 8 9 3 4 6 11 PRGSVE SOUND DTS F .SURR. 2 PL 2 D RPT -1 kHz PGM MHz RDM 6 12 8 9 7 5 11 3 10 2 1 4 HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 13 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 14 En 9 kHz/MHz (page 20) Indicates the frequen cy unit shown in the character disp lay ( kHz for AM, MHz for FM). 10 Character display 11 (page 21) Lights when slee p timer is active. 12 ï¤ Lights during playbac k. Remote control The illustration shows the HTZ280/282DVD-AP. 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON (page 17, 32, 43, 50, 52 and 54) 2 Function select bu ttons 1 3 Number buttons, CLEAR, DISPLAY , SLEEP and DVD controls CLEAR DISPLAY (page 30) SHIFT SLEEP (page 21) SHIFT USB REC (page 31) SHIFT AUDIO (page 30) SHIFT SUBTITLE (p age 30) Note 1 Only the HTZ280/282DVD-AP models are equipped with the adapter port. 1 USB REC CLEAR TOP MENU TUNE ECHO TUNE KARAOKE MENU MIC VOL PLAYLIST OPEN /CLOSE RETURN SETUP AUTO / STEREO MP3 EXP/ V.ENH SURROUND SOUND CLASS VOLUME CHANNEL T V CONTROL INPUT SHIFT VOLU ME MUTE T.EDIT PRESET PRESET AUDIO ANGLE SLEEP SUBTITLE ADAPTER PORT USB LINE TUNER ( FM/AM ) DVD/CD STANDBY /ON ZOOM DISPLAY 23 456 789 0 HOME MENU 1 2 3 ENTER 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 14 HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 14 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 15 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español SHIFT ANGLE (page 30) SHIFT ZOOM (page 30 ) 4 TOP MENU (page 19 and 30) SHIFT SETUP (page 17, 20, 41, 43, 44, 45, 51, 52 and 57) 5 SHIFT KARAOK E (page 33) SHIFT ECHO (page 33 ) SHIFT ï / SHIFT ï (p age 33) Cursor buttons ENTER TUNE (page 20) PRESET (page 20) 6 HOME MENU 7 Sound control s AUTO / STEREO (page 22 and 23) SURROUND (page 22 and 23) SOUND (page 23 a nd 24) MP3 EXP / V.ENH (page 24) 8 Playback controls (page 19 and 25 ) 9 TV CONTROL buttons These control Pioneer flat scree n TVs. 1 10 SHIFT 11 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE (page 18, 32 and 53) 12 PLAYLIST buttons (page 27 ) 13 MIC VOL /â (page 33) 14 MENU (page 19, 26 and 30) 15 RETURN 16 Tuner controls CLASS (page 21) SHIFT T.EDIT (page 20) 17 MUTE 18 VOLUME /â (page 18) Putting the bat teries in the remote control 1 Open the battery compartment cover on the back of th e remote control. 2 Insert two AA/R6 batteries into the battery compartmen t following the indication s ( ï« , ïª ) inside the compartment. 3 Close the cove r. CAUTION Incorrect use of batteries c an result in hazards such as leakage and bursting. Please observe the foll owing: ⢠Always insert batteries into the battery compartment corr ectly matching the positive ï« and nega tive ïª polarities, as shown by the display inside the compartment. ⢠Never mix new and used batteries. ⢠Batteries of the same size may have different volt ages, depending on brand. Do not mix diffe rent brands of batteries. ⢠When disposing of u sed batteries, please comply with governmental regula tions or environment al public in structionâÂÂs rul es that apply in you r country or area. Note 1 Hold down t he number button 1 for over three seconds with the CLEAR pressed. If the TV refuses to respond, hold down the number button 2 . After control is properly switched over, the power to the TV can be operated by directing the TV CONTROL ïµ toward the TV and pressing it. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 15 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 16 En ⢠In order to prevent battery lea kage, remove the batteries when not using the remote control for an extended period (one month or more). If leakage o ccurs, carefully wipe away any battery fluid inside the compartment, and replace the batteries with new ones. ⢠Do not allow books or other objects to rest on top of the remote control, since the buttons may be depressed, causing faster exhaustion of the batteries. ⢠Do not use or store batteries in direct sunlight or excessively hot plac es, such as inside a car or near a hea ter. This can cause batteries to leak, overheat, ex plode or catch fire. It can also reduce the life or performance o f batteries. Using the re mote control The remote control can be used within a range of about 7 meter s from the remote sensor on the front panel, and within a 30 degree angle. ⢠The remote control may not wor k if there is an obstacle between the rem ote control and the display unit , or if the remo te control is not directed towards the remote sensor of the di splay unit at the correct angle. ⢠The remote control may not wor k properly if strong light such as direct sunlight or fluorescent light is shining o nto the unitâÂÂs remote se nsor. ⢠The remote control may not work properly when this unit is use d near devices emitting infrared rays, or when r emote controls of other devices which use infrared rays are u sed. Also, the use of this remote control may cau se other devices to work improp erly. ⢠When the operating range of th e remote becomes too short, replace the batteries. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 16 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 17 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 4 Getting started Setting Speaker Layout Select the speaker layout for the speak er setting you arranged to your liste ning area environment. First time you switch on the system, the followin g speaker layout se tting appea rs. If you switch off the system without finishing this setting, the same appear s again next time you switch on the system. 1 Press ïµ STANDBY/ON and confirm WELCOME is shown on the display. 2 SELECT SPEAKER LAYOUT will run on the display for ab out 10 seconds. 3U s e ï©/ïª to sel ect appropriate speaker layout. There are two speaker layout mo des â 5 spot speaker layout and 3 spot spea ker layout. See Setup Guide for more details about speaker layout and mode description. ⢠5 SPOT â Optimal for 5.1 channel h ome theater sound by placing the two surround speakers in the rear of the listening position . ⢠4 SPOT (HTZ181DVD only ) â Th is is the standa rd layout for li stening to the surround sound, which is similar t o the 5 spot speaker layout. The two center speakers are separated to the right and left sides, and ne atly arranged around th e TV. ⢠3 SPOT â This is the classic layout for the Front Surround mode. The two surround speakers are placed in fron t of the liste ning position . ⢠2 SPOT (HTZ181DVD only) â This layout for the Front Surround mode is the same as the 3 spot speaker layout. The two center speakers are separated to the right and left sides, and neatl y arranged around the TV. 4 Press ENTER to confirm. 1 Setting the channel levels Set the relative chann el levels from your main listening p osition. 2 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct SOUNDSET, then press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct CH LEVEL, then press ENTER. 4U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct TESTTONE, then press ENTER. The test ton e is output in the follow ing order (from the speakers a ctive in the current listening mo de): ⢠L â Front left speaker ⢠C â Center speaker ⢠R â Front right speaker ⢠SR â Surround right speaker ⢠SL â Surround left speaker ⢠SW â Subwoofer 3 Note 1 To change the setting, press SHIFT SETUP , use ï«/ï¬ to select SYS SET , then use ï«/ï¬ to select LAYOUT to start setting procedure. 2 ⢠This is only available when DVD /CD is selected and playback is stopped. Also make sure headphones are unplugged. ⢠To adjust the overall balance while liste ning to any sound so urce you want, press SHIFT SETUP , use ï«/ï¬ to select SOUNDSET , then press ENTER . Use ï«/ï¬ to select CH LEVEL , then press ENTER . Use ï«/ï¬ to switch between channels, and ï©/ïª to adjust the channel levels. Press ENTER when youâÂÂre finished. 3 Since the subwoofer produces ultra-low frequencies its sound may seem quieter than it actually is. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 17 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 18 En 5 Use the VOLUME /â to adjust the volume to an appropriate le vel. 1 6U s e ï©/ïª to ad just the channel lev els in turn. You should h ear the test t one at the same volume from each speaker when seated in the main listening position. The channe l level range is ñ10 dB. 7 When youâÂÂre do ne, press ENTER to exit test tone setup. Using the on-screen displays For ease of use, this system makes extensive use of graphical on-scre en displays (OSDs). All the screens are nav igated in basically th e same way, using ï© , ïª , ï« , ï¬ to change the highlighted item and pressing ENTER to select it. 2 Important ⢠Throughout this m anual, âÂÂSelectâ m eans use the cursor buttons to highlight an item on-screen, then pre ss ENTER . Tip ⢠The button guide at the botto m of every OSD screen shows you which buttons youâÂÂll need to use for that screen. Playing discs The basi c playback controls for pla ying DVD, CD, Video CD/Super VCD, DivX video/WMV and WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs a re covered here. Further functions are detailed in chapte r 6. Important ⢠Throughout this manua l, the term âÂÂDVDâ means DVD-Video, DVD-R and DVD-RW. 1 If the player isnâÂÂt al ready on, switch it on. If youâÂÂr e playing a disc wi th video, also turn on your TV and make sure that it is set to the correct video input. 2 Press ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE to load a disc. Load a disc with the label side facing up, using the disc tray guide to align the disc (if youâÂÂre loading a double -sided DVD disc, load it wit h the side you want to play face down). 3 Press ï¤ (play) to start playback. If youâÂÂre playing a DVD or Video CD/Sup er VCD, a menu may appear. See DVD-Video di sc menus and Video CD /Super VCD PBC menus on page 19 to navigate these. If you loaded a disc containing JPEGs, a slideshow will start. See Playing a JPEG slideshow on page 25 for more on this. ⢠If a d isc contain s a mixture of D ivX video/ WMV and other media file types (MP3, for example), fir st select whether to play the DivX video/WMV files ( DivX / WMV ) or the other media f ile types ( MP3 / WMA / JPEG / MPEG-4 AAC ) from the on-scree n display. Note 1 When the volume is set to 51 or more, TEST TONE cannot be selected and the chan nel level setting range is restricted. In ad- dition, if the channel level range of any spea ker is set to the side, the maximum volume is also restricted. 2 The screen saver will appear after five minutes of inactivity. Button What it does HOME MENU Displays/exits the on-screen display . ï«ï©ïªï¬ Changes the highlighted menu item. ENTER Selects the highligh ted menu item. RETURN Returns to the main menu without saving changes. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 18 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 19 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español ⢠Please see Disc/content format playback compatibility on page 47 if you want to play a DualDi sc (DVD/CD hybrid disc) . 4 Adjust the volume. Use the VOLUME /â contro l. Basic playback controls The following table shows the basic controls on the remote for playing discs. 1 You can find other playback fe atures in chapter 6. Resume and Last Memory When you st op playback of a di sc, RESUME shows in the display indicating th at you can resume playback fro m that point. With DVDs and Video CD /Super VCDs, even if ejected, the play position is stored in memory. 2 The next time you load the disc, the display shows LAST MEM and you can resume playback. If you want to clear the resume point, press ï§ (stop) while RESUME is displayed. DVD-Video disc menus Many DVD-Video discs con tain menus from which you can select wh at you want to watch. Sometimes DVD-Video m enus are displayed automatically when you start playback ; others only appear whe n you press MENU or TOP MENU . Video CD/Super VCD PBC m e nus Some Vid eo CD/Supe r VCDs have me nus from which you can choose what you want to watc h. These are PBC (P layback control) menus. Note 1 You may find wit h some DVD discs that some playback controls donâÂÂt wo rk in certain parts of the disc. Button What it does ï¤ Starts/resumes normal playback. ⢠If the display shows RESUME or LAST MEM playback starts from the resume or last memory point (see Resume and La st Memory below). ïÂÂ¥ P auses/unpauses a disc. ï§ Stops playback or cancels the re sume function (if the display shows RESU ME ). ï P ress to start fast reverse scanning. ï® P ress to start fast for ward scanning. ï¯ Skips to the start of the current track or chapter , then previous tracks/chapters. ï° Skips to the next track or chapter . Numbers Use to enter a title/chapter/track number . Press ENTER to select. ⢠If the disc is stopped, playback starts from the selected title (for DV D) or track (for CD/Video CD/Super VCD). ⢠If the disc is play ing, playback jumps to the start of the selected title (VR mode DVD-R /-RW), chapter (DVD - Video) or track (CD/V ideo CD/Super VCD). 2 â¢The Resume and the Last Memory functions may not work with some discs. ⢠For DVD-Video discs ( except VR mode DVD-R/-RW), the play er stores the play position of the last five discs. Button What it does TOP MENU Displays the âÂÂtop menuâ of a DVD disc â this varies with the disc. MENU Displays a DVD disc menu â this varies with the disc and may be the same as the âÂÂtop menuâÂÂ. ï«ï©ïªï¬ Moves the cursor around the screen. ENTER Selects the current menu option. RETURN Returns to the previously displayed menu screen . Numbers Highlights a numbered menu option (some discs only). P ress ENTER to select. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 19 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 20 En You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD without having to na vigate the PBC menu by starting playback using a number button to select a trac k, rather th an the ï¤ (play) button. Listening to th e radio The tuner can receive both FM and AM broadcasts, and l ets you memorize your favorite stations so you donâ t have to manually tune in every time you wan t to listen. 1P r e s s TUNER to switch to the tuner, th en press repeatedly to select the AM or FM band. The display shows the band a nd frequency. 2 Tune to a frequency. There are three tuning modes â manual, auto, and high-speed: ⢠Manual tu ning : Press TUNE repeat edly to change the displayed frequency. ⢠Auto tuning : Press and hold TUNE until the frequency display starts to move, then release. The tuner will stop on the next station it finds. Repeat to keep searchin g. ⢠High-speed tu ning : Press and hold TUNE until the frequen cy display starts to move rapidly. Keep th e button held down until you reach the frequency you wa nt. If necessary, fine tune the frequen cy using the manual tuning method. Improving poor FM reception If youâÂÂre listening to an FM station in stereo but the reception is weak, yo u can improve the sound quality by switching to mono. 1 Tune to an FM radio station then press SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose TUNERSET then press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose FM MODE then press ENTER . 4U s e ï©/ïª to select FM MONO then press ENTER . The mono indica tor ( ) lights when the tuner is in mono rec eption mode. Select FM AUTO above to switch back to auto- stereo mode (the stereo indicator ( ) lights when receiving a stereo broadcast). Reducing AM reception noise If AM reception seems particularly poor, or the AM radio station you âÂÂre listening to seems noisy, try using th e Noise Cut feature for b etter sound quality. 1 Tune to an AM radio station then press SHIFT SETUP. 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose TUNERSET then press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose NOISECUT then pres s ENTER. 4U s e ï©/ïª to select the noi se cut mode then press ENTER. Select an effect level between 1 or 2. Memorizing stations This system can memorize up to 30 stations, stored in three banks, or classes (A, B and C) of 10 stations each . 1 Tune to an AM or FM radio station. For the FM band, select mono or auto-stereo reception as necessary. This setting is saved along with the preset. 2 Press SHIFT T.EDIT . 3 Press CLASS to select one of the three classes, then use the PRESET buttons to select the station preset you want. You can also us e the number buttons to selec t a pres et. Button What it does RETURN Displ ays the PBC menu. Numbers Selects numbered menu options. P ress ENTER to select. ï¯ Displays the previous menu page (if there is one). ï° Displays the next menu page (if there is one). HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 20 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 21 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español 4 Press ENTER . After pressing ENTER , the preset class and number stop blinking and the system memorize station. Listening t o station presets You will need to have so me presets stored to do this. 1 Make sure the TUNER function is selected. 2 Press CLASS to selec t the class i n which the channel is s tored. Press r epeatedly to cycle through classes A, B and C. 3U s e t h e PRESET b u t t o n s t o s e l e c t a s t a t i o n preset. ⢠You can also use the num ber buttons to do this. Listening to other sources You can conn ect auxiliary sources (TV, sa tellite receiver, etc.) to this unit for playback thro ugh the speaker system. See Connecting auxiliary audio components on page 40 f or more on this. ⢠To connect a USB device to th e USB terminal, see USB playback and Recordin g on page 31. ⢠HTZ280/282DVD-AP only: Bluetooth ADAPTER is selectable w hen it is plug ged and detected. See Bluetooth î ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoy ment of Mu sic on page 42 for more on this. 1 Make sure that the e x ternal source (TV, satellite recei ver, etc.) is switched on. 2 Press LINE to select the source. 3 If necessary, start playba ck of the source. Setting the sleep ti mer The sleep timer switches off the system after about an hour so you can fall asleep without worrying a bout it. 1 ⢠Press SHIFT SLEEP repeatedly to select an option then press ENTER . Choose between the follo wing options: ⢠SLP ON â Switches off after abou t an hour. The indica tor lights . ⢠SLP OFF â Cancels the sleep timer. After selecting SLP O N , you can p ress SHIFT SLEEP again to check how much time is left. Each line indicates approximately 12 minutes (remaining): Note 1 The display dims when the sleep timer is set. S L P --- -- HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 21 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Listening to your system 05 22 En Chapter 5 Listening to your system Important ⢠This unitâÂÂs audio func ti on may be restricted depending on the sound source, HDMI audio setting (page 41) or karao ke mode with the mi crophone plug ged in (page 33). In this event, the menus m ay not appear, or a message may be displayed instead (page 56). Selecting Listening mode Various listening modes are available for enjoyment of diverse soun d effects and for sound fiel d correctio n according to your preference. Depending on the spea ker layout you have chosen in the Home theater sound setup on page 6, the listening mode y ou can set differs. Read the fo llowing and p roceed with each setting. ⢠5 spot/4 spot speaker layout When you have ch osen 5 spot speaker layout, select one listening mode from the surround sound mode. See Li stening in surround s ound below. ⢠3 spot/2 spot speaker layout When you have ch osen 3 spot speaker layout which places the surround speake rs in front of you, select one listening mode from the front surround mode. See Using Front Surround on page 23. Auto li stenin g mode The Auto listening mode is the simplest way to listen to any source as it was mastered: the output from the speakers mirrors the ch annels in the source material. ⢠Press AUTO / STEREO to select the AUTO listening mode. 1 The listening mode is automa tically allotted accordi ng to the source material as shown in the table below. Listening in surround sound When you set up the system for 5 spot/4 spot speaker layout, the surround sound mode is availa ble. You can listen to stereo or mu ltichannel sources in surround sound. 2 Surround sound is generated from ster eo sources usin g one of the Dolby Pro Logic decoding modes. ⢠Press SURROUND repeatedly to selec t a listening mode. 1 The choices that appear in the display will vary accordin g to th e type of sou rce thatâÂÂs playing. ⢠STANDARD â Standard decoding mode (This mode can be selected only when the source is m ulti cha nnel) ⢠MOVIE (Dolby Pro Logi c II Movie) â Pro Logic II 5.1 channel surround sound, especially suited to movie sou rces (use with any two-channel source) Note 1 If the source is Dolby Digital or D TS, the corres ponding indicator lights in the front panel display. source 5 SPOT 4 SPOT 3 SPOT 2 SPOT two-ch STEREO STEREO multi-ch STANDARD F.SURR 2 Note that the input source must be switched to DVD/CD or USB for multichannel playback. 05_Home_thea ter.fm 22 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼ å¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂç«æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Listening to you r system 05 23 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español ⢠MUSIC (Dol by Pro Logic II Music ) â Pro Logic II 5.1 channel surro und sound, especially suited to music sources (use with an y two-chan nel source) ⢠DOLBY PL (Dol by Pro Logic) â 4.1 channel surround sound (use with any two-channel source) Using Front Surroun d The Front Surround mode and Extra Power mode are effective when DVD/CD or USB is selected as the input source and you a re using 3 spot (/2 spot only for HTZ181DVD ) speaker layout as described in Home t heater sound setup on page 6. ⢠Press SURROUND repeatedly to select a front surround mode. ⢠F.SURR â Use to provide rich surround sound effect. ⢠EXTRAPWR â Ou tputs stereo sound (in the case of multi-channel sources, down- mixed stereo soun d) from the surround speakers for powerful stereo effect. Listening in stereo You can listen to any source â stereo or multichannel â in st ereo. When playing a multichannel sourc e, all channels are downmixed to the front left/right sp eakers and the subwoo fer. â¢P r e s s AUTO/STEREO repeatedly until STEREO shows in the display . Listening with headphones When headpho nes are connected, the STEREO playback mod e starts. The listening mode cannot be changed. 1 Adjusting the bass and treble Use the bass and treble controls to adjust the overall tone. 1P r e s s SOUND . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select BASS/TRE then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to select BASS or TREBLE. 4U s e ï©/ïª to adjust the sound then press ENTER to confirm . ⢠Bass and Treble can be adjusted from âÂÂ6dB to 6dB . Using the SFC modes The SFC (So und Field Control) modes can be used with any multichannel or s tereo source fo r a variety of additional surround sound effects. 1P r e s s SOUND . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select SFC MODE then press ENTER . 3P r e s s ï©/ïª then ENTER to sele ct an SFC Sound mode. Select between OFF , LIVE , HALL , POP , ROCK , DRAMA or ACTION . Surround Speaker This illustration is 3 spot layout. For Front Surr ound mode For Extra Power mode For Front Surr ound mode For Extra Power mode For HTZ180DVD For HTZ181DVD Note 1 When you disconnect the headphones, the system reverts to the previous surround setting mode. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 23 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Listening to your system 05 24 En Boosting the bass level There are two bass modes you can use to enhance the bass in a source. 1P r e s s SOUND . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select BAS SMODE then press ENTER . 3U s e ï©/ïª to adjust the sound then press ENTER to confirm . Select between OFF , MUSIC or CINE MA . Using the MP3 Expander Reproduce the comfortable sound for compressed music (MP3, WMA , MPEG-4 AAC). ⢠Press MP3 EXP/V.ENH repeatedly to select MP3 EXP. 1 Using the Voice Enhanc er mode This mode is used for easy listening to t he spoken lines of the movies or dia logs. ⢠Press MP3 EXP/V.ENH repeatedly to select VOICE E. 2 Effective Sound (for optimum sound) With the uniquely shaped high-quality speakers su pplied with this unit, the Ef fective Sound mode enables the following Pioneer exclusive audio techno logies designed to maximize the real experience of sound original ly inherent in movie s and music. Turn on the Effective Sound mode under normal circumstances to m aximize the capabilities of thi s unit. 3 ⢠Dynamic Rang e Compressi on Resuscitates detailed sound susceptible to ambient noise to create an acoustic environment wh ere you feel as if you are right in the action. ⢠Frequen cy Characteri stic Correc tion Realize s the playback charac teristic optimized for long h ours of list ening in ad dition to th e added features of the supplied speaker unit s. 1 Press SHIFT SETUP and u se ï«/ï¬ to select SOUNDSET, then press ENTER. 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t S.FIELD then press ENTER . 3U s e ï©/ïª to adjust the setting then press ENTER to conf irm. ⢠EFFECT (Effective Sound) â Plays the sound with the characteristics opti mized for the included speakers. ⢠DIRECT (Direct Sound) â Turn s off the Effective Sound mode. Note 1 When turned on, the SFC mode will be turned off. 2 ⢠When turned on, the SFC mode will be turned off. ⢠Not applicable to the HTZ180/181DVD model - Effective only for the center cha nnel when a multi channel source is play ed . 3 The Sound Field will not affect the headphone outputs. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 24 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback features 06 25 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 6 Disc playback features Important ⢠Many of the functions covered in this chapter apply to DVD discs, Video CDs/ Super VCDs, CDs, DivX video/WM V and WMA/M P3/MPEG- 4 AAC/JPE G discs, although the exact operation of some varies sl ightly with th e kind of disc loaded. ⢠Some DVDs restrict the use of some functions (r andom or repeat, for e xample) in some or all parts of the disc . This is not a malfunction . ⢠When playing Video CD /Super VCDs, some of the functions are not available during PBC playba ck. If you want to use them, start the disc playing using a number button to select a t rack. Scanning discs You can fast-scan di scs forward or backward at various different speeds. 1 ⢠During playback, p ress ï or ï® to start scanni ng. Press repeatedly to increa se the scanning speed (shown on-screen). ⢠To resume playback, press ï¤ (play). 2 Playing in slow motion You can play DVDs, Video CD/S uper VCDs and DivX video/WMV at four different for ward slow motion speeds. DVD discs can also be played in reverse slow motion . 1 During playback, p ress ïÂÂ¥ (pause). 2 Press and hold ï³/ï± or ï²/ï´ until slow motion playback starts. Press repeatedly to change the slow motion speed (shown on-screen). ⢠To resume playback, press ï¤ (play). 2 Frame advance/frame re verse You can advance or back up DVD discs fr ame- by-frame. With Video CD /Super VCDs and DivX video/WMV you can only use fram e advance. 1 During playback, p ress ïÂÂ¥ (pause). 2P r e s s ï³/ï± or ï²/ï´ to reverse or advance a frame at a time. ⢠To resume playback, press ï¤ (play). 2 Playing a JPEG slideshow After loading a disc cont aining JP EG pictures, press ï¤ to start a slideshow from the first folder/pict ure on the disc. 3 The player displays the p ictures in each f o lder in al phabetical order. ⢠If the disc contains WMA/MP3/M PEG-4 AAC files, playback of the slideshow an d audio fil es repeats. During au dio playback, you can st ill use the sk ip ( ï¯ /ï° ), scan ( ïÂÂ/ ï® ) and pause ( ïÂÂ¥ ) functions. Pictures are automatically a djusted so that they fill as much of the screen as possible. Note 1 Only one speed is availabl e for DivX video/WMV dis cs. 2 ⢠Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatica lly resume when a new chapter is reached on a DVD disc. ⢠For Video CDs/Super VCDs in PBC mode and WMA/MP3 /MPEG-4 AAC tracks ( in Scan mo de only) normal p layback re sumes when you reach the beginning or the end of track. 3 ⢠The time it takes for the player to lo ad a file increases with large file sizes. ⢠Discs can contain up to 299 folders an d up to 648 folders and files combined. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 25 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback featur es 06 26 En While the slideshow is running: Browsing DVD or Video CD/ Super VCD discs with the Disc Navigator Use the Disc Navigator to browse through the contents of a D VD or Video C D/Super VCD disc to find the part you want to play. 1 During pl ayback, press HOME MENU and select âÂÂDisc Navigatorâ from the on- screen menu. 2 Selec t a view option. The options available depend on the kind of disc loaded and whether the disc is playing o r not, but includ e: ⢠Title â Titles from a DVD-Video disc. ⢠Chapter â Chapters from the current title of a DVD-Video disc. ⢠Track â Tracks from a Video CD /Super VCD disc. ⢠Time â Thumbnails from a Vi deo CD/Super VCD disc at 10 minute interva ls. ⢠Original: Ti tle â Origina l titles from a VR mode DVD-R/-RW disc. ⢠Playlis t: Title â Pl aylist titles from a VR mode DVD-R/-RW disc. ⢠Original: Ti me â Thum bnails from the Original content at 10 minu te intervals. ⢠Playli st: Time â Thumbnails from the Playlist at 10 minute interva ls. The screen shows up to six moving thumbnail images displayed one after a nother. To display the previous/next six thumbnails, press ï¯ / ï° . 3 Select the thumbnail image for what you want to play. You can use either ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to select a thumbnail, or the number buttons. To select using the number buttons, enter a two-digit number then press ENTER . Button What it does ïÂÂ¥ P auses the slideshow (or audio); press again to restart. ï¯ Jumps to the previous picture (or audio file with audio playback). ï° Jumps to the next picture (or audio file with audio playback). ï«/ï¬/ ï©/ïª P auses the slideshow and rotates/flips the displayed picture (P ress ï¤ (play) to restart slideshow). SHIFT ZOOM P auses the slideshow and zooms the picture. P ress again to toggle between 1x, 2x and 4x zoom (P ress ï¤ (play) to restart slideshow). MENU Displays the Disc Nav igator screen (see below). Disc Navigator Disc Navigator Title Chapter 01 04 02 05 03 06 Disc Navigator: Title 01- 49: - - HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 26 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback features 06 27 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Browsing Windows Media TM Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG-4 AAC, DivX video/WMV and JPEG files with the Disc Navigator Use the Disc Navigator to find a particular file or folder b y filename. 1 Press HOME MENU and select âÂÂDisc Navigatorâ from the on-screen menu. 2U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to navigate. Use ï©/ïª t o m o v e u p a n d d o w n t h e f o l d e r / f i l e l i s t . Use ï« to return to the parent folder. 1 Use ENTER or ï¬ to open a highlighted folder. ⢠When a JPEG f ile is highli ghted, a thumbnail image is displayed on the right. 3 To pla y the high lighted t rack or DivX video/WMV file o r displa y the highlighted JPEG fil e, press ENTER. ⢠When a WMA/MP3/M PEG-4 AAC or DivX video/WMV f ile is selected , playback begins from that file, and continues until the end of the folder. ⢠When a JPEG file is select ed, a slideshow begins, starting with th at file, and continues to the end of the folder. Tip ⢠You can also p lay a JPEG slideshow while list ening to WMA/ MP3/MPEG -4 AAC playback. Simply select the audio file you want to listen to follow ed by the JPEG from which you want the slideshow to start. Playback of both the slideshow and the audio file s repeats. Playba ck controls a re effective for the JPEG slideshow o nly. ⢠To play the co ntents of the whole disc rather than just the curren t folder, exit the Disc Naviga tor and start play back using the ï¤ (play) button. Using Playlists With this featu re, you can make up to three playlists of 30 files each for discs containing WMA, MP3, MPEG -4 AAC and JPEG files. Since this u nit will rememb er all playlists f or the last ten discs you have loaded, this is useful if you have a large nu mb er of files that you want to organize quickly and easily. 2 Programming play lists 1 With the disc stoppe d, press HOME MENU and select âÂÂDisc Navigatorâ from the on-screen menu. 2 Select the file you want to add to the playlist. See Browsing Windows Media TM Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG- 4 AAC, DivX video/WMV and JPEG files with the Disc Navi gator above if yo u donâÂÂt know how to do this. 3P r e s s PLAYLIST 1, 2 or 3. The file is added to the playlist you select. 4 Repeat steps 2 and 3 until youâÂÂr e done. Note 1 You can also do this by going to the â .. â folder at the top, then pressing ENTER . 00:00 / 00:00 0kbps Folder1 Folder2 Folder3 Folder4 File1 File2 File3 File4 File5 Folder 2 00:00 / 00:00 0kbps 2 The dis c must be loaded for th e f iles in your playlist to play back. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 27 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback featur es 06 28 En Tip ⢠To add files without the on-screen display, simply press PLAYLIST 1 , 2 or 3 during normal playback of the file you want (except when a JPEG slideshow is playing at the same time as audio). Listening to playlists ⢠With playback stop ped, p ress PLAYLIST 1, 2 or 3. During playback, PGM lights in the front panel display. If no playlist has been progra mmed, NO LIST shows in the display. ⢠If the playlist contains both JPEG and audio files, pla yback of the slideshow and audio files starts. Clearing files from a playlist 1 Start playback of your playlist. 2 From the âÂÂDisc N avigatorâ screen, highlight the file you want to remove from the playlist and press CLEAR . Looping a section of a disc The A-B Repeat function allows you to specify two points (A and B) withi n a track (CD, Video CD/Super VC D) or title (DVD ) that form a lo op which is played over and over. 1 During playback, press HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂA-B RepeatâÂÂ. 3P r e s s ENTER on âÂÂA(S tart Point)â t o set the loop start point. 4 Press ENTER on âÂÂB(End Point)â to set the loop end point. After pressing ENT ER , playback jumps back to the start point and plays the loop. 5 To resume normal playback, select âÂÂOffâÂÂ. Using repeat play In addition to variou s repeat play options, itâÂÂs also possible to use repeat play t o gether with program play (see Creating a program list on page 29). 1 During playback, press HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂRepeatâ then select a repeat play opti on. 1 If program play is active, select Program Repeat to repeat the program list, or Repeat Off to cancel. ⢠For DVD discs, select Title Rep eat or Chapter Repeat . ⢠For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select Disc Repeat or Track Repeat . ⢠For DivX video/WMV discs, select Title Repeat (or Repeat O ff ). Using random play Use this function to play tit les or chapters (DVD-Video) or tracks (CD and Video CD/Super VCD) in a random order. 2 1 During playback, press HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂRandomâ then select an option. ⢠For DVD discs, select Random Title or Random Cha pter . ⢠For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select On or Off to switch rando m play on or off. Play Mode Note 1 You canâÂÂt use repeat play with WMA/MP3/ M PEG-4 AAC discs. 2 ⢠You can set the random play option when a disc is pla ying or stopped. Ho wever, you canâÂÂt use random play together with program play. ⢠You canâÂÂt use random play with VR form at DVD- R/-RW discs, WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs, DivX video/WMV discs, or while a DVD disc menu is being displayed. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 28 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback features 06 29 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Tip ⢠Use the following contro ls during random play: ⢠Rando m play remains in e ffect until you select Random Off from the r andom play menu options. Creating a program list This feature lets you progra m the play order of titles/chapters/tracks on a disc. 1 1 During playback, press HOME M ENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂProgramâ then select âÂÂCreate/Editâ from the li st of program op tions. 3U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to selec t a title, ch apter or track for the current step in the progr am list. ⢠For a D VD disc, you can add a title or a chapter. ⢠For a CD or Vide o CD/Super VCD, select a track to add to the program list. After pressing ENTER to select the title/ chapter/track, the step number automa tically moves down one. 4 Repeat step 3 to build up a program list. A program list ca n contain up to 24 steps. ⢠You can insert steps by just hi ghlighting the position where you wa nt the new step to appear and entering a title/chapter/track number . ⢠To delete a step, highlight it and press CLEAR . 5 To play the program list , press ï¤ (play). Program play remains a ctive until you turn off program play (see below), erase the progra m list (see below), eject the disc or switch off. Tip ⢠Use the fo llowing con trols during program play: Other functions available from the program menu There are a number of o ther options in the program m enu in addi tion to Crea te/Edit. ⢠Playback Start â St arts playbac k of a saved program list ⢠Playback Stop â Tur ns off program pl ay, but does not erase the program list ⢠Program Delete â Erases the program list and tu rns off program play Searching a disc You can sear ch DVD disc s by title or chapter number, or by time; CD s and Video C D/Super VCDs by tra ck number or time; DivX video / WMV discs by time. 1P r e s s HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂSearch ModeâÂÂ. The search op tions that appea r depend on the kind of disc loaded. 3 Select a search mo de. ⢠The disc must be playing in order to use time search. Button What it does ï° Selects a new track/title/chapter at random. ï¯ Returns to the beginning of the current track/title/chapter; further presses select another random track/title/chapter. Note 1 You canâÂÂt use Program play with VR format DVD-R/-RW discs, WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs, DivX video/WMV discs, or while a DVD disc menu is being displayed. Button What it does HOME MENU Save the program list and exit without starting playback. ï° Skip to the next step in the program list. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 29 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback featur es 06 30 En 4 Use the number b uttons to enter a title, chapter or track number, or a ti me. ⢠For a time search, en ter the numbe r of minutes and seconds into the currently playing title (DVD/DivX video/WMV) or track (CD/Video CD/Supe r VCD) you want playback to resume from. For example, press 4 , 5, 0 , 0 to have playback start from 45 minutes into the disc. For 1 ho ur, 20 minutes and 30 seconds, press 8 , 0 , 3 , 0 . 5P r e s s ENTER to start play back. Switching subtitles Some DVD discs and DivX video discs have subtitles in one or more languag e s; the disc box will usually tell you which subtitle languages are ava ilable. You can switch subtitle language during pl ayback. 1 â¢P r e s s SHIFT SUBTITLE repeatedly to select a subtitle opt ion. ⢠To set subtitle preferences, see Language settings on page 36. â¢S e e Displaying DivX subtitle fil es on page 48 for more on DivX subtitles. Switching language/audio channels When playing discs recorded with dialogue in two or more lan guages, or with dual-mono audio 2 you can switch th ese during playback. 3 When playing a Video CD/Super VCD, you can switch between stereo, just the left channel or just the rig ht channel. â¢P r e s s SHIFT AUDIO repeatedly to select an audio language optio n. ⢠To set audio language preferences, see Language settings on page 36. Zooming the screen Using the zoom fea ture you can magnify a part of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, wh ile watching a DVD, DivX video/WMV title o r Video CD/Super VCD or playing a JPEG disc . 1 During playback, press SHIFT ZOOM to select the zoom factor (Nor mal, 2x or 4x). 2U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ to change the zoomed area. You can chan ge the zoom factor and the zoomed area freely during pla yback. 4 Switching camera angles Some DVD discs feature scenes shot from two or more angles â check the disc box for details. When a multi-a ngle scene is playing, a icon appears on screen (this can be switched off if you prefer â see Display settings on page 37). ⢠During playb ack (or when paused), press SHIFT ANGLE to switch angle. Displaying disc information Various track, chapter and title information can be displayed on-screen during playback. ⢠To show/switch/hide t he information displayed, press DISPLAY repeatedly. Limited disc information also appears in the front panel display. Press DISPLAY to change the displa yed information . Note 1 Some discs only allow you to change subtitle language from the disc menu. Pr ess TOP MENU or MENU to access. 2 Some Super VCDs have two soundtracks. With these discs you can switch between the two soundtracks as well as individual channels in each. 3 Some discs only allow you to change audio language from the disc menu. Press TOP MENU or MENU to access. 4 ⢠Since DVD, Video CD/Super VCD, DivX video/WMV title an d JPEG pictures have a fixed resolution, picture quality will deteriorate, especially at 4x zoom. This is not a malfunction. ⢠If the navigation square at the top of the screen disappears, press SHIFT ZOOM again to display it. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 30 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
USB playback and Recording 07 31 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 7 USB playback and Recording Using the USB interface It is possible to listen to two-channel audio 1 and watch DivX video/WMV/JPEG file s using the USB interface on th e front of this un it. Connect a USB mass storage device 2 as shown below. 1 With the player switched on, press USB. Make sure your TV is on and set to the correct video inpu t. 2 Connect your U SB device. The USB term inal is located on the front panel. 3 Press ï¤ (play) to start playback. If your USB device contains JPEGs, a slideshow will start. See Playing a JP EG slideshow on page 25 for more on this. â¢M a k e s u r e USB DATA is show ing in the front panel displa y (or the system is in standby) when disconnecting. Important If a USB ERR message lights in the display, it may mean that the power requirements of the USB device are too high for this player, or that the device is incompatib le. Try the fo llowing: ⢠Switch the player o ff, then on again. ⢠Reconnecting the USB device with th e player switched off. ⢠Selecting to another input source (like DVD/CD ), then back to USB . ⢠Using a de dicated AC adap ter (supplied with the de vice) for USB pow er. If this doesnâÂÂt remedy the problem, it i s likely your USB device is inc ompatible. Recording the tracks of a music CD on a USB device The tracks of a music CD load ed in this unit can be recorded on a USB connected to the USB port. Recording all the tracks 1 Load the music CD. Press ï§ to stop playback. Note 1 This includes playback of DivX video/WMV/WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC files (except files with copy-protection or restricted playback). 2 ⢠Compatible USB devices include external magnetic hard driv es, portable flash memory (particularly key drives) and digital audio players (MP3 players) o f format FAT 16/32. It is not possible to connect this unit to a person al computer for USB playback . ⢠Pioneer cannot guarantee compatibility (operation and/or bu s power) with all USB mass storage devices and assumes no responsibility for any loss of data that may occur when connected to this unit. ⢠With la rge amounts of da ta, it may take lo nger for the syste m to read the cont ents of a USB device . ⢠Some USB devices may not be properly recognized. ⢠Even when they are in a s upported format, some files may not play or display depending on the content. USB USB USB mass sto rage device USB (Type A) HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 31 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
USB playback and Recording 07 32 En 2P r e s s SHIFT USB REC to displa y the âÂÂCD -> USB Recâ screen. 3P r e s s ENTER to start r ecording. Recording starts. T h e screen shown below is displayed during recording. 1 Recording specific tracks 1 Load the musi c CD. Press ï§ to stop playback. 2 Press HOME MENU and select âÂÂCD ->USB RecâÂÂ. CD -> USB Rec can onl y be se lected whe n the music CD is stopped. 3 Make setting usin g ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ an d ENTER . 4 Select the track you want to record. ⢠Individu al â Select on e track at a time. ⢠Select All â Select all the track s. ⢠All Clear â Clear all selected tracks. 5 Select the bit rate (transfer rate). Select 128 kbps , 192 kbps or 320 kb ps . 6S e l e c t â Startâ using the ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ , then press ENTER . 2 Recording starts. Note 1 Recording cannot be started if ther e is not enough free space on the USB device. In this case, âÂÂAvailable USB space is lowâ is displayed. CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack To t a l T i m e T rack 1âÂÂ13 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 3 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 4 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 5 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 6 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 7 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 8 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 13 ï¦ï 055:07 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack To t a l T i m e î 13 î 055:07 Cancel î 01:43 î 03:17 î 04:18 î 04:59 î 04:20 î 04:38 î 04:40 î 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î î Tr a ck 0 1 î î Tr a ck 0 2 î î Tr a ck 0 3 î î Tr a ck 0 4 î î Tr a ck 0 5 î î Tr a ck 0 6 î î Tr a ck 0 7 î î Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD â > USB Rec Start Selected T rack To t a l T i m e ï¦ï 00 ï¦ï 000:00 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 Tr a ck 0 1 Tr a ck 0 2 Tr a ck 0 3 Tr a ck 0 4 Tr a ck 0 5 Tr a ck 0 6 Tr a ck 0 7 Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec 2 ⢠When recording is finished, a folder named âÂÂPIONEERâ is cr eated automatically on the USB device. The recorded tra cks are stored in this folder. ⢠Up to 99 âÂÂPIONEERâ folders can be created. ⢠Recording is not possible if t he US B device contains 300 folders or more. ⢠When recording on a USB device is under wa y, all DVD-rela ted key operations are disabled except for the operation of ïµ STANDBY/ON and ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE buttons and switchover of the funct ions. ⢠When the sleep timer is ON, it is cancelled once recording on a USB device is started. Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 01 ï¦ï 003:17 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 Tr a ck 0 3 Tr a ck 0 4 Tr a ck 0 5 Tr a ck 0 6 Tr a ck 0 7 Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Select T rack Bitrate ï§ î 128kbps 192kbps 320kbps ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack To t a l T i m e T rack 1âÂÂ13 î Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 î Tr a ck 0 3 î Tr a ck 0 4 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 5 î Tr a ck 0 6 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 7 î Tr a ck 0 8 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack To t a l T i m e ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Cancel ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 î Tr a ck 0 3 î Tr a ck 0 4 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 5 î Tr a ck 0 6 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 7 î Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec 07_playing usb.f m 32 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂç« æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Singing karaoke 08 33 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 8 Singing karaoke Singing karaoke Using the kara oke features you can plug in a microp hone and mix th e sound of your own voice with a backing track. 1 You can sele ct a backing tr ack from audio s ources such as CDs , DVDs, VCDs or USB devices. Adju st the microphone level rela tive to the backing track. 1 Plug in the microp hone(s). If youâÂÂre only using on e mic, plug it into the MIC (MAIN) jack. The MIC (SUB) jack can be used only if MIC (MAIN) is also connected. ⢠If the microphone ha s an on/off switch, make sure itâÂÂs on. 2 Load a karaoke backing di sc. You can al so use track s on a USB device as source material for a bac king track. 3 Adjust KARAOKE mode settings. ⢠Press SHIFT KARAOKE to turn KARAOKE mode on or off for di scs that have vocals on both Left and Right channels: KARAOKE (Vocal Fade) â Vocals in the backing tra ck are partially elimin ated. OFF (default) â Switches the Karaoke mo de off. â¢P r e s s SHIFT AUDIO to switch between audio channels (except Data discs and USB sources) with discs that have vocal tracks on only one channel: Left â Left channel only. Use for tracks that have a vocal recorded in the righ t channel. Right â Right channel only. Use for tracks that have a vocal recorded in the left ch annel. STEREO â Switches the Karaoke mode off. 4 Play the backing track. 5 Adjust the MIC VOL /â to get the sound you want. 2 To avoid unple asant feedback, make su re you donâÂÂt point the micropho ne(s) at the speakers. 3 Changing the vocal mix Adding some effects to the microphone mix can sometimes impro ve the overall sound. 4 You can choose between th ree echo levels. ⢠To add effects to t he microphone mix, press SHIFT ECHO. Pressing repeatedly switches between echo levels 1 to 3 and off. Changing the backing track You may want to lower or raise the pitch of the backing track to match your vocal range. 5 â¢P r e s s SHIFT ï or SHIFT ï to lower or raise the pitch of the backing track. Note 1 ⢠These features are only possible when a microphone is connected. If you try to use SHIFT KARAOKE , SHIFT ECHO , SHIFT ï , SHIFT ï or MIC VOL when no mic is connected, a NO MIC error message is displayed. Also note that during DVD playback, when you connect a mic sound se ttings are automatically switched to STEREO playback and the player downmixes multichannel sources to 2.1 channels. ⢠These features are only a vailab le with the DVD/CD or USB input functions. MAIN SUB MIC 2 MIC VOL is set to 0 when you remove the microp hone, change the function or turn the power off . 3 Depending on the microphone level, the sound of the disc may distort. If this happens, turn down the volume. 4 You cannot adjust SFC modes, tone co ntrols (bass, tr eble, and bass boost), Extr a Power mode, Front Surround mode, MP3 Expander mode or Voice Enhancer mo de when a microphone is plugged in. 5 This feature is not compatible with DTS signals. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 33 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Audio Settings and Video Adjust menus 09 34 En Chapter 9 Audio Settings and Video Adjust menus Audio Sett ings menu The Audio Settings me nu offers features for adjusting the way discs sound. 1P r e s s HOME MENU and select âÂÂAudi o Settingsâ from the on-screen display. 2 Select and change settings u sing ï©/ïª/ ï«/ï¬ and ENTER . Audio DRC â¢S e t t i n g s : High , Medium , Lo w , Off (default) When watching Dolby Digital DVDs at low volume, itâÂÂs easy to lose the quiet e r sounds complete ly â including some of th e dialog. Switching Audio DRC (Dynamic Range Control) to on can help by bringing up the quieter sounds, while control ling loud peaks. How much of a difference yo u hear depends on the material youâÂÂre listening to. I f the material doesnâÂÂt have wide varia tions in volume, you may not noti ce much chang e. 1 Video Adj u st menu From the Video Adjust scre en you can adjust settings that affe ct picture pres entation. 1 Press HOME M ENU and sel ect âÂÂVi deo Adjustâ from th e on-screen display. 2 Make settings usi ng ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER . You can adjust the following settings: ⢠Sharpness â Adjusts the sharpness of edges in the picture ( Fine , Standard , Soft ) ⢠Brightness â Adjusts the o verall brightness ( âÂÂ20 to 20 ) ⢠Contrast â Adjusts the contrast between light and dark ( âÂÂ16 to 16 ) ⢠Gamma â Adjusts the âÂÂwarmthâ of the picture ( High, Medium, Low, Off ) ⢠Hue â Adjusts the red/green balance ( Gree n 9 to Red 9 ) ⢠Chroma Level â Adjusts how saturat ed colors appear ( âÂÂ9 to 9 ) Adjust the Brightne ss, Contrast, Hue an d Chroma Leve l settings using ï«/ï¬ . 3 Press ENTER to return to th e Video Adjust screen, or HOME MENU to exit. Note 1 Audio DRC is only effective wit h Dolby Digital audio sources. Audio Settings Audio Settings Audio DRC High Medium Low Off Video Adjust Sharpness Brightness Contrast Gamma Hue Chroma Level Standard 0 0 Off 0 0 î î î î î î Video Adjust Brightness min max 0 HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 34 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 35 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 10 Initial Settings menu Using the Initial Settings menu The Initia l Setting s menu provid es audio a nd video outp ut settings, pa rental lock settings, and display settings, among others. If an option i s grayed out it means that it cannot be changed at the current time. This is usual ly because a disc is playing. Stop the disc, then change the setting. 1P r e s s DVD/CD . 2 With playback stop ped, press HOME MENU and select âÂÂInitial Setti ngsâÂÂ. 3U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to select the setting and option you want to set. All the settings and op tions are explained on the foll owing pages . 1 Video Output set tings Note 1 ⢠In the table, the default setting is shown in bold : other settings are shown in italics . ⢠Some settings, such as T V Screen , Audio Language and Subtitle Language may be overridden by the DVD disc. Often these settings can also be made fro m the DVD disc menu. ⢠The HDMI Resolution and HDMI Color settings only need to be set if you connected t his player to a n HD MI-compatible component using the HDMI connector. 2 This setting can only be used when you are connect ed via HDMI and have the HDMI resolution set to 1920x1080p, 1920x1080i or 1280x720p. When using this setting, only the HDMI connection is available. Initial Settings Setting Option What it means TV Screen (See also Screen sizes and disc formats on page 51.) 4:3 (Letter Box) Set if you have a conventional 4:3 TV. Widesc reen movies are shown with black bars top and bottom. 4:3 (Pan & Scan) Set if you have a conventional 4:3 TV. Widescreen mov ies are shown with the sides cropped so that the image fills the screen. 16:9 (Wide) Set if you have a widescreen TV. 16:9 (Compressed) Set if you have a widescreen TV. 4:3 material is shown with black bars on either side of the screen. 2 Component Out (See also Connecting auxiliar y audio comp onent s on page 40 .) Interlac e Set if your T V is no t compa tib le with progressive scan video. Progressive Set if yo ur TV is compatible wi th progressive scan video (see your TVâÂÂs instruction manual for details). Press ENTER once more to confirm (or RETURN to cancel). Note that pro gressive s can vide o is on ly output from the component vide o jacks. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 35 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 36 En Language settings HDMI Resolution* (See Connecting using HDMI on page 41.) * Default cha n ges with TV format (PAL/N TSC). 1920x1080p Set if your TV supports 1920 x 1080 pixel progressive-scan video. 1920x1080i Set if your TV supports 1920 x 1080 pi xel interlace video. 1280x720p Set if your TV supports 1280 x 720 pixel progressive-scan v ideo. 720x480p (NTSC)/ 720x576p (PAL) Set if your TV supports 720 x 480 (NTS C)/720 x 576 (PAL) pixel progressive-scan video. 720x480i (NTSC)/ 720x576i (PAL) Set if your TV supports 720 x 480 (NTS C)/720 x 576 (PAL) pixel interlace video. HDMI Color* (See Connecting using HDMI on page 41.) * Default changes dependin g on device connected. Full range RGB If colors are weak, this gives br ighter colors and deeper black (default setting for HDMI-compatible DVI devices). RGB Use this setting if colors appear over ly rich on the Full Range RGB setting. Component Outputs 8-bit component video format (default setting for HDMI-compatible devices). Setting Opt ion Wh at it means Audio Language E n glish If there is an English soundtrac k on the disc, it is played. Languages as displayed If there is a language selected on the disc, it is played. Othe r Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see Using the language code list on page 57). Subtitle Language English If there are English subtitles on the disc they are displaye d. Languages as displayed The subtitle language sele cted on the disc is displayed. Othe r Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see Using the language code list on page 57). DVD Menu Language w/Subtitle La ng. DVD disc menus are displayed in the same language as your selected subtitle language, if possible. Languages as displayed DVD menus are displayed in the selec ted language, if possible. Othe r Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see Using the language code list on page 57). Subtitle Display On Subtitles are displayed in your selected subtitle language. Off Subtitles are always off by defa ult when you play a DVD disc. Setting Opt ion Wh at it means HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 36 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 37 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Display settings Options settings Speakers settings Parental Lock ⢠Default level: Off ; Default password: none ; Default Coun try/Area code: us (2119) To give you some control ov er what your children watch on your DVD player, some DVD- Video discs feature a Parent al Lock level. If your player is set to a lower level than the disc, the disc wonâÂÂt play. Some discs also supp ort the Country/Area Code feature. The player does not play certain scenes on these discs, depending on th e Country/Area Code yo u set. Registering a new passw ord Register a password to change the Parental Lock level or enter a Country/Area code. 1 1 Select âÂÂPasswordâÂÂ. 2 Use the number butt ons to input a fo ur- digit password then press ENTER . Changing your password To change your password, confirm your existing password then enter a new one. 1 Select âÂÂPassword ChangeâÂÂ, input your existing password, then press ENTER . 2 Enter a new password and press ENTER . Setting Option What it means OSD Language English On-screen displays ar e shown in English. Languages as displayed On-screen displays are shown in the language selected. Angle Indicator On A camera ic on is displayed on-screen during multi-angle scenes on a DVD disc. Off No multi-angle indication is shown. Setting Option What it means Parent al Lock â See Parental Lock below. DivX(R) VOD Display See About DivX î VOD content below. Setting Option What it means Speaker Dista nce â Specify th e distanc e of your sp eakers from your list ening position (see Speaker Distance on page 39). Note 1 ⢠Not all discs use Parental Lock, and will play without requiring the password first. ⢠If you forget your password, youâÂÂll need to reset the player to register a new password (see Res etting the system on page 57). Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD Passw ord Level Change Country Code Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 37 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 38 En Setting/changing the Parent al Lock 1 Select âÂÂLevel ChangeâÂÂ. 2 Use number buttons to ent er your password, then press ENTER . 3 Select a new lev el and press ENTER . ⢠Press ï« repeatedly to l ock more levels (more discs will require the password); press ï¬ to u nlock levels. You canâÂÂt lock level 1. Setting/changing the Country/Area code You can f ind the Country/Area code list on page 58. 1 Select âÂÂCountry Co deâÂÂ, input yo ur password, then press ENTER . 2 Select a Country/Area code then press ENTER . There are two ways yo u can do this: ⢠Select by code let ter: Use ï©/ïª to change the Country/Area code. ⢠Select by code number: Press ï¬ then use the number buttons to enter the four-digit Country/Area code. The new Country/Area code takes effect after ejecting the disc once. About DivX î VOD content In order to play DivX VOD (video on demand) content on this pla yer, you first need to register the player with your DivX VO D content provider. You do this by generating a DivX VOD registration code, which you submit to you r provider. 1 Important ⢠DivX VOD content is protected by a DRM (Digital Rights Management) sy stem. This restricts playback of content to specific, registered devices. ⢠If you load a disc tha t contains DivX VOD content not authorized for your pla yer, the message Authorization Error is displayed and the content will not play. Displaying your Di vX VOD registration code 1 Press HOM E MENU and sele ct âÂÂInitial SettingsâÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂOptio nsâÂÂ, then âÂÂDivX (R) VODâÂÂ. 3 Select âÂÂDispl ayâÂÂ. Your eight-digit registrati on code is displayed. Make a note of the code as you will need it when you register with a D ivX VOD provider. Playing Di vX î VOD content Some DivX VOD con tent may only be playable for a fixed nu mber of times . When you load a disc containing th is type of DivX VOD content, the remainin g numbe r of plays i s shown on-s creen and you then have the option of playing the disc (thereby using up one of the remaini ng plays), or stopping. If you lo ad a disc that contains exp ired DivX VOD content (for exa mple, content that has zero remain ing pl ays), the message Rental Expired is displayed. If your DivX VOD content allows an un limited number of plays, th en you may load th e disc into your player and pla y the content as often as you like , and no message will be displayed. Note 1 Resetting the player (as described in Resetting th e system on page 57) will not cause you to lose your registration code. Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Display Initial Settings Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 38 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 39 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Speaker D istance â¢D e f a u l t s e t t i n g : 3.0m To get the best surround sound from your system, you should set up the speakers equal distances from your listening position. 1 Press HOME MENU and select âÂÂInitial SettingsâÂÂ. 2 Select â Speaker sâÂÂ, then âÂÂSpe aker Distance âÂÂ. 3U s e ï©/ïª to select a speak er. 4P r e s s ï¬ to change the speaker distance for the highlighted speaker. 5U s e ï©/ïª to change the distance. ⢠When you change the distance settings of the front left ( L ) or front right (R ) speake rs, all the other speaker distances ch ange relative to it. â¢F r o n t l e f t / r i g h t ( L / R ) speaker di stances ca n be set from 30 cm to 9 m in 30 cm increments. 1 ⢠The center speaker ( C ) can be set from âÂÂ2.1 m to 0 m relative to the front left/right speakers. ⢠Surround left/right ( SL /SR ) speakers can be set from âÂÂ6.0 m to 0 m relative to the front left/right speakers. 2 â¢T h e s u b w o o f e r ( SW ) c a n b e s e t f r o m â 2 . 1 m to 0 m relative to th e front left/right speakers. 6P r e s s ï« to go back to the speaker list if you want to modify a nother speaker, or press ENTER to exit the Speaker Distance screen. Note 1T h e L and R speakers are paired; you canâÂÂt set them differently. 2 Make sure to set them the same distance when using the Ex tr a Power mode (page 23). Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Speaker Distance Initial Settings Video Output Language Display Options Speakers L C R SR SL SW 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 39 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 40 En Chapter 11 Other connections Important ⢠When making or changing co nnections on th e rear panel of this unit, be sure to switch power off and disconnect the power cord from the wall socket. After completing all c onnections, connec t the power cord to the wall socket. Connecting auxiliary audio components Using the stereo analog inputs, you can connect an external c omponent su ch as a tape deck or MD player f or playback through this system. For the connection diagram , see 1 above. ⢠Connect the ANALOG AU DIO IN ( LINE 1) jacks to the analog outputs of an external playback component. Connec t using RCA pin- plug stereo cables. AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R L R FRONT CENTER R SURROUND SUB WOOFER A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP Y P B P R ADAPTER PORT VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO 5 m to 6 m From audio output From audio output To HDMI input To component input P AL connecto r Outdoo r antenna Indoo r antenna (vinyl-coated wi re) Bluetooth î ADAPTER KURO LINK -com p atible P ionee r flat sc reen TV Ta p e deck, etc. TV AM loo p antenna 11_Other con nections.fm 40 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ã 水æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 41 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Connecting usin g the component video out put If your TV has component vi deo inputs, y ou can use these ins tead of the sta ndard video outputs for a better quality picture. 1 For the connection diagr am, see 2 on page 40. ⢠Use a compo nent video cable to connect the COMPONEN T VIDEO OUT to a set of component inputs on you r TV. About progressive scan video Compared to interlace video, progressive scan video effectively doubles the scanning rate of the picture, resulting in a very stable, flicker- free image. Progressive scan video is available only from the co mponent video output. Compatibility of this player with progressive-scan and high-definition TVs. ⢠This player is compatible wit h progressive video Macro Vision System Copy Guard. 2 Connecting usin g HDMI If you have a HDM I or DVI (with HDCP) equipped monitor or display, you can co nnect it to this player usin g a commercially ava ilable HDMI cable for high quality digital video. 3 For the connection diagr am, see 3 on page 40. ⢠Use an HDMI cable to connect the HDMI OUT inte rconnect on this player to an HDMI interconnect on a HDMI-compatible display. ⢠The arrow on the cable con nector body should be face down for correct alignment with the connecto r on the player. You can also adjust the HDMI se ttings for resolution and color. F or more on these settings s ee Video Output settings on page 35. Switching the HDMI audio setting You can sele ct the system speaker o r the TV through t he HDMI to output the audio sound of the DVD/CD or USB fu nction. 4 You cannot use a number of sound func ti ons of this system when HDMI audio is set to TV . 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select HDMI SET then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose HDMI MODE then press ENTER . 4U s e ï©/ïª to choose the setting you want then press ENTER . ⢠AMP â Output Audio sound of th e DVD/CD and USB function signal from this system. Note 1 ⢠The component video outp ut is switchab le between interlaced and progressive formats. See Video Output settings on page 35. ⢠While the player is connected using HDMI cable, the component video output cannot be switched between Interlace and Progressive formats. When H DMI Resolution is set to 720x480i (NTSC)/720x5 76i (PAL) , Interlace format is automatically selected, and Progressive format is automatically selected in other settings. 2 Consumers should note that not all high-definition televisi on sets are fully compatible with this product and may cause artifacts to be displayed in the picture. In case of 525 progressi ve scan picture problems, it is recommended that the user swi tch the connection to the âÂÂstandard definitionâ output (Interlace). If there are questions regarding our TV set compatibility with this model, please contact our customer service center. 3 ⢠An HDMI connection can only be made with DVI-equipped components compatible with both DVI and High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP). If you choose to connect to a DVI connect or, you will need a separate adaptor (DVI ï¤ HD MI) to do so. A DVI connectio n, however, does not support audi o signa ls. Cons ult your local au dio dealer for more informa t ion. ⢠Depending on the component you have connected, using a DV I con nection may result in unreliable signal transfers. ⢠When you change the component connected to the HDMI output , you will also need to change the HDMI settings to match the new component (see Video Output settings on page 35 to do this). 4 It is not possible to switch this setting when KURO LINK setti ng is ON and flat screen TV is in synchronized amp mode. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 41 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 42 En ⢠TV â Output Audio sound of the DVD/CD and USB func tion signal fro m a TV or flat screen TV. 1 Resetting the HDMI co nnection If you get an error message (the d isplay shows HDMI ERR ) or if the screen goes blank (for example, after changin g the resolution), check the troubleshooting guide o n page 53. If this doesnâÂÂt solve the problem, follo w the steps below to reset the HDMI connection. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select INITIAL then pr ess ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose HDMIINIT then press ENTER . 4P r e s s ENTER while INIT O K is blinking. The system will restart and the HDMI settings are automa tically reset to the fact ory defaults. See Video Output settings on page 35 for more on thes e setting s. About HDMI HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface) supports bo th video and audi o on a single digital connection for use with DVD players, DTV, set-top boxes, and other AV devices. HDMI was developed to provide the technologies of High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP) as well as Digital Visual Interface (DVI) in one specification. HDCP is used to protect digital content transmitte d and received by DVI- compliant displays. HDMI has the capability to support standard, enhanced, or high-defin ition video plus standar d to multichanne l surround-soun d audio. HDMI features include unco mpressed digital video, a bandwidth of up to fi ve gigabytes per second (with HDTV signal s), one connector (instead of several cables and connectors), and commun ication between th e AV source and AV devices suc h as DTVs. HDMI, the HDM I logo and High-De finition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trad emarks of HDMI Lice nsing, LLC. Connecting external antenn as For an external AM antenna, use 5 m to 6 m of vinyl-insulated wire and set up either indoors or outdoors. Leave the loop anten na connected. Only use the included AM loop antenna. For an external FM a ntenna, use a PAL connector to hook up an externa l FM antenna. For the connection dia gram, see 4 on pa ge 40. Blue tooth î ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoyment of Music HTZ280/282DVD- AP models only Wireless music play When the Blue tooth ADA PTER (Pioneer Mode l No. AS-B T100) is conn ected to t his unit, a product equipped with Bluetooth wireless technology (portable cell phone, digi tal music player, etc.) can be used to listen to music wirelessly. 2 Also, by using a commercia lly availa ble transmitter supporting Bluetooth wireless technology, you can listen to musi c on a device not equipped with Bluetooth wireless technology. The AS-BT100 model supports SCMS- T contents protecti on, so mu sic can also be enjoyed on devices equipped with SCMS-T t ype Bluetooth wireless t echnology. Note 1 This mak es it possible to use the TVâÂÂs built-in speake rs to listen to the audio input from a DVD or USB device. Audio output from the HDMI termin al is 2 channel linear PCM only. In this event, no so und will be heard from this unitâÂÂs spea kers (or headphones) . All other audi o sources (includi ng TUNER ) are output from this un it normally. 2 It may be necessary th at the Bluetooth wireless technology enabled device supports A2DP profiles. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 42 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 43 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Remote cont rol operatio n The remote control supplied with this system allows you to play and st op media, and perform other operation s. 1 Connecting Optional Bluetooth ADAPTE R 1 Switch the system into standby and connect Bluetooth ADAPTER to the ADAPTER PORT located in the rear panel. For the connection diagr am, see 5 on page 40. 2P r e s s ïµ STANDBY/O N . 3P r e s s ADAPTER PORT and to switch to BT AUDIO input mode. 2 Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTE R and Bluetooth wireless technology device âÂÂPairingâ m ust be done befo re you start playback of Bluetooth wireless t echnology content u sing Bluetooth ADAPTE R. Make sure to perform pa iring first time you operate the system or any time pa iring data is cleared. âÂÂPairingâ is the step necessary to register Bluetooth wireless technology d evice to enable Bluetooth communications. 3 For more details, see also the operating instructio ns of your Bluetooth wi reless technology device. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP to select BT SETUP , then press ENTER . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select PAIRING , then press ENTER . 3 Select the PIN code to be used from 0000/ 1234/8888 using ï©/ïª , then press ENTER. PAIRING blinks. CAUTION ⢠You can use any of 0000 /1234/8888 PIN codes. Blueto oth wireless technology device using any other PIN code cannot be used with this system. 4 Switch on the Bluetooth wireless technology device that you want to make pairing, place it near the system and set it into the pairing m ode. Note 1 ⢠It may be necessary that the Bl uetooth wireless technology enabled device supports A VRCP profiles. ⢠Remote control operations cannot be guaranteed for all Bl uetooth wireless technology enabled devices. Music data This unit Bluetooth î ADAPTER Remote cont rol o pe ration Bluetooth wi reless technology enabled device: cell phone Bluetooth wi reless technology enabled device: Digital music p layer Device not equi pped with Bluetooth wi reless technology : Digital music p layer Bluetooth audio t ransmitte r (sold comme rcially) 2 When the Blue tooth ADAPTER is not plugged in the ADAPTER PORT , BT AUDIO input mode cannot be entered even if ADAPTER PORT is pressed. 3 ⢠Pairing is required when you first use Bluetooth wireless t echnology device and Bluetoo th ADAPTER. ⢠To enable Bl uetooth communication, pairing should be done with both of your system and Bl uetooth wireless technology device. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 43 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 44 En 5 Check to see that the Bluetooth ADAPTER is detected by the Bluetooth wireles s technology device. When the Bluetooth wireless technology device detects the Bl uetooth ADAPTER, the adapterâÂÂs identification âÂÂAS-BT100â appea rs in the Bluetooth wireless techno logy device list. 1 6F r o m t h e Bluetooth wireless technology device list, select Bluetooth ADAPTER and enter the PIN code selected in the step 3. 2 Listening to Music Contents of Bluetooth wireless technology device with Your System 1P r e s s ADAPTER PORT and to switch to BT AUDIO input mode. 2 Connect th e Bluetooth wireless technology device to the Bluetooth ADAPTER. When Bluetooth wire less technology device i s connected: Bluetoot h wireless techno logy device name appears in the system display. 3 When Bluetooth wire less technology device i s not connected: NODEVICE appears in the system display. 3 Start playback of music contents stored in Bluetooth wireless technology device. The following o perations are now possible for Bluetoot h wireless technology devices, using the button at the top of the system and remote controller. 4 Clearing Pairing 5 1 Press SHIFT SETUP , select BT SETUP , then press ENTER . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t PAIR C LR , then press ENTER . 3 When CLR OK appears, press ENTER . The Bluetooth î word mark and logos are registered trademarks o wned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such m arks by Pioneer Corporation is un der license. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners. Note 1 When a Bluetooth wireless technology device does not appear in th e list of detected devices or has no display, the Bluetooth wireless technology device list does not a ppear. In some cases, you may pair the Bl uetooth ADAPTER and that Bluetooth wireless technology device by using the pairing mode. 2 PIN code may in some case be referred to as PA SSKEY. 3 The system can display alphanumeric character s on ly. Other characters may not be displayed correctly. Button What it does ï¤/ïÂÂ¥ (system) Starts normal playback and pauses/unpauses playback. 4⢠Bluetooth wireless technolog y device should be compatible with AVRCP profile. ⢠Depending on Bluetooth wireless technology device you use, operation may differ from what is shown in this table. ï¤ (remote control) Starts normal playback. ïÂÂ¥ (remote control) Pa u s e s p l a y b a c k . ï§ (system/ remote contro l) Stops playback. ï (remote control) P ress to start fast reverse scanning. ï® (remote control) P ress to start fast for ward scanning. ï¯ (remote control) Skips to the start of the current file, then previous files. ï° (remote control) Skips to the next file. 5 ⢠Clearing should be done with Blue tooth wireless technology device being d isconnected. ⢠When you connect Bluetooth wireless technology device again after clearing, repeat the pairing steps referring to Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTER an d Bluetooth wireless technology device on page 43. Button What it does HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 44 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
KURO LINK 12 45 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 12 KURO LINK Not applicable to th e HTZ18 0/181DVD models By connecting this un it to a KURO LINK- compatible Pioneer fl at screen TV with a HDMI cable, you can co ntrol this unit from the remote control of a conn ected flat screen TV, as well as have the conn ected flat screen TV automatically change inputs in response to operations carried ou t on this unit. In addition, when la nguage information is input from th e connected flat screen TV, this unitâÂÂs GUI display la nguage automa tically changes (only when playback is stopped and GUI screen is not displayed, with DVD/CD function onl y). Refer to the operating in structions for your flat screen TV for more in formation about which operations can be carried out by connec ting via HDMI cable. ⢠You cannot use this function with components tha t do not support K URO LINK. ⢠We cannot g uarantee this unit will w ork with KURO LINK-compatible com ponents other than those m ade by Pioneer. Making the KURO LINK connections You can u se synchron ized operati on for a connected flat sc reen TV. Be sure to connect the flat screen TVâÂÂs au dio cable to the audio inpu t of this uni t. For the connection diagr am, see 3 on page 40. ⢠KURO LINK may not operate properly if yo u do not use a High Speed HDM I cable. ⢠Co nnect the flat screen TV directly to this unit. Interr upting a di rect connecti on with other a mps or an A V converter (such as an HDMI switch) c an cause op erational err ors. Important ⢠When connectin g this system or changing connections, be sure to switch the power off and disconnect the power cord fr om the wall socket. After completing all connectio ns, connect the power cords to the wall socket. KURO LINK Set up You must adjust the settings of this unit as well as KURO LINK-compatible c o nnected components in order to make use of the KURO LINK function. For more in formation see the operating instructions f or each compo nent. Setting the KURO LINK mode Choose whether to set this unitâÂÂs KURO LINK function ON or OFF . You will need to set it to LINK ON to use the K URO LINK function. ⢠When using a TV that does not support the KURO LINK function, set this to LINK OFF . MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES HDMI cable HDMI cable HDMI input HDMI output HDMI input HDMI OUT Othe r am p s o r A V conve rte r This unit KURO LINK -com patible P ionee r flat sc reen TV HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 45 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
KURO LINK 12 46 En 1 Press SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select HDMI SET then press ENTER . 3 U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct KURO LINK , then press ENTER . 4 U s e ï©/ïª to select the setting th en press ENTER to confirm . ⢠LINK ON â Enables the KURO LINK function. ⢠LINK OFF â The KURO LINK is disabled. Synchronized op erations cannot be used. Before using synchronization Once you have finished all connections and settings, you must: 1 Put all compo nents into standby mode. 2 Turn the power ON for all compo nents, with the power for the flat screen TV being turned on last. 3 Choose DVD/CD and see i f video output displays properly on the screen or not. Synchronized amp mode The synchronized a mp mode can be set from the KURO LINK-comp atible TVâÂÂs remote control. See th e explanation below for operations in th e synchronized amp m ode. These functions are set from the TVâÂÂs menu screen. For more inf ormation, refer to the operating instructions of the KURO LINK- compatible TV. Synchronized amp mode operations When using the synchron ized amp mode, the KURO LINK-comp atible component connected to th is unit operates in sync as descri bed below . ⢠The unitâÂÂs volume can be set a nd the sound can be muted using the TVâÂÂs remote control. ⢠When the TVâÂÂs power is set to st andby, the unitâÂÂs power is also set to standby. (The unitâÂÂs power is automatically turned off when the TVâÂÂs power is turned off while a video DVD is being played on the unit. However, the unitâÂÂs power may not turn off automatically in some cases, for ex ample, if you are listening to a CD or radio and turn off the output device.) ⢠The unitâÂÂs input switches automa tically when the TVâÂÂs channel is switched. ⢠The synchronized amp mo de remains in effect even if the unitâÂÂs input is switche d to a function o ther than the DVD /CD. The operations below can also be used on Pioneer KURO LINK-compatible flat scree n TVs. ⢠When the unitâÂÂs volu me is adjusted or the sound is muted, the volume status is displayed on the flat screen TVâÂÂs screen. ⢠When the OSD langua ge is switched on the flat screen TV, th e unitâÂÂs lan guage setting also swi tches a ccordin gly. Canceling synchronized amp mode ⢠When the synchron ized amp mode is canceled, the unitâÂÂs power turns off if you were viewing a TV program on th e TV. ⢠When in the synch ronized amp m ode, the synchronized amp mode is canceled when the unitâ s power is turn ed off. To turn the sync hronized amp mode back on, sele ct the s ynchronized a mp mode using the TVâÂÂs remote control. ⢠When in the synch ronized amp m ode, the synchronized amp mode is canceled if an operat ion that prod uces sound fr om the TV is performed from the TVâÂÂs men u screen, etc. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 46 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 47 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 13 Additional information Disc/content format p layback compatibility This player is co mpatible with a wide range of disc types (media) and formats. Playab le discs will generally feature on e of the following logos on the disc and/or disc pack aging. Note however that some disc types, such as recordable CD and DVD, may be in an unplayable fo rmat. See the Disc compatibili ty table below for more information. ⢠This unit will play DVD R/ RW discs . ⢠is a trademark of FUJIFILM Corporation. ⢠is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo Licens ing Corpo ration. ⢠Also compatib le with KODAK Pic ture CD. This player su pports the IECâÂÂs Super VCD standard for su perior picture quality, dual soundtracks, and widescreen support. About DualDisc playback A DualDisc is a new two -sided disc, one side of which conta ins DVD content video, audio, etc. while the other side contains non -DVD content such as digital audio material. The non-DVD, audio side of the disc is not compliant with the CD Au dio specific ation and therefore may no t play. The DVD side of a D ualDisc plays in this product. DVD-Au dio content will not play. For more detailed information on the DualDisc specification, please refer to the disc manufacturer or disc retailer. Disc compatibility table DVD- Video DVD-R DVD-RW Video CD F ujicolo r CD Audio CD CD-R CD-RW Su pe r Video CD (Su pe r VCD) Media Compatible formats CD-R/-RW ⢠CD-Audio, Video C D/Super VCD, ISO 9660 C D-ROM* containing MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC, JPEG or DivX video/WMV files. * ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. CD physical format: Mode1, Mode2 XA Form1. Romeo and Joliet file systems are both compatible. ⢠Multi-session playback: No ⢠Unfinalized disc pla yback: No DVD-R/-RW ⢠DVD - Video (Video mode), Video Record ing (VR)*, UDF Bridge DVD-ROM containing MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC, JPEG or DivX video/WMV files. * Edit points may not play exactly as edited; screen may go momentarily blank at edited points. ⢠Multi Border playbac k: No ⢠Unfinalized playbac k: No PC-cre ated disc ⢠Discs recorded using a PC may not be playable du e to the setting of the software used to create the disc. In th ese instances, check the DVD-R /-RW or CD-R/-RW software manual or disc boxes for more on compatib ility. ⢠Discs recorded in packe t write mode are not compatible. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 47 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 48 En About DVD R/DVD RW compatibility Only DVD R/DVD RW discs recorded in âÂÂVideo Mode (DVD Video Mode)â which have been finalized, can be played back. However, some editing made during the recording may not be played back ac curately. About DivX DivX is a digital video format created by DivX, Inc. This player can play DivX videos recorded on DVDs, CDs, or USB storage devices. Keeping the same term inology as DVD- Video, individual DivX vi deo files are called âÂÂTit lesâÂÂ. DivX video comp atibility ⢠Plays DivX î video 1 ⢠File extensions: .avi a nd .divx (these must be used for the player to recognize DivX video files). Note that all files with the .avi extension are recogni zed as MPEG4, but not all of thes e are necessarily DivX vid eo files and therefore may not be playable on this player. Displaying DivX subtit le files The font sets listed belo w are ava ilable for Di vX external subtitle fil es. You can see the proper font set on-screen by setting the Subtitle Language (in Lang uage settings on page 36) to match the subtitle fil e. 2 Group 1: Albanian (sq), Basque (eu), Catalan (ca), Danish (da), Dutch (nl), English (en), Faroese (fo), Finnish (fi), French (fr), Ge rman (de), Icelandic (is), Irish (ga), Italian (it), Norwegian (no), Portuguese (pt), Rhaeto-Romanic (rm), Sco ttish (gd), Spanish (es), Swedish (sv) Group 2: Albanian (sq), Croatian (hr), Czech (cs), Hungarian (hu), Polish (pl), Romanian (ro), Slovak (sk), Slovenian (sl) Compresse d audio ⢠MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3), Windows Media Audio (WMA), MPEG - 4 AAC ⢠Sampling ra tes: 32 kHz/44.1 kHz/ 48 kHz ⢠Bit-rates: Any (128 kbps or higher recommend ed) ⢠VBR (variable bit rate) MP3/WMA/ MPEG -4 AAC playback: No ⢠WMA lossless encoding: No ⢠DRM (Digital Rights Ma nagement) compatible: Y es (D RM-protected audio files will not play in this player .) ⢠File e xtensions: .mp3, .wma, .m4a (these must be used for the pl ayer to recognize MP3/WMA/MPEG-4 AAC files) ⢠File s tructure (may differ): Up to 299 folders on a disc; up to 648 fold ers and files (combi ned) within each f older JPEG file ⢠Baseline JPEG and EXIF 2.2* still image fi les up to a resolu tion of 3072 x 2048 *File format for digital still cameras ⢠Progressive JPEG compatible: No ⢠File extensions: .jpg ( must be used for the player to recognize JPEG files) ⢠File s tructur e (may d iffer): Up to 299 folders on a disc; up to 648 fold ers and files (combi ned) within each f older Media Compatible formats Note 1 Playback of .avi video files larger than 4 GB is not possible. 2 ⢠For external subtitle files the following subtitle format filename extensions are supported (please note that these files ar e not shown within the disc navigation menu): .srt, . sub, .ssa, .smi ⢠Some external subtitle files may be displayed incorrectly or not at all. ⢠The filename of the movie file has to be repeated at th e beginning of the filename for t he external subtitle file. ⢠The number of external subtitle files which can be switch ed for the same movie file is limited to a maximum of 10. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 48 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 49 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Group 3: Bulgarian (bg), Byelorussian (be), Maced onian (m k), Ru ssian (r u), Serb ian (sr), Ukrainian (uk) Group 4: Hebrew (iw), Yiddish (ji) Group 5: Turkish (tr) DivX î is a registered trademark of DivX, Inc., and is used unde r license. About WMV WMV is an acronym fo r Windows Media Video and refers to a video compression te chnology developed by Microsoft Corporation. WM V content can be encoded by using Windows Media Enc oder. ⢠This player is compat ible with WMV9 files that are encoded by using the Windows Media Encoder 9 Series, with .wm v as an extension. ⢠Compatible with size under 720 x 57 6 pixels/ 720 x 480 pixels. ⢠Advanced Prof ile is not s upported. ⢠DRM-protec ted video files will not play in this player. ⢠File extensions .wmv. ⢠Compatible with bit rate under 1 92 kbps. About MPEG-4 AAC Advanced Audio Coding (AAC) is at the core of the MPEG-4 AAC standard, which incorporates MPEG-2 AAC, forming the basis of the M PEG-4 audio compression technol o gy. The fi le format and extension used depend on the application used to encode th e AAC file. Thi s unit plays back AAC files encoded by iTunes î bearing the extensi on â .m4a âÂÂ. DR M-protected fi les will not play, and files encoded with some versions of iTunes î may not play, o r filenames may display incorrectly. Apple and iTun es are trademarks o f Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. About WMA This player can playbac k Windows Media Audio content. WMA is an acron ym for Windows Media Au dio and refers to an audio co mpression technolo gy developed by Microsoft Corporation. WMA content can be encoded by using Windows Media Player version 7.7.1, Win dows Media Player for Windows XP, or Windows Media Player 9 series. Windows Medi a is a trademark of Micros oft Corporation. This product inc ludes technology owned by Microsoft Co rporation and cannot be us ed or distribut ed without a license fr om Microsoft Licensing, Inc. Using and taki ng care of discs Handling discs Hold the disc by i ts edges when handling so as not to leave fingerprints , dirt or scratches on either side of the disc. Damaged or dirty disc s can aff ect playback perf ormance. If a disc becomes marked with fingerprints, dust, etc., clean using a soft, dry c l oth. Wipe lightl y from the ce nt er of the disc usin g straight stroke s. DonâÂÂt wipe the disc surface with circular strokes. If necessary, use a cloth soaked in a lcohol, or a commerciall y available C D/DVD cleaning kit to clean a disc more thoro ughly. Never use benzine, thinner or o ther cleaning agents such as those desi gned for cleaning vinyl r ecords. Storing discs Avoid leaving discs in excessively cold, humid, or hot environments (i ncluding un der direct sunlight). DonâÂÂt glu e paper or put stickers onto the disc, or use a pencil, ball-po int pen or other sharp-tipped writing in strument. These could all damage the disc. 13_Additional_in formation.fm 49 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂç«æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 50 En Discs to avoid Discs spin at high speed inside the player. If a disc is cracked, chipped, warped, or ot herwise damaged, donâÂÂt risk usin g it in your player â you could end up damaging the unit. This unit is desi gned for use with conve ntional, fully circular di scs only . Pioneer disclaims all liability arising in co nnection with t he use of shaped discs. DVD Video regions All DVD Video discs carry a region mark that indicates which regi on(s) of the world the di sc is compatib le with. You r DVD system a lso has a region mark (on the rear panel). Discs fro m incompati ble regions will not play in thi s player. Discs marked ALL play in any player. When you insert a disc tha t cannot be played on this player, on e of the following messages is displayed: Incompatib le disc regio n number CanâÂÂt play disc Installa tion and mainte nance Hints on installation We want you to enjo y using this system for years to come, so please be ar in mind the following p oints wh en choosing a location: Do... ï± Use in a well-ve ntilate d room. ï± Place on a solid, flat, level surfa ce, such as a table, shelf or stere o rack . DonâÂÂt... ï³ Use in a plac e exposed to h igh tempera tures or humidity, incl uding near radia tors and other heat-generating appliances. ï³ Place on a window sill or other place where the system will be exposed to direct sunlight. ï³ Use in an excess ively dusty or damp environment. ï³ Place directly on top of an amplifier, or other component in your stereo system that becomes hot in use . ï³ Use near a television or monitor as you may experience interference â especially if the television uses an in door antenna . ï³ Use in a kit chen or other r oom where th e system may be exposed to sm oke or steam. ï³ Use on a thick rug o r carpet, or cover wi th cloth â this may prevent prope r cooling of the system unit. ï³ Place on an unstable sur face, or one th at is not large enough to support all four of the system unitâÂÂs f eet. Cleaning the pickup lens The DVD playerâÂÂs lens should not beco me dirty in no r ma l u se , b ut if fo r s om e r ea so n it sh ou ld malfunction due to dust or dirt, consult your nearest Pioneer authorized serv ice center. Altho ugh lens cleaners are com mercially available, we do not recommend using them since some may damage the lens. Problems with condensation Condensation may form inside the player if it is brought in to a warm room from outsi de, or if the temperature of the room rises qu ickly. Although the condensation wonâÂÂt damage the player, it may temporaril y impair perf ormance. Leave it to adjust to the warmer temperature for about an hou r before switching on. Moving the system unit If you need to move the main unit, first rem ove a disc if thereâÂÂs one in the player, then pr ess ïµ STANDBY/ON on the front panel to turn the system off. Wait for -OFF- to disappear from the display, then unplug the power co rd. 1 Never lift or move the un it during playback â discs rotate at high speeds and may damage. Note 1 Unplugging the unit before -OFF- disappears from the display may cause the system to return to th e factory settings. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 50 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 51 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Screen sizes and disc formats DVD-Video discs com e in different screen aspects, ra nging from TV prog rams, which are generally 4:3, to CinemaScope widescr een movies 1 , with an aspect ratio of up to about 7:3. Televisions also come in different aspect ratios; âÂÂstandardâ 4:3 and widescreen 16:9. 2 Widescreen TV users If you have a widescreen TV, the TV Scre en setting (page 35) of th is player should be set to 16:9 (Wide) or 16:9 (Compressed) . When you watch discs reco rded in 4:3 format with th e 16:9 (W ide) setting, you can use the TV controls to select how the picture is presented. Your TV may offer various zoom and stretch options; see the i nstructions that came with your TV for details. Please note that some movie aspect ratios are wider than 16:9, so even though you have a widescreen TV, these discs will still play in a âÂÂletter boxâ style with black bars at th e top and bottom of the screen. Standard TV users If you have a standard TV, the TV Screen setting (page 35) of this player should be set to 4:3 (Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan), depending on which you prefer. Please note that many widescreen discs override the playerâÂÂs setting so that the disc is shown in le tter box format reg ardless of the setting. TV system setting The defau lt setting of t his system i s AUTO , and unless you notice that th e picture is distorted when playing some discs, you should leave it set to AUTO . If you find picture distortion with some discs, set the TV system to match your country or regionâÂÂs system. However, this m ay restrict the kinds of disc you can watch. See the table for the kinds of discs com patible with each setting ( AUTO , PAL and NTSC ). 3 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select SYS SET then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose TV SYS then press ENTER . The TV system changes as follows: ⢠AUTO ï¤ NTSC ⢠NTSC ï¤ PAL ⢠PAL ï¤ AUTO Note 1 Many widescreen discs override the systemâÂÂs settings so that th e disc is shown in letterbox format regardless of the setting. 2U s i n g t h e 16:9 (W ide) or 16:9 (Compressed) setting with a standard 4:3 TV, or one of the 4:3 settings with a widescreen TV, will result in picture distortion. Set to 4:3 (Letter Box) , widescreen discs are shown with black bars top and bottom. Set to 4:3 (Pan & Scan) , widescreen discs are shown with the left and right sides cropped. Although the picture looks larger, you donâÂÂt actually see the wh ole picture. 3 Most models of the newly developed countdown PAL TV system detect 50 Hz (PAL)/60 Hz (NTSC) and automatically switch vertical amplitude, resulting in a display without vert ical shrinkage. However, in some cases, the image may app ear without color. If your PAL TV does not have a V-Hold cont rol, you may not be able to watch NTSC disc s beca u se of picture roll. If the TV has a V-Hold control, adjust it until the pictur e stops rolling. On some TVs, the picture may shrink vertically, leaving black bands at the top and bottom of the screen. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 51 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 52 En 4 Press ENTER while CHANGE is blinking. The system will automa tically enter standby mode, then turn on again. YouâÂÂll see the new TV system settin g in the displa y after seeing POWER ON . 1 Frequency step setting Not applicable to Saudi Arabia, Israel , South Africa, other middle e astern contries and duty free mo dels If you find that you canâÂÂt tune into stations successfully, the frequency step may n ot be suitable for your co untry/region. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose A M 9K/10K then press ENTER . 3U s e ï©/ïª to select AM 9K or AM 10K then press ENTER . Dimming the Di splay You can adjust the brightness of the text in the front pan el displa y. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select SYS SET then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to select DIMMER then press ENTER . This is sh own in the fr ont panel dis play. 4U s e ï©/ïª to select LIGHT or DARK t hen press ENTER . Setting the Key Lock You can disable the front panel butto ns by switching the Key Lock feature o n. 1 P ress SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t SYS SET then pr ess ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose KEYLOCK then press ENTER . 4U s e ï©/ïª to select LOCK ON or LOCK OFF then press ENTER . Player setting Media T ype Format NTSC PAL AUTO DVD/Super VCD/ Video CD/DivX video/WMV NTSC NTSC PAL NTSC PAL NTSC PAL PAL CD/MP3/WMA/ MPEG-4 AAC/ JPEG/no disc â NTSC PAL NTSC or PAL Note 1 You have to switch the player into standby (press ïµ STANDBY/ON ) before each change. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 52 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 53 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Troubleshoot ing Incorrect opera tions are often mistaken f or troubl e an d malfunctions. If you think tha t there is something wrong with this compon ent, check the points below. Som etimes the trouble may lie in another componen t. Investigate the other components and electrical appliances being used. If the trouble cannot be re ctified even after exercising th e ch ecks listed below, ask your nearest Pioneer authorized service center or your de aler to carry o ut repair work. ⢠If the system does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricit y, disconnect the plug from the outlet and in sert again to return to n ormal operat ing conditio ns. General Problem Remedy The power does not turn on, or switches off suddenly (an error message may be displaye d at startup ). ⢠Wait for one min ute be f ore switching back o n. ⢠Make sure there are no loose stra nds of wire touching the unit. This could cause the system to shut off au tomatically. ⢠Check that the speakers are co nnected correctly. ⢠Make sure the voltage of the mains po wer source is corre ct for the model. ⢠Try reducing th e volume level. ⢠If the problem persists, tak e it to your nearest Pioneer authorized servic e center or your dealer for servicing. No sound is o utput when a functio n is selecte d. ⢠If youâÂÂre using the li ne input, make sure the component is conn ected correctly (see Connecting auxiliary audio components on page 40). ⢠N o a ud io is ou tp ut fr om th e s pe ak er s con n ec te d to th i s u ni t i f HD M I a ud io mo de is set to TV (page 41). ⢠Press MUTE on the rem ote control to turn muting off. ⢠T urn up t he volume. No sound from surround or center speakers. ⢠Refer to Setting the channel levels on page 17 t o check the speaker levels. ⢠When TUNER , ADAPTER PORT or LINE is sel ected, you can only hear the source in stereo. Switch t he input source to DVD/CD or USB for mul tichannel sound. ⢠Check that you ha venâÂÂt selected the ST EREO mode (see Listening in su rround sound on page 22). ⢠Check if a microphone i s connected or not. ⢠Connect the speakers properly (see Basic connections on page 9). CanâÂÂt operate the remote control. ⢠Replace the batteries (see Putting the batteries in the remote control on page 15). ⢠Operate within 7 m, 30ð o f the remote sensor (see Using the remote control on page 16). ⢠Remove any obsta c les or operate f rom another position. ⢠Avoid exposin g the remote sensor on the front p anel to direct light. The microphone can âÂÂt be heard . ⢠Y ou are only using on e microphone and itâÂÂs plugge d into the MIC (SUB) jack. The MIC (SU B) jack can only be used if there is also a microphone plugged int o the MIC (MAIN) jack. ⢠Adjust th e MIC VOL /â . F eedback noise when mic is switched on. ⢠The mic is poin ting toward the speakers. Keep the mic poi nted away from the speakers. ⢠The mic rophone leve l is set too hi gh. T urn down t he mic control level. TRAYLOCK shows in the displ ay and the tray canâÂÂt be ejected. ⢠Press and ho ld ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE on the front panel for about eig ht seconds. The n the tray can be open ed/closed using ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE . HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 53 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 54 En DVD/CD/ Video CD play er Problem Remedy The disc is ejected automatical ly after loadin g. ⢠Clean the disc and al ign the disc properly in the disc guide. ⢠If the region nu mber on a DVD-video disc does not match the number on the player, the disc cannot be used (see DVD Video regions on page 50). In this instance, one of the following messages appears on screen: Incompatible disc region number / CanâÂÂt play disc . ⢠Allow t ime for any co ndensation inside the player to evapor a te. Avoid using the player near an air-con ditioning unit. Playback not p ossible. ⢠If the disc is lo aded upsi de do wn, reload the di sc with label s ide face up. Picture playback stops and buttons cannot b e used. ⢠Press ï§ (stop), the n ï¤ (play) to start playback again. ⢠Switch the power off once, then on again using the fron t panel ïµ STANDBY/ON button. Settings are canceled. ⢠When the power is cut, settings wil l be canceled. No picture/No color. ⢠Check that connect ions are correct and that plugs are inserted full y. ⢠Check th e manual of th e TV/monitor to make sure the settings are correct. ⢠If the Progressiv e setting is selected and you have use d component vide o cables to connect a TV that is not compatible with a progressive scan signal, you will not be able to s ee any picture at all. With yo ur TV connected usin g either the composite or S -video term inals, change th e Component Out se tting to Interlac e (see Video Output settings on page 35). Screen is stretched or aspect doesnâÂÂt change. ⢠The TV Screen setting is incorre ct. Set the TV Scree n option to m atch the TV / monitor youâÂÂre using ( see Video Ou tput settings on page 35). When recorded on a VCR or passed through an AV selector, there is disturbance in the playback picture. ⢠This syst em uses copy-p rotection tech nology whic h may pre vent recording o r cause picture problems whe n connected through a VCR or AV se lector. This is not a malfu nction. Picture disturb ance during playback or dark. ⢠This player is compat ible with Macro- Vision System copy guard. S ome discs include a copy prevention signal , and when th is typ e of disc is played back, stripes etc., may appear on some sect ions of the picture depen din g on the TV. This is not a malfu nction. ⢠Discs respond different ly to particular pl ay er functions. This may result in the screen becoming bl ack for a brief instant or shaking slightly whe n the function is executed. These problems are largel y due to differences between discs and disc content and are not malfunctions of this player. Noticeable diff erence in DVD and CD vo lume. ⢠DVDs and CDs use different reco rding methods. This is not a malf unction. CD-ROM dis c is not recognized. ⢠Make sure that t he CD-ROM was recorded using the ISO 9660 disc format . See Disc com patibilit y table on page 47 fo r more on disc co mpatibility. DVD-ROM disc is not recognized. ⢠Make sure that the DVD-ROM was record ed using the UDF bridge format. See Disc compatibility table on page 47 for mo re on disc compatibility . Files donâÂÂt show up in the Disc Navigator/P hoto Browser. ⢠The files on the d isc must be named with the correct file exte nsion: .mp3 for MP3 files; .wma for WMA files; .m4a for MPEG-4 AAC files; .jpg for JP EG f iles (upp er or lower-case is OK). S ee Disc com patibility table on page 47. CanâÂÂt pl ay WMA or MPEG-4 AAC files. ⢠The files were recorded us ing DRM (digital rights management). This i s not a malfu nction. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 54 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 55 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Tuner USB connection HDMI connection CanâÂÂt play W MV files. ⢠When the bit rate the fil e is more than 192 kbps, t he file cannot be played back. Problem Remedy Problem Remedy Conside rable noise in radio broadcast s. ⢠Connect the AM antenna (see B asic connections on page 9) and adjust the direction and posit ion for best reception. You may al so connect an additional i nternal or external AM antenna ( refer to Conn ecting external antennas on page 42). ⢠Fully extend the FM wire antenna, positi on for best reception, and secure to a wall. You may also connect an o utdoor FM antenna (see Connec ting external antennas on page 42). ⢠Turn off other eq uipment that may be causing th e noise or move it further away. ⢠The tuning i nterval is incorrect for your count ry or region. See Frequency st ep setting on page 5 2 to switch the tu ning interval . Auto tuning does not pick up some statio ns. ⢠The radio signal is weak. Auto tuning will only detect radio stati ons with a good signal. For more sensitive t uning, connect an outdoor antenna. Problem Remedy USB mass storage d evice is not recogn ized by the system. ⢠Make sure you have complet ely inserted the USB connector to th is unit. ⢠Check that the memory format i s FAT16 or FAT32. ⢠USB device s with an in ternal USB hu b are not supp orted. Files donâÂÂt show up in t he Navigator/Phot o Browser. ⢠The files must ha ve the correct file exte nsion: .mp3 for MP3 files; .wma for WMA files; .m4a for MPEG-4 AAC fi les; .jpg for JPEG files (u pper or lower-case is O K). ⢠Make sure the file permi ssion hasnâÂÂt been restricted (t hrough a password, etc.). CanâÂÂt play WM A or MPEG-4 AAC files. ⢠The files were recorded us ing DR M (digital rights ma nagement). This is not a malfunction. Problem Remedy No H DM I vi de o ou tp ut . ⢠Ma ke su re th at yo uâ ve se le ct ed th is pl ay er as th e HD MI in pu t i n t he se tt in gs fo r t he componen t youâÂÂre using (refer to the co mponentâÂÂs in struction man ual). ⢠Check that the HDMI cable is connected properly and isnâÂÂt damaged. ⢠Check that components connect ed using the HDMI interface are switched on and HDMI compatib le (componen ts must be compatible with bo th DVI and High Bandwi dth Digita l Conte nt Protec tion (HD CP)). ⢠Depending o n the component you have connected, u s ing a DVI connection may result in unreliable signal transfers. ⢠Make sure th e resolution o n this play er matches t hat of the com ponent yo u have connected using HDMI. See Video Output settings on page 35 to change the HDMI resolution. ⢠If the screen goes blank aft er changing the resolution, it means the re solution you selected is i ncompatible with your monito r. See Resetting the HDMI connection on page 42 to reset to the factory def aults. Color problems occur with your mo nitor after changing the HDMI Color setting (page 36). ⢠Depending o n the connected equipment, so me HDMI Color settings may cause the picture to be displayed incorrectly. In this case, us e the TVâÂÂs own video input settings to select RGB, if possible. Alternatively, revert to the pre vious HD MI Co lor setting. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 55 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 56 En Bluetooth connection Error Messages No picture or sound. ⢠If the problem still persi sts when connecting your HDMI component d irectly to your monitor, please consult the component or monitor manual or contact the manufacturer for support. No HDMI au dio output. ⢠See Switching the HDMI audio setting on page 41 to make sure that TV is selected. KURO LINK does not function. ⢠Verify that the HDMI ca ble is firmly connected. ⢠Make sure that this unitâÂÂs KURO LINK mode is set to LINK ON (page 45). ⢠Check whether the connected component supports KURO LI N K or not. Fo r more information refer to the operating manual of your flat screen TV. ⢠KURO LINK may not work properly if a SCART cable and an HDMI cable are connected simultaneously. Set KURO LINK mode to LINK OFF when connecti ng SCART and HDMI cables s imultaneously. Your TV automatically change inputs. ⢠The connected TV auto matically may change inputs i n response to this unit st ar ti ng pl ay ba ck DV D o r ha v in g th e GUI sc re en (e x. Di sc Na vi ga to r) dis p la yed , etc . I f you do not want yo ur TV to change inputs in this way, set this unit KURO LINK mode to LINK OFF (page 45). Problem Remedy Problem Remedy The Bluetooth wireless technology device cannot be connected or operated . Sound from the Bluetooth wireless technology device is not emitted or the sou nd is interrupted. ⢠Check that no object that e mits electromag netic waves in th e 2.4 GHz band (microwave oven, wire less LAN device or Bluetooth wireless techno logy appara tus) is near th e unit. If such an object is near the unit, set the unit far from it. Or, stop using the ob j ect emit ting the electromag netic waves. ⢠Check that the Blue tooth wireless tech nology devi ce is not too far f rom the unit and that obstructions are no t set between th e Bluetooth wireless tec hnology devi ce and the unit. S et the Bluetooth wireless technology device a nd the unit so that the distance between them is less than abou t 10 m and no obstructio ns exist betw een them. ⢠Check that the Blue tooth ADAPTER and the ADAPTER PORT of the unit ar e correctly connected. ⢠The Bluetooth wireless tec hnology device may not be set to the communication mode supporting the Bluetooth wireless technology . Che ck the setting of the Bluetooth wireless technology device . ⢠Check that pairing is correc t. The pairing settin g was deleted from this unit or the Bluetooth wireless technology device . Reset the pairing. ⢠Check th at the prof ile is correct. Use a Bluetooth wireless technology device that supports A2DP profile and AVRCP profile. Message Description EXTRAPWR ⢠You cannot adjust SFC modes, tone controls (bass, treble, and bass boost), MP3 Expander mode, Voice Enhancer mode when using Extra Power mode . CANNOT ⢠Operation is p rohibited because DVD/CD or U SB isnâÂÂt selected, or SHIFT KARAOKE , SHIFT ECHO , SH IFT ï or SHIFT ï has been pressed. ⢠Appears when DVD/CD is not selected and SHIFT USB REC is pressed. TRAYLOCK ⢠The tray lock is on. See General in Troubleshooting on page 53. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 56 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 57 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Resetting the system Use this procedure to reset all syst e m settings to the factory default. 1 With th e system o n, press SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct INITIAL t hen press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t ALL INIT th en press ENTER . ⢠INIT OK is disp layed. 4 Press ENTER while INIT OK is blinkin g. 1 Using the language code list Some of the language options (see La nguage settings on page 36) allow you to set your preferred language from an y of the 136 languages in the Language code list below. 1 Select âÂÂOther LanguageâÂÂ. 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select either a code letter or a code number . 3U s e ï©/ïª to se lec t a co de le tter or a code number. See the Language code list below for a complete list of la nguages and codes. STEREO ⢠STEREO appears w hen SURROUND or AUTO/STEREO is pressed in th e TUNER , LINE or ADAPTER PORT input mode. KEYLOCK ⢠The key lo ck is enabled. S ee Setting the Key Lock on page 52. USB ERR ⢠See Important in Using the USB interface on page 31 for more on this. HDMI ERR ⢠See HDMI connectio n above for troubleshooting tips. See also Res etting the HDMI connection on p age 42 if the pro blem persis ts. EEP ERR ⢠Cont act your Pioneer authorized service ce nter or your dealer for servicing. EXIT ⢠Appears when any prohibited si gnal is input or the headphones are connected while the m enu screen i s displayed, an d then the di splay returns to the normal display . NO MIC ⢠Appears when you press SHIFT KARAOKE , SHIFT ECHO , SHIFT ï , SH IFT ï or MIC VOL /â when no mic is inserted. OC ERR 1 OC ERR 2 ⢠Check whether the speaker cab l es are short-ci rcuited. If the error message continues to be displayed , contact your Pioneer authorized service cen ter or your dealer for servicing. OVER TEMP ⢠Try lowering the v olume. If this problem is not fixed by removing and inserting the power cabl e, this unit may be damaged. In s uch an event, please contact a Pi oneer- authorized service cent er or your nearest dealer. BT ERR ⢠Power consumption by Bluet ooth ADAPTER is too high to supply the po wer. Reconnect the Blue tooth ADAPTER. TV AUDIO ⢠Indicator is l it for two seconds if the listening mode is changed while HDMI audio mode is set f or TV. KARAOKE ⢠Appears when you press SURROUND , SOUND , AUTO/ST EREO or MP 3 EXP/ V.ENH when a mic is insert ed. PHONESI N ⢠Appears when you press SURROUND , SOUND , AUTO/STEREO or MP3 EXP/ V.ENH when a headphone is inserted . Message Descrip tion Note 1 Do not operate the unit without reason or pull the power cord because the sys t emâÂÂs power automatically turns on. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 57 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 58 En Language code list Language (Language code letter), Language code Country/Area code list Country/Area, Country/Area co de , Country/Area code letter Japa nese (j a), 1001 English (en), 0514 French (fr), 0618 German (de), 0405 Italian (it), 0920 Spanish (es), 0519 Dutch (nl), 1412 Russian (ru), 1821 Chinese (zh), 2608 Korean (ko), 1115 Greek (el), 0512 Afar (aa), 0101 Abkhazian (ab), 010 2 Afrikaans (af), 0106 Amharic (am), 0113 Arabic (ar), 0118 Assamese (as), 0119 Aymara (ay), 012 5 Azerbaijani (az), 0126 Bashkir (ba), 0201 Byelorussian (be), 0205 Bulgarian (bg), 0207 Bihari (bh), 0208 Bislama (bi), 0209 Bengali (bn), 0214 Tibetan (bo), 0215 Breton (br), 0218 Catalan (ca), 0301 Corsican (co), 0315 Czech (cs), 0319 Welsh (cy), 0325 Danish (da), 0401 Bhutani (dz), 0426 Esperanto (eo), 0515 Estonian (et), 0520 Basq ue (e u), 0521 Persian (fa), 0601 Finnish (fi), 0609 Fiji (fj), 0610 Faroese (fo), 0615 Frisian (fy), 0625 Irish (ga), 0701 Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704 Galician (gl), 0712 Guarani (gn), 0714 Gujarati (gu), 0721 Hausa (ha), 0801 Hindi (hi), 0809 Croatian (hr), 0818 Hungarian (hu), 0821 Armenian (hy), 0825 Interlingua (ia), 0901 Interlingue (ie ), 0905 Inupiak (ik), 0911 Indonesian (in), 0914 Icelandic (is), 0919 Hebrew (iw), 0923 Yiddish (ji), 1009 Javanese (jw), 1023 Georgian (ka), 1101 Kazakh (kk), 1111 Greenl andic (kl), 1112 Cambodian (km), 1113 Kannada (kn), 1114 Kashmiri (ks), 1119 Kurdish (ku), 1121 Kirghiz (ky), 1125 Latin (la), 1201 Lingala (ln), 1214 Laothian (lo), 1215 Lithuanian (lt), 1220 Latvian (lv), 1222 Malagasy (mg), 1307 Maori (mi), 1309 Macedonian (mk), 1311 Malayalam (ml), 1312 Mongolian (mn), 1314 Moldavian (mo), 1315 Marathi (mr), 1318 Malay (ms), 1319 Maltese (mt), 1320 Burmese (my), 1325 Nauru (na), 1401 Nepali (ne), 1405 Norwegian (no), 1415 Oc cita n (oc), 1503 Oromo (om), 1513 Oriya (or), 1518 Panjabi (pa), 1601 Polish (pl), 1612 Pashto, Pushto (ps), 161 9 Portuguese (pt), 1620 Quechua (qu), 1721 Rhaeto-Romance (rm), 1813 Kirundi (rn), 1814 Romanian (ro), 1815 Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823 Sanskrit (sa), 1901 Sindhi (sd), 1904 Sangho (sg), 1907 Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908 Sinhalese (si), 1909 Slovak (sk), 1911 Slovenian (sl), 1912 Samoa n (sm), 1913 Shona (sn), 1914 Somali (so), 1915 Alba nian (s q), 1917 Serbian (sr), 1918 Siswati (ss), 1919 Sesotho (st), 1920 Sundanese (su), 1921 Swedish (sv), 1922 Swahili (sw), 1923 Tamil (ta), 2001 Telugu (te), 2005 Tajik (tg), 2007 Thai (th), 2008 Tigrinya (ti), 2009 Turkmen (tk), 2011 Tagalo g (tl), 2012 Setswana (tn), 2014 Tonga (to), 2015 Turkish (tr), 2018 Tsonga (ts), 2019 Tatar (tt ), 2020 Twi (tw), 2023 Ukrainian (uk), 2111 Urdu (ur), 2118 Uzbek (uz), 2126 Vietnam ese (v i), 2209 Volapük (vo), 2215 Wolof (wo), 2315 Xhosa (xh), 2408 Yoruba (yo), 2 515 Zulu (zu), 2621 A rgentina, 0118 , ar Australia, 0121, au Austria, 0120, at Belgium, 0205, be Brazil, 0218, br Canada, 0301, ca Chile, 0312, cl China, 0314, cn Denmark, 0411, dk Finland, 0609, fi France, 0618, fr Germany, 0405, de Hong Kong, 0811, hk India, 0914, in Indonesia , 0904, id Italy, 0920, it Japan, 1016 , jp Korea, Republic of, 1118, kr Malaysia, 1325, my Mexico, 1324, mx Netherlands, 1412, nl New Zealand, 1426, nz Norway, 1415, no Pakistan, 1611, pk Philippines, 1608, ph Portugal, 1620, pt Russian Federation, 1821, r u Singapore, 1907, sg Spain, 0519, es Switzerland, 0308, ch Sweden, 1905, se Taiwan, 2023, tw Thailand, 2008, th United Kingdom, 0702, gb United St ates of Americ a, 2119, us HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 58 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 59 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Specifications ⢠Amplifier section RMS Power Output: Front, Center, Surround . . . 60 W per channel (1 kHz, 10 % T.H.D., 4 é ) Subwoofer . . . 60 W (100 Hz, 10 % T.H.D., 4 é ) ⢠Disc section Type . . . . . . . . D VD system, Video CD/Super VCD system and Compact Disc digital audio system ⢠FM tuner section Frequency range . . . . . . . . 8 7.5 MHz to 108 MHz Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 é , unbalanced ⢠AM tuner section Frequency range: Saudi Arabia, Israel, South Africa, other middle eastern contries and duty free models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz All other models With 9 kHz step . . . . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz With 10 kHz step . . . . . . . 530 kHz to 1700 kHz Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Loop antenna ⢠Miscellan eous Power requirements: Singapore, Indonesia, Hong Ko ng, Malaysia, Philippines models . . . . . . . . . . . . AC 220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz All other models . . . . . . . . . . . . AC 110 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz Power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 W Power consumption in standby: For HTZ180/181DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W Others KURO LINK ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.73 W KURO LINK OFF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W Dimensions . . . . . . . . 420 mm (W) x 62 mm (H) x 33 1 mm (D ) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 kg ⢠Accessories (DVD/CD receiver) Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AA/R6 dry cell batter ies (to confirm system operation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Video cable (yellow plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AM loop antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 FM antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Setup Guide Operating instructions (This document) S-DV180 Spe aker system ⢠Front speakers Enclosure . . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 105 mm (W) x 115 mm (H) x 114 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠Center speak er Enclosure . . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 115 mm (W) x 105 mm (H) x 114 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠Surround speaker Enclosure . . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 105 mm (W) x 118 mm (H) x 114 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠Subwoofer Enclosure . . . . . . Bass-reflex flo or standing type System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Hz to 1 kHz Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 190 mm (W) x 360 mm (H) x 317 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠Accessories Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Mounting brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Screws (for mounting brackets) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 13_Additional_in formation.fm 59 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂæ°´æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 60 En S-DV585 Spe aker system ⢠Front/surround speakers Enclosure. . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .(magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensi ons . . . . . . . 96 mm (W) x 96 mm (H) x 96 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠Center speaker Enclosure. . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 W Dimensi ons . . . . . . . 96 mm (W) x 96 mm (H) x 96 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠Subwoofer Enclosure. . . . . Bass-reflex floorstanding type System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz to 1 kHz Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensi ons . . . . 230 mm (W) x 380 mm (H) x 360 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠Accessories Speaker cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Brackets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Mounting brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Screws (common use for brackets and mounting brackets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 S-DV280T Spe aker sys tem ⢠Front speakers Enclosure . . . . Closed-box floorstanding type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .(magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-way system Speakers: Woofer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Tweeter . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm semi-dome type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 62 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . 260 mm (W) x 1097 mm (H) x 260 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠Center speaker Enclosure . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 72 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 220 mm (W) x 90 mm (H) x 100 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg ⢠Surround speakers Enclosure . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensions . . . . . 100 mm (W) x 100 mm (H) x 100 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠Acce ssorie s Speaker cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Speaker stand bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Screws (for bases) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 S-DV2 82T Speaker system ⢠Front/surround speakers Same as S-DV280T Front speakers ( se e above ) ⢠Center speaker Same as S-DV280T Center speaker ( see above ) ⢠Acce ssorie s Speaker cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Speaker stand bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Screws (for bases) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 13_Additional_in formation.fm 60 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂæ°´æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 61 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español S-DV5SW Speaker system â¢S u b w o o f e r Enclosure . . . . . . . Bass-reflex floorstanding type System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz to 1 kHz Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensions . . . . . . . 2 30 mm (W) x 380 mm (H) x 36 0 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠Acce ssorie s Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Note ⢠Specifications and design subject to possible modification wit hout notice, due to improvements. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. âÂÂDolbyâÂÂ, âÂÂPro Logicâ , and the double -D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #âÂÂs: 5,45 1,942; 5,956, 674; 5,974,380; 5 ,978,762; 6,487,53 5 & other U.S. and worl dwide patents issued & pending . DTS and DTS Digital Surround are registered trademarks and th e DTS logos and Symbol are trademarks of DTS, Inc. é 1996 -2008 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Published by Pioneer Corporation. Copyright é 20 09 Pioneer Corporation. All rights reserved. This product includes F ontAvenue î fonts licenced by NEC Corporation. F ontAvenue is a register ed trademark of NEC Corporation. This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is pr otected by method claims of certain U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights owned by Macrovision Corporation and other rights owners. Use of this copyright protection technology must be authorized by Macrovision Corporation, and is intended for home and other limited viewing uses only unless other wise authorized by Macrovision Corporation. Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited. DRM (digital rights management) copy protection is a technology designed to prevent unauthorized copying by restricting playback, etc. of compressed audio files on devices other than the PC (or other recording equipment) used to record it. F or detailed information, please see the instruction manuals or help files that came with your PC and/or software. 13_Additional_in formation.fm 61 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂæ°´æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
à ¹ÂáÂÂîÃÂÃÂòàá¡ÂáÂÂáµÃÂÃ Ã¶à ¶«á»ûãòè à ½ÂÃÂá¡ÃÂÃ¤à ®´ÃÂáÂÂñÃÂá±áÂÂà ¹Âà £»áÂ±à ¥¨à ¥Âá´ ÃÂÃ à ¹ÂáÂÂîÃÂÃÂÃ²à ®´Ã¥áÂÂáÂÂÃ à ¬±áÂ¬à ²ÂáµÃÂÃÂÃÂÃ à £ÂáÂÂÃÂûãòÃÂÃ¨à ½ÂÃÂà ±±à  £áÂ¡à ·§Ã²ÃÂà ¹Âá£àöááÂÂá‡ÂÂ÷ÃÂáÂÂÃ¼à ´ÂÃÂáÂÂá¬àááÂÂÃ Ã¨à ½ à £ÂáÂÂüáÂÂá‡áÂÂÃÂáÂÂý÷äñïáÂÂÃÂÃÂà ¤¨à ¥® ÃÂÃÂÃÂÿáÂÂüáÂÂá¬ÃÂÃ¨à ¼ÂÃÂáÂ¡Ã²à ¸ÂÃÂÃ¥àý áÂ±à ¦Âûãàá®ÃÂÃÂà ¤¸á°áÂ±à ¦ÂÃÂà ÂÂáÂÂáÂÂà ¹Âà ® à ½¿ áÂ±à ¦ÂÃ¢à ¦¸Ã à ¥¨à ¥ ÃÂÃÂàåáÂÂá¬àáá áÂÂýÃÂà »¡ D3-4-2-1-1_A1_Zhtw áÂÂñáÂÂá« áÂÂñáÂÂáÂ«à ¾¤à ¡ÂáÂ à ¾¢à ¡ÂàìöáèáÃÂáìôöáèÃÂìõòáéáÃÂáìúöáéàÃÂÃÂüùöáæà Âà  ÃÂÃ½à ®Âà ¼ÂÃ¿à  ÂÃÂàáÂÂÃ½Ã¶à ³¾à ¥´ÃÂÃÂà ³ÂÃÂá¹áÂªÃ¼à ¬¾à ¾¢à ¡ÂÃÂà »©ÃÂÃ£à §£ÃÂÃÂà ®½à ©© Ã Ã¢à ´ÂÃÂà ¾ÂÃÂÃ à µ ÃÂÃÂáÂÂÃÂá¡àD3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_Zhtw HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 2 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 3 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
4 Zhtw æÂÂè¬ÂæÂ¨è³¼è²·æÂŒÂ°å ÂéÂÂç¢åÂÂã è«Âå¾¹åºÂé±è®ÂæÂ¾ÂÂä½ÂæÂÂå ï¼Â以便æÂ£ç¢ºå°æÂÂä½ÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¢åÂÂãÂÂå¨æÂ¨é±è®Âå®ÂæÂ åÂÂå¾Âï¼Âè«Â妥çºä¿Â管以便å°Âä¾Âå èÂÂä¹Âç¨ã ç®é 01 æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 3 é» /2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 æºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 æÂÂæÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç¸åÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂå·¥ ä½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 HTZ280DVD/HTZ28 0DVD-AP/HTZ282DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP çÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂ工你. . . . . . . . . . . . 6 å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂ工你. . . 7 å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨çÂÂ丠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 å®Âè£Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 å é©ç¨æÂ¼å®Â裠HTZ180 /181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂç æÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âä¹Âå ¶ä»Â注æÂÂäºÂé  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 02 æÂ¥ç· åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 03 æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 Ã¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 顯示幠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 éÂÂæÂ§å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 å®Âè£ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é»池. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 éÂÂç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 04 éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 è¨Âç½®è²éÂÂé³é . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 使ç¨å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢ ï¼ OSD ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 åºæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶æÂ æÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD PBC é¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 èÂÂè½æÂ¶é³橠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 æÂ¹å FM æÂ¥æÂ¶ä¸Âè¯ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 æÂÂå¶ AM æÂ¥æÂ¶éÂÂ訠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 è¨ÂæÂ¶éÂȌ° . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 æÂ¶è½é Âè¨ÂéÂȌ° . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 èÂÂè½堶ä»Âä¾Â溠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 è¨Âç½®ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 05 èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 é¸åÂÂèÂÂè½模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 èªåÂÂèÂÂè½模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 以ç°ç¹Âè²èÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè² . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 以ç«Âé«Âè²èÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 以è³æ©ÂèÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 調æÂ´ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 使ç¨ SFC 模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 å éÂÂä½Âé³é³é . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 使ç¨ MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 使ç¨è²é³強åÂÂå¨模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 æÂÂæÂÂè²é³ ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂä½³è²é³@. . . . . . . . . . 24 06 ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 æ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 æ ¼é²ï¼Âæ ¼éÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂç 秠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂçÂÂ覽 DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 å¯å©ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ覽 Windows Media⢠Audi o (WMA) ã MP3ã MPEG-4 AAC ã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV å JPEG æªÂæ¡ . . . . . 27 使ç¨æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 製ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 èÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 渠餿ÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ段 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 使ç¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 使ç¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 建ç«Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯é¸å®ä¸Âå ¶ä»Âå¯ç¨ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . 29 æÂÂç´¢ç¢Âç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼Âé³頻è² é . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 æÂ¾å¤§ç«é¢ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè§Â度 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 顯示ç¢ÂçÂÂè³Â訠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 4 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
5 Zhtw English Español 07 USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 使ç¨ USB ä»Âé¢ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 å¨ USB è£Âç½®ä¸ÂéÂÂ製é³樠CD çÂÂæÂ² ç® . . . . . . . 31 éÂÂ製æÂÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 éÂÂ製ç¹å®ÂæÂ²ç® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 08 å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 è®ÂæÂ´æ··è²æÂÂæÂ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 è®ÂæÂ´èÂÂæÂ¯é³樠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 09 é³頻è¨Âç½®åÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´é¸å® ãÂÂé³頻è¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 é³頻 DRC ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ§å¶@. . . . . . . . . . . . 34 ãÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´ãÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 10 ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 使ç¨ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 顯示å¹Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 é¸頠è¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 æÂÂ人éÂÂå® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX î VOD 堧容 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 æÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 11 å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻è¨Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 使ç¨è²差è¦Â頻輸åºé£æÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 éÂÂæÂ¼éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé » . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ HDMI é³頻è¨Âç½®å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 éÂÂæÂ¼ HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 ç¨æÂ¼ç¡ç·Â享åÂÂ鳿¨Âç Bluetooth î å³輸å¨ . . . 42 ç¡ç·Â鳿¨ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 éÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂÂä½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 é£æÂ¥é¸購ç Bluetooth å³輸å¨ . . . . . . . . . . 43 é Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å Blueto oth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ è£Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 使ç¨æÂ¨çÂÂ系統èÂÂè½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ç é³æ¨Â堧容 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 渠é¤é Âå° . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 12 KURO LINK 飿ÂÂ¥ KURO LINK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 KURO LINK è¨Âå® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 è¨Âå® KURO LINK 模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 使ç¨åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂä¹Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂÂä½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Ã¥ÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 13 å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Â堧容格å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¸容 æÂ§ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 éÂÂæÂ¼ DVD R/DVD RW ç¸容æÂ§ . . . . . . . . . . 48 éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 éÂÂæÂ¼ WMV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 éÂÂæÂ¼ MPEG-4 AAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 éÂÂæÂ¼ WMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ使ç¨åÂÂç¶Âè· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 DVD Video é©ç¨å°å . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 å®Âè£ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¿Â餠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 å®Âè£ÂæÂÂ示 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 渠æ½Âè®Â寫é ÂæÂ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 æ°´æ°£åÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 æÂŒÂÂ系統主橠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 ç«é¢大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ格张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Â使ç¨è . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 æ¨ÂæºÂé»è¦Â使ç¨è . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 é»è¦Â系統è¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 é »çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 調æÂÂ顯示å¹Â亮度 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂéµé @Key Lock ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 æÂ éÂÂæÂÂé¤ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 ä¸ÂèÂŒÂÂé¡ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 DVD/CD/VC D æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 調諧å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 USB 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Bluetoot h é£締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Ã¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 è¦Âæ ¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 5 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 01 6 Zhtw 第 1 ç« æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® è¦ÂæÂ¨æÂ¿éÂÂçÂÂ大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¹æÂ§èÂÂå®Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å¨堩種æÂ¹ å¼Âä¸Âé¸åÂÂå ¶ä¸Âä¾ÂæÂºè¨ÂæÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨以使ç¨æÂ¬ç³» çµ±ãÂÂéÂÂæÂ¼æÂÂè²å¨é Â置@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ãÂÂè¨Âå®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã ã 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ éÂÂæÂ¯ä¸Â種è½æÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂä½³ 5.1 è²éÂÂå®¶åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂ ç æ¨ÂæºÂå¤Âè²éÂÂç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂè² å¨è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¹å¼Âã 3 é» /2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ æÂ¤ç¨®è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¹å¼Âå¨ç¡æ³Âé²è¡Âå¾Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂºè¨ æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¨å¸ÂæÂÂè½é¿å Âå¨èÂÂè½åÂÂå §ä½Âè¨ÂéÂÂé·çÂÂæÂ è²å¨ç·ÂæÂÂï¼Âç¸ç¶çÂÂ實ç¨ ã æºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂÂæÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç¸åÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂå·¥ ä½ å®Âè£Â鲿»Â墠⢠å°Âå°ÂçÂÂ鲿»Âå¢Âè²¼å°æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂåºÂ座丠ã å å¡Â大çÂÂçÂÂ鲿»Âå¢ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Âè²¼ å°éÂÂä½Âé³ä¸Âã 使ç¨ ç¨é¨éÂÂçÂÂè 水尠3 å° 4 çÂÂ鲿»Âå¢Âè²¼å°æ¯Âå æÂ è²å¨çÂÂåºÂ座 ï¼Âå¹³å¦表é¢ï¼Âä¸Âã HTZ280DVD/HTZ280DVD- AP/ HTZ282DVD/HTZ282DVD-AP çÂÂæºÂå 工你5 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨å 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂºè¨Âç¸åÂÂï¼ çµÂè£ÂæÂÂè²å¨蠳æÂ¶ ⢠å©ç¨æÂÂéÂÂè´ÂçÂÂèº絲å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨åºÂ座å®Âè£Âå°æÂ¯ æÂ±ä¸Âã å°ÂæÂ£æÂ¯æÂ±åÂÂ庠座å¾Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ãÂÂè¨Âå®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂå°Âå° èº絲éÂÂå ¥åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèº絲åÂÂå § ã è«Â注æÂÂï¼ æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂæÂ åÂÂçÂÂè °ä¸Âè§Âå½¢çÂÂåºÂ座çÂÂæÂ¹åÂÂã 注æÂ â¢ è«Âå°Âå¿Âä¸Âè¦Âå°Âèº絲éÂÂ太 ç·Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂ太ç¨åÂÂéÂÂç·Âèº絲 ï¼ èº絲åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂèº帽çÂÂèº ç´Âå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂ壠ã 使ç¨ä¸ÂçÂÂ尺寸çÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèº 絲起 Ã¥ÂÂçµÂè£Âã â¢ è«Âå¿使ç¨å¯è½æÂÂå°Âèº絲åÂÂèº帽æÂ½å éÂÂ大å éÂÂçÂÂéÂȌÂÂèº絲起åÂÂæÂÂå°º 寸太大çÂÂèº絲起å ã â¢ çµÂè£ÂæÂ ï¼ ç¢ºèªÂæ²ÂæÂÂç°ç©é»Âå¨蠳æÂ¶åºÂ座æÂ é«Âç æÂÂè²å¨ä¸Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂçµÂè£ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ ï¼ è ³æÂ¶åºÂ座èÂÂé«ÂæÂÂè²å¨ä¹Âé å¡ä½Âç°ç© ï¼ åÂÂå¯è½ç¡æ³Âå®Âå ¨å°çµÂè£ÂæÂ¬æ© ï¼ å° è´æÂ¬æ©Âç¿»è¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂè½ã â¢ è«Âå¿ç«Âå¨é«ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨蠳æÂ¶åºÂ座ä¸ÂæÂ¨ Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã æÂÂè²å¨å¯è½æÂÂè½åÂÂ破裠@æÂÂå°Âè´人å¡åÂÂå·ãÂÂè«Â注 æÂÂå°Âå©ã åºå®ÂæÂ¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®èÂÂç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠使ç¨é¨éÂÂçÂÂå¡Âè é¤åºå®Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®èÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂ è²å¨ã å°Âå ©åÂÂæÂ¯æÂÂé¤éÂÂå ¥æÂÂè²å¨å¾Âé¢çÂÂçÂÂå£Â丠ã å°Âä¸Â梠ç²ÂçºÂç·Âç©¿éÂÂé¤åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¡Âè é¤ä¾Âåºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Â確宠å Â測試å®ÂæÂ¯å¦è½æÂ¯æÂÂæÂ è²å¨çÂÂéÂÂéÂÂï¼ ãÂÂå®Âè£Âå¾Â@確å®Âå·²ç¢ç¢åºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨ãÂ à ¼®á³áÂ à ®Âà ²ÂàᤠHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 6 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 01 7 Zhtw English Español English Español 注æÂ â¢ å¡Âè é¤ä¸ÂæÂ¯åºå®Âé Âä»¶ ï¼ èÂÂä¸Âä¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ使ç¨æÂ¤é¤ Ã¥ÂÂç´æÂ¥å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂå¨çÂÂå£Â丠ã ä¸Âå¾Â使ç¨çºÂç· ä¿ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂç©©å®Âã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼å ä¸Âç¶çµÂè£ÂãÂÂå® è£ÂãÂÂå®Âè£ÂæÂÂæÂÂ強度丠足 ã 誤ç¨æÂÂ天ç¶ç½害é æÂÂçÂÂä»» ä½ÂæÂÂ失æÂÂæÂ å£Âï¼Âå ÂéÂÂæ¦Âä¸ÂæÂÂè² ä»»ä½Â責任ã â¢ æÂ¾ç½®æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ ï¼ è«Â確å®Âå·²ç¢ç¢åºå®ÂæÂ¬æ© ï¼ ä¸¦é¿ å ÂæÂ¾ç½®å¨å¯è½å 天 ç¶ç½害 ï¼ ä¾Âå¦Âå°é ï¼Âè æÂÂè½並é æÂÂ人å¡åÂÂå·çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂ工你å ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨並使ç¨æÂÂæÂ¶åº宠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨èÂÂé¢çÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Â籤ä¸Â齿ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå©èÂÂå¥ç é¡Âè²æ¨Â示æÂÂ示ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂç §é¡Âè²æÂÂ示並æÂ£ç¢ºå®Âè£ÂæÂ è²å¨ã å¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ示å ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã 1 å¦Â以ä¸Âæ¯Âå¼µåÂÂçÂÂæÂÂ示 ï¼ å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¶å°Âé½ÂÃ¥ÂÂèªçÂÂä¸Âå´èÂÂä¸Âå´èº絲åÂÂï¼Âç¶å¾Âå® å ¨å°åºå®Âèº絲ã 4 é» /3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨é Â置@2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨é Â置@注æÂ â¢ é£æÂ¥æÂÂæÂ¶æÂ ï¼ ä¸Âå¯åÂÂ試æÂ¿èÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã éÂÂ樣 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂé æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶æÂÂ壠ï¼ÂæÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶åÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂÂè½æÂÂå°Âè´å®ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂå£ÂæÂ´ å å´éÂÂã å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨çÂÂ丠HTZ180DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç°繠æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂåºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ã HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½® ãÂÂä¸Âç½®åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂÂåºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ã HTZ280DVD/280D VD-AP æ©Âå çÂÂä¸Âç½®åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂåºå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂã HTZ282 DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂåªæÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂ åº宠åÂÂã å®Âè£Âå â¢ è«Âè¨Âå¾ÂæÂÂè²å¨å¾Âé @åÂÂæÂÂå ¶éÂÂéÂÂå¯å°Âè´èº絲 é¬Âè« ï¼ æÂÂçÂÂå£Âç¨æÂÂæÂÂå£Âé£以æÂ¯æÂ ï¼ èÂÂé æÂÂæÂ è²å¨æÂÂè½ ã è«Â確å®ÂæÂ¨è¦Âå®Âè£ÂçÂÂé£é¢çÂÂçÂÂ強度 足以æÂ¯æÂ´éÂÂäºÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã è«Âå¿å®Âè£Âå¨è åÂÂæÂ¿æÂ è»Â質çÂÂçÂÂå£Âä¸Âã éÂÂ註 1 使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âè« å¿çÂÂèµ·ç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂè²å¨ï¼ÂèÂÂæÂ¯å°Âå®Âå æÂ¾å¨åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ夠60 ð é¢åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨以åÂÂå¾ÂæÂ ä½³é³æÂÂãÂ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂá£ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÿá áÂ§Ã à ¤Âàâá 4 áÂÂû à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÿá áÂ£Ã ÃªÃ Ã¹Ã à ¤Âàâá 3 áÂÂû á ÃÂà ¡¿Ã±á¸ á¡áÂÂáÂÂá¡ á§àêàáÂ´à ¹ ÃÂà ¢ á ÃÂà ¡¿Ã±á¸ á¡áÂÂáÂÂá¡ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÿá á£àêàáÂ§Ã Ã¹Ã à ¤Âàá§àâá áÂ´à ¹ ÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂá£ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂà ¢ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 7 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 01 8 Zhtw ⢠å®Âè£Âèº絲æÂªé ã è«Â使ç¨é©åÂÂçÂÂå£ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå å¯ 以æÂ¯æÂÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂèº絲ã 注æÂ â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä¸Â確å®ÂçÂÂå£ÂçÂÂæÂÂ質 Ã¥ÂÂ強度 ï¼ è«Â洽詢尠æ¥Â人å¡çÂÂæÂÂè¦Âã â¢ å ÂéÂÂå°ÂæÂ¼å ä¸ÂæÂ£ç¢ºå®Âè£ÂæÂÂé æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂå¤ÂæÂÂæÂ å£Âï¼Âä¸Âæ¦Âä¸Âè² ä»»ä½Â責任ã å é©ç¨æÂ¼å®Â裠HTZ180/181 D VD æ©Âå çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶ ⢠å¨å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¶å®Âè£Âå°æÂÂè²å¨è é¢æÂ ï¼ è«Â確實åÂÂé å°Â鍿©ÂéÂÂè´ÂçÂÂèº絲ä¸Âç·Âåº å®Âã â¢ è«Âå¿å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¶å®Âè£Âå°ä¸Âç½®æÂ è²å¨ã æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âä¹Âå ¶ä»Â注æÂÂäºÂ頠⢠å°Â主è¦ÂçÂÂå·¦åÂÂç½®åÂÂå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨é» è¦Âæ©Âå ©å´åÂÂçÂÂçÂÂè·Âé¢丠ã â¢ 使ç¨ 5 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂæÂ ï¼ å°Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Â裠å¨ç¨Âé«ÂæÂ¼è³æÂ悮Â度çÂÂ你置以å¾Âå°æÂÂä½³æÂÂæÂ ã é Âé²äºÂ頠@⢠å°Âä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨é» è¦Âæ©Âä¸ÂæÂ¹æÂ ï¼ è«Â確實 ç¨è 帶æÂÂå ¶ä»Âé©ç¶çÂÂæÂ¹ æ³Âå°Âå ¶åº宠ã å¦å @æÂÂè²å¨å¯è½æÂÂå å°éÂÂçÂÂå¤ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèÂÂå¾Âé»覠æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂè½ ï¼ å±åÂÂé°è¿ÂçÂÂ人塿ÂÂé æÂÂæÂÂè² å¨æÂ å£Âã â¢ è«Â確å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂ裸é²çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ç·Âå·²æÂ²ç¹Âå¨ä¸Âèµ· 並å®Âå ¨æÂÂå ¥æÂÂè²å¨端å ã èÂ¥æÂÂä»»ä½Â裸é²çÂÂå° ç·Â碰觸å°èÂÂé¢æÂ¿ ï¼ åÂÂ黿ºÂå¯è½æÂÂå æÂ¤åÂÂæÂ·ä»¥ çÂÂå®Âå ¨ã â¢ æÂŒÂÂç½® ã ä¸Âç½® ã ç°ç¹ÂæÂ è²å¨åÂÂç¶ÂéÂÂé²ç£Âè ç ã ç¶è @éÂÂè¦Âå®Âè£Âä½Âç½®èÂÂå® ï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ å®Âè£Â太éÂÂé è¿Âé»è¦Âæ©Âç« é¢æÂ ï¼ ä»ÂæÂÂå¯è½ç¼ç è²彩失çÂÂçÂÂç¾象 ã å¦ÂæÂÂç¼çÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®æÂ å½¢ ï¼ è«Âå° é»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂï¼ 15 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂè³ 30 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂå¾ åÂÂæÂÂé ã å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âä»Âç¶åÂÂå¨ ï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂÂè²å¨宠è£Âå¨é é¢é»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂå°æÂ¹ ã â¢ éÂÂä½Âé³æÂªç¶Âé²ç£ÂèÂÂç @å æÂ¤ä¸Âå¯æÂºå¾Â太éÂÂé è¿Âé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂ顯示å¨ãÂÂç£ÂæÂ§å²åÂÂåªÂé« ï¼Âå¦Â磠ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂé³帶æÂÂéÂÂå½± 帶ç ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂºæÂ¾çÂÂä½Âç½® 亦ä¸ÂæÂÂ太éÂÂæÂ¥è¿ÂéÂÂä½Âé³ ã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½® ï¼ HTZ280/ 282DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Âå HTZ282DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä½Âé³ æÂÂè²å¨å®Â裠å¨çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂ天è±æÂ¿ä¸ ã å®ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂè½èÂÂ使人 Ã¥ÂÂå·ã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¾å¨ Ã¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨çÂÂä¸Âé¢ ï¼ å¦åÂÂæÂÂè½æÂÂå¯è½å°Âè´人 å¡åÂÂå· ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ280DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã 5 mm à7 mm ÿâáÂ´à ¹ ÃÂÃÂäà5 mm 10 mm áÂ´à ¹ÂÃÂáÂÂäàHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 8 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 9 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 2 ç« æÂ¥ç· åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ çºäºÂå¾Âå°æÂÂ好çÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼ è«Âå¦Âä¸ÂæÂÂ示è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ãÂÂå·¦åÂÂç½®åÂÂå³ Ã¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂ該ç¸è·Âç´ 1.8 m è³ 2.7 m ã ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨åÂÂè HTZ180DVD ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠å¨é£æÂ¥æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ è«Â確實尠黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂ並å¾ÂçÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座æÂÂä¸Âé» æºÂç·Âã å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âå¾ ï¼ è«Âå°Â黿ºÂç·Âé£æÂ¥è³çÂÂå£ÂæÂ åº§ä¸Âã è¦å â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼é¯誤çµÂè£ÂæÂÂå®Â裠ã çÂÂå£Âå®Âè£Â強度ä¸Âè¶³ ã å®Âè£Âåºå®Âé Âä»¶ï¼ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂ¿å±Âåº宠é Âä»¶ï¼ ãÂÂ使 ç¨é¯誤æÂÂ天ç¶ç½害é æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂ夠äºÂä»¶ ï¼ å ÂéÂÂ榠ä¸ÂæÂÂè² ä»»ä½Â責任ã 1 çµÂ裠AM ç°åÂÂ天ç·Âã a. å°Âè ³æÂ¶æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç®Âé ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¹åÂÂã b. æÂÂç°åÂÂ夾å°蠳æÂ¶ä¸Âã c. å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³åºå®Âå°çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Â表é¢ 丠@è«Âå¨å© ç¨èº絲å Âåºå®Âè ³æÂ¶ä¹Âå¾ ï¼ÂæÂÂ¥ èÂÂå·è¡ÂæÂ¥é© b ã 建è°æÂ¨å Âå©ç¨èº絲åºå®Âè ³æÂ¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¾Â決å®ÂæÂÂ¥ æÂ¶å¼·åº¦ã AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R Y P B P R L R FRONT CENTER L R SURROUND SUB WOOFER VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP âáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂùÃÂÃ Ã¢à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂà ¤ÂÃÂÃ Ã¿à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂêÃÂÃ à ¥¨Ã´à ¥²à ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂà ¹ÂÃÂàÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂá§ÃÂàÿáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂá£ÃÂÃ à ²°á ÂÃÂá áÂ¬à ºÂá¡ ÃÂà ºÂáÂÂá°ä FM ÃÂᤠAM áÂÂà  ¯ÃÂᤠᨠa ᨠb ᨠc HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 9 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 10 Zhtw 2 飿ÂÂ¥ AM å FM 天ç·Âã 1 a. è«ÂæÂÂé¤ AM 天ç·ÂéÂÂ屬ç·Âä¸ÂçÂÂä¿Âè·夠ç® ã é£æÂÂ¥ AM ç°åÂÂ天ç·ÂçÂÂæ¯Âè¡éÂÂ屬ç·Âè³åÂÂå AM 天 ç·Â端åÂÂä¸Âã 2 å¨åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ端åÂÂ丠@å°Âåºå®ÂçÂÂå¾Âä¸Âå£ÂæÂ é @ç¶徠æÂÂå ¥éÂÂ屬ç·Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂãÂÂé ä¸Âåºå®Âã b. æÂ FM 天締3 æÂÂé Âå£Âå ¥ FM 天ç·ÂæÂÂ座çÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂæÂÂ¥ 蠳堧ã 3-1 é£æÂ¥æ¯ÂåªæÂ è²å¨ã â¢ é£æÂ¥éÂÂ屬ç·Âè³æÂÂè²å¨ä¸Âã â¢ æÂÂè½Â並æÂ¯ä¸Âæ¯Âæ¢ÂéÂÂ屬ç·Â丠çÂÂä¿Âè·å¤Âç®ã â¢ å°Âé¡Âè²æ¨Â示ç·Âé Â好æ¨Â籤 ä¸ÂçÂÂé¡Âè²æÂÂ示 ï¼ ç¶徠å°Âé¡Âè²æ¨Â示ç·ÂæÂÂ堥素è² ï¼ ï¼Â端ï¼Âè å¦ 丠æ¢Âç·ÂæÂÂå ¥é»Âè² ï¼ âÂÂï¼Â端ã å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180DVD æ©Â種@é¸æÂ 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â侠砧以ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ¥é© a å° c ä¾ÂæÂ¾ç½®æÂ è²å¨ã a. æ¯ÂåªæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂåºÂ座è¦Âå°ÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ä¸ÂæÂ¹ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ§½è£Âä¸Âï¼Âå¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ示ã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠å°Â天ç·ÂæÂ¾ç½®å¨é é¢æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨æÂÂå ¶ ä»Âé£æÂ¥ç·ÂçÂÂä½Âç½®ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂ使ç¨æÂÂéÂÂ天 ç·ÂçÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ä¸Âè¯ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 20 é Âç æÂ¹å FM æÂ¥æÂ¶ä¸Âè¯ æÂÂ第 42 é Âç é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締ä¾ÂæÂ¹åÂÂã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âå®Âè£Âé¨é çÂÂç°形天ç·Â以å¤ÂçÂÂä»»ä½Â天ç·Âï¼ÂæÂÂå¦Â第 42 é ÂæÂÂè¿°çÂÂå¤Âé¨天ç·Âã 2 ⢠è«Âå¿è®Âå ¶æÂ¥è§¸å°éÂÂ屬ç©é«Â並é¿ å ÂæÂºå¨é»蠦ãÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Âé»氣è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé è¿Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¶é³æ©ÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ ä¸Âè¯ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å°Âæ¯Âæ¢Â天ç·ÂéÂÂ屬ç·ÂéÂÂæÂ°æÂÂå ¥ ç¸å°ÂçÂÂ端åÂÂå §æÂÂ坿ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¹åÂÂã â¢ çºäºÂè½æÂÂæÂÂä½³ç æÂ¥æÂ¶æ¢Âä»¶ï¼Âè«Âå¿尠AM ç°åÂÂ天ç·ÂéÂÂ屬ç·Âè§£éÂÂæÂÂå°Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂ´ Ã¥ÂÂç°åÂÂ天ç·Âã 3 欲確ä¿ÂæÂÂä½³çÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æ¢Âä»¶ï¼Âè«Â確實尠FM 天ç·Âå®Â堨伸å±ÂéÂÂä¾Âï¼Âä¸Âå¯æÂ²æÂ²æÂÂæÂ¸æÂ æÂ¼æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂå¾ÂæÂ¹ã 1 2 3 á ÃÂáÂÂñᤠÃÂà ´Âà ¯¦ÃÂà ¶µáÂÂá£àá ÃÂáÂÂÃ±à ¯¦á ÃÂà ´Âà ¯¦ÃÂà ¡¤à ¥®ÃÂÃÂá à ¼Âà(âÂÂ) á ÃÂáÂÂñá¤ à ¤Âà( ) HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 10 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 11 Zhtw English Español English Español b. åºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨ç·Âã å¨測å®ÂæÂÂè²å¨è½ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂçÂÂ鬠ç·Â度徠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鱿ÂÂ¥ ä¸Âä¾Âä¹ÂæÂ¥é©Âï¼ ï¼Âè«Âå©ç¨æÂÂæÂÂä¾ÂçÂÂå¹槽 ä¾Âåºå®ÂæÂ è²å¨ç·Âã c. å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨è½ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè¿ÂçÂÂçÂÂ壠@令ç®Âé Âå°Âé½Â以宠æÂÂæÂÂä½³ç ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ãÂÂè¨Âç½® ã éÂÂæÂ¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã 模å¼Âï¼Âè«Âè½Âå æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ 使åºÂ座ä¸Âç ï¢ ç®Âé Âè½å°Âé½ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ä¸Âç ï¡ ï¼ FRONT SURROUND ï¼Âç® é ÂãÂÂé æÂ¼ ã å 大 Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂã 模å¼Âï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢ ãÂÂå¦Âé æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã è ãÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂã 模张çÂÂ詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 ã 注æÂ â¢ çºäºÂé¿å Âç¼çÂÂæÂÂ夠@è«Â確å®Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¯æÂ£ 確åºå®ÂæÂ¼åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ä¹Âä¸Âã â¢ è«Âå¿å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå°çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨蠳æÂ¶ä¸ ä¾Âå®ÂæÂ 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©Â種@a. é£æÂ¥ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂ ï¼Â以ç¸åÂÂæÂ¹æ³Âå° Y æÂ¥ç· å ©ç«¯é£æÂ¥è³堩åÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè² å¨ã é¸æÂÂç¨æÂÂæÂ¶çµÂè£Âç 4 é»ÂãÂÂ3 é»ÂæÂ 2 é»ÂæÂºè¨ÂæÂÂï¼ è«Âä¾Âç §ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ¥é© b ã b. å®ÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ ï¼ è«Âåºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· ã å°Âé£ æÂ¥ç·Âåºå®Â卿ÂÂæÂ¶çÂÂæºÂ槽丠ã 3-2 é£æÂ¥æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ä¸ÂçÂÂæ¯Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨端åÂÂã â¢ é£æÂ¥å¦ä¸Â端è³æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ èÂÂé¢ä¸ÂæÂÂæ¨Â示é¡Âè²ç æÂÂè²å¨端åÂÂä¸ÂãÂÂ確å®Â已宠堨æÂÂå ¥ã æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂé Âå¨éÂÂ屬締端èÂÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ端åÂÂæÂÂ覠é£æÂ¥çÂÂæÂ¯ä¸ÂæÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂè² å¨端åÂÂä¾Â颿ÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ ä¸ÂãÂÂè«Â確實æÂ£ç¢ºå°é£æÂ¥ã Y à ´Âà ¯¦á¤ ÃÂÃȇ¡ ñàáÂÂàïàáÂÂàHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 11 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 12 Zhtw 注æÂ â¢ éÂÂäºÂæÂÂè²å¨端åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ帶æÂ å± éªé»壠ã çºé¿å Âå¨ é£æÂ¥æÂÂè«é¢æÂÂè²å¨ç·ÂæÂÂç¼ çÂÂéÂȾÂÂå±éª ï¼ å¨觸 æÂ¸ä»»ä½ÂæÂªçµÂç·£é¨åÂÂä¹Âå @è«Âå Âå°Â黿ºÂç·ÂæÂÂé  æÂÂé¢ã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Â鍿©ÂéÂÂè´Â以å¤ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬ç³» çµ±ä¸Âã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âé¨éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥è³ä¸ÂæÂ¯é¨æÂ¬ç³»çµ± ä¸Âèµ·éÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤§å¨ ã é£æÂ¥è³堶ä»ÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤§å¨丠å¯è½æÂÂå°Âè´æÂ éÂÂæÂÂèµ·ç«ã â¢ é£æÂ¥æÂÂé Âå¾ ï¼ è¼ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥ç·Â以確å®Âé£æÂ¥ç·Â端 ç¢ ç¢é£æÂ¥è³端å ã é£æÂ¥ä¸Âè¯å¯è½é æÂÂéÂÂè¨Âå è² é³ä¸ÂæÂ·ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥ç·ÂçÂÂç·Âè·¯æÂ£å¥½é åº端åÂÂ夠@è®Âç·Âè·¯ äºÂç¸æÂ¥è§¸ ï¼ é æÂÂæÂ´å¤§å¨éÂÂ大çÂÂé¡Â夠負輠ã é 樣å¯è½å°Âè´æÂ´å¤§å¨åÂÂæÂ¢ä½ ç¨ ï¼ çÂÂè³å¯è½æÂÂ壠æÂ´å¤§å¨ã 4 å°Âå ¶ä¸Âä¸Â端é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂè¦Â頻輸堥 æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ è«Â使ç¨éÂÂè´ÂçÂÂè¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç· ã 5 å°Âå¦ä¸Â端é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ç è¦Â頻輸åºæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Âé ÂÃ¥ÂÂé²æÂ·æÂÂè¡ ã è«Âå¿使ç¨影é³é£æÂ¥ç·Âé éÂÂéÂÂæÂ¾å½±æ©Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé£æÂ¥è³ æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ© ï¼ å¦å æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂå½±åÂÂç¡æ³Âå¨æÂ¨çÂÂé» è¦Âæ©Âä¸ÂæÂ£å¸¸é¡¯ç¤º ã 6 é£æÂ¥é»æºÂç·Âã 1 â¢ é£æÂ¥é»æºÂç·Âè³æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ä¸Âç AC æÂÂ座 ã é£æÂ¥é» æºÂç·Âè³çÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座ã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠è«Âå¿使ç¨éÂÂé¨æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂéÂÂè´Âç 堶ä»Â黿ºÂç·Âã â¢ 鍿©ÂéÂÂè´ÂçÂÂé»溠ç·Âé¤äºÂé£æÂ¥æÂ¬ç³»çµ±å¤Âï¼Âè«Âå¿åÂÂå ¶ä»Âç¨éÂÂã AC IN àAC à ¶©à §µ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 12 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 13 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 3 ç« æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 Ã¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼Â第 17 ã 32 ã 43 ã 50 ã 52 以å 54 é Âï¼ 2 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE ï¼Â第 18 ã 32 以å 53 é Âï¼ 3 Ã¥ÂÂè½ 4 ï¦ 5 ï§ 6V O L U M E / â ï¼Â第 19 é Âï¼ 7 ç¢Âç¤ ï¼Â第 18 é Âï¼ 8 éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ ï¼Â第 15 é Âï¼ 9 顯示幠10 USB ä»Âé¢ ï¼Â第 31 é Âï¼ 11 MIC 輸堥æÂÂå ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ 12 PHONES æÂÂå ï¼Â第 23 é Â@顯示幠1 解碼æÂÂ示ç ï¼Â第 22 é Âï¼ DTS å¨ DTS ä¾ÂæºÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 2 PL II å¨ 2 Dolby Pro Logic II 解碼æÂÂ亮起 ï¼ 2 D 卿ÂÂæÂ¾ æÂÂæ¯ÂæÂ¸ä½Â鳿ºÂæÂÂ亮起ã 2P R G S V E ï¼Â第 41 é Âï¼ è²差影åÂÂ輸åº端åÂÂ輸åºéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¨ÂèÂÂæÂ ï¼Â便æÂ äº®èµ·ã 3S O U N D ï¼Â第 23 é Âï¼ SFC 模张ã é³調æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âé«Âé³ ã ä½Â鳿ÂÂéÂÂä½Âé³@ã MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨模张ã è²é³強åÂÂå¨模å¼Âèµ·åÂÂæÂ æÂÂ亮 èµ·ã 4F . S U R R . ï¼Â第 23 é Âï¼ é¸å ãÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂã 模å¼Âï¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã 模张æÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 5R P T å RPT-1 ï¼Â第 28 é Âï¼ RPT å¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé æÂÂ亮起ã RPT-1 å¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾å®æÂ²æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 6P G M ï¼Â第 27 以å 29 é Âï¼ æÂ¤çÂÂæÂ¼ç¯Âç®æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®æÂ æÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 7 調諧卿ÂÂ示ç ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ æÂ¶è½å°廣æÂÂç¯Âç®æÂÂæÂÂ亮起@æÂ¶è½å°章é«Âè² FM 廣æÂÂç¯Âç®æÂÂæÂÂ亮起 ï¼ å¨é¸å FM å® è²éÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 8R D M ï¼Â第 28 é Âï¼ æÂ¤çÂÂå¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮 èµ·ã MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES ï¨ï OPEN /CLOSE ïµ ï ST ANDBY/ ON FUNCTION VOLUME ï¦ï§ MAIN SUB MIC PHONES USB 10 12 5 2 1 7 8 9 3 4 6 11 PRGSVE SOUND DTS F .SURR. 2 PL 2 D RPT -1 kHz PGM MHz RDM 6 12 8 9 7 5 11 3 10 2 1 4 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 13 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 14 Zhtw 9 kHz/MHz ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ çºæÂÂ示åÂÂå Â顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示çÂÂé »çÂÂå®你@kHz é©ç¨æÂ¼ AM ï¼ MHz é©ç¨æÂ¼ FM ï¼Âã 10 Ã¥ÂÂå Â顯示幠11 ï¼Â第 21 é Âï¼ æÂ¤çÂÂå¨ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ æÂÂ亮起ã 12 ï¤ æÂ¤çÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起 ã éÂÂæÂ§å¨ ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示 HTZ280/282DVD-AP ã 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼Â第 17 ã 32 ã 43 ã 50 ã 52 以å 54 é Âï¼ 2 Ã¥ÂÂè½é¸åÂÂæÂÂéµ 1 3 æÂ¸åÂÂéµ ã CLEAR ã DISPLAY ã SLEEP å DVD æÂ§å¶ CLEAR DISPLAY ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT SLEEP ï¼Â第 21 é Âï¼ SHIFT USB RE C ï¼Â第 31 é Âï¼ SHIFT AUDIO ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ éÂÂ註 1 åªæÂ HTZ280/282DVD- AP æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂé ÂÃ¥ÂÂå³輸 å ã 1 USB REC CLEAR TOP MENU TUNE ECHO TUNE KARAOKE MENU MIC VOL PLAYLIST OPEN /CLOSE RETURN SETUP AUTO / STEREO MP3 EXP/ V.ENH SURROUND SOUND CLASS VOLUME CHANNEL T V CONTROL INPUT SHIFT VOLU ME MUTE T.EDIT PRESET PRESET AUDIO ANGLE SLEEP SUBTITLE ADAPTER PORT USB LINE TUNER ( FM/AM ) DVD/CD STANDBY /ON ZOOM DISPLAY 23 456 789 0 HOME MENU 1 2 3 ENTER 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 14 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 14 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 15 Zhtw English Español English Español SHIFT SUBTITLE ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT ANGLE ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT ZOOM ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ 4T O P M E N U ï¼Â第 19 以å 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT SETUP @第 17 ã 20 ã 41 ã 43 ã 44 ã 45 ã 51 ã 52 以å 57 é  ï¼ 5 SHIFT KARAOKE ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ SHIFT ECHO ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ SHIFT ï / SHIFT ï ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ éÂÂæ¨ÂæÂÂéµ ENTER TUNE ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ PRESET ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ 6H O M E M E N U 7 鳿ÂÂæÂ§å¶ AUTO / STEREO ï¼Â第 22 以å 23 é Âï¼ SURROUND ï¼Â第 22 以å 23 é Âï¼ SOUND ï¼Â第 23 以å 24 é Âï¼ MP3 EXP / V.ENH ï¼Â第 24 é Âï¼ 8 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ ï¼Â第 19 以å 25 é Âï¼ 9T V C O N T R O L æÂÂéµ å¯ç¨æÂ¼æÂ§å¶å ÂéÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Âã 1 10 SHIFT 11 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE ï¼Â第 18 ãÂÂ32 以å 53 é Âï¼ 12 PLAYLIST æÂÂéµ ï¼Â第 27 é Âï¼ 13 MIC VOL /â ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ 14 MENU ï¼Â第 19 ã 26 以å 30 é Âï¼ 15 RETURN 16 調諧å¨æÂ§å¶éµ CLASS ï¼Â第 21 é Âï¼ SHIFT T.EDIT ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ 17 MUTE 18 VOLUME /â ï¼Â第 18 é Âï¼ å®Âè£ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é»池1 æÂÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨èÂÂé¢ä¸ÂçÂÂé»池室èÂÂã 2 å°Âç §é»池室堧çÂÂæ¨Â示 ï¼ ï« ï¼Âïª ï¼Âå°Âå ©é¡ AA/R6 é»池æÂÂå ¥é»池室堧ã 3 éÂÂä¸Âé»池室èÂÂã 注æÂ é»池使ç¨ä¸Âç¶æÂÂå°Âè´å¦Âé» æ± æ¶²å¤Âæ¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè£ÂçÂÂå± éªç¼çÂÂãÂÂè«Âéµå®Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂäºÂ頠@⢠å°Âé»池æÂÂå ¥é»池槽æÂÂï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿ ä¾Âé»池槽堧 çÂÂæÂÂ示ï¼Âå°Âé»池çÂÂ極æÂ§å° æºÂæÂ£æ¥µ ï« èÂÂ負極 ïª 極æÂ§ã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂå¿å°ÂæÂ°èÂÂé»池混ç¨ã â¢ ç¸åÂÂé¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé»池å¯è½æÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé»壠ï¼Âè¦Âå çÂÂèÂÂå®ÂãÂÂè«Âå¿混ç¨ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂå çÂÂçÂÂé»池ã â¢ èÂÂçÂÂ廢èÂÂé»池æÂ ï¼ è«Âéµå®ÂæÂ¿åºÂæ¢Âä¾ÂæÂÂé©ç¨æÂ¼ è²´åÂÂæÂÂå°åÂÂçÂÂç°å¢Â堬報æÂ ä»¤è¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 æÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂéµ 1 è¶ éÂÂä¸Âç§Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠CLEARãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦ÂæÂÂçµÂå æÂÂï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂéµ 2ãÂÂæÂ£ç¢ºåÂÂæÂÂæÂ§å¶å¾Âï¼Âå° TV CONTROL ïµ æÂ åÂÂé»è¦Â並æÂÂä¸Âå®Â坿ÂÂä½ å°é»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 15 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 16 Zhtw ⢠çºäºÂé¿å Âé»池æ¼Âæ¶²ï¼Âé·æÂÂé @ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ æÂÂæÂ´ ä¹ ï¼ ä¸Â使ç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂåºéÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂé» æ± ã å¦ÂæÂÂæ¼Âæ¶² ï¼ è«Âå°Âå¿ÂæÂ¦æÂÂé»池槽堧çÂÂä»» ä½ é»池液ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂç¨æÂ°é»池ã â¢ è«Âå¿è®ÂæÂ¸æÂ¾ÂÂå ¶ä»Âç©é«Â壠å¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨丠@å çº éÂÂ樣å¯è½å£Âä½ÂæÂÂéµ ï¼ é æÂÂé»池çÂÂéÂȎÂÂæÂ´å¿«è ç¡ã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂå¿å¨è»Âå §æÂÂå ç±å¨éÂÂè¿ÂçÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°é½å Âç´ å°ÂæÂÂéÂÂç±çÂÂç°å¢Âä¸Â使ç¨æÂ åÂÂæÂ¾é»池ã éÂÂç±ç ç°å¢Âå¯è½å°Âè´é»池破æ¼Âã éÂÂç± ã çÂÂç¸æÂÂèµ· ç«ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¸Âå°Âé»池çÂÂ使ç¨ 壽彿ÂÂæÂÂè½ã éÂÂç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨ éÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂ使ç¨ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂçº跠é¢åÂÂé¢æÂ¿æÂÂæÂÂå¨ç 7 m å §ï¼ÂèÂÂä¸Âå¨ 30 ð å §ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨åÂÂ顯示è£Â置习éÂÂæÂÂéÂÂç¤Âç© ï¼ æÂÂ妠æÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂªä»¥æÂ£ç¢ºè§Â度æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示è£Âç½®çÂÂé æÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯è½ ç¡æ³Âä½Âç¨ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂé½å Âç´å°ÂæÂÂè¢å ÂçÂÂçÂÂå¼·å¶砧å°æÂ¬æ©Âç éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ä¸Âï¼ åÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ 常你ç¨ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂå¨é è¿ÂæÂÂç¼å°Âç´ å¤Âç· çÂÂè£Âç½® ï¼ æÂÂå ¶ä»Â裠置çÂÂç´ å¤Âç·ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂä½Âç½® 使ç¨æÂ¬æ© ï¼ åÂÂéÂÂæÂ§ å¨å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸ä½Âç¨ ã æÂ¤å¤ ï¼ ä½¿ç¨æÂ¤éÂÂæÂ§å¨ å¯è½é æÂÂå ¶ä»Âè£Âç½®çÂÂéÂÂä½ ç°常ã â¢ éÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂæÂÂä½Âç¯Âå è®Âå¾Â太çÂÂæÂ ï¼Âè«ÂæÂ´æÂÂé» æ± ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 16 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 17 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 4 ç« éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ é¸æÂÂæÂ¨çºæÂ¨çÂÂèÂÂè½åÂÂç°å¢Âå®ÂæÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨è¨Âå®Âç æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã 第ä¸Â次éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ系統黿ºÂæÂÂï¼Â顯示ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂº è¨Âè¨Âå® ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂªå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®Âå³éÂÂéÂÂç³» çµ±é»溠@ä¸Â次éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ系統黿ºÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ次 顯示ç¸åÂÂ堧容ã 1 æÂ ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼ ç¶å¾Â確èªÂ顯示å¹Â顯示 WELCOME ï¼ÂæÂ¡è¿Â使ç¨@ã 2 SELECT SPEAKER LAYOUT å°Âå¨顯示å¹Â丠å·è¡Âç´ 10 ç§ÂéÂÂã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸åÂÂé©ç¶çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã æÂÂ堩種æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Â模å¼Âï¼ 5 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âå 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã å¦ÂéÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂèÂÂ模å¼Â說æÂÂçÂÂ詳細è³ÂæÂÂï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ãÂÂè¨Âå®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã ã â¢ 5 SPOT ï¼ å°Âå ©åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¾ç½®å¨èÂÂè½你置å¾Âé¢ï¼ÂæÂÂé©ç¨æÂ¼ 5.1 è²éÂÂå®¶åºÂé»影é¢ç è²é³ã â¢ 4 SPOT ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD ï¼ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ¯ ç¨æÂ¼èÂÂè½ç°ç¹Âè²çÂÂæ¨ÂæºÂæÂºè¨Âï¼ é¡Âä¼¼ 5 é»ÂæÂ è²å¨æÂºè¨ÂãÂÂå ©åÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨å åÂ¥æÂ¾å¨å³å´ Ã¥ÂÂå·¦åÂÂï¼Â並æÂ´é½Âå°æÂºæÂ¾å¨é»覠æÂÂéÂÂã â¢ 3 SPOT ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ¯ç¨æÂ¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã 模å¼Âç 堸åÂÂæÂºè¨ ãÂÂå ©åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¾å¨èÂÂè½ä½Âç½® Ã¥ÂÂé¢ã â¢ 2 SPOT ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD ï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¤é  ç½®é©ç¨æÂ¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ãÂÂ模张ï¼Âå 3 é»ÂæÂ è²å¨æÂºè¨Âç¸å ãÂÂå ©åÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨åÂÂå¥æÂ¾å¨ å³å´åÂÂå·¦åÂÂï¼Â並æÂ´é½Âå°æÂº æÂ¾å¨é»è¦ÂæÂÂéÂÂã 4 æÂÂ丠ENTER 確èªÂ調æÂ´ã 1 è¨Âç½®è²éÂÂé³é è¨Âç½®æÂ¨ä¸»è¦ÂèÂÂè½ä½Âç½®çÂÂç¸ å°Âè²éÂÂé³éÂÂã 2 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SOUNDSET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å CH LEVEL ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å TESTTONE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 測試é³調æÂÂæÂÂ以ä¸Âé ÂåºÂ輸 åº ï¼Âå¾Âç®åÂÂèÂÂè½模张ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨@@⢠L ï¼ å·¦åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠C ï¼Âä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠R ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠SR ï¼Âå³ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ⢠SL ï¼Âå·¦ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ⢠SW ï¼ÂéÂÂä½Âé³ 3 éÂÂ註 1 èÂ¥è¦Âè®ÂæÂ´è¨Âå®Âï¼Âè«ÂæÂ SHIFT SETUP ï¼Â使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å SYS SETï¼Âç¶å¾Â使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å LAYOUT 以éÂÂå§Âè¨Âå®Âç¨ÂåºÂã 2 ⢠æÂ¤é  å å¨é¸å DVD/CD ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½使ç¨ãÂÂå¦è«Â確å®Âè³橠å°ÂæÂªæÂ¥ä¸Âã â¢ è¦Â調æÂ´æÂÂè è½é³æÂÂä¾ÂæºÂçÂÂæÂ´é«Â平衡ï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUPï¼Â使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å SOUNDSETï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERãÂÂ使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å CH LEVEL ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERãÂÂ使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂè²éÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ以 ï©/ïª 調æÂ´è²éÂÂä½ÂæºÂã å¨æÂ¨å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENT ERã 3 ç±æÂ¼éÂÂä½Â鳿ÂÂç¢çÂÂè¶ ä½ÂéÂÂé » çÂÂï¼Âå æÂ¤å ¶é³æÂÂè½起ä¾ÂæÂÂè¼Â實éÂÂ丠çÂÂé³éÂÂå®ÂéÂÂä¸ÂäºÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 17 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 18 Zhtw 5 使ç¨ VOLUME /â 以調æÂ´é³éÂÂè³ é©度çÂÂ篠åÂÂã 1 6 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以輪æµÂ調æÂ´è²éÂÂçÂÂé³éÂÂã ç¶åÂÂå¨主è¦ÂèÂÂè½ä½Âç½®ä¸Âï¼ÂæÂ¨æÂÂ該æÂÂè½å°ä¾Âèª毠åÂÂæÂÂè²å¨åÂÂ樣é³éÂÂçÂÂ測試é³調ãÂÂè²éÂÂé³éÂÂç¯Âå çº ñ 10 dB ã 7 å¨æÂ¨å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以éÂÂåº測試é³調 è¨Âç½®ã 使ç¨å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢ ï¼ OSDï¼ çºäºÂ使ç¨æÂ¹ä¾¿ï¼ÂæÂ¬ç³»çµ± æÂ¡ç¨äºÂ大éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå½¢åÂÂçÂÂå¨ å±Â顯示ç«é¢ ï¼ OSD ï¼Âã æÂÂæÂÂç«é¢çÂÂå°Â覽æÂ¹å¼ÂåºæÂ¬ä¸Â並ç¡ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«Â使ç¨ ï© ã ïª ã ï« ã ï¬ è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂç½頠ç® @並æÂÂ丠ENTER å®ÂæÂÂé¸åÂÂã 2 éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠æÂ´æÂ¾ÂÂå @ãÂÂé¸åÂÂã æÂ¯æÂÂ使ç¨游æ¨ÂæÂÂéµåÂÂç½ å¨å±Âç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂé  ç®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ ä¸ ENTER ä¹ÂæÂÂã æÂÂ示 â¢ å¨ OSD ç«é¢ä¸ÂæÂ¹çÂÂæÂÂéµæÂ åÂÂå¯åÂÂ訴æÂ¨æÂÂä½ ç«é¢æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨çÂÂæÂÂéµã ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ã CDã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã DivX 覠頻 /WMV å WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC çÂÂ碠çÂÂçÂÂåºæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âå¨æÂ¤åÂÂé©ç¨ ã æÂ´å¤ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ æÂÂå¨第 6 ç« ä¸Â詳細說æÂÂã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 â¢ å¨æÂ´æÂ¾ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠@ã DVD ã ä¸Âè©ÂæÂÂçÂÂæÂ¯ DVD- Video ã DVD-R å DVD-RWã 1 å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨å°ÂæÂªéÂÂæ©Âï¼Âè«Âå°Âå® éÂÂæ©Âã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾å«æÂÂå½±åÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå°Âé» è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂéÂÂ並確å®Âè¨Âç½®çÂÂæÂ¯æÂ£ 確çÂÂè¦Â頻輸堥ã 2 æÂÂ丠ï¨ OPEN /CLOSE 以置堥ç¢ÂçÂÂã æ¨Â籤颿ÂÂä¸Â置堥ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âå©ç¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âæ§½å°ÂæºÂç¢Âç ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç½®å ¥çÂÂæÂ¯éÂÂé¢ DVD ç¢Âç @置堥æÂÂè«Âå° æÂ³è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂä¸Â颿ÂÂä¸Âï¼ ã 3 æÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Â以éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂæÂ¯ DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼Â便 æÂÂåºç¾ä¸Âé¸å®ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 19 é Âç DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD PBC é¸å® 堧容@以çÂÂçÂ¥å°Â覽çÂÂæÂ¹æ³Âã èÂ¥æÂ¯æÂ¨ç½®å ¥çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂç¶ä¸Âå«æÂ JPEG ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå§Âå¹» çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã èÂÂå ¶ç¸éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 25 é  ç æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã â¢ èÂ¥ç¢ÂçÂÂå §å« DivX è¦Âé » /WMV Ã¥ÂÂå ¶ä»ÂåªÂé«Â檠æ¡Âé¡Âå @ä¾Â妠MP3 ï¼ ï¼Âé¦Âå Âè«Âå¾Âè¢å¹ÂæÂÂä½ ç«é¢ ï¼ OSD ï¼Âä¸Âé¸åÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DivX è¦Âé » / WMV æªÂæ¡ ï¼ DivX / WMVï¼ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂåªÂé«Â檠æ¡Âé¡Âå @MP3 / WMA/ JPEG/ MPEG-4 AAC ï¼Âã éÂÂ註 1 é³ éÂÂè¨Âå®Âçº 51 æÂÂ以ä¸ÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ç¡æ³Âé¸æÂ TESTTONE ä¸Âè²éÂÂé³éÂÂè¨Âå®Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°éÂÂå¶ãÂÂæÂ¤ å¤Âï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂä»»ä½ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂè²é é³éÂÂç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂ訠å®Âå¨ 端ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ大 é³éÂÂä¹ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°éÂÂå¶ã 2 è¢ å¹Âä¿ÂèÂ፬ÂåºÂæÂÂå¨系統éÂÂ置亠åÂÂéÂÂå¾Âåºç¾ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ HOME MENU 顯示ï¼ÂéÂÂåºå¨å±Â顯示 ç«é¢ ï¼ OSDï¼ ã ï«ï©ïªï¬ è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂç½çÂÂé¸å®頠ç® ã ENTER é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½çÂÂé¸å®頠ç® ã RETURN è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂ主é¸å®ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ任你è®ÂæÂ´ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 18 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 19 Zhtw English Español English Español ⢠å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DualD isc ï¼ DVD/CD æ··å 碠çÂÂï¼ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Â堧容格å¼ÂæÂ æÂ¾ç¸容æÂ§ ã 4 é³éÂÂ調æÂ´ã è«Â使ç¨ VOLUME /â ä¾ÂæÂ§å¶é³éÂÂã åºæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ 以ä¸Â表格æÂÂ示çºéÂÂæÂ§å¨ä¸Âç¨以æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂåºæÂ¬ æÂ§å¶ã 1 æÂ¨å¨第 6 ç« ä¸Âå¯以æÂ¾å°堶ä»ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å è½ã æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ¨åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ ï¼ RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ åÂÂ樣æÂ åºç¾å¨è¢å¹Âä¸Â@表示æÂ¨å¯以å¾Â該é»Âä½Âç½®ä¾ÂæÂ¢å¾© æÂÂæÂ¾ã å°ÂæÂ¼ DVD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD è è¨Âï¼Âå³ 使 é åº@æÂÂæÂ¾ä½Â置亦æÂÂå²åÂÂå¨è¨ÂæÂ¶é«Â裠ã 2 ä¸Â次æÂ¨ç½®å ¥ ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ ï¼ è¢å¹Âä¸Â峿ÂÂ顯示 LAST MEM ï¼ÂæÂÂçµÂ訠æÂ¶ï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè®ÂæÂ¨å¾ÂæÂ¤æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³è¦Â渠é¤æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂä½Âç½®ï¼Âè«Âå¨è¢å¹Â丠顯示 RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣æÂ ï¼ æÂ ä¸ ï§ ï¼Âå æÂ¢ï¼ ã DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® 許夠DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂå §å«æÂ¨å¯以é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Âè§ è³Â堧容çÂÂé¸å®ã æÂÂæÂ ï¼ DVD-Video é¸å®æÂÂèªåÂÂå¨æÂ¨éÂÂå§ÂæÂ æÂ¾æÂ é¡¯ç¤ºå¨è¢å¹Â丠@堶ä»Âç¢ÂçÂÂåªæÂÂå¨æÂ¨æÂÂ丠MENU æÂ TOP MENU æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ顯示ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD PBC é¸å® æÂÂ亠VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD å ·æÂÂæÂ¨å¯å¾Âä¸Âé¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Âè§ è³Â堧容çÂÂé¸å® ã éÂÂäºÂ便æÂ¯ PBC ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶@é¸ å®ã éÂÂ註 1 å¨æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂ亠DV D ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¨æÂÂç¼ç¾æÂÂäºÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶å¯è½ç¡æ³Âç¨ ä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂäºÂé¨å ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ï¤ éÂÂå§Âï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂè¢å¹Âä¸Â顯示 RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ æÂ LAST MEM ï¼ æÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶ï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣 ï¼ åÂÂæÂ æÂ¾ä½Âæ¥Â便æÂÂå¾ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ æÂÂæÂÂå¾Âè¨ÂæÂ¶çÂÂä½ ç½®éÂÂå§ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂÂçµ è¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼Âã ïÂÂ¥ æÂ«åÂÂï¼Âç¹¼çºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂã ï§ å¯åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ÂæÂ¢å¾© æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂ è¢å¹Âä¸Â顯示 RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣@ã ï æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âå¿«è½Âã ï® æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿«è½Âã ï¯ å¯跳è³ç®åÂÂæÂ²ç®æÂÂ章篠çÂÂéÂÂé Âï¼Â以åÂÂå ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Âç« ç¯Âã ï° å¯跳è³ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ²ç®æÂÂç« ç¯Âã æÂ¸åÂÂéµ å¯ç¨以輸 å ¥æ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç®çÂÂç·¨è ã æÂÂ丠ENTER æÂÂéµ以ä½Âåºé¸åÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ å¾ÂæÂÂ鏿¨Âé¡ ï¼ DVD ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD/VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂçÂÂéÂÂé ÂèÂÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂ鏿¨Âé¡ ï¼ VR 模张DV D-R/-R W ï¼Âã 章篠@DVD-Video ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD/VC D/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂçÂÂéÂÂé Âè éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 2 ⢠ãÂÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂå ãÂÂæÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¯è½ä¸Âé© ç¨æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ DVD-Video ç¢Âç ï¼Âé¤ VR 模张DVD- R/-RW å¤Âï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¬æ©Âå¯å²åÂÂæÂÂå¾ÂäºÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä½Âç½® ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ TOP MENU 顯示 DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂç ãÂÂä¸Â層 é¸å®ã @æÂ¤é  åÂÂè½æÂÂè¦Â碠çÂÂèÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂã MENU å¯顯示 DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸ å®ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂÂä¾Â碠çÂÂèÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¯ è½è ãÂÂ丠層é¸å®ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ç¸åÂÂã ï«ï©ïªï¬ å¨ç«é¢ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢移åÂÂ游樠ã ENTER é¸åÂÂç®åÂÂé¸å®ä¸ÂçÂÂé¸頠ã RETURN è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示çÂÂé¸å® ç«é¢ã æÂ¸åÂÂéµ å¯é¸åÂÂç·¨æÂÂèÂÂ碼çÂÂé¸å®é¸頠ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ ãÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTER æÂÂéµ以ä½Âåºé¸åÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 19 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 20 Zhtw æÂ¨å¯以ç´æÂ¥å©ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ é¸åÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Âä¸Âç¨æÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ æÂÂéµä¾ÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂèÂÂç¡ é Âå°Â覽 PBC é¸å®ï¼Â便坿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ´å¼µ P BC VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã èÂÂè½æÂ¶é³橠調諧å¨å¯以æÂ¥æÂ¶ FM å AM 堩種廣æÂÂï¼Â並è®ÂæÂ¨ è¨ÂæÂ¶åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶è½çÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Â使æÂ¨ç¡é Âæ¯Â次è¦ÂæÂ¶è½æÂ éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調諧ã 1 æÂÂ丠TUNER 以åÂÂæÂÂ調諧å¨ ï¼ ç¶å¾Âé£çºÂæÂÂ以 é¸å AM æÂ FM 波段ã è¢å¹ÂæÂ¤æÂÂæÂÂ顯示波段å 頻çÂÂã 2 調é¸éÂÂè¦ÂçÂÂé »çÂÂã éÂÂ裡æÂÂä¸Â種調諧模å¼Âï¼ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé«ÂéÂÂ@⢠æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調諧 ï¼ é£çºÂæÂ TUNE 以æÂ¹è®ÂæÂÂ顯示çÂÂé » çÂÂã â¢ èªåÂÂ調諧 ï¼ æÂÂä½ TUNE ï¼ ç´å°æÂÂ顯示çÂÂé »ç éÂÂå§Âè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂçºæÂ¢ ï¼ ç¶å¾Âå°ÂæÂÂéµæÂ¾é ã ä¸ÂæÂ¦æÂ¾å° ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂȌ° @調諧å¨å³æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢åÂÂä½ ã éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂ¥ é©Â以繼çºÂæÂÂç´¢ã â¢ é«ÂéÂÂ調諧 ï¼ æÂÂä½ TUNE ï¼ ç´å°顯示çÂÂé »çÂÂé å§Âå¿«éÂÂè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂçºæÂ¢ ã å¦ÂæÂÂ忠覠@å¯使ç¨æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調 è«§åÂÂè½ä¾Â微調頻çÂÂã æÂ¹å FM æÂ¥æÂ¶ ä¸Âè¯ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£å¨以ç«Âé«Âè²æÂ¶ è½ FM éÂȌ°ï¼Âä½ÂæÂ¥æÂ¶å» å¾Â微弱ï¼Âé£麼æÂ¨å¯以å°Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå®è²éÂÂä¾ÂæÂ¹å è²é³çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ質ã 1 調é¸è³ FM 廣æÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å TUNERSET ï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å FM MOD E ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸å FM MONO ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 調諧å¨å¨å®è²éÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æ¨¡å¼Â丠@å®è²éÂÂæÂÂ示ç @ï¼ÂæÂÂ亮起ã é¸åÂÂä¸Âè¿°ç FM AUTO 以åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèªåÂÂç«Âé«Âè²模 å¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¶è½ç«Âé«Âè²廣æÂÂæÂ ï¼ ç«Âé«Âè²æÂÂ示ç @@æÂÂ亮起@ã æÂÂå¶ AM æÂ¥æÂ¶éÂÂ訠èÂÂ¥ AM æÂ¥æÂ¶æÂ æ³ÂéÂÂ常丠好ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ£å¨æÂ¶è½ç AM éÂȌ°太éÂÂåµé ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ試使ç¨ ãÂÂéÂÂè¨ÂæÂÂå¶ã å è½調æÂ´è³è¼Âä½³çÂÂé³質ã 1 調諧è³ AM 廣æÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å TUNERSET ï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å NOISECUT ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸åÂÂéÂÂè¨ÂæÂÂå¶模å¼Âï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã é¸å 1 æÂ 2 ä¹ÂéÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæºÂã è¨ÂæÂ¶éÂȌ° æÂ¤ç³»çµ±å¯以è¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂ夠30 Ã¥ÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Âå²åÂÂå¨ä¸Âå é¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂ¥ ï¼ A ã B å C @丠@æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âå¥å¯å²å 10 å éÂȌ°ã 1 調諧è³ AM æÂ FM 廣æÂÂéÂȌ°ã å°ÂæÂ¼ FM 波段ï¼Âå¯è¦ÂéÂÂè¦Âä¾Âé¸åÂÂå®è²éÂÂæÂ èªå ç«Âé«Âè²çÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æÂ¹å¼ÂãÂÂæÂ¤é  è¨Âå®Â弿ÂÂé£åÂÂé Âè¨Âé» å°ä¸Âä½µåÂÂã 2 æÂÂ丠SHIFT T.EDIT ã 3 æÂÂ丠CLASS å¯é¸åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âå¥çÂÂå ¶ä¸Âä¹Â丠@ç¶å¾Â使ç¨ PRESET æÂÂéµé¸ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂçÂÂé Âè¨ÂéÂȌ°ã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµä¾Âé¸å é Âè¨ÂéÂȌ°ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ RETURN 顯示 PBC é¸å®ã æÂ¸åÂÂéµ é¸åÂÂç·¨æÂÂèÂÂ碼çÂÂé¸å®é¸頠ãÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTER æÂ éµ以ä½Âåºé¸åÂÂã ï¯ 顯示åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸å®頠ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ話@ã ï° 顯示ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸å®頠ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ話@ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 20 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 21 Zhtw English Español English Español 4 æÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂ ENTER å¾ ï¼ é Âè¨Âé¡Âå¥åÂÂç·¨èÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ éÂÂç @ç¶徠系統è¨ÂæÂ¶éÂȌ°ã æÂ¶è½é Âè¨ÂéÂȌ° æÂ¨å¿ é Âå Âå²åÂÂä¸ÂäºÂé Âè¨Âå¼æÂ è½å·è¡ÂæÂ¤æÂÂä½Âã 1 確å®Âå·²é¸å TUNER Ã¥ÂÂè½ã 2 æÂÂ丠CLASS 以é¸åÂÂå²åÂÂé »éÂÂæÂÂå¨çÂÂé¡Âå¥ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂä¸Âå¯åÂÂæÂ A ãÂÂB å C é¡Âå¥ã 3 使ç¨ PRESET æÂÂéµ以é¸åÂÂä¸Âé Â訠éÂȌ°ã â¢ æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ ä¾Âé¸åÂÂé Âè¨ÂéÂȌ°ã èÂÂè½堶ä»Âä¾Â溠å¯å°Âè¼Âå©ä¾Â溠ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ© ãÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶å¨çÂÂï¼ é£æÂÂ¥ è³æÂ¬æ©Âä¸Âï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂÂè²å¨系統æÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂèÂÂå ¶ç¸éÂÂç æÂ´å¤Âè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âç é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻訠å ã â¢ è¦Âå°Â丠USB è£Âç½®é£æÂ¥è³ US B 端åÂÂ丠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 31 é Âç USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 ã â¢ å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ280/282DVD-AP ï¼ÂæÂÂå ¥å åµ測å° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å¾Âï¼ å³å¯é¸æÂ Bluetooth å³輸å¨ãÂÂèÂÂå ¶ç¸ éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³ è¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç ç¨æÂ¼ç¡ç·Â享åÂÂé³樠ç Bluetooth î å³輸å¨ ã 1 確å®Âå¤Âé¨ä¾Â溠@é»è¦Âæ© ã è¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ç @已ç¶ÂéÂÂæ©Âã 2 æÂÂ丠LINE 以é¸åÂÂä¾ÂæºÂã 3 å¦ÂæÂÂå¿ è¦Âï¼Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¾ÂæºÂã è¨Âç½®ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨å¯å¨æÂ¨ç¡ èÂÂç´Âä¸Âå°ÂæÂÂå¾Âå°Â系統é æ©Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å®Âå ¨ç¡é ÂæÂÂå¿Âã 1 ⢠é£çºÂæÂ SHIFT SLEEP以é¸åÂÂé¸頠@ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã é¸åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸頠@⢠SLP ON ï¼Âç´Âå¨ä¸Âå°ÂæÂÂå¾ÂéÂÂæ© ã æÂÂ示çÂÂæÂ äº®èµ·ã â¢ SLP OFF ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶Âç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ ã å¨é¸å SLP ON å¾ ï¼ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SLEEP 以確èªÂä¸Âä¸Âå©é¤ÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂã æ¯Âæ¢Âç·Â代表素12 å é ï¼Âå©é¤ÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼ éÂÂ註 1 顯示å¹Âå¨ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂè¨Â置好æÂ æÂÂè®ÂæÂÂã S L P --- -- HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 21 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 05 22 Zhtw 第 5 ç« èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠æÂ¬æ©Âé³頻åÂÂè½æÂ¯å¦åÂÂéÂÂ覠é³溠ã HDMI é³頻 è¨Âç½® ï¼Â第 41 é Âï¼ æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ堥麥å Â風çÂÂä¼´å±模 å¼Â@第 33 é Âï¼ èÂÂå® ã æÂ¤æÂÂé¸å®å¯è½ä¸ÂæÂÂ顯 示ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¹çº顯示è¨ÂæÂ¯ ï¼Â第 56 é Âï¼ ã é¸åÂÂèÂÂè½模张æÂ¨å¯以使ç¨åÂÂ種èÂÂè½模å¼Â享åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ鳿ÂÂï¼Âå 根æÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ好修æÂ£é³場ãÂÂæÂ¨å¯以è¨Âå®Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè è½模张@è¦ÂæÂ¨å¨第 6 é Âç 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® é¸ æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂèÂÂå®ÂãÂÂè«Âé±è®Â以ä¸Â堧容並é²衠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¨Âå®Âã â¢ 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂºè¨ ç¶æÂ¨å·²é¸æÂ 5 é» æÂÂè²å¨é Âç½®æÂÂï¼Âè«Âå¾Âç°ç¹Âè²模 å¼Âä¸Â鏿ÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂèÂÂè½模å¼ÂãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå 以ç°ç¹Âè² èÂÂè½ ã â¢ 3 é» /2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂºè¨ ç¶æÂ¨å·²é¸æÂÂå°Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè² å¨æÂ¾å¨æÂ¨åÂÂé¢ç 3 é»ÂæÂ è²å¨é Âç½®æÂÂï¼Âè«Âå¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼Âä¸Â鏿ÂÂä¸Âå èÂÂè½模张ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 23 é Âç 使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè² ã èªåÂÂèÂÂè½模张èªåÂÂèÂÂè½模å¼ÂæÂ¯èÂÂè½主è¦ÂæÂ§å¶çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ種ä¾ÂæºÂæÂÂç°¡ å®çÂÂæÂ¹æ³Âï¼ èªæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂ輸åºåÂÂæÂ åºä¾ÂæºÂé¡ÂæÂÂ丠çÂÂéÂÂéÂÂã â¢ æÂÂ丠AUTO/STEREO 以é¸å AUTO èÂÂè½模 å¼Âã 1 èÂÂè½模å¼Âæ ¹æÂÂä¸Â表æÂÂ示çÂÂä¾ÂæºÂåªÂé«ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé Âè² é³ã 以ç°ç¹Âè²èÂÂè½ ç¶æÂ¨å°Â系統æÂºè¨Âçº 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂæÂ ï¼ å¯ 使ç¨ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼Âã æÂ¨å¯以ç°ç¹Âè²ä¾Âè è½ç«Âé«Âè²æÂÂå¤Âè²éÂÂä¾Â溠ã 2 ç°ç¹Âè²ä¾ÂèªæÂ¼æÂ¡ç¨æÂÂ種 Dolby Pro Logic 解碼 模å¼ÂçÂÂç«Âé«Âè²ä¾ÂæºÂã â¢ é£çºÂæÂ SURROUND 以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種èÂÂè½模张ã 1 顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂåºç¾çÂÂé¸åÂÂæÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂä¾ÂæºÂé¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂè æÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ STANDARD ï¼Âæ¨ÂæºÂ解碼模张ï¼ÂåªæÂÂå¨ä¾Â溠çºå¤Âè²éÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½é¸æÂ æÂ¤æ¨¡å¼Â@⢠MOVIE (Dolby Pro Log ic II Movie ï¼ ï¼ Pro Logic II 5.1 è²éÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼Âç¹åÂ¥é©å é»影 ä¾Â溠ï¼Âå¯ç¨æÂ¼ä»»ä½Âä¸Â種é è²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂï¼ éÂÂ註 1 èÂÂ¥ ä¾ÂæºÂçº Dolby Di gital æÂ DTS ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤ºå¹Âä¸ÂçÂÂç¸å°ÂæÂÂ示ç æÂÂ亮起ã ä¾Â溠5 SPOT 4 SPOT 3 SPOT 2 SPOT éÂÂè²é STEREO STEREO å¤Âè²é STANDARD F.SURR 2 注 æÂÂéÂÂå°Â輸堥ä¾ÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè³ DVD/CD æÂ USBï¼ÂæÂÂè½é²è¡Âå¤Âè²éÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 22 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 05 23 Zhtw English Español English Español ⢠MUSIC (Dolby Pro Logic II Music ï¼ ï¼ å¯ ç¢ç Pro Logic II 5.1 è²éÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼Âç¹åÂÂ¥ é©åÂÂ鳿¨Âä¾Â溠ï¼Âé©ç¨æÂ¼éÂÂè²éÂÂä¾ æºÂ@⢠DOLBY P L (Dolby Pro Logi c ï¼ ï¼ å¯ç¢ç 4.1 è²éÂÂç°ç¹Âé³æÂ ï¼Âé©ç¨æÂ¼ éÂÂè²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂ@使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè² é¸å DV D/CD æÂ USB ä½Âçº輸堥ä¾ÂæºÂ並å¦Â第 6 é Âç 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® ä¸ÂæÂÂ述使ç¨ 3 é»Âï¼ /2 é»Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ æÂ ï¼ åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂ模å¼Âç¼ æÂ®ä½Âç¨ ã â¢ éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ SURROUND 以é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模 å¼Âã â¢ F.SURR ï¼Âå¯ç¨æÂ¼æÂÂä¾Âè±Âå¯ÂçÂÂç°ç¹Âé³ æÂÂã â¢ EXTRAPWR ï¼Âå¾Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨輸åºç«Âé« è²é³ æÂ ï¼ÂèÂ¥çºå¤Âè²éÂÂä¾Â溠@åÂÂä¸Âæ··åÂÂç«Âé«Â鳿ÂÂ@@以ç²å¾Â強大çÂÂç«Âé«Âè²æÂÂæÂÂã 以ç«Âé«Âè²èÂÂè½ æÂ¨å¯以å¨ç«Âé«Âè²é³æÂÂä¸Âè è½任ä½Âä¸Â種ä¾ÂæºÂâÂÂç« é«Âè²æÂÂå¤Âè²éÂÂãÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾å¤Âè²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂæÂ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂè² éÂÂæÂÂç¶Â縮混å¾Âå³éÂÂè³åÂÂç½® å·¦ï¼Â峿ÂÂè²å¨åÂÂéÂÂä½ é³ä¹Âä¸Âã â¢ é£çºÂæÂÂ丠AUTO/STEREO ç´å°顯示å¹Âä¸Âåº ç¾ STEREO çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣çºæÂ¢ã 以è³æ©ÂèÂÂè½ æÂÂå ¥è³æ©ÂæÂÂï¼ STEREO æÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂèÂÂè½模 å¼Âç¡æ³Âè®ÂæÂ´ã 1 調æÂ´ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³ 使ç¨ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³æÂ§å¶å¯調 æÂ´å ¨é¢çÂÂé³調ã 1 æÂÂ丠SOUND ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å BA SS/TRE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å BASS æÂ TREBLE ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 調æÂ´è²é³ ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 確誠ã â¢ ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³çÂÂ調æÂ´ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¨ â 6dB è³ 6dB ä¹ éÂÂã 使ç¨ SFC 模张SFC ï¼Âé³場æÂ§å¶@模å¼Âå¯以é©ç¨æÂ¼ä»»ä½ÂçÂÂå¤Âè²é æÂÂç«Âé«Âè²ä¾Â溠@以æÂÂä¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¼Âå ¶ä»ÂçÂÂç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂæÂ ã 1 æÂÂ丠SOUND ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SF C MODE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 æÂÂ丠ï©/ïª ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以é¸å SFC é³ æÂÂ模å¼Âã è«Âé¸å OFF ã LIVE ã HALL ã POP ã ROCK ã DRAMA æÂ ACTIONã áÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠëáÂ¨à £ î 3îÂÂáÂÂøÃÂÃ Ã£Ã¼à  ÂáÂÂáÂÂáÂÂá áÂÂàãüÃÂÃÂÃÂà ±¦ áÂÂÃ Ã£Ã¼à  ÂáÂÂáÂÂáÂÂá áÂÂàãüÃÂÃÂÃÂà ±¦ áÂÂàãü HTZ180DVD ãü HTZ181DVD éÂÂ註 1 å¨æÂ¨æÂÂä¸Âè³æ©ÂæÂÂï¼Â峿ÂÂæÂ¢å¾© æÂÂå ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç°ç¹Âè²è¨Âå®Â模å¼Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 23 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 05 24 Zhtw å éÂÂä½Âé³é³é æÂ¬æ©Âå ±æÂÂäºÂ種ä½Âé³模å¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯ç¨ä¾Âå¢Âå¼·ä¾ÂæºÂ丠çÂÂä½Âé³é³éÂÂã 1 æÂÂ丠SOUND ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å BASSMODE ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 調æÂ´è²é³ ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 確誠ã é¸å OFFï¼ MUSIC æÂ CINEMAã 使ç¨ MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨ éÂÂç¾å£Â縮鳿¨ÂçÂÂç¾Âè² ï¼ MP3 ã WMAã MPEG-4 AAC ï¼Âã â¢ éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH é¸å MP3 EXPã 1 使ç¨è²é³強åÂÂå¨模张æÂ¤æ¨¡å¼Âå¯ç¨æÂ¼èÂÂè½é»影 æÂÂå°Âç½ä¸ÂçÂÂå°è©Âã â¢ éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH é¸å VOICE Eã 2 æÂÂæÂÂè²é³ ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂä½³è²é³@æÂ¬æ©Âé¨éÂÂç¹æ®Âå½¢ç çÂÂé«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ質æÂÂè²å¨@ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè² é³ãÂÂ模å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂå°Âé»影åÂÂ鳿¨ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ鳿ÂÂä½³ çÂÂ實é«Âé©ÂçÂÂå ÂéÂÂç¨家é³頻æÂ è¡ÂèÂÂè¨Âè¨Âã å¨æÂ£å¸¸æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè²é³模å¼Â坿ÂÂä½³åÂÂæÂ¬ æ©ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ã 3 ⢠åÂÂæ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂå£Â縮 éÂÂç¾容æÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç°å¢Âåªé³影é¿çÂÂç´°é¨è²é³æÂÂåµé åºä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè®ÂæÂ¨æÂÂ覺身æÂ·å ¶å¢Âç åÂÂé³ç°å¢Âã â¢ é »çÂÂç¹æÂ§ä¿®æÂ£ çÂÂè§£é¤äºÂé¨éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨è£Âç½®çÂÂæÂ°å¢ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¤Âï¼Âé å°Âé·æÂÂéÂÂèÂÂè½èÂÂæÂÂä½³åÂÂçÂÂæÂ æÂ¾ç¹æÂ§ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP 並使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å SOUNDSET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å S.FIELD ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以調æÂ´è¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTE R 確èªÂã â¢ EFFECT ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²é³@ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¹æÂ§å·²éÂÂå°Âé¨ éÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂä½³åÂÂçÂÂè²é³ ã â¢ DIRECT ï¼Âç´æÂ¥è²é³@ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂ æÂÂè²é³模张ã éÂÂ註 1 é åÂÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂï¼ SFC 模å¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂã 2 ⢠éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¤ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂï¼ SFC 模å¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂã â¢ ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180/181DVD æ©Âå ï¼Âå å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¤Âè²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂç ä¸Âç½®è²éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂã 3 é³ å ´ä¸ÂæÂÂå½±é¿è³æ©Â輸åºã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 24 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 25 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 6 ç« ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠å³使æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ實éÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂå 置堥çÂÂç¢Âç 種é¡ÂèÂÂæÂÂäºÂ許ä¸ÂçÂÂå·®ç° ï¼ æÂ¬ç« æÂÂæ¶µèÂÂçÂÂ許夠åÂÂè½ä»Âå¯é©ç¨æÂ¼ DVD ç¢Âç ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã CD ã Di vX è¦Âé » /WMV 以å WMA/ MP3/MPEG-4 AAC/JPEG ç¢ÂçÂÂã â¢ æÂÂ亠DVD æÂÂéÂÂå¶æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ ï¼Âä¾Âå¦Â鍿©ÂæÂÂé è¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂé¨åÂÂæÂÂå ¨ é¨çÂÂ使ç¨ ã éÂÂ並 ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã â¢ 卿ÂÂæÂ¾ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂ ï¼ æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¨ PBC æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸Âé©ç¨ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³ è¦Â使ç¨éÂÂ亠åÂÂè½ï¼Âè«Â使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµé¸åÂÂæÂ²ç® ä¾ÂéÂÂå§Âç¢Âç çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂ種çÂÂéÂÂ度åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå å¾Âå¿«éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂç¢Âç ã 1 ⢠æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï æÂ ï® 以éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂÂã é£çºÂæÂÂä¸Â以å¢Âå æÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ度 ï¼Âå¦Âå¨å±Â顯示@ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂ種栢åÂÂä½ÂéÂÂ度ä¾ÂæÂ æÂ¾ DVD ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD å DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ãÂÂDVD ç¢ÂçÂÂéÂÂå¯ 以åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ïÂÂ¥ ï¼ÂæÂ«åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æÂÂä½ ï³/ï± æÂ ï²/ï´ æÂÂéµ ï¼ ç´å°éÂÂå§Âæ ¢å ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çºæÂ¢ã é£çºÂæÂÂ以è®ÂæÂ´æ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ éÂÂ度 ï¼Âå¦Âå¨å±Â顯示@ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æ ¼é²ï¼Âæ ¼éÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ¨å¯以éÂÂæ ¼åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¾ÂéÂÂç æÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢Âç ã å°ÂæÂ¼ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD å DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ï¼ÂæÂ¨ åªå¯以使ç¨格鲿ÂÂæÂ¾ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ïÂÂ¥ ï¼ÂæÂ«åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æÂÂ丠ï³/ï± æÂ ï²/ï´ æÂÂéµ以å¾ÂéÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé²ç æÂ¹å¼Âä¸Â次ä¸Âæ ¼æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ å¨置堥堧å« JPEG Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¾Âï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ 以 éÂÂå§Âå¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂ第ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ æÂÂ夾ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂéÂÂå§Âå¹»ç çÂÂç§ ã 3 æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Âé ÂåºÂä¾Â顯示æ¯Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂ å¤¾ä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂã â¢ è¥該è£Â置堧å«æÂ WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂÃ¥ÂÂé³頻 æªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂä¸ÂæÂ· éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã é³頻æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé @æÂ¨ä»Âç¶å¯以使 ç¨跳é @ï¯ / ï° ï¼ ãÂÂæÂ æÂ ï¼ ï /ï® ï¼Âå æÂ«å @ïÂ¥ï¼ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé  åÂÂè½ã åÂÂçÂÂæÂÂèªåÂÂ調æÂ´ä»¥ç¡éÂÂå¡« 滿æÂ´åÂÂè¢å¹Âç«é¢ã éÂÂ註 1D i v X è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂå é©ç¨ä¸Â種éÂÂ度ã 2 ⢠è¦Âç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼ÂæÂ£å¸¸ çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂå¨è®ÂÃ¥ÂÂå° DVD ç¢Âç ä¸ÂæÂ°çÂÂç« ç¯ÂæÂÂï¼ÂèªåÂÂæÂ¢å¾©ã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ PBC 模张ä¸Âç VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD 以å WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC æÂ²ç® ï¼Âé ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ模å¼ÂãÂÂä¸Âï¼ ï¼Âå°éÂÂæÂ²ç®çÂÂéÂÂé ÂæÂÂçµ å°¾æÂÂå°ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ã 3 ⢠æÂ¬æ©Âå°Âä¸Â份æªÂæ¡Âè¼ å ¥çÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂÂé¨èÂÂæªÂæ¡Â容éÂÂæÂ å¤§èÂÂå¢Âå ã â¢ ä¸Âå¼µç¢ÂçÂÂå¯ å å«å¤Âé 299 Ã¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂ å¤¾å 648 Ã¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä½µçÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾èÂÂæªÂæ¡ ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 25 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 26 Zhtw å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂ@使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂçÂÂ覽 DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç 使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂå¯çÂÂ覽æÂ´ å¼µ DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ堧容 ï¼ æÂ¾å°æÂ¨æÂ³è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂé¨å ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé @æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並 å¾Âå¨å±Âé¸ å®ä¸Âé¸å ã Disc Na vigator ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âå @ã ã 2 é¸åÂÂ檢è¦Âé¸頠ã å¯以使ç¨çÂÂé¸頠è¦Â置堥çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ種é¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯å¦è¦ÂæÂ æÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼Âç¶èÂÂä»Âå å«@⢠Title ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âç æ¨Âé¡Âã â¢ Chapter ï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ DVD-Video ç¢Âç ç®åÂÂæ¨Âé¡Âä¸ÂçÂÂç« ç¯Âã â¢ Track ï¼ÂæÂ²ç®@@æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ²ç®ã â¢ Time ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼ æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç ä¸Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮å ã â¢ Original: Ti tle ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ VR 模张DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âæ¨Âé¡Âã â¢ Playlis t: Title ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ VR 模张DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂç¶ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®樠é¡Âã â¢ Original: Ti me ï¼ÂæÂ éÂÂï¼ ï¼ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Â堧容丠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮åÂÂã â¢ Playli st: Time ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼ æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®丠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮åÂÂã æÂ´åÂÂè¢å¹Âç«é¢åÂÂå¾Âä¸Â次æÂÂå¤Âå¯æÂ¥é£顯示å Â張縮 Ã¥ÂÂå½±åÂÂãÂÂè¦Â顯示åÂÂä¸ÂçµÂï¼Âä¸Âä¸ÂçµÂå Â張縮åÂÂï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ ï¯ / ï° ã 3 é¸åÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂ縮åÂÂå½±åÂÂã æÂ¨å¯使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å EN TER é¸åÂÂ縮åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¸ Ã¥ÂÂéµã è¦Â使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµé¸åÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â輸堥堩ä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ïÂÂ¥ å¯æÂ«åÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ï¼ÂæÂÂé³頻ï¼ÂçÂÂæÂ æÂ¾ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯åÂÂ度éÂÂå§ÂæÂ æÂ¾ã ï¯ å¯跳è³åÂÂä¸Âå¼µåÂÂç ï¼ÂæÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡ çÂÂé³頻æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ã ï° å¯跳è³ä¸Âä¸Âå¼µåÂÂç ï¼ÂæÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡ çÂÂé³頻æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ã ï«/ï¬/ ï©/ïª å¯æÂ«åÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ä¸¦æÂÂè½ ï¼Âç¿»åÂÂæÂÂ顯示çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµå¯éÂÂæÂ°éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âï¼ ã SHIFT ZOOM å¯æÂ«åÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ä¸¦å°Âå çÂÂæÂ¾å¤§ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯åÂÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂãÂÂ亠åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ¾å¤§åÂÂæÂ¸ ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµå¯éÂÂæÂ°éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âï¼ ã MENU å¯顯示 ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂç«é¢ ï¼Âè« åÂÂé±以ä¸Â說æÂÂï¼ ã Disc Navigator Di sc Navigator Title Chapter 0 1 04 02 05 03 0 6 Di s c Navigator: Title 0 1 - 49: - - HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 26 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 27 Zhtw English Español English Español å¯å©ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ覽 Windows Media ⢠Audio (WMA) ã MP3ã MPEG-4 AAC ã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV å JPEG æªÂ桠使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂæÂ ç §æªÂÃ¥ÂÂå°ÂæÂ¾ä¸Âç¹å®ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ æÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並徠å¨å±Â顯示é¸å®ä¸Âé¸ Ã¥ÂÂã Disc Navigator ï¼Âç¢Âç å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ãÂÂã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER ä¾ÂçÂÂ覽ã 使ç¨ ï©/ïª å¯ä¸Âä¸Âç§»åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ï¼ÂæªÂæ¡Â渠å®ã 使ç¨ ï« 以åÂÂå°根è³ÂæÂÂ夾ã 1 使ç¨ ENTER æÂ ï¬ å¯éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½çÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾 ã â¢ ç¶åÂÂç½ JPEG æªÂ桠@便æÂÂä¸Â縮åÂÂå½±åÂÂ顯示å¨ è¢å¹Âå³å´ã 3 è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂç½çÂÂæÂ²ç®æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV 檠æ¡ÂæÂÂ顯示åÂÂç½ç JPEG 檠桠æÂÂï¼Âå¯ æÂ ä¸ ENTER ã â¢ ç¶已é¸å WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV æªÂæ¡ ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂèª該æªÂæ¡ÂéÂÂå§ æÂÂæÂ¾å°æÂ´åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾çµÂæÂÂçºæÂ¢ã â¢ ç¶é¸åÂÂ亠JPEG æªÂæ¡Âï¼Âå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âå³ æÂÂéÂÂå§Â@並å¾ÂæÂÂ鏿ªÂæ¡ÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ ä¸Âç´å°æÂ´åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾 æÂÂæÂ¾å®ÂçºæÂ¢ã æÂÂ示 ⢠å¨èÂÂè½ WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ ï¼ ä¹Âå¯以åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã åªé é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦ÂèÂÂè½çÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡Âï¼ åÂÂé¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦ÂæÂ æÂ¾å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âç JPEG æªÂæ¡Âå³å¯ ã æÂ¤æÂÂå¹»çÂÂç ç§ÂÃ¥ÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂæÂ·éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã åÂÂé  æÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶å é©ç¨æÂ¼ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âã â¢ è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ´å¼µç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂ丠æÂ¯åªæÂÂç®åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ç 堧容 ï¼ è«Âå ÂéÂÂåº ã ç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âå ã @ç¶å¾Â使ç¨ ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµä¾ÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 使ç¨æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® é ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¤é  åÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å°Âå« æÂ WMA ã MP3ã MPEG-4 AAC å JPEG æªÂæ¡ÂçÂÂç¢Âç @製ä½ÂæÂÂ丠份æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® ï¼Âæ¯Â份 30 Ã¥ÂÂæªÂæ¡Âï¼ ãÂÂç±æÂ¼æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ è¨Âä½ÂæÂÂå¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂ張置堥ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® ï¼ÂéÂÂå¨ æÂ¨æÂ³è¦Âå¿«éÂÂä¸Âè¼Âé¬Âå°æÂ´çÂÂ大éÂÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂ ï¼Âç¸ç¶ æÂÂç¨ã 2 製ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® 1 å¨ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂ ï¼ æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並å¾Âè¢ å¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½é¸å®ä¸Âé¸å ã Disc Navigator ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂå° åÂÂï¼ ã ã 2 é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Âå å°æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®丠çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã èÂ¥ä¸ÂçÂ¥éÂÂæÂÂ麼åÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ä¸Âè¿° å¯å©ç¨ ãÂÂç¢Âç å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ覽 Windows Media⢠Aud io (WMA) ã MP3 ã MPEG-4 AAC ã DivX è¦Âé » / WMV å JPEG æªÂæ¡ ã 3 æÂÂ丠PLAYLIST 1 ãÂÂ2 æÂ 3 ã æÂ¤æÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂå å°æÂÂé¸åÂÂç æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ä¸Âã 4 éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ¥é© 2 å 3 ï¼Âç´å°æÂ´åÂÂæÂÂä½Âå®ÂæÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以é²堥æÂÂä¸Â層ç ã ..ãÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ä¾Âå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¤é  åÂÂä½Âã 00:00 / 00:00 0kbp s Folder 1 Folder2 Folder3 Folder4 File 1 File2 File3 File4 File5 Folder 2 00:00 / 00:00 0kbp s 2 該ç¢ÂçÂÂå¿ é Â置堥æÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ç¶ä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 27 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 28 Zhtw æÂÂ示 ⢠è¦Â卿²ÂæÂÂå¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢ç æÂ æ³Âä¸Âå 堥檠æ¡Âï¼ÂåªéÂÂå¨æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé æªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ丠PLAYLIST 1 ãÂÂ2 æÂ 3 å³å¯ ï¼Âé¤å¨æÂÂæÂ¾é³頻 çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âå¤Âï¼ ã èÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠PLAYLIST 1 ã 2 æÂ 3ã æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤º å¹Âä¸Âç PGM æÂÂ示çÂÂæÂ èµ·ãÂÂèÂ¥æÂªè¨Âå®Âä»»ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯 示 NO LISTã â¢ èÂ¥æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®堧å«æÂ JPEG Ã¥ÂÂé³頻堩種æªÂæ¡Âï¼ åÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âå é³頻æªÂæ¡Âã 渠餿ÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ 1 éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ã 2 å¾Âã Disc N avigator ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âå @ãÂÂç«é¢ ä¸Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½æÂ³å¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® ä¸Â渠é¤çÂÂæªÂæ¡Â並æÂÂ丠CLEAR ã 循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ段 ã A-B éÂÂ褠ã åÂÂè½å¯è®ÂæÂ¨æÂÂå®Âä¸ÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ æ¨ é¡ ï¼ DVD ï¼ ä¸ÂçÂÂå ©é» ï¼ A å B ï¼ ï¼Âä¾Âä¸Âç´ä¸ÂæÂ·å°循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã 2 é¸å ã A-B Repeat ï¼ A-B éÂÂè¤Âï¼ ã ã 3 å¨ã A(Start Point) ï¼ÂéÂÂå§Âé»Âï¼ ãÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以è¨Â置循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂéÂÂå§Âé»Âã 4 å¨ã B(End Point) ï¼ÂçµÂæÂÂé»Âï¼ ãÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以è¨Â置循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ç çµÂæÂÂé»Âã å¨æÂÂ丠ENTER å¾ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä½Âæ¥ÂæÂÂè·³å è³éÂÂå§Âé»Âï¼ ç¶å¾ÂéÂÂå§Â循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ã 5 è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Âè«Âé¸å ã Off ï¼ é ï¼ÂãÂÂã 使ç¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ é¤äºÂÃ¥ÂÂ種çÂÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾é¸頠å¤Âï¼Âä¹Âå¯以å°ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾åÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¸Â起使ç¨ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 29 é ÂçÂʌȼ ç«Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® ï¼Âã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mo de ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã 2 é¸å ã Repea t ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤Âï¼ ã ï¼Âç¶å¾Âé¸åÂÂéÂÂ褠æÂÂæÂ¾é¸頠ã 1 å¦ÂæÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âå¯ é¸å Program Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¨Âå¼Âï¼ ä¾ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯 渠å® ï¼ æÂÂé¸å Repeat Off ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å æ¶ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD 碠ç æÂÂï¼Âå¯ é¸ å Title Repeat ï¼Âé è¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡Âï¼ æÂ Chapter Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾ç« ï¼ ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂ ï¼ å¯é¸å Disc Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å®ç¢Âï¼ æÂ Track Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ²ç®@ã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âå¯é¸å Title Repeat ï¼Âé 褠æÂ æÂ¾ 樠é¡Âï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ æÂ¯ Repeat Off ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ï¼Âã 使ç¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ å¯使ç¨æÂ¤é  åÂÂè½以鍿ÂÂçÂÂé ÂåºÂä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡ÂæÂÂç« ç¯Âï¼ DVD-Video ï¼ æÂÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼Âã 2 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mo de ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã Play Mode éÂÂ註 1 æÂ¨ ç¡æ³Â使ç¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾ WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC ç¢ÂçÂÂã 2 ⢠æÂ¨å¯以 å¨ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ è¨Âç½®é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂé¸頠ãÂÂç¶èÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ç¡ æ³Âå°Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé Âç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ä¸Â起使ç¨ã â¢ æÂ¨ä¸Âè½使ç¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ VR 格张DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂã WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC ç¢ÂçÂÂã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂå¨ DVD 碠çÂÂé¸å®已顯示çÂÂæÂ æ³Âä¸Â使ç¨ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 28 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 29 Zhtw English Español English Español 2 é¸å ã Rando m ï¼Â鍿©Âï¼ ã @ç¶å¾Âé¸åÂÂé¸頠ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯é¸å Random Title ï¼Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡Âï¼ æÂ Random Ch apter ï¼Âé¨ æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç« ï¼ ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂÂï¼Âå¯ é¸ å On ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ æÂ Off ï¼ÂéÂÂ@以éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂ鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ Ã¥ÂÂè½ã æÂÂ示 â¢ é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨以 ä¸ÂæÂ§å¶åÂÂè½@â¢ é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂç¹¼çºÂå·衠@ç´å°æÂ¨å¾Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾é¸ å®é¸頠ä¸Âé¸åÂÂ亠Random Off ï¼Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ éÂÂéÂÂï¼ çºæÂ¢ã 建ç«Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® æÂ¬é  åÂÂè½å¯è®ÂæÂ¨ç·¨è¼¯ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç® çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾é ÂåºÂç¨ÂåºÂã 1 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã 2 é¸å ã Program ï¼Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯@ã @ç¶å¾Âå¾Â稠å¼Âé¸頠渠å®ä¸Âé¸å ã Create/Ed it ï¼Âç·¨åºÂåµ建ï¼Â編輯@ã ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER 以é¸åÂÂ丠æ¨Âé¡ ã 章ç¯ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç®ä½Âçºç®åÂÂå¨ç¯Âç® 渠å®ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ¥é©Âã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ DVD ç¢Âç @æÂ¨éÂÂå¯以å¢Âå æ¨Âé¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¯ç« ç¯Âã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ CD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ å¯é¸åÂÂæÂ²ç®å å°ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å®ä¹Âä¸Âã å¨æÂÂ丠ENTER é¸åÂÂæ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç®徠@編庠æÂ¥é©Âç·¨èÂÂæÂÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âç§»åÂÂ丠ä½Âã 4 è«ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂ¥é© 3 以建ç«Âä¸Âç·¨åºÂÃ¥ÂÂ表ã ä¸Â份編åºÂÃ¥ÂÂ表ä¸Âå¯å å«夠é 24 Ã¥ÂÂç·¨åºÂæÂ¥é©Âã â¢ æÂ¨åªéÂÂå°ÂæÂ¨æÂ³é¡¯ç¤ºæÂ° ç·¨åºÂæÂ¥é©ÂçÂÂä½Âç½®åÂʊȴ Ã¥ÂÂç½åÂÂ輸堥æ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç®編èÂÂ@便å¯ æÂÂ堥編åºÂæÂ¥é©Âã â¢ è¦Âåªé¤編åºÂæÂ¥é©Âï¼Âè«Âå°Âå ¶ Ã¥ÂÂç½å¾ÂæÂÂ丠CLEAR å³å¯ã 5 è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç·¨åºÂÃ¥ÂÂ表 ï¼ è«ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ æÂÂéµ ã ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠宿ÂÂç¹¼çºÂÃ¥ÂÂå¨@ç´å°æÂ¨éÂÂéÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂ æÂ¾ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±以ä¸Â說æÂÂï¼ ã åªé¤ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® ï¼Âè« åÂÂé±以ä¸Â說æÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂéÂÂåºç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæ©ÂçºæÂ¢ã æÂÂ示 ⢠ç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨以ä¸ÂæÂ§ å¶åÂÂè½@ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯é¸å®ä¸Âå ¶ä»Âå¯ç¨ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ å¨ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯é¸å®ä¸Âå°ÂæÂÂé¤ äºÂç·¨åºÂåµ建ï¼Â編輯以 å¤ÂçÂÂå ¶ä»Âé¸頠ã â¢ Playback Start ï¼Âç·¨åºÂæÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂå§ ï¼ ï¼ å¯é å§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å²åÂÂçÂÂç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® â¢ Playback Stop ï¼Âç·¨åºÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂ¢ ï¼ ï¼ å¯é éÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Âä½Âä¸ÂæÂÂåªé¤ ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® â¢ Program Delete ï¼Âç·¨åºÂåªé¤@@å¯åªé¤稠åºÂ編輯渠å®並éÂÂéÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂ æÂ¾ æÂÂç´¢ç¢Âç æÂ¨å¯以æÂÂæ¨Âé¡ÂæÂÂç« ç¯Âç·¨è @æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂç´¢ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD 坿ÂÂæÂ²ç® ç·¨èÂÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ坿ÂÂæÂ éÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂç´¢ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ï° é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¸Âé¸åÂÂä¸ÂæÂ° çÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Â樠é¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âã ï¯ å¯è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ç®åÂÂæÂ²ç®@æ¨Âé¡Âï¼Â章篠çÂÂéÂÂé Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯é¨ æ©Âé¸åÂÂå ¶ä» çÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼Â章篠ã éÂÂ註 1V R æ ¼å¼Âç DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂã WMA/MP 3/MPEG-4 AAC ç¢ÂçÂÂã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å®顯示æÂÂï¼Âç¡æ³Â使ç¨ ç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ HOME MENU å¯å²åÂÂç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å®並 éÂÂåºä½Â丠æÂÂæÂ¾ã ï° å¯跳è³ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å®丠çÂÂä¸Âä¸Âå 編åºÂæÂ¥é©Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 29 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 30 Zhtw 2 é¸å ã Search Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂ索模å¼Âï¼ ã ã æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾çÂÂæÂÂç´¢é¸頠æÂÂ覠置堥çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ種é¡ÂèÂÂå®Âã 3 é¸åÂÂæÂÂ索模å¼Âã â¢ ç¢ÂçÂÂå¿ é ÂæÂÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä»¥ä¾¿ä½¿ ç¨æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂç´¢åÂÂè½ ã 4 使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ輸堥æ¨Âé¡ ã 章ç¯ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç®編è @æÂ æÂÂéÂÂã â¢ 使ç¨æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂç´¢æÂ ï¼ è«ÂæÂÂç §æÂ¨æÂ³è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ ç ä½Âç½®ä¾Â輸堥ç®åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡ ï¼ DVD/Di vX 覠頻 /WMV ï¼ æÂ æÂ²ç® ï¼ CD/VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCDï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂ¸åÂÂç§ÂæÂ¸ãÂÂä¾Âå¦Âï¼ æÂÂ丠4 ãÂÂ5 ãÂÂ0 ãÂÂ0 峿ÂÂå¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂ第 45 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂä½Âç½®éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã æÂ³è¦Â輸堥 1 å°ÂæÂÂã 20 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂå 30 ç§ÂæÂÂï¼ å¯ æÂÂ丠8 ãÂÂ0 ãÂÂ3 ãÂÂ0 ã 5 æÂÂ丠ENTER éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ æÂÂ亠DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂå DivX è¦Âé »ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä¸Â種以丠èªÂè¨ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Âï¼Âå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå è£Âä¸ÂæÂÂ渠æ¥ÂÃ¥ÂÂ訴æÂ¨å¯以 使ç¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Â種é¡ÂãÂÂæÂ¨å¯以卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂä¾Âå æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âã 1 ⢠é£çºÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SUBTITLE 以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種å å¹Âé¸頠ã â¢ è¦Âè¨Âç½®åÂÂå¹ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ好è¨Âå® ï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã â¢ æÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ DivX Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂçÂÂè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 48 é  ç 顯示 DivX Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ ã åÂÂæÂÂå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼Âé³頻è²é å¨æÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂæÂÂ堩種æÂÂæÂ´å¤ÂèªÂè¨Âå°Âç½堧容ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂ éÂÂå®è²éÂÂ鳿ÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ 2 ï¼ æÂ¨å¯以卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂä¾ åÂÂæÂÂéÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ã 3 æÂÂæÂ¾ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂ ï¼ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂæÂÂç«Âé«Âè² ã å 左è²éÂÂæÂÂå å³è²éÂÂã â¢ é£çºÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT AUDIO 以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種å°Âç½誠è¨Âé¸頠ã â¢ è¦Âè¨Âç½®å°Âç½èªÂè¨ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ好 è¨Âå®Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã æÂ¾å¤§ç«é¢ 使ç¨æÂ¾å¤§åÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å¨觠賠DVD ã DivX 覠頻 /WMV æ¨Âé¡ÂæÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂæÂ æÂ æÂ¾ JPEG ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå°Âç«é¢æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¨ä½ÂæÂ¾ 大äºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã 1 æÂ æÂ¾ æÂ éÂÂï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ SHIFT ZOOM 以é¸å æÂ¾å¤§ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¸ ï¼ÂæÂ£å¸¸ã 2 x æÂ 4 x ï¼Âã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ ä¾Âè®ÂæÂ´ç¸®æÂ¾åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã æÂ¨å¯以卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂèªç±åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¤§åÂÂæÂ¸ï¼Â以åÂÂæÂ¾ 大åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã 4 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè§Â度 æÂÂ亠DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ堩種æÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè§Â度æÂÂæÂÂè æÂÂç 場æÂ¯ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ç¢ÂçÂÂå è£Âä¸Âç 詳細說æÂÂã å¨æÂÂæÂ¾å¤Âè§Â度場æÂ¯æÂ ï¼ å±Âå¹Â丠æÂÂåºç¾ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ示 ï¼ÂæÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以é¸åÂÂå°Âå®ÂéÂÂé ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 37 é Âç 顯 示å¹Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼Âã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ«åÂÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ SHIFT ANGLE 以åÂÂæÂÂè§Â度ã 顯示ç¢ÂçÂÂè³Â訠æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼Âå¯å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ種æÂ²ç®ãÂÂç« ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âé¡ÂçÂÂè³Â訠顯示å¨å±Âå¹Âä¸Âã â¢ è¦Â顯示ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼Âé±èÂÂ顯 示çÂÂè³Â訠@å¯é£çºÂæÂ ä¸ DISPLAYã æÂÂéÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂè³Âè¨Â亦æÂÂåºç¾åÂÂé¢æÂ¿çÂÂè¢å¹Âä¸ÂãÂÂæÂ ä¸ DISPLAY 以è®ÂæÂ´æÂÂ顯示ç è³Âè¨Âã éÂÂ註 1 æÂ äºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå å Â許æÂ¨å¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® ä¸Âä¾ÂæÂ¹è®ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨ÂãÂÂæÂÂ丠TOP MENU æÂ MENU å³å¯é²堥é¸å®ã 2 æÂ äºÂè¶ ç´ VC D éÂÂæÂÂ堩種 é³è»ÂãÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ堩種é³è»Âï¼Â以åÂÂæ¯Âå é³è»Âç¨æÂÂçÂÂè²éÂÂã 3 æÂ äºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå å Â許æÂ¨å¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® ä¸Âä¾ÂæÂ¹è®Âå°Âç½èªÂè¨ÂãÂÂæÂÂ丠TOP MENU æÂ MENU å³å¯é²堥é¸å®ã 4 â¢ ç±æÂ¼ DVD ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VC D ã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV æ¨Âé¡Âå JPEG Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂåªæÂÂåºå®ÂçÂÂè§£æÂ åº¦ï¼Âå æÂ¤ç«質ç¹åÂ¥å¨æÂ¾å¤§å åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ失 çÂÂçÂÂæÂ å½¢ãÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç«é¢ä¸ÂæÂ¹çÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¹å¡Â涠失ï¼Â坿ÂÂ丠SHI FT ZOOM Ã¥ÂÂå°Âå®Â顯示 å¨è¢å¹Âä¸Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 30 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 07 31 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 7 ç« USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 使ç¨ USB ä»Âé¢ å©ç¨æÂ¬æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢ç USB ä»Âé¢就å¯以èÂÂè½éÂÂè² éÂÂé³ é » 1 並è§Âç DivX è¦Âé » /WMV/JPEG æªÂæ¡ ã æÂÂ丠åÂÂæÂ¹å¼Âé£æÂ¥ä¸ USB 大éÂÂå²åÂÂè£Âç½® 2 ã 1 éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂ丠USB ã 確å®Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå·²éÂÂ並è¨Âå®ÂçºæÂ£ 確çÂÂè¦Â頻輸堥ã 2 é£æÂ¥æÂ¨ç USB è£Âç½®ã USB 端åÂÂçÂÂä½Â置就å¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸ ã 3 æÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Â以éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã èÂ¥æÂ¯æÂ¨ç USB è£Âç½®ç¶ä¸Âå«æÂ JPEG ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå§ å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã èÂÂå ¶ç¸é çÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 25 é Âç æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã â¢ 確å®Âå¨è«é¢æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ系統å¨ å¾ æ©ÂçÂÂæ Âä¸Âï¼ ï¼Âå é¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤ºå¹Âä¸Â顯示 USB D ATA ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 è¥顯示å¹Âä¸Âç USB ERR è¨ÂæÂ¯æÂÂ示çÂÂ亮起 ï¼ åÂÂ表 示該 USB è£Âç½®çÂÂ黿ºÂéÂÂæ±Âå°ÂæÂ¼æÂ¬æ©Âä¾Â說太髠@æÂÂ該è£Âç½®ä¸Âç¸容ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ試 以ä¸ÂæÂ¹æ³Â@⢠éÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂå ã â¢ éÂÂæÂ°å¨æÂÂæÂ¾å¨éÂÂéÂÂæÂÂå° USB è£Âç½®æÂ¥ä¸Âã â¢ é¸åÂÂå ¶ä»Â輸堥ä¾Â溠ï¼Â妠DVD/CD ï¼ ï¼Âç¶ å¾ å é Âé¸å USB ã â¢ 使ç¨åÂÂå» å°Âç¨ç AC 黿ºÂè®Âå£Âå¨ ï¼Âé¨è£Âç½®é è´Âï¼Âä¾ÂæÂ USB 黿ºÂã èÂ¥ä¸Âè¿°æÂ¹å¼Âç¡æ³Â解決åÂÂé¡ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ該æÂ¯æÂ¨ç USB è£Âç½®ä¸Âç¸容ã å¨ USB è£Âç½®ä¸ÂéÂÂ製é³樠CD çÂÂæÂ² ç® å¨é£æÂ¥è³ USB å ç US B ä¸Âå¯以éÂÂ製è¼Âå ¥æÂ¬æ© ä¸ÂçÂÂé³樠CD æÂ²ç®ã éÂÂ製æÂÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® 1 è¼Âå ¥é³樠CD ã æÂÂ丠ï§ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ã éÂÂ註 1 éÂÂå æÂ¬ Di vX è¦Âé » /WMV/WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AA C æªÂæ¡ ï¼Âé¤å«é²æÂ·å §å®¹æÂÂéÂÂå¶æÂ æÂ¾å §å®¹çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âå¤Âï¼ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 2 ⢠ç¸容ç USB è£Âç½®å æÂ¬å±¬æÂ¼ FAT16/32 æ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂç£Âç¢Âæ©ÂãÂÂ坿ÂÂå¼Âå¿« éÂÂè¨ÂæÂ¶é« ï¼Âç¹æ®Âé¨ 身ç¢Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³頻æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ ï¼ MP3 æÂÂæÂ¾ å¨@ãÂÂæÂ¬æ© ä¸Âè½é£æÂ¥è³åÂÂ人é»蠦ä¸Âé²衠USB æÂÂæÂ¾ ã â¢ å ÂéÂÂæ¦Âä¸Âä¿ èÂÂæÂÂæÂ USB 大é å²åÂÂè£Âç½®çÂÂç¸容æÂ§ ï¼ÂæÂÂä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ坿µÂæÂÂ黿ºÂï¼ ï¼Â亦ä¸ÂæÂ¿æÂÂé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ© æÂÂå¯è½é æÂÂè³ÂæÂÂéº失ç ç¸éÂÂ責任ã â¢ è³ÂæÂÂå«éÂÂ徠大æÂÂï¼Â系統æÂÂéÂÂè¦Âè¼Âé·çÂÂæÂÂéÂÂä¾Âè® å USB è£Âç½®çÂÂ堧容ã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Âå¯è½ç¡ æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢ºèÂÂ奿ÂÂ亠USB è£Âç½®ã â¢ å³使æÂ¯æÂ¯æÂ´ çÂÂæ ¼å¼Âï¼Âä»ÂæÂÂå 堧容èÂÂç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ é¡¯ç¤ºæÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡Âã USB ÃÂà » á¾ÃÂáÂÂá USB àA à  ¯Ã USB HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 31 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 07 32 Zhtw 2 æÂ SHIFT USB REC 以顯示 ã CD -> USB Rec ï¼ CD -> USB è½ÂéÂÂï¼ ãÂÂç«é¢ã 3 æÂÂ丠ENTER éÂÂå§ÂéÂÂ製ã éÂÂå§ÂéÂÂ製ãÂÂéÂÂ製æÂÂï¼Â顯 示以ä¸ÂæÂÂ示çÂÂç«é¢ã 1 éÂÂ製ç¹å®ÂæÂ²ç® 1 è¼Âå ¥é³樠CD ã æÂÂ丠ï§ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ã 2 æÂ HOME MENU ï¼Âç¶å¾Âé¸æÂ ã CD -> USB Rec ï¼ CD -> USB è½ÂéÂÂï¼ ã ã åªæÂÂå¨åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾é³樠CD æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½é¸æÂ CD -> US B Rec ï¼ CD -> USB è½ÂéÂÂï¼ ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER å®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé  è¨Âå® å¼ã 4 é¸åÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂéÂÂ製çÂÂæÂ²ç®ã â¢ Individu al ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ¥ é¸åÂÂï¼ â ä¸Â次é¸åÂÂä¸Âå æÂ²ç®ã â¢ Select All ï¼Â鏿ÂÂå ¨é¨@â é¸åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ²ç®ã â¢ All Clear ï¼Â渠é¤堨é¨@â 渠餿ÂÂé¸åÂÂçÂÂæÂ æÂÂæÂ²ç®ã 5 鏿ÂÂä½Âå Âç ï¼Âå³輸çÂÂï¼ ã é¸æÂ 128 kbps ã 192 kb ps æÂ 320 kb ps ã 6 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ é¸æÂ ã Start ï¼ÂéÂÂå§Âï¼ ã @ç¶å¾ÂæÂ ENTER ã 2 éÂÂå§ÂéÂÂ製ã éÂÂ註 1 å¦ÂæÂ USB è£Âç½®æ²ÂæÂÂè¶³ 夠çÂÂ空éÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¡æ³ÂéÂÂå§Âé 製ãÂÂå¨éÂÂ種æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼Â顯示 ãÂÂå¯ç¨ USB 空éÂÂä¸Âè¶³ã ã CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack T otal Time T rack 1âÂÂ13 ï§ î T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 ï§ î T rack03 ï§ î T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 ï§ î T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 ï§ î T rack08 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 13 ï¦ï 055:07 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack T otal Time î 13 î 055:07 Cancel î 01:43 î 03:17 î 04:18 î 04:59 î 04:20 î 04:38 î 04:40 î 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î î T rack01 î î T rack02 î î T rack03 î î T rack04 î î T rack05 î î T rack06 î î T rack07 î î T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD â > USB Rec Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 00 ï¦ï 000:00 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 T rack05 T rack06 T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec 2 ⢠å®ÂæÂÂé 製æÂÂï¼Âå¨ USB è£Âç½®ä¸ÂæÂÂèªåÂÂ建ç«Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçº ãÂÂå ÂéÂÂãÂÂçÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ãÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ製ç æÂ²ç®å²åÂÂå¨æÂ¤è³ÂæÂÂ夾ä¸Âã â¢ æÂÂå¤Âå¯建章99 å ãÂÂå ÂéÂÂãÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾 ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂ USB è£Âç½®å å« 300 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂ以 ä¸ÂçÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¡æ³Âé²è¡Âé 製ã â¢ å¨ USB è£Âç½® ä¸Âé²è¡ÂéÂÂ製æÂÂï¼Âé¤äºÂæÂÂä½ ïµ STANDBY/ON å ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE æÂÂéµèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¤Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂÂè DVD ç¸éÂÂç 主è¦ÂæÂÂä½Âã â¢ ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ ON ï¼ÂéÂÂå ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂå§Âå¨ US B è£Âç½®éÂÂ製徠å³å°Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 01 ï¦ï 003:17 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 T rack05 T rack06 T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Select T rack Bitrate ï§ î 128kbps 192kbps 320kbps ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack T otal Time T rack 1âÂÂ13 î T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 î T rack03 î T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 î T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 î T rack08 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Cancel ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 î T rack03 î T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 î T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 î T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 32 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± 08 33 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 8 ç« å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± 使ç¨伴å±åÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å°Â麥å Â風æÂÂä¸Âå¾Âï¼Âå°Âèª å·±çÂÂè²é³溶堥èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âç¶ä¸Âã 1 æÂ¨å¯以é¸åÂÂä¾ èª CD ã DVD ã VCD æÂ US B è£Âç½®çÂÂ鳿ºÂçÂÂèÂÂæÂ¯ 鳿¨ÂãÂÂè«Â調æÂ´éº¥å Â風èÂÂèÂÂæÂ¯ ç¸å°ÂçÂÂé³éÂÂã 1 æÂÂ堥麥å Â風ã å¦ÂæÂÂåªæÂÂ使ç¨ä¸Âé»麥å Â風 ï¼ è«Âå°Âå®ÂæÂÂ丠MIC (MAIN) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã MIC (SUB) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂåªè½å¨æÂÂæÂ¥ä¸ MIC (MAIN) çÂÂæÂ æ³Âä¸ÂæÂÂè½使ç¨ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂ麥å Â風ä¸ÂæÂÂéÂÂé ï¼Âè«ÂæÂ¥è³éÂÂçÂÂä½Âç½®ã 2 置堥æÂÂä¼´å±èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨ÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以å©ç¨ USB è£Âç½®çÂÂæÂ²ç®ä½Âçº èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âç ä¾ÂæºÂåªÂé«Âã 3 調æÂ´ KARAOKE 模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âã â¢ æÂ SHIFT KARAOKE å¯éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂé éÂÂç¢Âç ï¼Âå·¦å³置è²éÂÂæÂÂ人è²ï¼Âç KAR AOKE 模å¼Âï¼ KARAOKE @人 è²æ¶Âé³@ï¼ÂèÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âä¸Âç 人è² æÂÂé¨åÂÂæÂÂæ¶Âé³ã OFF ï¼Âé Âè¨Âå¼ï¼Âï¼Âå¯å°Âä¼´å±模张éÂÂéÂÂã â¢ æÂ SHIFT AUDIO å¯åÂÂæÂÂç¢Âç ï¼Âå å®è²éÂÂæÂ äººè²æÂ²ç®@çÂÂé³頻è²é ï¼Âé¤è³ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå USB ä¾ æºÂå¤Âï¼ ï¼ Left ï¼Âå 左è²éÂÂãÂÂç¨æÂ¼å³è²éÂÂä¸Âé 製æÂÂ人è²é çÂÂæÂ²ç®ã Right ï¼Âå å³è²éÂÂãÂÂç¨æÂ¼å·¦è²éÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂ製æÂÂ人è² éÂÂçÂÂæÂ²ç®ã STEREO ï¼Âå¯å°Âä¼´å±模å¼Âé éÂÂã 4 æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âã 5 調æÂ´ MIC VOL /â æÂÂéÂÂè³æÂ¨æÂ³è¦ÂçÂÂè²é³ ã 2 çºé¿å Âç¢çÂÂæÂ±äººçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¥Âä¿¡è ï¼Âè«Â確å®ÂæÂ¨æ²ÂæÂÂ尠麥å Â風æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ã 3 è®ÂæÂ´æ··è²æÂÂæÂ å¨麥å Â風混è²ä¸Âå 堥ä¸Â亠æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯以æÂ¹åÂÂæÂ´ é«Âè²é³çÂÂæÂÂ覺ã 4 æÂ¨å¯以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種迴é³ä½ÂæºÂã â¢ è¦Âå¨麥å Â風ä¸Âå 堥æÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT ECHO ã é£çºÂæÂÂä¸Â以åÂÂæÂÂé³é 1 å°é³é 3 Ã¥ÂÂé ã è®ÂæÂ´èÂÂæÂ¯é³樠æÂ¨å¯è½éÂÂè¦ÂéÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂÂé«Âè æÂ¯é³æ¨ÂçÂÂé³éÂÂ以é Âå æÂ¨çÂÂè²é³ã 5 ⢠æÂÂ丠SHIFT ï æÂ SHIFT ï 以éÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂÂé«Âè æÂ¯é³æ¨ÂçÂÂé³éÂÂé«Âä½Âã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠éÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½åªæÂÂ卿ÂÂ¥ ä¸Â麥å Â風æÂÂæÂÂå¯使ç¨ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂ æÂ¨åÂÂ試å¨æÂªæÂ¥ä¸Â麥å Â風æÂÂ使ç¨ SHIFT KARAOKEã SHIFT E CHOã SHIFT ï ã SHIFT ï æÂ MIC VOLï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¢ å¹ÂæÂÂ顯示 NO MIC ï¼ÂæÂªæÂ¥ä¸Â麥å Â風ï¼Âè¨ÂæÂ¯ãÂÂå¦è«Â注 æÂÂï¼Â卿ÂÂæÂ¾ DVD çÂÂæÂÂé ï¼Âç¶æÂ¨æÂ¥ä¸ éº¥å Â風æÂÂï¼Âè²é³è¨Âå®Âèª Ã¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ STEREO æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Â並å°Âå¤Âè²éÂÂä¾ æºÂ縮混æÂ 2.1 è²éÂÂã â¢ éÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½åª è½æÂÂé  DVD/CD æÂ USB 輸堥åÂÂè½使ç¨ã MAIN SUB MIC 2M I C V O L å¨æÂ¨åÂÂä¸Â麥 å Â風ï¼Âè®ÂæÂ´åÂÂè½æÂÂéÂÂéÂÂ黿ºÂæÂÂè¨Âå® çº 0ã 3 è¦Â麥å Â風é³éÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂç è²é³å¯è½æÂÂ失çÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂç¼çÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®æÂ å½¢ï¼Âè«Âå°Âé³éÂÂ調ä½Âã 4 æÂÂ堥麥å Â風æÂÂï¼Âç¡æ³Â調æÂ´ SFC 模å¼ÂãÂÂé³調æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âä½Âé³ãÂÂé«Âé³åÂÂä½Âé³å éÂÂï¼ ãÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂ模å¼ÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°繠è²模å¼Âã MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨ 模å¼ÂæÂÂè²é³強åÂÂå¨模张ã 5 æÂ¤åÂÂè½è DTS è¨ÂèÂÂ丠ç¸容ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 33 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
é³頻è¨Âç½®åÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´é¸å® 09 34 Zhtw 第 9 ç« é³頻è¨Âç½®åÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´é¸å® ãÂÂé³頻è¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® ãÂÂé³頻è¨Âç½®ã é¸å®å¯æÂÂä¾Â調 æÂ´ç¢ÂçÂÂè²é³çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並å¾Âå¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢é¸ å ã Audio Se ttings ï¼Âé³頻è¨Â置@ã ã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER ä¾Âé¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ è¨Âå®Âå¼ã é³頻 DRC ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ§å¶@⢠è¨Â置@High ï¼Âé« ï¼ ã Medi um ï¼Âä¸Âï¼ ã Low ï¼Âä½Âï¼ ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼Âé Âè¨Âå¼@å¨以ä½Âé³éÂÂè§Âè³ Dolby Digital DVD æÂÂï¼Âå¾Â容 æÂÂå®Â堨失å»è¼ÂéÂÂçÂÂè²é³ï¼Âå æÂ¬ä¸ÂäºÂå°Âç½å¨堧ã å°Âé³頻 DRC ï¼Âå æ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ§å¶@åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ坿ÂÂå©æÂ¼çª é¡¯è¼Âè¼ÂçÂÂè²é³ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ æÂÂæÂ§å¶è¼ÂéÂÂçÂÂè²é³ã æÂÂè½å°è²é³çÂÂå·®åÂÂ¥ ï¼ è¦ÂæÂ¨èÂÂè½çÂÂåªÂ髠堧容èÂÂå® ã å¦ÂæÂÂåªÂé«Â堧容å¨é³éÂÂä¸Âæ²ÂæÂÂ太å¤Âè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âé£æÂ¨ä¾¿ ä¸ÂæÂÂ注æÂÂæÂÂä½Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã 1 ãÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´ãÂÂé¸å® å¾ ãÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´ãÂÂç åÂÂè½ç«é¢ä¸Âï¼ æÂ¨å¯以調æÂ´è½ å½±é¿影åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並å¾Âå¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢é¸ å ã Video Adju st ï¼Âè¦Â頻調æÂ´ï¼ ã ã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER ä¾Âå®ÂæÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã æÂ¨å¯以調æÂ´ä»¥ä¸ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼@⢠Sharpness ï¼Âé³ 度@ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´ç«é¢éÂÂç·£ç é³å©度 ï¼ Fine ï¼Â精細@ã Standard ï¼Âæ¨ÂæºÂï¼ ã Soft ï¼ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ@@⢠Brightness ï¼Â亮度@ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´æÂ´é«ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ç 亮度 ï¼ â 20 è³ 20@⢠Contrast ï¼Âå°Â毠度 ï¼ ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´äº®èÂÂæÂÂä¹Âé çÂÂå°Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ ï¼ â 16 è³ 16@⢠Gamma ï¼Âä¼½çª@ï¼Âå¯調 æÂ´å½±åÂÂç ãÂÂæÂÂ度ã @High ï¼Âé«Âï¼ ã Medium ï¼Âä¸Âï¼ ã Low ï¼Âä½Âï¼ ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂ@@⢠Hue ï¼ è²調@ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´ç´ ï¼Â綠平衡 ï¼ Green 9 ï¼Âç¶ è² 9 ï¼ è³ Red 9 ï¼Âç´ è² 9 @@⢠Chroma Level ï¼Âè²度çÂÂç´Âï¼ ï¼ å¯調è²彩å ç¾çÂÂ飽åÂÂ度 ï¼ â 9 è³ 9 @使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ ä¾Â調æÂ´äº®åº¦ãÂÂå°Âæ¯Â度ãÂÂè²調åÂÂè²度 çÂÂç´ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ã 3 æÂÂ丠ENTER 以è¿Âå ã Vide o Adjust ï¼Â覠頻調æÂ´ï¼ ã åÂÂè½ç«é¢ ï¼ æÂÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU é åºåÂÂè½ç«é¢ã éÂÂ註 1 é³頻 DRC å 尠Dolby Digital é³頻ä¾ÂæºÂè½ç¼æÂ®æÂÂç¨ã Audio Settings Audio Settings Audio DRC High Medium Low Off Video Adjust Sharpness Brightness Contrast Gamma Hue Chroma Level Standard 0 0 Off 0 0 î î î î î î Video Adjust Brightness min max 0 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 34 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 35 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 10 ç« ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 使ç¨ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ã é¸å®æÂÂä¾Âé³ é »åÂÂè¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã æÂÂ人éÂÂå®Âï¼Â以åÂÂ顯示è¨Âå®Âå¼ çÂÂã å¦ÂæÂÂé¸頠åÂÂç¾淡åºçÂÂç°è²ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ表示æÂ¤æÂÂç¡æ³ÂæÂÂ¥ Ã¥ÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ãÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®æÂ å½¢éÂÂ常æÂ¯å çºç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾çÂʍ᣾ ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ åÂÂè®ÂæÂ´è¨Âå®Âå¼ã 1 æÂÂ丠DVD/CD ã 2 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME ME NU 並é¸å ã Initia l Settings ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Â置@ã ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ ï¬ å ENTER 以é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Â訠å®ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂé¸頠ã æÂÂæÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂé¸頠å°ÂæÂÂå¨ å¾ÂçºÂçÂÂ堧容ä¸Â詳å 說 æÂÂã 1 è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ éÂÂ註 1 ⢠å¨表ä¸Âï¼Âé Âè¨Â弿Âʊȴ ç²Âé«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示@堶仠çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂæÂÂ以 æÂÂé«Âå 顯示å¨è¢å¹Âä¸Âã â¢ æÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯ TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ ã Audio La nguage ï¼Âå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼Âå Subtitle Language ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼Âå¯è½ å° DVD 碠çÂÂ並ä¸Âå ·æÂÂç¨ãÂÂéÂÂ常éÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼亦 å¯徠DVD çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® ä¸Âä¾Âå®ÂæÂÂè¨Âç½®ã â¢ HDMI Resolution ï¼ HDMI è§£æÂÂ度@è HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼åªæÂÂå¨æÂ¨å©ç¨ HDMI æÂ¥é Âå°ÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨é£æÂ¥è³ HDMI ç¸容è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂ忠覠é²è¡Âè¨Âå®Âã 2 ç¶æÂ¨ç¶Âç± HDMI é£æÂ¥æÂ¹å¼ÂãÂÂ並尠HDMI è§£æÂÂ度è¨Âçº 1920 x 1080p ã 1920 x 10 80i æÂ 1280 x 720p æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½ 使ç¨æÂ¤è¨Âå®Âã 使ç¨æÂ¤è¨Âå®Â弿ÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨åª è½使ç¨ HDMI é£æÂ¥æÂ¹å¼Âã Initial Settings è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ ï¼Âå¦è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 51 é Âç ç« é¢大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæ ¼ å¼ ãÂÂï¼ 4:3 (Letter Box) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å³統 4:3 é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ã 寬è¢å¹Âé» å½±å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂï¼Âä¸Âä¸Âå ©å´æÂÂæÂ é»Âè²æ¢ÂéÂÂã 4:3 (Pan & Scan) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å³統 4:3 é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ãÂÂ寬è¢å¹Âé» å½±å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂæÂÂè£ÂæÂÂå·¦å³堩å´ ä¸Âé¨åÂÂï¼Â以å©填滿æÂ´åÂÂè¢å¹Âã 16:9 (W ide) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å¯¬è¢å¹Âé»覠æ©ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ã 16:9 (Compressed) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å¯¬è¢å¹Âé»覠æ©ÂæÂÂï¼ éÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ãÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ 4:3 çÂÂå § 容æÂÂï¼Âç«é¢堶ä¸Âä¸Âå´å°Â顯示 é»Âè²æ¢ÂéÂÂã 2 Component Out ï¼Âè²差è¦Â頻輸åº@ï¼Âå¦è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âç é£ æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻è¨Âå ãÂÂï¼ Interlac e ï¼Âé è¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂèÂ¥ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »æÂÂï¼ éÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ã Progressive ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âå¦ÂæÂÂé©ç¨æÂ¼éÂÂè¡ æÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »æÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ï¼Âè«Âå é±æÂ¨é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂ詳 細說æÂÂï¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂä¸Â次 ENTER 確誠ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠RETURN Ã¥ÂÂæ¶Âè¨Â置@ã è«Â注æÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂ覠頻å å¯ç¶Âç±è²差è¦Âé »æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ輸åºã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 35 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 36 Zhtw èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ HDMI Resolution ï¼ HDMI è§£æÂÂ度 ï¼ * ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 41 é Âç 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ãÂÂï¼ * é Âè¨Â弿ÂÂé ÂÃ¥ÂÂé»è¦Âæ ¼ å¼Âï¼ PAL/NTSC ï¼ÂæÂ¹è®Âã 1920 x 1080p å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 1920 x 1080 ç«素éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Â訠å®ÂæÂ¤é  ã 1920 x 1080i å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 1920 x 1080 ç«素éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ ï¼ åÂÂè«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã 1280 x 720p å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 1280 x 720 ç«素éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Âè¨Âå® æÂ¤é  ã 720 x 480p (NTSC)/ 720 x 576p (PAL) å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 720 x 480 (NTSC)/720 x 576 (PAL) ç«素é è¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã 720 x 480i (NTSC)/ 720 x 576i (PAL) å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 720 x 480 (NTSC)/72 0 x 576 (PAL) ç«素é è¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@* ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 41 é Âç 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ãÂÂï¼ * é Âè¨Â弿ÂÂè¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂ訠åÂÂæÂ¹è®Âã Full range RGB ï¼Âé²é RGB ï¼ è²彩微弱æÂÂï¼Â坿ÂÂä¾ÂæÂ´äº® éºÂçÂÂè²彩åÂÂæÂ´æ·±çÂÂé»Âè² ï¼ÂæÂ¤é Âè¨Âå¼ é©ç¨æÂ¼ HDMI ç¸容ç DV I è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã RGB 使ç¨ ãÂÂé²é RGB ã è¨Âå®Âå¼æÂ ï¼ÂèÂ¥è² 彩太éÂÂ飽滿@è«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã Component ï¼Âè²差 ï¼ å¯輸åº 8-bit çÂÂè²差è¦Â頻格张ï¼ÂæÂ¤é Âè¨Âå¼é©ç¨æÂ¼ HDMI ç¸容 è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ Audio Language ï¼Âå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼ English ï¼Âè±èªÂï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂæÂ è± èªÂçÂÂé³è»Âï¼Â峿ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠å¦ÂæÂÂé¸åÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼ å³æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 堶ä»ÂèªÂ訠é¸åÂÂæÂÂ顯示以å¤ÂçÂÂèªÂ訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼Âã Subtitle Language ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼ English ï¼Âè±èªÂï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂæÂ è± èªÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Âï¼Â峿ÂÂ顯示ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠æÂÂ顯示å¨ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âé¸åÂÂçÂÂå å¹ÂèªÂè¨Âã 堶ä»ÂèªÂ訠é¸åÂÂæÂÂ顯示以å¤ÂçÂÂèªÂ訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼Âã DVD Menu Language ï¼ DVD èÂÂå®èªÂ訠@w/Subtitle La ng. ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âé£åÂÂï¼ å¯è½çÂÂ話@DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å®æÂÂ以åÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂé¸åÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âç¸å çÂÂèªÂ訠顯示ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠å¯è½çÂÂ話@DVD é¸å®æÂÂ以æÂÂé¸çÂÂèªÂè¨Â顯 示ã 堶ä»ÂèªÂ訠é¸åÂÂæÂÂ顯示以å¤ÂçÂÂèªÂ訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼Âã Subtitle Display ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Â顯示@On ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ åÂÂå¹ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂé¸çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Â誠è¨Â顯示ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ å¨æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢Âç æÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂæÂÂä¾Âé Âè¨ÂæÂ¹å¼Âä¿ÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂçÂÂçÂÂæ Âã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 36 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 37 Zhtw English Español English Español 顯示å¹Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠è¨Âå®Âå¼ æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® æÂÂ人éÂÂ宠⢠é Âè¨ÂçÂÂç´Âï¼ Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼Âé Âè¨Âå¯Â碼@ç¡ ï¼ é Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼@us (2119) çºäºÂè®ÂæÂ¨å¯以æÂ§å¶ä¸Âè®ÂæÂ¨ç å°Âå©使ç¨æÂ¨ç DVD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨è§Âè³Âå½±çÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ亠DVD-Vi deo ç¢ÂçÂÂçµÂå æÂÂæÂÂ人éÂÂå®ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç´ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨è¨Âç½® çÂÂçÂÂç´Âè¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂçºä½Âï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂ便 ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¹ÂæÂÂæÂ¯æÂ´åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼åÂÂè½ãÂÂæÂ¬æ© ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂäºÂå ´æÂ¯ï¼Âè¦ÂæÂ¨è¨Âç½®ç åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼èÂÂå®Âã çÂȎÂÂæÂ°å¯Â碼 è«Â輸堥å¯Â碼以è®ÂæÂ´æÂÂ人éÂÂå®ÂçÂÂç´ÂæÂÂ輸堥åÂÂå®¶ï¼ å°åÂÂ代碼ã 1 1 é¸å ã Password ï¼Âå¯Â碼@ã ã 2 使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ輸堥åÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸å å¯Â碼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂ´æÂÂå¯Â碼 è¦ÂæÂ´æÂ¹å¯Â碼ï¼Âè«Âå Â確èªÂç¾æÂÂå¯Â碼ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ輸堥æÂ°ç å¯Â碼ã 1 é¸åÂÂã Passwo rd Change ï¼ÂæÂ´æÂÂå¯Â碼@ã @輸堥ç¾è¡ÂçÂÂå¯Â碼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ ä¸ ENTER ã 2 輸堥æÂ°å¯Â碼並æÂÂ丠ENTER ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ OSD Language ï¼Âå¨å±Â顯示èªÂè¨Âï¼ English ï¼Âè± èªÂï¼ å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢æÂÂæÂÂè±èªÂ顯示ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂé¸çÂÂ誠è¨Â顯示ã Angle Indicator ï¼Âè§Â度æÂÂ示çÂÂï¼ On ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ å¨æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂå¤Âè§Â度場æÂ¯æÂÂé ï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示ç¸橠åÂÂ示ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ ä¸Â顯示å¤Âè§Â度æÂÂ示åÂÂ示ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ Parent al Lock ï¼ÂæÂÂ人éÂÂå®Âï¼ â è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå æÂÂ人éÂÂå® ã DivX(R) VOD Display è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX î VOD 堧容 ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ Speaker Dista nce ï¼ÂæÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢@â å¯æÂÂå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨èÂÂèÂÂè½ä½Âç½®ç è·Âé¢ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 39 é Âç æÂÂè² å¨è·Âé¢ ï¼Âã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠並éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ種é¡ÂçÂÂ碠çÂÂé½é©ç¨æÂÂ人éÂÂå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ï¼Âè ä¸Â亦ç¡é Âå Â輸堥å¯Â碼æÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨å¿Â訠å¯Â碼ï¼ÂæÂ¨æÂÂéÂÂè¦Âå°ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨éÂÂç½®æÂÂè½ ç»è¨ÂæÂ°çÂÂå¯Â碼 ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 ï¼Âã Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD Passw ord Level Change Country Code Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 37 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 38 Zhtw è¨Âç½®ï¼ÂæÂ¹è®ÂæÂÂ人éÂÂå® 1 é¸å ã Level Chang e ï¼ÂæÂ¹è®Âç´Âå¥@ã ã 2 使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ輸堥æÂ¨çÂÂå¯Â碼 ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 é¸åÂÂæÂ°çÂÂçÂÂç´Â並æÂÂ丠ENTER ã â¢ é£çºÂæÂ ï« 以éÂÂå®Âå¨æÂ´é«ÂçÂÂ層次 ï¼ÂæÂ´å¤Âç¢Âç éÂÂè¦Â使ç¨å¯Â碼@ï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ ï¬ 以åÂÂæ¶ÂéÂÂå®Â層次 ã æÂ¨ä¸Âè½éÂÂå¨çÂÂç´ 1 ã è¨Âç½®ï¼Âè®ÂæÂ´åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼 æÂ¨å¯以å¾Â第 58 é Âç åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼渠å® ç¶丠æÂ¾å°ã 1 é¸å ã Country Code ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ家代碼@ã ï¼Â輸 å ¥å¯Â碼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTE R ã 2 é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã å¨æÂ¤æÂÂä¾Â堩種è¨Âç½®çÂÂæÂ¹ æ³Â@⢠æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼é¸å @使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂå®¶ï¼ å°åÂÂ代碼ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¸åÂÂ代碼é¸åÂÂï¼ æÂÂ丠ï¬ï¼Âç¶å¾Â使ç¨æÂ¸å éµ輸堥åÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼ å°åÂÂ代碼ã å¨éÂÂåºç¢ÂçÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂ°çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼便ç«Âå³ç æÂÂã éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX î VOD 堧容 çºäºÂè® DivX VOD ï¼Âé¨é¸è¦Âé »ï¼ÂçÂÂ堧容è½å¨æÂ¬ æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¿ é Âå Âå æÂ¨ç DivX VOD 堧容侠æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂȎÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂè³ÂæÂ ã æÂ¨å¯以èÂÂç±ç¢çÂÂä¸Âçµ DivX VOD çÂȎÂÂ代碼ï¼Âç¼éÂÂ給æÂ¨çÂÂä¾ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¾Âå® æÂÂçÂȎÂÂä½Âæ¥Âã 1 éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠DivX VOD 堧容å DRM ï¼ÂæÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂ@系統æÂÂä¿Âè· ã éÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå¶åªæÂÂä¸ÂäºÂç¹ å® ã 已ç» éÂÂçÂÂè£Âç½®æÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨å¨æÂ¬æ©Â堧置堥ä¸Âç æÂªç¶ÂæÂÂæ¬Â使ç¨ ï¼ å § å« DivX VOD 堧容çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸Â峿ÂÂ顯 示 Authorization Error ï¼ÂæÂÂæ¬Âé¯誤@çÂÂ訠æÂ¯ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ堧容亦ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã 顯示æÂ¨ç DivX VOD çÂȎÂÂ代碼 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã In itial Settings ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Â置@ã ã 2 é¸å ã Options ï¼Âé¸頠@ã ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ¯ ã DivX (R) VOD ãÂÂã 3 é¸å ã Display ãÂÂã è¢å¹Âä¸Â顯示æÂ¨çÂÂå «ä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂç» éÂÂ代碼ã è«Âè¨Âä¸Â代碼ï¼Âå çºå¨åÂÂæÂ¨ç DivX VOD ä¾ÂæÂÂå çÂȎÂÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂè¦Âç¨å°ã æÂÂæÂ¾ DivX î VOD 堧容 æÂÂ亠DivX VOD å § 容å è½ä½Âä¸Âå®ÂæÂÂéÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã å¨ æÂ¨ç½®å ¥å«æÂÂæÂ¤ç¨® DivX VOD 堧容çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ ï¼ å©餠æÂÂæÂ¾æ¬¡æÂ¸ä¾¿æÂÂ顯示å¨è¢å¹Â丠@ç¶å¾ÂæÂ¨ 便å¯以é¸å è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢Âç ï¼Âå æÂ¤ å¯以ç¨ä¸Âå ¶ä¸Âä¸Â種å©é¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ 次æÂ¸ï¼ ï¼ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç½®å ¥çÂÂæÂ¯å«æÂÂæÂÂé 已éÂÂç DivX VOD 堧容 ï¼Âä¾Âå¦Âï¼Â堧容çÂÂå©é¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾æ¬¡æÂ¸æÂ¯é¶@ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¢å¹Âä¸Â便æÂÂ顯示 Rent al Expired ï¼Âç§ÂæÂÂå·²éÂÂï¼ çÂÂè¨ÂæÂ¯ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç DivX VOD 堧容å Â許ä¸ÂéÂÂ次æÂ¸çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ é£æÂ¨ä¾¿å¯以å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂ置堥æÂ¬æ©Âï¼Â並æÂÂæÂ¾æÂ¨å¸¸çÂÂç 堧容ï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸Â亦ä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示任 ä½Âè¨ÂæÂ¯ã éÂÂ註 1 é 置æÂ¬æ© ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 ï¼Âä¸Âè´使æÂ¨å¤±åÂȾ¨çÂÂçÂȎÂÂ代 碼ã Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Display Initial Settings Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 38 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 39 Zhtw English Español English Español æÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢ â¢ é Âè¨Âå¼@3.0m æÂ³è¦Âå¾ÂæÂ¨çÂÂ系統ä¸Âç¢çÂÂæÂÂä½³çÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂå° ç¸è·ÂèÂÂè½ä½Â置堩å´çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ è¨Âå®ÂçºåÂÂçÂÂè·Âé¢ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸ å ã Initia l Settings ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Â置@ã ã 2 é¸å ã Speaker s ï¼ æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼ ã ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ¯ ã Speaker Dis tance ï¼ æÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢ ï¼ ã ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸åÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂè²å¨ã 4 æÂÂ丠ï¬ 以è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂç½æÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨éÂÂè·Âã 5 使ç¨ ï©/ïª è®ÂæÂ´éÂÂè·Âã â¢ å¨æÂ¨è®ÂæÂ´å·¦åÂÂç½® ï¼ L ï¼ÂæÂÂå³åÂÂç½® ï¼ÂR ï¼ÂæÂÂè² å¨çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âå®Âå¼æÂ ï¼ æÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂéÂÂ跠亦æÂÂç¸å°Âè®ÂæÂ´ã â¢ å·¦ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½® ï¼ L / R ï¼ÂæÂÂè²å¨éÂÂè·Âå¯以毠30 cm çºå¢Âå å®你@徠30 cm å¢Âè³ 9 m ã 1 ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼ C ï¼Âå¯ 以 â 2.1 m è³ 0 m çÂÂè·Âé¢ ç¸å°ÂæÂ¼å·¦ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® ã â¢ å·¦ï¼Âå³ç°繠@SL / SR ï¼ æÂ è²å¨å¯以è¨Âç½®å¾Âå¯ 以 â 6.0 m è³ 0 m çÂÂè·Âé¢ç¸å°ÂæÂ¼å·¦ï¼Âå³å 置æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½®ã 2 ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ ï¼ SWï¼ å¯以è¨Âç½®å¾Âå¯以 â 2.1 m è³ 0 m çÂÂè·Âé¢ç¸å°ÂæÂ¼å·¦ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® ã 6 å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³è¦Âè®ÂæÂ´å ¶ä»ÂçÂÂæÂ è²å¨éÂÂè·Âå¼ï¼Âè« æÂÂ丠ï« 以è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨渠å®ï¼ÂæÂ æÂÂ丠ENTER 以éÂÂåºæÂÂè²å¨éÂÂè·Âç«é¢ã éÂÂ註 1 L å R æÂÂè²å¨åÂÂæÂ¯æÂÂå°ÂçÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ ç¡æ³ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¾Âè¨Âç½®ã 2 å¨使ç¨å 大åÂÂçÂÂ模张ï¼Â第 23 é Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â確實è¨Â置以ç¸ Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂéÂÂè·Âã Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Speaker Distance Initial Settings Video Output Language Display Options Speakers L C R SR SL SW 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 39 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 40 Zhtw 第 11 ç« å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 â¢ å¨æÂ¬æ©Âå¾Âé¢æÂ¿é£æÂ¥æÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â確實å°Â黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂ並å¾ÂçÂÂ壠æÂÂ座æÂÂä¸Â黿ºÂç·Âã å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âå¾Âï¼Âè«Âå°Âé» æºÂç·Âé£æÂ¥è³çÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座ä¸Âã é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻è¨Âå 使ç¨ç«Âé«Âè²é¡Âæ¯Â輸堥å¯é£æÂ¥å¡å¼ÂéÂÂé³座æÂ MD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨çÂÂå¤Âé¨è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âç¶Âç±æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂæÂ¾ã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±丠述ç 1 ã â¢ 飿ÂÂ¥ (LIN E 1) AUDIO IN æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè³å¤Âé¨æÂ æÂ¾è¨ åÂÂçÂÂé¡Âæ¯Â輸åºä¸Âã å¯使ç¨ RCA éÂÂé ÂÃ¥ÂÂç«Âé«Âè²é£æÂ¥ç·Âä¾Âé£æÂ¥ã AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R L R FRONT CENTER R SURROUND SUB WOOFER A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP Y P B P R ADAPTER PORT VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO 5 m à6 m ÿÃÂà ¥²áÂÂá°àÿÃÂà ¥²á á°ààî HDMI á°ä ÃÂÃÂà §°á°ä PA L à ´Âà ¯¦áÂ à ¡ÂõÃÂá¤ à ¡ÂòÃÂᤠÃÂÃÂà ±Âà ®Âà ¼°à ¨ ÃÂáµá¤àBluetooth î à ¼Âá°á£ KURO LINK à £»à §¡Ã ÃÂá£ÃÂà ¥®áÂ¬à º ÃÂÃÂáÂÂà ¥²à §µà ¹ áÂ¬à ºÂá¡ AM áÂÂà  ¯ ÃÂᤠHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 40 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 41 Zhtw English Español English Español 使ç¨è²差è¦Â頻輸åºé£æÂÂ¥ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂè² å·®è¦Â頻輸堥@æÂ¨å¯以使ç¨ éÂÂäºÂ輸堥åÂÂ代æ¨ÂæºÂè¦Â頻輸åº以å¾Âå°æÂ´å¥½çÂÂç« 質ã 1 éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 2 ã â¢ 使ç¨è²差è¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç·Â飿ÂÂ¥ COMPONENT VIDEO OUT è³æÂ¨é»è¦Âæ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂè²差輸堥絠ã éÂÂæÂ¼éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé » ç¸è¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »æÂ´è½æÂÂæÂÂç å åÂÂå½±åÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂé »çÂÂï¼Âç¢çÂÂç¸ç¶穩å®Âï¼Âç¡跳å çÂÂå½±åÂÂãÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »å å¯éÂÂéÂÂè²差è¦Â頻輸åº 端åÂÂ輸åºã æÂ¬æ©ÂèÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé«Âå³çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âä¹Âç¸容æÂ§ã â¢ æÂ¬æ©ÂèÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé » Macro Vision System Copy Guard ç¸容ã 2 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ èÂ¥é Âå HDMI æÂ DVI ï¼ÂçµÂå HDCP ï¼ çÂÂ顯示å¨ æÂÂ顯示è£Âç½®ï¼Âå¯ å©ç¨ä¸Âè¬å¸Âé¢ä¸Âç HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ç·Âå°Âå®Âé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ï¼Â以æÂÂä¾Âé«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ質çÂÂæÂ¸ä½ è¦Âé »ã 3 éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 3 ã â¢ 使ç¨ HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âå°ÂæÂ¬ æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ç HDMI OUT é£æÂ¥ç«¯å é£æÂ¥è³ HDMI ç¸ 容顯示å¨ä¸Âç HDMI é£æÂ¥ç«¯åÂÂã â¢ é£æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¥é ÂçÂÂç®Âé ÂæÂ æÂÂä¸Â精確å°ÂæºÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ çÂÂæÂ¥é Âã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以調æÂ´è§£æÂÂ度åÂÂè² 彩ç HDMI è¨Âå®Âå¼ã 欲äºÂè§£èÂÂéÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ç¸éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³Â訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã åÂÂæÂ HDMI é³頻è¨Âç½® å¼ æÂ¨å¯以鏿ÂÂ系統æÂÂè²å¨æÂ é»è¦Âï¼ éÂÂé HDMI 輸 åº DVD/CD æÂ USB Ã¥ÂÂè½çÂÂè²é³ ã 4 HDMI é³頻 è¨Âå®Âçº TV æÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ç¡æ³Â使ç¨æÂ¬ç³»çµ±çÂÂå¤Âå è²é³ Ã¥ÂÂè½ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å HDMI SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å HDMI MODE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ ä¸ ENTERã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ ä¸ ENTER ã â¢ AMP â å¾ÂæÂ¬ç³»çµ±è¼¸åº DVD/CD çÂÂè²é³è USB Ã¥ÂÂè½è¨ÂèÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠è²差è¦Â頻輸åº å¯å¨éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂæ ¼å¼Âä¹ÂéÂÂä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂãÂÂè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã â¢ 使ç¨ HDMI ç·Âé£æÂ¥æÂÂæÂ¾å¨æÂÂï¼Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂå½±åÂÂ輸åºä¸Âå¯å¨ Interlace ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè Progressiv e ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âæ ¼å¼Âä¹ éÂÂå æÂÂã HDMI è§£æÂÂ度è¨Âçº 720x480i (NTSC)/720x576i(PAL) æ ¼å¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âå°ÂèªåÂÂé¸å Interlace ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âæ ¼å¼Âã ä½Âå¨堶ä»Âè¨Âå® ä¸Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯èªåÂÂé¸å Progressive ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âæ ¼å¼Âã 2 æ¶Âè²»è æÂÂ注æÂÂï¼Â並éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂç é«Âå³çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½èÂÂæÂÂ¢åÂÂå®Âå ¨ç¸ 容ï¼Âä¸Âå¯è½å°Âè´ç«é¢ä¸Âåº ç¾人çºé æÂÂçÂÂç¾象ãÂÂå°ÂæÂ¼ 525 éÂÂè¡ æÂÂæÂÂç«é¢åÂÂé¡Âï¼Â建è°使 ç¨è å¯å°Âé£æÂ¥ç«¯åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè³ ãÂÂæ¨ÂæºÂè§£æÂÂ度ãÂÂ輸åº ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ ä¾Âå 以æÂ¹åÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂç¼çÂÂé»覠æ©ÂèÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âå¨ç¸ 容æÂ§æÂ¹é¢çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âï¼Âè«Âè æÂ¬å ¬å¸çÂÂ客æÂÂä¸Âå¿Âè¯繫ã 3 ⢠HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ æÂ¹å¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼è DVI å HDCP ï¼ High Bandwidth Digi tal Content P rotection ï¼Âç¸ 容 ç DVI å 訠åÂÂãÂÂèÂÂ¥ é¸ å é£ æÂ¥è³ DVI æÂ¥é Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨å¦å¤ÂçÂÂè½ÂæÂ¥é  ï¼ DVI ï¤ HDMI ï¼Âå®ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥ãÂÂç¶èÂÂï¼ DVI é£æÂ¥æÂ¹ å¼Â並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´é³頻信èÂÂãÂÂ欲äºÂè§£æÂ´å¤ ç¸é è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«Âæ´½ç¶å°é³é¿綠é·åÂÂã â¢ è¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂ訠åÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼Â使ç¨ DVI é£ æÂ¥å¯è½å°Âè´信èÂÂå³輸ä¸Âç©©ã â¢ èÂ¥æÂ¹è®Â飿ÂÂ¥ è³ HDMI 輸åºçÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âä¹Âå¿ é Âè® æÂ´ HDMI è¨Âå®Âå¼以符åÂÂæÂ°çÂÂè¨Âå ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ å®ÂæÂÂæÂ¤ é  æÂÂä½Âï¼ ã 4 KURO LINK è¨Âå®Âçº ON ä¸Âå¹³é¢é»è¦Âå¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾åÂÂ模å¼Âä¸ÂæÂ ï¼Âç¡æ³ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 41 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 42 Zhtw ⢠TV â å¾Âé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Âæ© åº DVD/CD ç è²é³è USB Ã¥ÂÂè½è¨ÂèÂÂã 1 éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ èÂ¥åºç¾é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯ ï¼Â顯示å¹Âå±Â示 HD MI ERR ï¼ÂæÂ èÂ¥ç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂ空ç½ ï¼Âå¦Âå¨è®ÂæÂ´è§£æÂ åº¦å¾Âï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 53 é  çÂÂæÂ éÂÂæÂÂ餿ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂèÂ¥ä»Âç¡æ³Â解決 Ã¥ÂÂé¡Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Âä¾Âä¸Âè¿°æÂ¥é© éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI é£æÂ¥ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å INITIAL ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å HDMIINIT ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4I N I T O K éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 系統æÂÂéÂÂæÂ°åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠HDMI è¨Âå®Â弿ÂÂèªåÂÂéÂÂæÂ°è¨ åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» é Âè¨Âå¼ãÂÂ欲äºÂè§£èÂÂéÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ç¸éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´ å¤Âè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã éÂÂæÂ¼ HDMI HDMI ï¼ High Definition Multimedia Interface ï¼Âå¯æÂ¯æÂ´ä»¥å®ä¸ÂæÂ¸ä½Âé£æÂ¥ç·Â飿ÂÂ¥ DVD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ã DTV ãÂÂæ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå ¶ä» å½±é³è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂ@並åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä¾Âè¦Âé »åÂÂé³頻ã HDMI çÂÂç Âç¼æÂ¯çº亠æÂÂä¾Âè½尠HDCP ï¼ High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection ï¼Âè DVI ï¼ Digital Visual Interface ï¼Âå ©é  æÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂèÂÂçºä¸ÂçÂÂè¦Âæ ¼ã HD CP æÂ¯ç¨ä¾Âä¿Âè·ç± DVI ç¸容顯示卿ÂÂå³輸åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ç æÂ¸ä½Â堧容ã HDMI æÂÂæÂÂè½æÂ¯æÂ´æ¨Â溠ãÂÂå¢Âå¼·æÂÂé«Âç«質è¦Âé »å å¤Âè²éÂÂç°ç¹Âè²é³æÂÂæ¨Â溠çÂÂè½åÂÂã HDMI çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ å æÂ¬ï¼ÂæÂªå£Â縮æÂ¸ä½Âè¦Âé » ãÂÂæ¯Âç§Âå¯é 5 GB 頻寬 ï¼Âå« HDTV ä¿¡èÂÂï¼ ãÂÂå®ä¸ÂæÂ¥é  ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ代æÂ¸æ¢ÂæÂÂ¥ ç· åÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âï¼ ï¼Â以 Ã¥ÂÂè½å¨影é³ä¾ÂæºÂå DTV çÂÂå½±é³訠åÂÂéÂÂé²è¡ÂéÂÂè¨ÂçÂÂã HDMI ã HDMI æ¨ÂèªÂå High- Definit ion Multimedia Interface Ã¥ÂÂçº HDMI Licensing, LLC çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨ÂæÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨ AM 天ç·ÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯使ç¨ 5 m è³ 6 m ä¹ ç¯åºéÂÂ屬ç·Â並å®Âè£ÂæÂ¼å®¤å §æÂÂ室å¤ÂãÂÂä¿ÂçÂÂé£æÂ¥ç ç°åÂÂ天ç·ÂãÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨é¨éÂÂç AM ç°形天ç·Âã é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨ FM 天ç·ÂæÂ ï¼ å¯使ç¨ PAL é£æÂ¥é ÂæÂ¥ä¸ ä¸Âçµ FM 天ç·Âã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 4 ã ç¨æÂ¼ç¡ç·Â享åÂÂ鳿¨Âç Bluetooth î å³輸å¨ å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ280/282DVD-A P æ©Âå ç¡ç·Â鳿¨ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ Bluetooth å³輸å¨ ï¼Âå ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè AS-BT100 ï¼Âé£ æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯使ç¨æÂÂè¼ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ ï¼ è¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂé»話ã æÂ¸ä½Â鳿¨ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨çÂÂï¼ çÂÂç¢åÂÂä¾Âç¡ ç·ÂèÂÂè½é³樠ã 2 æÂ¤å¤ ï¼ ä½¿ç¨å¸Âå®çÂÂæÂ¯æÂ´ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂç¼å°Âå¨ ï¼ å¯以èÂÂè½æÂªé Âå Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂè£Âç½®ä¸ÂçÂÂ鳿¨Âã AS-BT100 æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯ æÂ´ SCMS-T 堧容ä¿Âè· ï¼ å æÂ¤å¨é Âå SCMS-T å Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂç¢å ä¸Âä¹Âå¯以享åÂÂé³樠ã éÂÂ註 1 Ã¥ÂÂ樣å¯以使ç¨é»è¦Âæ©Â堧建çÂÂæÂÂè² å¨ä¾ÂèÂÂè½èª DVD æÂ USB è£Â置輸堥çÂÂé³è¨Âã HDMI 端åÂÂçÂÂé³頻輸åºå å é©ç¨æÂ¼ éÂÂè²éÂÂç·Âå PCM ãÂÂæÂ¤æÂÂï¼Âè½ä¸Âå°ä¾ÂèªæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂè² å¨ ï¼ÂæÂÂè³æ©Âï¼ÂçÂÂ任你è²é³ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Âé³頻 ï¼Âå æÂ¬ TUNERï¼Âå¾ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ£å¸¸è¼¸ åºã 2 Bl uetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨裠置å¯è½é ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ A2DP è¨Âå®Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 42 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 43 Zhtw English Español English Español éÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂÂä½ æÂ¬ç³»çµ±é¨éÂÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å Â許æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢åªÂé«Â@以åÂÂå·è¡Âå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂä½Âã 1 é£æÂ¥é¸購ç Bluetooth å³輸å¨ 1 å°Â系統åÂÂæÂÂè³徠æ©ÂçÂÂæ  ï¼ ç¶å¾Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨é£æÂ¥è³ä½ÂæÂ¼å¾Âé¢æÂ¿ç ADAPTER PORT ã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 5 ã 2 æÂÂ丠ïµ STANDBY/ON ã 3 æÂ ADAPTER PORT ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå° BT AUDIO 輸堥模å¼Âã 2 é Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® å¨使ç¨ Bluetooth å³輸å¨éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Â堧容ä¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âå¿ é Âå®ÂæÂ ãÂÂé Âå°Âã ãÂÂ第丠次æÂÂä½Â系統æÂÂä»»ä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ渠é¤é Âå°Âè³ÂæÂÂæÂ ï¼Âè«Â確 å®Âå·è¡Âé Âå° ã ãÂÂé Âå°Âã æÂ¯çÂȎ Bluetoot h ç¡締æÂÂè¡Âè£Â置以åÂÂç¨ Bluetooth éÂÂè¨ÂçÂÂå¿ è¦ÂæÂ¥é© ã 3 å¦ÂéÂÂ詳細è³ÂæÂÂï¼Âå¦è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± æÂ¨ç Bluetooth ç¡締æÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP 以é¸å BT SETUP ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å PA IRING ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª ï¼Âå¾ 0000/1234/8888 ä¸Âé¸ æÂÂ覠使ç¨ç PIN 碼@ç¶å¾ÂæÂ ENTER ã PAIRING éÂÂçÂÂã 注æÂ â¢ æÂ¨å¯以使ç¨任ä¸Âå 0000/123 4/8888 PIN 碼ã Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置使 ç¨é¤æÂ¬ç³»çµ± 使ç¨çÂÂä»»ä½Âå ¶ä» PIN 碼ã 4 éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¨è¦Âé Âå°Âç Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ï¼ å°Âå®ÂæÂ¾å¨é è¿Â系統çÂÂä½Âç½® @並è¨Âå®Âå¨é Âå°Â模张ã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠Bluetooth ç¡ ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨è£Âç½®å¯è½é ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ AVRCP è¨Âå®Âã â¢ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âä¿Âè 使ç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯以æÂÂä½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âå ç¨çÂÂè£Âç½®ãÂ à ¥²áÂÂáÂ¦à ¨ ÃÂá¡ Bluetooth î à ¼Âá°á£ áÂÂà ¯¢á£áÂÂñ á£ò á à ¸ÂáÂ¤Ã à ³Âà °Âã áÂÂáÂÂàÃÂà ÂÂáÂ‡Â à ¸ÂáÂ¤Ã à ³Âà °Âã áÂÂáÂÂàá¶ÃÂà ¥²áÂÂáÂÂúᣠáÂÂáÂÂÃÂà ¬ªà ´± Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡à ¸ÂᤠÃÂà ³ á¶ÃÂà ¥²á áÂÂúá£ Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡à ¥²à ¬ à ¸¶à §£á£ ÃÂÃÂà ¶àá£ò á£ò á£ò 2 å¨ Bluetooth å³輸å¨å°ÂæÂªæÂÂå ¥ ADAPTER PORT æÂÂï¼Âå³使æÂÂ丠ADAPTER PORT ä¹Âç¡æ³Âé²堥 BT AUDIO 輸堥模å¼Âã 3 ⢠第ä¸Â次使ç¨ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Â裠置å Blue tooth å³輸卿ÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¦Âé Âå°Âã â¢ èÂ¥è¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ Blueto oth éÂÂè¨Âï¼ÂæÂ¨çÂÂ系統å Blueto oth ç¡ç·ÂæÂ è¡Âè£Âç½®é½æÂÂ該å®ÂæÂÂé Âå°Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 43 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 44 Zhtw 5 檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·Âè£Âç½®æÂ¯å¦åµ測å° Bluetooth å³輸å¨ã ç¶ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®åµ測å° Bluetooth å³輸å¨æÂ ï¼ å³輸å¨çÂÂèÂÂå¥編 è ã AS-BT100 ã 顯示å¨ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置渠å®ä¸Âã 1 6 å¾ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置渠å®ä¸Âï¼Âé¸å Bluetooth å³輸å¨ï¼Âç¶å¾Âå¨æÂ¥é© 3 輸堥æÂÂé¸å ç PIN 碼ã 2 使ç¨æÂ¨çÂÂ系統èÂÂè½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂ è¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂ鳿¨Â堧容 1 æÂ ADAPTER PORT ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå° BT AUDIO 輸堥模å¼Âã 2 å° Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®é£ æÂ¥è³ Bluetooth å³輸å¨ã é£æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂï¼ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®å 稱顯示å¨系統顯示 å¹Âä¸Âã 3 æÂªé£æÂÂ¥ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂï¼ NODEVICE 顯示å¨系統顯示å¹Âä¸Âã 3 éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å²åÂÂå¨ Blue tooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ä¸ÂçÂÂ鳿¨Â堧容ã 使ç¨系統é Â端åÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨ ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂéµ ï¼ å° Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®é²è¡Âä¸Âå æÂÂä½Âã 4 渠é¤é Âå° 5 1 è«ÂæÂ SHIFT SETUP ï¼Âé¸å BT SETUP ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂ ENTER ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å PAIR CLR ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 顯示 CLR OK æÂ ï¼Âè«ÂæÂ ENTER ã Bluetooth î Ã¥ÂÂæ¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âçº Bluetoo th SIG, Inc. æÂÂæÂÂï¼ å ÂéÂÂå ¬å¸使ç¨éÂÂ亠æ¨ÂèªÂçÂÂéÂÂç²å¾ÂæÂÂæ¬Âã 堶ä»ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ稱åÂÂ屬堶 Ã¥ÂÂèªçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè æÂ æÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 ç¶ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂªé¡¯ç¤ºå¨åµ測å°ç è£Â置渠å®ä¸ÂæÂÂæÂªé¡¯ç¤ºæÂÂï¼Âå ä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示 Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置渠å®ãÂÂ卿ÂÂ亠æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以使ç¨é Âå°Â模 å¼Âä¾Âé Âå° Bluetooth å³ 輸å¨åÂÂ該 Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ã 2 æÂ äºÂæÂ æ³Âç PI N 碼ä¹Â稱çº ãÂÂéÂÂè¡Â碼ã ã 3 ç³» çµ±åªè½顯示è±æÂ¸åÂÂå ÂãÂÂå ¶ä» åÂÂå Âå¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢ºé¡¯ç¤ºã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ï¤/ïÂÂ¥ ï¼Â系統@éÂÂå§ÂæÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂ«åÂÂï¼Âå 涠æÂ«åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ï¤ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@éÂÂå§ÂæÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ã ïÂÂ¥ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@å¯æÂ«åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ï§ ï¼Â系統ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ã 4 ⢠Blue tooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂè AVRCP è¨Âå®Âç¸容ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨ç Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®èÂÂå®Âï¼ÂæÂÂä½Âå¯è½èÂÂæÂ¤ 表æÂÂ示æÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã ï ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âå¿«è½ ã ï® ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿«è½ ã ï¯ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@å¯跳è³ç®åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æªÂæ¡ çÂÂæÂÂå é¢ä½Âç½®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè·³è³åÂÂ丠åÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã ï° ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@å¯跳è³ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã 5 ⢠ä¸ÂæÂ·é£ æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®å³å¯å®ÂæÂ æ¸ é¤ã â¢ ç¶æÂ¨å¨渠é¤å¾ÂéÂÂæÂ°é£æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 43 é Âç é Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ä¾ÂéÂÂè¤Âé Âå°ÂæÂ¥é©Âã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 44 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
KURO LINK 12 45 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 12 ç« KURO LINK ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180/181 DVD æ©Âå 使ç¨ HDM I é£æÂ¥ç·Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé£æÂ¥è³ KURO LINK ç¸容å ÂéÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Âå¾Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以使ç¨æÂÂé£æÂ¥å¹³é¢ é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂ§å¶æÂ¬æ©Âï¼Â並ä¸Âè®ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥çÂÂå¹³é¢ é»è¦ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ輸堥ï¼Â以åÂÂæÂ æÂ¬æ©Âå·è¡ÂçÂÂæÂÂä½Âã æÂ¤å¤Âï¼Âå¾Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Â輸堥èªÂè¨Âè³Âè¨ÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¬ æ©ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ形使ç¨è ä»Âé¢顯示誠è¨ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ ï¼Âå å¨ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ形使ç¨è ä»Âé¢çÂÂç«é¢æÂªé¡¯ç¤ºï¼Âåª è½使ç¨ DVD/CD å è½æÂÂï¼ ã å¦ÂéÂÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂé HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âå¯å·è¡ÂåªäºÂæÂ ä½Âç 詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±平é¢é»覠çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ æÂ¨ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂé Âä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ KURO LINK çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¾Â使 ç¨æÂ¤åÂÂè½ã â¢ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âä¿ÂèÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âè½æÂÂé Âå ÂéÂÂ以å¤ÂæÂÂ製é ç KURO LINK ç¸容è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂ使ç¨ã é£æÂÂ¥ KURO LINK æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂæÂ¥æÂÂä½ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥çÂÂå¹³ é¢é»è¦Âã 確å®Âå°Âå¹³é¢é»è¦ÂçÂÂé³頻ç·Âé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂé³頻輸 å ¥æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 3 ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂä¸Â使ç¨é«Âé HDMI é£æÂ¥ç· ï¼ KURO LINK å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸éÂÂä½Âã â¢ å°Âå¹³é¢é»è¦Âç´æÂ¥é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ© ã ä¸ÂæÂ·èÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂ´ 大卿ÂÂå½±é³è½ÂæÂÂå¨ ï¼Âä¾Â妠HDMI éÂÂéÂÂï¼Âç ç´æÂ¥é£æÂ¥æÂÂå°Âè´æÂÂä½Âç¼çÂÂé¯誤ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠å¨é£æÂ¥æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂè®ÂæÂ´æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂï¼ è«Â確實 å°Â黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂ並å¾ÂçÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座 æÂÂä¸Â黿ºÂç·Âã å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âå¾ ï¼Âè«Âå°Â黿ºÂç·Âé£æÂ¥è³çÂÂ壠æÂÂ座ä¸Âã KURO LINK è¨Âå® çºäºÂ堠份éÂÂç¨ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¿ é Â調æÂ´ æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå KURO LINK ç¸容çÂÂé£æÂ¥è¨Âå ã 妠éÂÂ詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鱿¯Âå è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã è¨Âå® KURO LINK 模张é¸åÂÂæÂ¯å¦å°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½è¨Âå®Âçº ON æÂ OFF ã æÂ¨å¿ é Âå°Âå®Âè¨Âå®Âçº LINK ON æÂÂè½使ç¨ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½ã â¢ 使ç¨ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½çÂÂé»è¦ÂæÂ ï¼ è« å°ÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®Âçº LINK OFF ã MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES HDMI à ´Âà ¯¦á¤ HDMI à ´Âà ¯¦á¤ HDMI á°ä HDMI á°àHDMI á°ä HDMI á°àÃÂÃÂáÂÂÃÂᣠÃÂáÂÂà ¥²áÂ¾à ¶³á£ ÃÂá¡ KURO LINK à £»à §¡Ã ÃÂá£ÃÂà ¥®áÂ¬à º HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 45 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
KURO LINK 12 46 Zhtw 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å HDMI SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å KURO LINK ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸åÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 確èªÂã â¢ LINK ON ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½ã â¢ LINK OFF ï¼Âå·²åÂÂç¨ KURO LINK ã ç¡æ³Â使ç¨ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂÂä½Âã 使ç¨åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂä¹Âå ä¸Âå®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥èÂÂè¨Âå® å¾Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¿ é Âï¼ 1 è®ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂé²堥徠æ©Â模张ã 2 éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé»溠@æÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹³é¢é»覠çÂÂ黿ºÂã 3 é¸æÂ DVD/CD ï¼Â並æÂ¥çÂÂç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂè¦Âè¨Â輸åº 顯示æÂ¯å¦æÂ£å¸¸ã åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ ä½¿ç¨ KURO LINK ç¸容é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯以è¨Âå® åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂãÂÂæÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂçÂÂå¾Âé»è¦Âç é¸å®ç«é¢ä¸Âå¯以è¨Âå®Âé äºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ã å¾Âé»è¦ÂçÂÂé¸å®ç«é¢ä¸Âå¯以è¨Âå®ÂéÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ãÂÂå¦Âé 詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± KURO LINK ç¸容é»è¦ÂçÂÂæÂ ä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂÂ你使ç¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK ç¸容è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¦Âä¸ÂæÂÂè¿°åÂÂæÂÂ¥ éÂÂä½Âã â¢ 使ç¨é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯以è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé³éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå° è²é³éÂÂé³ã â¢ é»è¦ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂè¨Âå®Âçº徠橠æÂ ï¼ æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂä¹ÂæÂ è¨Âå®Âçº徠橠ã ï¼ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾è¦Âé » DVD æÂÂï¼ éÂÂéÂÂé»è¦ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂä¹ÂæÂÂèª Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂé»溠ã ä½ÂæÂÂäºÂæÂ æ³Â丠@æÂ¬æ©Â黿ºÂç¡æ³ÂèªåÂÂéÂÂé @侠妠@ç¶æÂ¨æÂ£å¨èÂÂè½ CD æÂÂ廣æÂÂ並éÂÂéÂÂ輸åº裠置æÂÂãÂÂ@⢠æÂ¬æ©Â輸堥å¨åÂÂæÂÂé»è¦Âé » éÂÂæÂÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂã â¢ å³使æÂ¬æ©Â輸堥åÂÂæÂÂè³ DVD/CD 以å¤ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ ï¼ åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼Âä»Âç¶æÂÂæÂ ã å¨å Âé KURO LINK ç¸容平é¢é»è¦Âä¸Âä¹Âå¯以使 ç¨以ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂä½Âã â¢ 調æÂ´æÂ¬æ©Âé³éÂÂæÂÂè²é³é é³æÂ ï¼ é³éÂÂçÂÂæ ÂæÂÂ顯 示å¨平é¢é»è¦ÂçÂÂç«é¢丠ã â¢ å¨平é¢é»è¦Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ OSD èªÂè¨ÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂ誠è¨Âè¨Âå®Âä¹ÂæÂÂé¨èÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂã åÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ â¢ Ã¥ÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£å¨è§ÂçÂÂé»覠ä¸ÂçÂÂé»è¦Âç¯Âç®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¬æ© é»æºÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂã â¢ å¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ æÂ¬æ©Â黿ºÂèÂ¥éÂÂé @åÂÂæÂÂ¥ æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ ã èÂ¥è¦ÂéÂÂæÂ°éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡ å¼ ï¼Âè«Â使ç¨é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾ 大模 å¼Âã â¢ å¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂå¾Âé»è¦Âé¸å®ç«é¢å· è¡Âå¾Âé»è¦Âç¢çÂÂè²é³çÂÂæÂ ä½ ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾ 大模å¼Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 46 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 47 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 13 ç« å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Â堧容格å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¸容æÂ§ æÂ¬æ©Âé©åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂ種é¡Âå ï¼ÂåªÂé«Âï¼ åÂÂæ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂç¢Âç ã å¯æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âèάç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå è£Âä¸ÂæÂ æÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂå ¶ä¸Âä¸Â種æ¨ÂèªÂãÂÂç¶èÂÂè«Â注æÂÂæÂÂäºÂé¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç ç¢Âç ï¼Âå æÂ¯å¯çÂÂéÂÂå¼ CD å DVD ï¼ å¯è½ä»Â屬æÂ¼ ä¸Â坿ÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂæ ¼å¼Âã æÂ´å¤Âè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Â坿ÂÂæÂ¾ DVD R/ RW ç¢ÂçÂÂã â¢ æÂ¯ FUJIFILM Corporation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã â¢ æÂ¯ DVD Format/Logo Licensing Corpor ation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Â亦è KODAK Picture CD ç¸容ã æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¯æÂ¯æÂ´è½ç¢çÂÂåªç° ç«質 ã éÂÂè²éÂÂç IEC çÂÂè¶ ç´ VCD æ¨ÂæºÂï¼Â並å¯æÂ¯æÂ´å¯¬å±Âå¹Âç« é¢ã éÂÂæÂ¼ DualDisc çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DualDisc æÂ¯ä¸Â種堨æÂ° ã éÂÂé¢çÂÂç¢Âç @ä¸Âé¢å¯容 ç´ DVD æ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂå½±å ã è²é³ç @å¦ä¸Âé¢åÂÂå¯容素é DVD æ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂ堧容ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³頻 åªÂé«Â堧容ã èÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®ç¢ÂçÂÂ容ç´Âé DVD é³頻çÂÂä¸Âé¢å ä¸Â符 CD-Audio çÂÂè¦Â格@æÂ å¯è½æÂÂç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã DualDisc ç DVD é¢å¯å¨æÂÂ¢åÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã DVD-Audio 堧容ä¸Âè½ æÂÂæÂ¾ã æÂÂé DualDi sc è¦Âæ ¼çÂÂæÂ´å¤Â詳ç¡è³Â訠@è«Â洽詢碠çÂÂ製é åÂÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂé¶å®åÂÂã ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 DVD- Video DVD-R DVD-RW VCD F ujicolor CD à ¥²á CD CD-R CD-RW Super Video CD ( à º»à ª¼ VCD) åªÂé« ç¸ 容格张CD-R/-RW ⢠CD-Audi o ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã ISO 9660 CD-ROM* ï¼Âå å« MP3 ã WMA ã MPEG- 4 AAC ã JPEG æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /W MV æªÂæ¡Âã * 符å ISO 9660 Level 1 æÂ 2 ä¹Â樠æºÂã CD 實é«Âæ ¼å¼Âï¼ Mode1 ã Mode2 XA Form1 ãÂÂè Romeo å Joliet 堩種æªÂæ¡Â系統ç¸容ã â¢ å¤ÂÃ¥ÂÂ段æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ â¢ æÂªæÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ DVD-R/-RW ⢠DVD-Vide o ï¼Âè¦Â頻模å¼Âï¼ ãÂÂ覠頻 é 製@VR ï¼ * ã UDF Brid ge DVD-ROM ï¼ å å« MP3 ã WMA ã MPEG-4 AAC ã JPEG æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV æªÂæ¡Âã * 編輯é»Âå¯è½ç¡æ³Âå®Âå ¨æÂÂç §ç·¨ 輯ç æÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ æÂÂæÂ¾å°編輯é»ÂæÂÂç«é¢ å¯è½ æÂÂæÂÂçÂÂæÂ«ç©ºç½çÂÂæÂ å½¢ ã â¢ å¤ÂéÂÂéÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ â¢ æÂªæÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ PC 製ä½Âç¢Âç â¢ 使ç¨ PC éÂÂ製çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¯è½æÂÂå çºç¨ 以製ä½Âç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂè»Âé«ÂæÂ¬ 身çÂÂè¨Âç½®èÂÂç¡ æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂæÂ¤æÂÂï¼Âè«Â檢 æÂÂ¥ DVD-R/ -RW æÂ CD-R/- RW è»Âé«ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ ç¢Âç å è£Âä¸ÂæÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ç¸容 æÂ§çÂÂ說æÂÂã â¢ 以å°Âå ç éÂÂæÂ¹å¼ÂéÂÂ製çÂÂç¢Âç ä¸Âç¸ 容ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 47 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 48 Zhtw éÂÂæÂ¼ DVD R/DVD RW ç¸容æÂ§ å å¯æÂÂæÂ¾ä»¥ ãÂÂè¦Â頻模张@DVD-Video 模å¼Âï¼ ã éÂÂ製並已å®ÂæÂÂå°ÂçÂÂç DVD R/DVD RW ãÂÂç¶ èÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂäºÂå¨éÂÂå½±æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂå®ÂæÂÂçÂÂ編輯堧容å¯è½æÂ ç¡æ³Â精確å°æÂÂæÂ¾ã éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX DivX æÂ¯ DivX, Inc. ç¼æÂÂçÂÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³è¨Â格张ã æÂ¾Â æÂ¾å¨å¯以æÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂ製å¨ DVD ã CD æÂ USB å²åÂÂ裠置ä¸Âç DivX è¦Âè¨Âã ä¿ÂæÂÂè DVD-Video ç¸åÂÂçÂÂè¡ÂèªÂï¼Âç¨ç¹ ç DivX è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂ稱你ãÂÂæ¨Âé¡Âã ã DivX è¦Âé »ç¸容æÂ§ ⢠æÂÂæÂ¾ DivX î è¦Â訠1 â¢ å¯æªÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ .avi å .divx ï¼Âå¿ é Â使ç¨éÂÂäºÂå¯檠åÂÂï¼Â以å©æÂ¬æ©Â辨è DivX è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡ ï¼ ã è«Â注 æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¡ç¨ .avi 坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ辨è æÂ MPEG4 ï¼ ä½ÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡Â並éÂÂä¸Âå® æÂ¯ DivX è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡Âï¼Â亦å æÂ¤ä¸Âè¦Âå¾ è½å¨æÂ¬æ©Â丠æÂÂæÂ¾ã 顯示 DivX Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂ桠以ä¸ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçº DivX å¤Âé¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂé©ç¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå 絠ã æÂ¨å¯以èÂÂç±è¨Âå®Âè½符åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ ç S ubtitle Language ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼ ï¼Âå¨第 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Â訠å®Âå¼ ï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¼è¢å¹Âä¸Âè¦Âå°æÂ£ç¢ºçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂã 2 å°Âçµ 1 ï¼ Albanian ( é¿ç¾巴 å°¼äºÂ誠) (sq) ï¼ Basque ( å·´æÂ¯å Â誠) (eu) ï¼ Catalan ( Ã¥ÂÂæ³°ç¾ å°¼äºÂ誠) (ca) ï¼ Danish ( 丹麥誠) (da) ï¼ Dutch ( è·èÂÂ誠) (nl) ï¼ English ( è±誠) (en)ï¼ Faroese ( æ³Â羠誠) (fo)ï¼ Finnish ( èÂÂ誠) (fi) ï¼ French ( æ³Â誠) (fr ) ï¼ German ( 德誠) (de) ï¼ Icelandic ( å°島誠) (is)ï¼ Irish ( æÂÂç¾èÂÂ誠) (ga)ï¼ Itali an ( 義大å©誠) (it) ï¼ Norwegian ( æÂªå¨Â誠) (no) ï¼ Portuguese ( è¡èÂÂçÂÂ誠) (pt) ï¼ R haeto-Romanic ( éÂÂæÂÂç¾ æÂ¼æÂ¯èª ) (rm) ï¼ Scottish ( èÂÂæ ¼èÂÂ誠) (gd) ï¼ Spanish ( 西çÂÂçÂÂ誠) (es) ï¼ Swedish ( çÂÂ堸誠) (sv) é³頻å£Â縮 ⢠MPEG-1 Audi o Layer 3 (MP3) ã W indows Media A udio (WMA) ã MPEG-4 AAC ⢠åÂÂ樣頻çÂÂï¼ 32 kHz/44.1 kHz/ 48 kHz ⢠ä½Âå Âç @任ä½Âå³輸ç @建è°æÂ¡ç¨ 128 kbps 以ä¸Â@⢠VBR ï¼Âå¯è®Âä½ å ÂçÂÂï¼ MP3/WMA/ MPEG-4 AAC æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ â¢ WMA ç¡失çÂÂ編碼@å¦ â¢ DRM ï¼ æÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管ç @ç¸容æÂ§ ï¼ ç¸容 ï¼Âå DRM ä¿Âè·ä¹Â鳿¨ÂæªÂæ¡Âå° ç¡ æ³ å¨æÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂï¼ â¢ å¯æªÂå @.mp3 ã .wma ã .m4a ï¼Âé 使ç¨éÂÂäºÂ坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂ以å©æÂ æÂ¾å¨辨è MP3/WMA/MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡Â@⢠æªÂæ¡ÂçµÂæ§ ï¼Âå¯è½æÂÂæÂ ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ï¼ ä¸Âå¼µ ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå¤Âå¯å²å 299 Ã¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾@æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ä¸ÂæÂÂå¤Âå¯å æÂ¾ 648 è³ÂæÂ å¤¾åÂÂæªÂæ¡ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂä½µå¾Âï¼ JPEG æªÂ桠⢠Baseline JPEG å EXIF 2.2* éÂÂæ Âå½± Ã¥ÂÂæªÂæ¡Âå¯é 3072 x 2048 è§£æÂÂ度ç« ç´ * çºæÂ¸ä½Âç¸æ©Âå°Âç¨ä¹ÂæªÂ桠格张⢠éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ JPEG ç¸容æÂ§ï¼ å¦ â¢ å¯æªÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ .jpg ï¼Âå¿ é Â使ç¨éÂÂ亠å¯ æªÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Â以å©æÂ¬æ©Â辨è JPEG æªÂæ¡Â@⢠æªÂæ¡ÂçµÂæ§ ï¼Âå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ@@丠張ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå¤Âå¯å²å 299 Ã¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂ å¤¾ï¼Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ä¸ÂæÂÂ夠å¯åÂÂæÂ¾ 648 è³ÂæÂÂ夾åÂÂæªÂæ¡ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂä½µå¾Âï¼ åªÂé« ç¸容格张éÂÂ註 1 ç¡ æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å®¹éÂÂ大æÂ¼ 4 GB ç .avi è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡Âã 2 ⢠å¨å¤Âé¨ Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡Âé¨åÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¬æ©Âå¯æÂ¯æÂ´ 以ä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Âæ ¼å¼ÂæªÂæ¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂ稱 ï¼Âè«Â注æÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡Â丠æÂÂå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸å®ä¸Â顯示@@.srt ã .sub ã .ssa ã .smi ⢠æÂÂäºÂå¤Âé¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡Âå¯è½ç¡泠æÂ£ç¢ºé¡¯ç¤ºæÂÂå®Âå ¨ç¡æ³Â顯示ã â¢ å½±çÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂçÂÂæªÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿ é ÂéÂÂè¤Âåº ç¾å¨å¤Âé¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ÂæªÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé é ÂèÂÂã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂä¸Âå½±çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âè½夠åÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ夠é¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¸éÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂå¤ÂéÂÂå® çº 10 ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 48 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 49 Zhtw English Español English Español å°Âçµ 2 ï¼ Albanian ( é¿ç¾巴尼äºÂ誠) ( sq) ï¼ Croatian ( å Âç¾ åÂÂ西äºÂ誠) (hr) ï¼ Czech ( æÂ·å Â誠) (cs) ï¼ Hungarian ( Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂå©誠) (hu) ï¼ Polish ( æ³¢èÂÂ誠) (pl) ï¼ Romanian ( 羠馬尼äºÂ誠) (ro ) ï¼ Slovak ( æÂ¯æ´Âä¼Âå Â誠) (sk) ï¼ Slovenian ( æÂ¯æ´Âç¶Âå°¼äºÂ誠) ( sl) å°Âçµ 3 ï¼ Bulgarian ( ä¿Âå å©äºÂ誠) (bg) ï¼ Byelorussian ( ç½ä¿Âç¾ æÂ¯èª ) (b e) ï¼ Macedonian ( 馬堶頠誠) (mk) ï¼ Russian ( ä¿Â誠) (ru) ï¼ Se rbian ( å¡Âç¾ç¶ÂäºÂ誠) (sr) ï¼ Ukrainian ( çÂÂå ÂèÂÂ誠) (uk) å°Âçµ 4 ï¼ Hebrew ( å¸Â伯ä¾Â誠) (i w) ï¼ Yiddi sh ( æÂÂ第ç·Â誠) ( ji) å°Âçµ 5 ï¼ Turkish ( Ã¥ÂÂè³堶誠) ( tr) DivX î æÂ¯ DivX, In c. çÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樠@並ç²æÂÂæ¬Â使ç¨ ã éÂÂæÂ¼ WMV WMV æÂ¯ Windows Media Video çÂÂ縮寫ï¼Â丠çº Microsoft Corporation æÂÂç Âç¼åºä¾ÂçÂÂè¦Âé » å£Â縮æÂÂè¡ÂãÂÂå¯使ç¨ Window s Media Encoder å° WMV 堧容å 以編碼ã â¢ æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¯æÂÂæÂ¾ä½¿ç¨ Windows Media Encoder 9 Series 編碼ãÂÂ使ç¨ .wmv å¯檠åÂÂç WMV9 æªÂæ¡Âã â¢ å¯使ç¨ 720 x 576 ç«素/720 x 480 ç«素以丠çÂÂ大å°Âã â¢ ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ Advanced Profile ã â¢ å DRM ä¿Âè·ä¹Âè¦Âé »æªÂæ¡Âå°Âç¡æ³Âå¨æÂ¬æ© ä¸ÂæÂ æÂ¾ã â¢ æªÂæ¡Â坿ªÂå .wmv ã â¢ å¯使ç¨ 192 kbps 以ä¸ÂçÂÂä½Âå ÂçÂÂã éÂÂæÂ¼ MPEG-4 AAC AAC (Advanced Audio Coding) æÂ¯ MPEG-4 AAC æ¨ÂæºÂçÂÂæ ¸å¿ÂæÂÂ衠@主è¦ÂçµÂå MPEG-2 AAC ï¼ æÂ¯æ§ÂæÂ MPEG-4 é³頻å£Â縮æÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂåº礠ã æÂÂ使ç¨çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âæ ¼å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ坿ªÂå éÂÂè¦Âç¨以é²衠AAC æªÂæ¡Â編碼çÂÂæÂÂç¨ç¨Âå¼ÂèÂÂå® ã æÂ¬æ©Â坿ÂÂæÂ¾ç± iTunes î æÂÂ編碼ï¼Â坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂçº ã .m4a ãÂÂç AAC æªÂæ¡ ã DRM æÂÂä¿Âè·çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âä¸Âè½æÂÂæÂ¾ @以åÂÂç±æÂ äº iTunes î çÂÂæÂ¾ÂÂ編碼çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âä¹Âå¯ è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ æÂÂæªÂÃ¥ÂÂå¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢ºé¡¯ç¤ºã Apple å iTunes Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¯ Apple Inc. æÂ¼ç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå ¶ ä»ÂÃ¥ÂÂ家註åÂÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã éÂÂæÂ¼ WMA æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¯æÂÂæÂ¾ Windo ws Media Audio çÂÂå § 容ã WMA æÂ¯ Windows Media Audi o ç 縮 寫ï¼Â丠çº Microsoft Corporation æÂÂç Âç¼åºä¾ÂçÂÂé³頻 å£Â縮æÂÂè¡Âã WMA 堧容坿ÂÂç¨ Windows Media Player versi on 7.7.1 ï¼ Windows Media Player ç¨亠Wind ows XP ï¼ÂæÂ Windows Media Pla yer 9 Series çÂÂè»Âé«Âé²衠編碼ã Windows Media æÂ¯ Microsoft Cor poration ç åÂÂæ¨Âã æÂÂ¢åÂÂæÂ¡ç¨ Microsoft Corporation éÂÂç¼ä¹ÂæÂ è¡Âï¼ÂæÂªç² Micr osoft Licens ing, Inc. æÂÂæ¬Âä¸Â徠使ç¨æÂÂæÂ£å¸ÂæÂ¾ÂÂè¡Âã ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ使ç¨åÂÂç¶Âè· æÂÂæÂ¿ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ æÂ¿åÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ è«ÂæÂ¡ä½Âå ¶éÂÂ緣以å Âå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂä»»ä½Â丠é¢çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂç´ÂãÂÂç°塵æÂÂå®ç ãÂÂå·²ç¶ÂæÂÂå£ÂæÂÂé«Â污ç ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂå½±é¿æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂæÂÂè½ã å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂç´ÂãÂÂç°塵çÂÂä¸Âæ½Âç© ï¼Âè«Â使ç¨ æÂÂè»ÂãÂÂä¹¾çÂ¥çÂÂå¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¦æÂÂä¹¾ æ·¨ã è«Âç´åÂÂè¼Âè¼Âç±ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Â央åÂÂå¤ÂæÂ¦æÂÂãÂÂè«Âå¿以ç«å çÂÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂ¦æÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ表é¢ã å¦ÂæÂÂå¿ è¦Âï¼Âè«Âç¨æÂÂå¸Âæ²¾ä¸Âé Âç²¾ï¼ÂæÂÂå¸Â颿ÂÂ購買 ç CD/DVD 渠æ½Â工堷ä¾ÂæÂ´å¾¹åºÂ渠æ½Â碠ç ã çµÂ丠使ç¨æÂ®ç¼åÂÂãÂÂç¨ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Âè¨Âè¨Âç¨ä¾Â渠æ½Âé»Âè å±çÂÂçÂÂ渠æ½ÂÃ¥ÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 49 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 50 Zhtw å²æÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ é¿å Âå°Âç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂå¨太å· ãÂÂ太æ¿ÂæÂ å¤ªç± ï¼Âå æÂŒÂÂå° é½å Âç´å°Âï¼ÂçÂÂç°å¢Âä¸Âã ä¸Âè¦Âå°Âç´ å¼µæÂÂè²¼ç´Âé»Âå¨ ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âï¼ÂæÂÂç¨éÂÂçÂÂã é¼ç çÂÂæÂÂå ¶ ä»Âå°Âé³çÂÂæÂ¸å¯« ç¨堷å¨ä¸Âé¢æÂ¸å¯«ãÂÂéÂÂ樣 æÂÂæÂÂå£Âç¢ÂçÂÂã ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂé¿å ÂäºÂé  ç¢ÂçÂÂä¿Â以é«ÂéÂÂå¨æÂ¬æ©Âå §æÂÂè½ÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂç¼çÂÂç è£Âã ç¢Âè£Âã æÂÂæÂ²æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂå£ÂæÂ å½¢ ï¼Âè«Âå¿åÂÂéª置 æÂ¼æÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ â æÂÂçµÂæÂ¨å¯è½æÂ ä½¿æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂå£Âã æÂ¬æ©Âå¨è¨Âè¨Âä¸Âçºå å¯ 使ç¨å³統ã 堨åÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂã å ÂéÂÂè²æÂÂï¼Âå°ÂæÂ¼å 使ç¨è®Âå½¢çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂå¼Âèµ·çÂÂæÂ æÂÂ責任ï¼Âæ¦Âä¸Â負責ã DVD Video é©ç¨å°å æÂÂæÂÂç DVD Video ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå°ä¸Âå°åÂÂæ¨Â示 @以æÂÂåº該ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ¼å ¨çÂÂé© ç¨çÂÂå°å ã æÂ¨ç DVD ç³» 統亦æÂÂä¸Âå°åÂÂæ¨Â示 ï¼Âå°±å¨èÂÂé¢æÂ¿ ä¸Âï¼ ãÂÂä¾Âèª丠ç¸容å°åÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âç¡æ³Âå¨æÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã æ¨Â示 ALL çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¯å¨任ä½ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ ä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ç¶æÂ¨æÂÂå ¥ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå° æÂÂåºç¾以ä¸Âè¨ÂæÂ¯ï¼ Incompatib le disc regio n number ï¼ÂéÂÂ堼容ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ碼@Can't play disc ï¼Âç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ å®Âè£ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¿Â餠å®Âè£ÂæÂÂ示 æÂ¬å ¬å¸å¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂªä¾Â幾年堧é½è½ç¡æÂ çÂÂ享ç¨æÂ¬ç³» çµ±ï¼Âå æÂ¤å¨é¸åÂÂå®Âè£Âé¨ä½ÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¬è«Âç¢è¨Â以ä¸Âå é»Âï¼ åÂÂå¿ ... ï± å¨éÂÂ風è¯好çÂÂ室堧使ç¨ã ï± ç½®æÂ¼å¹³å¦ãÂÂæ°´å¹³çÂÂ表é¢ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¸æ¡ÂãÂÂæÂ±æÂ¶æÂÂé³é¿æÂ¶ 丠ã åÂÂå¿ ... ï³ å¨é«Â溫æÂÂ極æ¿ÂçÂÂå°é»Â使ç¨ï¼Âå æÂ¾ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂç¢ çÂÂé«Âç±çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂè¿Âã ï³ ç½®æÂ¼çªÂ檯æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂ使系統åÂÂå°é½å Âç´å°ÂçÂÂå°é»Âã ï³ å¨å¤Âç°æÂÂ極æ¿ÂçÂÂç°å¢Âä¸Â使ç¨ã ï³ ç´æÂ¥æÂºå¨æÂ´å¤§å¨æÂÂé³é¿ 系統裡使ç¨æÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ漸 è® ç±çÂÂå ¶ä»Âå Âä»¶ä¸Âã ï³ å¨é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂ顯示å¨éÂÂè¿Â使ç¨ï¼Âå çºæÂÂå¯è½æÂÂç¢ç 干æÂ¾ ï¼ ç¹åÂ¥æÂ¯å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂ使ç¨室堧天ç·ÂæÂÂã ï³ å¨å»ÂæÂ¿æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂ使系統 æÂ´é²å¨æ¿Âç ÂæÂÂè¸氣习丠çÂÂå°é»Âã ï³ å¨åÂÂæ¯Â毯æÂÂå°毯ä¸Â使ç¨ï¼ÂæÂÂè¦ÂèÂÂå¸ÂæÂ ï¼ éÂÂ樣å¯ è½æÂÂ妨ç¤Â系統主æ©ÂçÂÂæÂ£ç¢ºæÂ£ç±æÂÂæÂÂã ï³ ç½®æÂ¼ä¸Â平穩çÂÂ表é¢ï¼ÂæÂÂé¢ç©Âä¸Â足以æÂ¯æÂÂ系統主橠åÂÂè ³çÂÂ表é¢ä¸Âã 渠æ½Âè®Â寫é ÂæÂ DVD æÂÂæÂ¾ å¨çÂÂè®Â寫é Âä¸Âè¬使ç¨æÂ¯ä¸ÂæÂÂå¼Âé«ÂçÂÂï¼ ä½Âå¦Âå æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂå ç©Âç°æÂÂé«Â污æÂÂï¼Âè«Â洽詢æÂ¨æÂÂå¨ å°çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ÂãÂÂéÂÂç¶è®ÂÃ¥ÂÂé Â渠æ½ÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠è¬å¸Âé¢ä¸Âé½å¯買å¾Âå°ï¼Âä½ÂæÂ¬å ¬å¸ä¸Â建è°使ç¨以 å Âå¯è½é æÂÂè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂé ÂæÂÂå£Âã 水氣åÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ å¦ÂæÂÂå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç±溫æÂÂçÂÂ室堧æÂŒÂ°å®¤å¤Âï¼ÂæÂÂ室堧溫 度é½ç¶ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå §é¨便å¯è½æÂÂæÂÂæ°´æ°£åÂÂçµÂãÂÂé ç¶åÂÂçµÂçÂÂæ°´æ°£ä¸ÂæÂÂå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé æÂÂæÂÂå£Âï¼Âä½Âå¯è½æÂ ä½¿æÂÂè½çÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå §åÂÂå°影é¿ãÂÂè«Âè®Âå ¶æÂÂ大ç´Âä¸Âå° æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂ¢å¾©è³è¼ÂæÂÂç±çÂÂ溫 度ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¡ÂéÂÂæ©Âã æÂŒÂÂ系統主橠å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂå¿ è¦Âç§»åÂÂå°主橠@ä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨堧æÂ ç¢Âç @è«Âå Âå°Âå ¶åÂÂåºï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂä¸Âå é¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç ïµ STANDBY/ON å°Â系統éÂÂæ©ÂãÂÂçÂÂå°è¢å¹Â丠ç -OFF- Ã¥ÂÂ樣æ¶Â失徠ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå°Â黿ºÂæÂÂé ÂæÂÂ丠ã 1 çµÂ丠å¯å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂå°Â主æ©ÂèÂÂèµ·æÂÂæÂŒÂ â å¯è½æÂÂ使 é«ÂéÂÂæÂÂè½Âä¸ÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂå£Âã éÂÂ註 1 å¦Âå¨ -OFF- Ã¥ÂÂ樣èªè¢å¹Âä¸Â涠失åÂÂ便å°Â主æ©ÂæÂÂé ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯ è½æÂÂ使系統æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» çÂÂè¨Âç½®ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 50 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 51 Zhtw English Español English Español ç«é¢大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ格张DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂè½æÂ¶éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ種çÂÂç«é¢ æ¯Âä¾ ï¼ ç¯Âä¾ å¾Âä¸Â荺 4:3 çÂÂé»è¦Âç¯Âç®å°ç«é¢æ¯Âä¾Âé«Âé 7:3 ç CinemaScope 寬è¢å¹Âé» å½± 1 é½å¯以ã é»è¦Âæ©Âä¹ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ種ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç«é¢æ¯Âä¾ ï¼ ã æ¨ÂæºÂã ç 4:3 以åÂÂ寬å±Âå¹ 16:9 ã 2 寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Â使ç¨è å¦ÂæÂÂ使ç¨寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¬ æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ç TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂè¨Âçº 16:9 (Wide) æÂ 16:9 (C ompressed) ï¼Â第 35 é Âï¼ ã ç¶æÂ¨ä½¿ç¨ 16:9 (Wide) è¨Âå®Âè§Âè³Â以 4:3 æ ¼å¼ÂæÂ éÂÂ製çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以使ç¨é»è¦ÂæÂ§å¶åÂÂè½ä¾Âé¸å 影åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾çÂÂæÂ¹å¼ÂãÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âå¯è½æÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮 æÂ¾åÂÂ伸å±ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ï¼Âç´°ç¯Âé¨åÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±æÂ¨é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂé çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã è«Â注æÂÂï¼Âé¨åÂÂé»影çÂÂç«é¢毠ä¾Â大æÂ¼ 16:9 ï¼Âå æÂ¤å³便使ç¨寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Âè§Âè³ ï¼Âä»ÂæÂÂ以 ã Letter Box ãÂÂ樣å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾è©²ç¨®ç¢Âç ï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸Â丠堩å´åºç¾ é»Âè²æ¢ÂéÂÂï¼ ã æ¨ÂæºÂé»è¦Â使ç¨è å¦ÂæÂÂ使ç¨æ¨ÂæºÂé»è¦Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¾Â æÂ¾å¨ç TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ è¨Âå®Âå¯ä¾ÂæÂ¨çÂÂå 好è¨Âçº 4:3 (Letter B ox) æÂ 4:3 (Pan & Scan) ï¼Â第 35 é Âï¼ ã è«Â注æÂ ï¼ å¤ æÂ¸å¯¬è¢å¹Âç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂç¡è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨çÂÂè¨Âå® ï¼ å æÂ¤ç¡è«Âè¨Âå®Âçº你@ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂ以 ã Letter Box ã 格å¼Â顯示ã é»è¦Â系統è¨Âç½® æÂ¬ç³»çµ±çÂÂé Âè¨Âå¼çº AUTO ï¼Âé¤éÂÂæÂ¨å¨æÂÂæÂ¾ é¨å ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂ注æÂÂå°影åÂÂæÂÂ失çÂÂç¾象 ï¼Âå¦åÂÂè«Âå°Â堶訠置çº AUTO ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç¼ç¾å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂç« é¢åºç¾失çÂÂçÂÂæÂ å½¢ï¼ è«Âå°Âé»è¦Â系統è¨Âç½®æÂÂ符å æÂ¨æÂÂå¨åÂÂå®¶æÂÂå°åÂÂçÂÂ系統ãÂÂ丠éÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂ樣ä¸Âä¾Âå¯ è½æÂÂéÂÂå¶æÂ¨å¯以è§ÂçÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ種é¡ÂãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå å°Â砧表ï¼Â以äºÂè§£åÂÂ種ç¢Âç æÂÂé©ç¨çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼ AUTO ã PAL å NTSC ï¼Âã 3 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SYS SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å TV S YS ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã é»è¦Âæ©Â系統æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¦Âä¸Â@⢠AUTO ï¤ NTSC ⢠NTSC ï¤ PA L ⢠PAL ï¤ AUTO éÂÂ註 1 許å¤Â寬è¢å¹Âç¢ÂçÂÂ齿ÂÂç¡è¦Âç³» çµ±çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼Âå æÂ¤ä¸Â管è¨Âå®Âå¼çº你ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂ齿ÂÂ以 ã Letterbox ãÂÂçÂÂæ ¼å¼Â顯示ã 2 å¦ÂæÂÂ卿¨Â溠4:3 çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Â丠æÂ¡ç¨ 16:9 (Wide) æÂ 16:9 (Compressed) çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼ÂæÂÂ寬è¢幠é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¡ç¨任ä½Âä¸Â種 4:3 è¨Âå®Âå¼@便æÂÂå°Âè´ç«é¢失çÂÂã è¨Âç½®æÂ 4:3 (Letter Box) æÂÂï¼Â寬è¢幠ç¢ÂçÂÂå¨顯示ç«é¢æÂÂï¼Âä¸Âä¸Âé½ æÂÂåºç¾黠è²æ¢ÂéÂÂã è¨Âç½®æÂ 4:3 (Pan & Scan) æÂÂï¼Â寬è¢幠ç¢ÂçÂÂå¨顯示ç«é¢æÂÂï¼Âå·¦å³é æÂÂæÂÂæÂªç çÂÂæÂ å½¢ãÂÂéÂÂç¶ç«é¢çÂÂèµ·ä¾Â大 äºÂï¼Âä½ÂæÂ¨ çÂÂå°çÂÂä¸ÂæÂ¯å¯¦éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´åÂÂç«é¢ ã 3 å¤ÂæÂ¸æÂ°åÂÂç PAL é» è¦Âæ©Â系統å¯åµ測 50 Hz (PAL )/60 Hz (NTSC) ï¼Â並å¯èªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç´ æÂ¯å¹ ï¼Â以æ¶Âé¤顯示ç«é¢ä¸Âç åÂÂç´æÂ¶ç¸®ç¾ 象ãÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂäºÂæÂ æ³ÂæÂ¯ å½±åÂÂ丠åÂÂç¾ä¸Âåºè²彩 ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç PAL TV æ²ÂæÂ V-Hold æÂ§å¶åÂÂè½ ï¼Â便æÂÂå çº NTSC ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âç« é¢æÂÂæÂÂèÂÂç¡ æ³Âè§ÂçÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ V-Hold æÂ§å¶åÂÂè½ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ調æÂ´ç´å°ç«é¢åÂÂæÂ¢æ»¾åÂÂçº æÂ¢ãÂÂé¨åÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âä¸Âï¼Âç«é¢æÂ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç´æÂ¶ç¸®çÂÂç¾象ï¼Âè´ 使è¢å¹Âä¸Âä¸Âå ©å´çÂÂæÂÂé» è²æ¢ÂéÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 51 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 52 Zhtw 4 CHANGE é çÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«ÂæÂ ENTER ã 系統å°ÂèªåÂÂé²堥徠æ©Â模å¼Âï¼Âç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂ°éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé» æºÂãÂÂçÂÂå° POWER ON å¾Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å°Âå¨顯示å¹Âä¸Âç å°æÂ°çÂÂé»è¦Â系統è¨Âå®Âã 1 é »çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âç½® ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼æ²ÂçÂÂå°é¿æÂÂ伯ãÂÂ以è²åÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä» ä¸ÂæÂ±åÂÂå®¶èÂÂå Â稠æ©Âå å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç¼ç¾æÂ¨ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調é¸å°éÂȌ°ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ表示頻 çÂÂéÂÂè·Âå¯è½ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¨æÂ å¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å AM 9K/10K ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸å AM 9K æÂ AM 10K ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERã 調æÂÂ顯示å¹Â亮度 æÂ¨å¯以調æÂ´åÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤º å¹ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ亮度ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SYS SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å DIMMERï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã éÂÂæÂÂ顯示å¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤º å¹Âä¸Âã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸å LIGHT æÂ DARK ï¼Âç¶ å¾ æÂ ä¸ ENTERã è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂéµé @Key Lockï¼ å°ÂæÂÂéµéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½æÂÂéÂÂï¼Âå³å¯åÂÂç¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé  æÂÂéµã 1 æÂ ä¸ SHIFT SETUPã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å SYS SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å KEYLOCK ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸å LOCK ON æÂ LOCK OFF ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂÂæÂ¾å¨è¨Âå®Âå¼ åªÂé«Âé¡Âå 系統 格张NTSC PAL AUTO DVD/ è¶ ç´ VCD/ VCD/DivX è¦Âé » / WMV NTSC NTSC PAL NTSC PAL NTSC PAL PAL CD/MP3/WMA/ MPEG-4 AAC/ JPEG/ ç¡ç¢Âç â NTSC PAL NTSC æÂ PAL éÂÂ註 1 é² è¡Âæ¯Âé  è¨Âå®Âå¼è®ÂæÂ´ä¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ å¿ é Âå Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¾ æ© ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 52 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 53 Zhtw English Español English Español æÂ éÂÂæÂÂé¤ 人åÂÂç¶Â常é¯å°Âä¸ÂæÂ£ç¢ºä¹ÂæÂÂä½ ç¶æÂÂ系統æÂ éÂÂæÂÂç°常ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨èª çºæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂä»»ä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ砧以丠åÂÂé» é²è¡Â檢æÂ¥ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ å¯è½æÂ¯ä¾Âèª堶ä»Âè£Âç½®ãÂÂè«Âä»Â細檢æÂ¥å ¶ ä»Â使ç¨ä¸ÂçÂÂè£Âç½®åÂÂéÂȌ¨è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂ å¨æÂÂ¥ èÂÂéÂÂ以ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé»Âå¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ÂéÂÂæÂ¯ç¡ æ³ÂæÂ¹å @è«Âå°±è¿Â洽詢æÂ¨çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ æÂÂç¶Âé·å @åÂÂä¾Â代çºç¶Âä¿® ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂ¯å çºåÂÂå°éÂÂéÂȍÂÂå¤Âä¾ÂæÂÂæÂÂè´使ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸ æÂÂä½Âï¼Âè«Âå°Â黿ºÂæÂÂé Âå¾Â輸åºæÂÂ座ä¸ÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå»ï¼Â以åÂÂ復æÂ£å¸¸çÂÂæÂÂä½ çÂÂæ Âã ä¸ÂèÂŒÂÂé¡ åÂÂ顠解決辦泠黿ºÂæ²ÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂçªÂç¶ é 橠ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂ丠é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯é¡¯ç¤ºï¼ ã â¢ éÂÂéÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«ÂçÂÂå¾ ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂã â¢ 確å®Â主æ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂç· æÂÂç¡é¬Âè«çÂÂæÂ å½¢ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂé¬Âè«ï¼Âå¯è½æÂÂé æÂ ç³»çµ±èªåÂÂéÂÂæ©Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂÂ¥ æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢ºã â¢ 確å®Â主黿ºÂçÂÂé» å£Â確實é©ç¨æÂ¼æÂŒÂÂæ©Â種ã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂ試éÂÂä½Âé³éÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âä»Âç¶å å¨ï¼Âè«Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂè³æÂÂè¿ÂçÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠å¿ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂèÂÂæÂ¥å ç¶Âä¿®ã é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¾Âï¼Âæ²ÂæÂÂè²é³ 輸 åºã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£ä½¿ç¨締路輸堥@è«Â確å®Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂé£æÂ¥æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âç é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³ é »è¨Âå ï¼Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂ HDMI é³è¨Â模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âçº TV ï¼Â第 41 é Âï¼ ï¼ åÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå¾Âé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ä¸Â輸 åº ä»»ä½Âè²é³ã â¢ æÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨ä¸Âç MUTE 以éÂÂéÂÂéÂÂé³åÂÂè½ã â¢ 調é«Âé³éÂÂã æ²ÂæÂÂè²é³ä¾Âèªç°ç¹Âè²æÂ ä¸ ç½®æÂÂè²å¨ã â¢ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 17 é Âç è¨Âç½®è²éÂÂé³é 以檢æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨ä½ÂæºÂã â¢ ç¶é¸å TUNER ã ADAPTER PORT æÂ LINE æÂ ï¼ æÂ¨åªè½以ç«Âé«Âè²è½åÂÂä¾Â溠ã å°Â輸堥侠æºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè³ DVD/CD æÂ USB ç¢ çÂÂå¤Âè²éÂÂ鳿ÂÂã â¢ 確å®ÂæÂ¨ä¸¦æÂªé¸å STEREO çÂÂ鳿ÂÂ模张ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 22 é Âç 以ç°ç¹Âè²èÂÂè½ ï¼Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥æÂ¯å¦æÂ¥ä¸Â麥 å Â風ã â¢ æÂ£ç¢ºé£æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 9 é Âç åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ ï¼Âã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂä½ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨ã â¢ æÂ´æÂ°é»池ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 15 é Âç å®Âè£ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é»池ï¼Âã â¢ è«Âå¨éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ ç 7 m ã 30 ð ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂå §æÂÂä½ ï¼Â第 16 é Âç éÂÂç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨ ï¼Âã â¢ ç§»é¤éÂÂç¤Âç©æÂÂå¾ å ¶ä»Âä½Âç½®æÂÂä½Âã â¢ é¿å ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨åÂÂå°é½å Âç´å°Âã 麥å Â風çÂÂè²é³è½ä¸Âå°ã â¢ æÂ¨åªè½使ç¨ä¸Âé»麥å Â風並é Âå°Âå ¶æÂÂå ¥ MIC (SUB) æÂÂå ã MIC (SUB) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂåª æÂÂå¨å¦夠æÂÂä¸Âé»麥å Â風æÂÂå ¥ MIC (MAIN) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ æ³Âä¸ÂæÂÂè½ 使ç¨ã â¢ 調æÂ´ MIC VOL / âÂÂã 麥å Â風æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¥Âé é³ã â¢ 麥å Â風æÂ£å°ÂèÂÂæÂ è²å¨ãÂÂç§»éÂÂ麥å Â風ä¸Âç´å°ÂèÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ã â¢ 麥å Â風é³éÂÂ調太 é«ÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âè½ÂÃ¥ÂÂ麥å Â風é³éÂÂæÂ§å¶éÂÂã 顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示 TRAYLOCK ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂç¡泠éÂÂåºç¢Âç¤ã â¢ æÂÂä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE æÂÂéµä¸ÂæÂ¾ç´Âå «ç§ÂéÂÂãÂÂæÂ¥è 便å¯使ç¨ ï¨ OPEN/C LOSE æÂ éµä¾ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂç¢Âç¤ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 53 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 54 Zhtw DVD/CD/VCD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ Ã¥ÂÂ顠解決辦泠ç¢ÂçÂÂå¨置堥å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂèªåÂÂé åºã â¢ 渠æ½Âç¢ÂçÂÂ並å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ£ 確å°ÂæºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âæ§½ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂ DVD-video ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂå°åÂÂ代碼èÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂ代 碼ä¸Âç¸符 @該ç¢ÂçÂÂ便ä¸Âè½使ç¨ ï¼Âè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 50 é Âç DVD Video é©ç¨å°å @ãÂÂå¨æÂ¤æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂåºç¾ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¨ÂæÂ¯ï¼ Incompatible disc region number / Can' t play disc ï¼ÂéÂÂ堼容ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ碼ï¼Âç¡ æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ ã â¢ è®ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨堧é¨çÂÂæ°´æ°£ æÂÂæÂÂéÂÂè¸ç¼ãÂÂé¿å Âå¨空調è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂè¿Â使ç¨æÂ¬ æ©Âã ç¡æ³Âé²è¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¨置堥æÂÂæÂ¾ Ã¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂéÂÂæÂ°å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂæ¨Â籤颿ÂÂä¸ÂæÂ¾å ¥ã 影åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¸ÂæÂ¢ï¼Âä¸ÂæÂÂéµç¡ æ³Â使ç¨ã â¢ æÂÂ丠ï§ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂ括Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å Âå°Â黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂï¼Âç¶徠åÂÂ使ç¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç ïµ STANDBY/ON æÂÂéµå°Â黿ºÂæÂÂéÂÂã è¨Âå®Âå¼堨鍿¶Âé¤ã â¢ 黿ºÂç¼çÂÂä¸ÂæÂ·æÂÂï¼Âå° æÂÂæ¶Âé¤è¨Âå®Âå¼ã æ²ÂæÂÂå½±åÂÂï¼Âæ²ÂæÂÂè²彩ã â¢ 檢æÂ¥é£æÂ¥æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢ºä»¥åÂÂæÂÂé ÂæÂ¯å¦å®Âå ¨æÂÂå ¥ ã â¢ æÂ¥é±é»è¦Âæ©Âï¼Â顯示å¨ çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Â以確å®Âè¨Âå®Âå¼æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢ºã â¢ èÂ¥æÂ¯é¸å Progressive ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè¨Âå®Âå¼å»已ç¨è²差 è¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç·Âä¾Âé£æÂ¥éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ ä¿¡èÂÂä¸Âç¸容çÂÂé»è¦Âæ© ï¼ å°Âå®Âå ¨ç¡æ³ÂçÂÂå°任ä½Âç«é¢ ã 使ç¨åÂÂæÂÂæÂ S-video 端åÂÂæÂ¥ä¸Âé»覠橠å¾Âï¼Âè« å° Compone nt Out ï¼Âè²差è¦Â頻輸åº@è¨Âå®Âå¼è®ÂæÂ´çº Interlace ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼Âã è¢å¹Âç«é¢æÂÂé·æÂÂæ¯Âä¾Âæ² è®Âã â¢ TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ© å±Âå¹Âï¼ çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ä¸ÂæÂ£ç¢ºãÂÂéÂÂæÂ°è¨Âç½®é»è¦Âæ© è¢å¹ÂçÂÂé¸頠ï¼Â使堶è æÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âï¼Â顯示å¨ç¸ 符 ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼Âã ç¶å¨ VCR ä¸ÂæÂÂéÂÂé AV é¸åÂÂå¨é²è¡ÂéÂÂ製ï¼Â便æÂÂå¹² æÂ¾å°影åÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ æÂ¬ç³»çµ±çºæÂ¡ç¨é²æÂ·æÂÂ衠@以é¿å ÂéÂÂé VCR æÂ AV é¸åÂÂå¨ç¼çÂÂéÂÂ製æÂÂå½±åÂÂæÂ¹é¢çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ ã éÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã ç«é¢å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°干æÂ¾ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ä¸ÂçÂÂæ¼Âé»Âã â¢ æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨è Macr o-Vision System é²æÂ·ç³»çµ±ç¸容 ã æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå §å«é²æÂᏬÂè @èÂÂä¸ÂæÂ¤ 種ç¢ÂçÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ ï¼Âå¨ç«é¢ä¸Âä¸Â亠å°æÂ¹æÂÂåºç¾å¦Âç·Âæ¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂéÂÂ訠ï¼Âè¦Â使ç¨ç é»è¦Âæ©Âé¡Âå èÂÂå®Âï¼ ãÂÂé 並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã â¢ ç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âç¹åÂ¥çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ Ã¥ÂÂè½åÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã éÂÂå¯è½æÂÂå°Âè´ç«é¢ å¨åÂÂè½å·è¡Âç¶æÂ ï¼ÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå ç¾æ¼Âé»ÂæÂÂè¼Âå¾®æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç¾象 ãÂÂéÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Â便å çºç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ堧容 ä¹ÂéÂÂçÂÂå·®ç°èÂÂæÂ´å çªÂ顯@ä½Â並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ éÂÂæÂÂè´ã DVD è CD é³éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ顯 å·®ç°ã â¢ DVD è CD 使ç¨çÂÂé 製æÂ¹å¼Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã CD-ROM ç¢ÂçÂÂç¡æ³Â辨 èÂÂã â¢ 確宠CD-ROM æÂ¯ä½¿ç¨ ISO 9660 çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæ ¼å¼ÂéÂÂ製 ã æÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§çÂÂè³Â訠@諠åÂÂéÂ񇪪 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã ç¡æ³Â辨è DVD-ROM 碠çÂÂã â¢ 確宠DVD-ROM æÂ¯æÂ¡ç¨ UDF bridge æ ¼å¼ÂéÂÂ製 ã æÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§çÂÂè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã æªÂæ¡Âç¡æ³Âå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âç¸ çÂÂçÂÂ覽å¨ç¶ä¸Â顯示ã â¢ ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡Âå¿ é Â以 æÂ£ç¢ºçÂÂ坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂå½å @è¬妠@MP 3 æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .mp3 ï¼ WMA æªÂæ¡ æÂ¡ç¨ .wma ï¼ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .m4a ï¼ JPEG æÂ¡ç¨ .jpg ï¼Â大寫æÂÂå°Â寫é½å¯以@ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ WMA æÂ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡ ã â¢ éÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡ÂçºæÂ¡ç¨ DRM ï¼ÂæÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂ製çÂÂãÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ WMV æªÂæ¡Âã â¢ ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä½Âå ÂçÂÂè¶ é 192 kbps çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 54 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 55 Zhtw English Español English Español 調諧å¨ USB 飿ÂÂ¥ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ Ã¥ÂÂ顠解決辦泠æÂ¶è½éÂȌ°廣æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ顯 ç éÂÂé³ã â¢ 飿ÂÂ¥ AM 天締ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 9 é Âç åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ ï¼ ä¸¦èª¿æÂ´å ¶æÂ¹åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä½Â置以徠å°æÂÂä½³ç æÂ¥æÂ¶æ¢Âä»¶ ã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以å¦å¤ÂæÂ¥ä¸Âæ¢Â堧鍿ÂÂå¤Âé¨ AM 天ç·Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天 ç· ï¼Âã â¢ å®Â堨伸å±Âé FM ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂ天ç·Â@調æÂ´è³æÂÂä½³æÂ¥æÂ¶çÂÂä½Âç½® ï¼Âç¶å¾Âåºå®ÂæÂ¼çÂÂ丠ãÂÂæÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以å¦ å¤ÂæÂ¥ä¸ÂçµÂå¤Âé¨ FM 天締ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締ï¼Âã â¢ éÂÂéÂÂå ¶ä»Âå¯è½é æÂÂéÂÂè¨ÂçÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå°Â堶移走ã â¢ 調諧éÂÂè·Âä¸Âé©ç¨ æÂ¨æÂÂå¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶æÂÂå°å ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 52 é Âç 頻çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âç½® çÂÂ說æÂÂ以å æÂÂ調諧éÂÂéÂÂã èªåÂÂ調諧åÂÂè½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ å° æÂÂäºÂéÂȌ°ã â¢ éÂȌ°è¨ÂèÂÂ微弱 ã èªåÂÂ調諧åÂÂè½å è½åµ測å°è¨ÂèÂÂç¼尠è¯好çÂÂç¡ç·ÂéÂȌ°ã æÂ³è¦Âç²å¾ÂæÂ´å éÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ調諧æ¢Âä»¶ï¼Âå¯æÂ¥ä¸ ä¸ÂçµÂ室å¤Â天ç·Âã åÂÂ顠解決辦泠æÂ¬ç³»çµ±ç¡æ³Â辨è USB 大 éÂÂå²åÂÂè£Âç½®ã â¢ 確å®Â已尠USB æÂ¥é Âå®Âå ¨æÂÂå ¥æÂ¬æ©Âå §ã â¢ 確èªÂè¨ÂæÂ¶é«Â格张çº FAT 1 6 æÂ FAT 3 2 ã â¢ ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´å §å»ºæÂ USB éÂÂç·Âå¨ç USB è£Âç½® ã æªÂæ¡Âç¡æ³Âå¨å°Â覽å¨ï¼Âç¸ ç çÂÂ覽å¨ä¸Â顯示ã â¢ æªÂæ¡Âå¿ é Âè¦ÂæÂÂæÂ£ 確çÂÂ坿ªÂå @è¬妠@MP3 æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .mp3 ï¼ WMA æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .wma ï¼ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .m4a ï¼ JPEG æÂ¡ç¨ .jpg ï¼Â大寫æÂÂå°Â寫é½å¯以@ã â¢ 確å®ÂæªÂæ¡Â許å¯欠æÂªåÂÂéÂÂå¶ ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂå¯Â碼çÂÂï¼ ã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ WMA æÂ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡Âã â¢ éÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡ÂçºæÂ¡ç¨ DRM ï¼ÂæÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂ製çÂÂãÂÂéÂÂ並丠æÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã åÂÂ顠解決辦泠ç¡ HDMI è¦Â頻輸åºã â¢ 確å®Âå¨éÂÂå°Â使ç¨è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Â丠@已é¸åÂÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ä½Âçº HDMI 輸堥ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ ä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã â¢ 確誠HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âå·²æÂ£ç¢ºæÂ¥ä¸ ä¸ÂæÂªæÂÂå£Âã â¢ 確èªÂ使ç¨ HDMI ä»Âé¢æÂ¥ä¸ÂçÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂå·²éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âè HDMI ç¸容 ï¼ÂéÂÂäºÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂé Âè DVI å HDCP ï¼ High B andwidth Digita l Co ntent Protec tion ï¼Âç¸容@ã â¢ è¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂè å®Âï¼Â使ç¨ DVI é£æÂ¥å¯è½å°Âè´信 èÂÂå³輸ä¸Âç©©ã â¢ 確å®ÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ä¸ÂçÂÂè§£æÂÂ度èÂÂ使ç¨ HDMI é£æÂ¥çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âè´ ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åº è¨Âå®Âå¼ è®ÂæÂ´è§£æÂÂ度ã â¢ èÂ¥è®ÂæÂ´è§£æÂÂ度徠ç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂ空ç½ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ表示é¸åÂÂçÂÂè§£æÂÂ度èÂÂæÂ¨ çÂÂ顯示å¨ä¸Â符ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 42 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ éÂÂæÂ°è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» é Âè¨Âå¼ã å¨è®ÂæÂ´ HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼ å¾Âï¼Â顯示å¨çÂÂè²彩åºç¾ å é¡Â@第 36 é Âï¼ ã â¢ è¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂè 宠@æÂÂ亠HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼å¯è½é æÂÂç«é¢ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢º 顯示ãÂÂæÂ¤æÂ ï¼Âè«Âè¦ÂçÂÂæ³Â使ç¨é»è¦Âæ©Âç è¦Â頻輸堥è¨Âå®Âå¼é¸å RGB ãÂÂæÂÂè å¯æÂ¢å¾©å ÂÃ¥ÂÂç HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 55 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 56 Zhtw Bluetooth é£締é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯ æ²ÂæÂÂå½±åÂÂæÂÂè²é³ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âä»Âç¶åÂÂå¨ ï¼ å¨å°ÂæÂ¨ç HDMI è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂç´æÂ¥é£æÂ¥è³顯示å¨æÂ ï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ顯示 å¨çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ洽詢製é åÂÂ以å°Âæ±ÂÃ¥ÂÂå©ã ç¡ HDMI é³頻輸åºã â¢ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 41 é Âç åÂÂæÂ HDMI é³頻è¨Âç½®å¼ ï¼Â確å®Âå·²é¸å TV ã KURO LINK ä¸Âä½Âç¨ã â¢ 確èªÂæÂ¯å¦已ç¢ç¢é£æÂÂ¥ HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âã â¢ 確å®ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK 模å¼Âå·²è¨Âå®Âçº LINK ON ï¼Â第 45 é Âï¼ ã â¢ 檢æÂ¥æÂÂé£æÂ¥è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯å¦ æÂ¯æÂ´ KURO LINK ã å¦ÂéÂÂ詳細è³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±æÂ¨çÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦ÂçÂÂæÂÂä½ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ飿ÂÂ¥ SCAR T é£æÂ¥ç·Âå HDMI é£ æÂÂ¥ ç·Âï¼Âå KURO LINK å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸ ä½Âç¨ ã å æÂÂ飿ÂÂ¥ SCART å HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Âå° KURO LINK 模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âçº LINK OFF ã æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ輸 å ¥ã â¢ é£æÂ¥é»è¦Âæ©ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ è¼¸å ¥ä»¥åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂéÂÂæ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DVD æÂÂ顯示åÂÂ形使ç¨è ä»Âé¢ç«é¢ ï¼Âä¾Âå¦Âç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ç ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä¸Âè¦ÂæÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Â以éÂÂ種æÂ¹å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ輸堥 ï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK 模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âçº LINK OFF ï¼Â第 45 é Âï¼ ã åÂÂ顠解決辦泠åÂÂ顠解決辦泠ç¡æ³Âé£æÂ¥æÂÂæÂÂä½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Â裠置ãÂÂä¾Âèª Blueto oth ç¡締æÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂè²é³æÂªç¼åº@æÂÂè²é³ä¸ÂæÂ·ã â¢ 檢æÂ¥é è¿ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂä½Âç½® æÂ¯å¦æ²ÂæÂÂä»»ä½Âç¼尠2.4 GHz 頻段é»池波çÂÂç©髠ï¼Â微波ç ã ç¡締LAN è£Âç½®æÂ Blue tooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂé¡Âç©é«Âé è¿ÂæÂ¬æ© ï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ¾å¨é é¢å®ÂçÂÂä½Âç½®ãÂÂæÂÂè ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ 使ç¨ç¼åºé»ç£Âæ³¢çÂÂç©é«Âã â¢ 檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·Âè£Âç½®æÂ¯å¦æ²ÂæÂÂé¢æÂ¬æ© å¤ªé @èÂÂ丠Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®èÂÂæÂ¬æ© ä¹ÂéÂÂæÂ¯å¦æ²ÂæÂÂä»»ä½ÂéÂÂç¤Âç©ã 尠Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®åÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ¾ç½®å¨彼æÂ¤ä¸Âè¶ é 10 m çÂÂè·Âé¢堧ï¼ÂèÂÂä¸Âä¸Âé ä¸Âå¯以æÂÂä»»ä½ÂéÂÂç¤Âç©ã â¢ 檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth å³輸å¨èÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âç ADAPTER PO RT æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º é£æÂ¥ã â¢ Blueto oth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ç¡æ³Âè¨Âå®ÂçºæÂ¯æÂ´ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂéÂÂè¨Â模å¼ÂãÂÂ檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂè¨Âå®Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥é Âå°ÂæÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º ã é Âå°Âè¨Âå®Âå·²èªæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ä¸Â被åªé¤ ã éÂÂ訠é Âå°Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º ã 使ç¨æÂ¯æÂ´ A2DP è¨Âå®Âå AV R C P è¨Âå®Âç Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ã è¨ÂæÂ¯ 說æÂ EXTRAPWR ⢠使ç¨å 大åÂÂçÂÂ模å¼ÂæÂ ï¼Âç¡æ³Â調æÂ´ SFC 模å¼Âã é³調æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âä½Âé³ã é«Âé³åÂÂä½Âé³å éÂÂï¼ ã MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨模å¼ÂãÂÂè²é³強åÂÂå¨模张ã CANNOT â¢ ç±æÂ¼ æÂªé¸æÂ DVD/CD æÂ USB ï¼ æÂÂå¨已æÂÂ丠SHIFT KARAOKE ã SHIFT ECHOã SHIFT ï æÂ SHIFT ï æÂÂç¦ÂæÂ¢æÂÂä½Âã â¢ å¨æÂªé¸å DVD/CD Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂ丠SH IF T USB REC æÂÂ顯示ã TRAYLOCK ⢠ç¢Âç¤éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 53 é Âç æÂ éÂÂæÂÂé¤ ç ä¸ÂèÂŒÂÂé¡ ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 56 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 57 Zhtw English Español English Español éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 è«ÂéÂÂç¨æÂ¤ç¨ÂåºÂå°ÂæÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ系統è¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂ復æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» çÂÂé Âè¨Âå¼ã 1 系統éÂÂæ©Âå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å INITIAL ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å ALL IN IT ï¼Âç¶ å¾ æÂ ENTER ã â¢ 顯示 INIT OK ã 4I N I T O K éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 1 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® æÂÂäºÂèªÂè¨Âé¸頠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼ è½è®ÂæÂ¨å¾Âä¸Âå èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ç 136 種èªÂè¨Âç¶ ä¸Âè¨Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂ人åÂÂ好çÂÂèªÂè¨Âã 1 é¸å ã Other Languag e ï¼Âå ¶ä» èªÂè¨Âï¼ ã ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼æÂÂæÂ¯æÂ¸ Ã¥ÂÂ代碼 ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼æÂÂæÂ¯æÂ¸åÂÂ代 碼ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå®ÂæÂ´èªÂè¨Â種顠åÂÂ代碼çÂÂ渠å®ã STEREO â¢ å¨ TUNER ã LINE æÂ ADAPTER PORT 輸堥模å¼Âä¸ÂæÂÂ丠SURROUND æÂ AUTO /STEREO æÂÂï¼Â顯示 STEREO ã KEYLOCK ⢠æÂÂéµéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ãÂÂè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 52 é Âç è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂéµé @Key Lock ï¼ ã USB ERR ⢠å¦ÂéÂÂæÂ´å¤ÂèÂÂæÂ¤ç¸ éÂÂçÂÂè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 31 é Âç 使ç¨ USB ä»Âé¢ ç éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ã HDMI ERR ⢠è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âè¿° HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ çÂÂæÂ éÂÂæÂÂ餿ÂÂ示 ã èÂ¥ä»ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ ï¼ åÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨ å® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ã EEP ERR ⢠ç¶Âä¿®äºÂå®Âè«Â洽詢 æÂ¨çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂã EXIT ⢠輸堥ç¦ÂæÂ¢çÂÂè¨Âè æÂÂå¨顯示é¸å®ç«é¢æÂÂæÂ¥ä¸Â麥å Â風峿ÂÂ顯示 ï¼ ç¶å¾Âç«é¢æÂÂè¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ£å¸¸ç« é¢ã NO MIC â¢ å¨æÂªæÂÂ堥麥堠風æÂÂï¼ÂæÂ SHIFT KARAOKEã SHI FT ECHO ãÂÂSHIFT ï ã SHIF T ï æÂ MIC VOL /â å³æÂÂ顯示ã OC ERR 1 OC ERR 2 ⢠檢æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂÂ¥ ç·ÂæÂ¯å¦çÂÂè·¯ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂçºÂ顯示é¯誤訠æÂ¯ï¼ è«Â洽詢æÂ¨çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠å¿ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂé²è¡Âç¶Âä¿® ã OVER TEMP ⢠åÂÂ試éÂÂä½Âé³é ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂæÂÂ堥黿ºÂç·Âç¡æ³Âä¿®æÂ£æÂ¤åÂÂé¡ ï¼Â表示æÂ¬æ©Âå¯è½已æÂ å£ÂãÂÂå¨ æÂ¤æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼Âè«Â洽詢å ÂéÂÂæÂ æ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ÂæÂÂé¢æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ°çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂã BT ERR ⢠Bluetooth å³輸å¨çÂÂæ¶ÂèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ太髠@以è´æÂ¼ç¡æ³Âä¾ÂæÂÂé»溠ã éÂÂæÂ°é£ æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth å³輸 å¨ã TV AUDIO å¦ÂæÂÂèÂÂè½模å¼Âå¨è¨Âå®Âä¾Âé» è¦Â使ç¨ç HDMI é³è¨Â模å¼ÂæÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ï¼ åÂÂ顯示çÂÂæÂÂ亮起堩ç§Âã KARAOKE ⢠æÂÂä¸Â麥å Â風æÂ ï¼ å¨æÂ¨æÂÂ丠SURROUND ã SOUND ã AUTO/STE REO æÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH æÂÂ顯示ã PHONESI N ⢠æÂÂä¸Âè³æ©ÂæÂ ï¼ å¨æÂ¨æÂÂ丠SURROUND ã SOUND ã AUTO/STER EO æÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH æÂÂ顯示ã è¨ÂæÂ¯ 說æÂ éÂÂ註 1 è«Âå¿å çº系統黿ºÂèªåÂÂéÂÂå ï¼Â就鍿ÂÂäºÂ使ç¨æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¯é»æºÂç· ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 57 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 58 Zhtw èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® èªÂ訠ï¼ÂèªÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼@ã èªÂè¨Â代碼 Ã¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼渠å® Ã¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂã åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå° Ã¥ÂÂ代碼 ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼 Japanese (ja), 1001 Englis h (en), 0514 French (fr), 0 618 German (de), 0405 Italian ( it), 0920 Spanish (es), 0519 Dutch (nl), 1412 Russian (ru), 1821 Chinese (zh), 2608 Korean (ko), 1115 Greek (el), 0512 Afar (aa), 0101 Abkhazian (ab), 0102 Afrikaans (af), 0106 Amharic (am), 0113 Arabic (ar) , 0118 Assamese (as), 0119 Aymara (ay), 0125 Azerb aijani (az) , 0126 Bashkir (ba), 0201 Byelorussian (be), 0205 Bulgarian (bg) ï¼ 0207 Bihari (bh), 0208 Bislama (bi), 0209 Bengal i (bn), 0214 Tibetan (bo), 0215 Breton (br), 0218 Catalan (ca), 0301 Corsican ( co), 0315 Czech (cs) , 0319 Welsh (cy), 0325 Danish (da), 0401 Bhutani (dz), 0426 Esperant o (eo), 0515 Estonia n (et), 0520 Basque (eu), 0521 Persian (fa), 0601 Finnish (fi), 0609 Fiji (fj) , 0610 Faroese (fo), 0615 Frisian (fy ), 0625 Irish (ga) , 0701 Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704 Galician (gl) , 0712 Guarani ( gn), 0714 Gujarat i (gu), 0721 Hausa (ha), 0801 Hindi (hi), 0809 Croatian (hr), 081 8 Hungarian (hu), 0821 Armenian (hy), 0825 Interlingua (ia), 0901 Interlingue (ie), 0905 Inupiak (ik), 0911 Indonesian (in), 0914 Icelandic (is), 0919 Hebrew ( iw) ï¼ 0923 Yiddish (ji ), 1009 Javanese (jw), 1023 Georgian (ka), 1101 Kazakh (kk), 1111 Greenlandic (kl ), 1112 Cambodian (km), 1113 Kannada (kn), 1114 Kashmiri (ks), 1119 Kurdish (ku), 1121 Kirghiz (ky), 1125 Latin (la), 1201 Lingala (ln), 1214 Laothian (lo), 1215 Lithuanian (lt) , 1220 Latvi an (lv), 1222 Malagasy (m g), 1307 Maori (mi), 1309 Macedonian (mk), 1311 Malayalam (ml), 1312 Mongolian (mn), 1314 Moldavian (mo), 1315 Marathi (mr), 1318 Malay (ms), 1319 Maltese (mt), 1320 Burmese (my), 1325 Nauru (na), 1401 Nepali (ne), 1405 Norwegian (no ), 1415 Occitan (oc), 1503 Oromo (om), 1513 Oriya (or), 1518 Panjabi (pa), 1601 Polish (p l), 1612 Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Portuguese (pt), 1620 Quechua (qu), 1721 Rhaeto-Romance (rm), 1813 Kirund i (rn), 1814 Romanian (ro), 1815 Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823 Sanskrit (sa), 1901 Sindhi (sd), 1904 Sangho (sg), 1907 Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908 Sinhalese (si), 1909 Slovak (sk), 1911 Slovenian (sl), 1912 Samoan (sm), 1913 Shona (sn), 1914 Somali ( so), 1915 Albanian (sq) ï¼ 1917 Serbian (sr), 1918 Siswati (ss), 1919 Sesotho (st), 1920 Sundanese (su), 1921 Swedish (sv), 1922 Swahili (sw) , 1923 Tamil (ta), 2001 Telugu (te), 2005 Tajik (tg), 2007 Thai (th), 2008 Tigrinya ( ti), 2009 Turkmen (tk), 2011 Tagalog (tl), 2012 Setswana (tn) , 2014 Tonga (to), 2015 Turkish (tr), 2 018 Tsonga (ts), 2019 Tatar (tt) , 2020 Twi (tw), 2023 Ukrainian (uk), 2111 Urdu (ur), 2118 Uzbek (uz), 2126 Vietname se (vi), 2209 Volap ü k (vo), 2215 Wolof (wo), 2315 Xhosa (xh), 2408 Yoruba (yo), 2 515 Zulu (zu), 26 21 é¿根廷 , 0118, ar 澳洲 , 0121, au 奧å°å© , 0120, at æ¯Âå©æÂ , 0205, be 巴西 , 0218, br å æÂ¿å¤§ , 0301, ca æÂºå© , 0312, cl ä¸Âå , 0314, cn 丹麥 , 0411, dk 菠, 0609, fi æ³Âå , 0618, fr å¾·å , 0405, de é¦Â港 , 0811, hk å°度 , 0914, in å°尼 , 0904, id 義大å© , 0920, it æÂ¥æÂ¬ , 1016, jp éÂÂå , 1118, kr 馬ä¾Â西亠, 1325, my 墨西åÂÂ¥ , 1324, m x è·è , 1412, nl ç´Â西è , 1426, nz æÂªå¨ , 1415, no å·´åºæÂ¯å¦ , 1611, pk è²å¾Âè³ , 1608, ph è¡èÂÂç , 1620, pt ä¿Âå ï¼Âä¿Âç¾ æÂ¯è¯é¦@, 1821, ru æÂ°å å¡ , 1907, sg 西çÂÂç , 0519, es çÂÂ士 , 0308, ch çÂÂå ¸ , 1905, se å°ç£ , 2023, tw æ³°å , 2008, th è±å , 0702, gb ç¾Âå , 2119, us HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 58 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 59 Zhtw English Español English Español è¦Âæ ¼ ⢠æÂ´å¤§å¨é¨å RMS Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂ輸åº@åÂÂç½®ãÂÂä¸Âç½®ãÂÂç°ç¹Âè² . . . . . æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè²é 60 W ï¼ 1 kHzï¼ 10 % T.H.D.ï¼ 4 é@éÂÂä½Âé³ . . . 60 W ï¼ 10 0 Hz ï¼ 10 % T.H.D. ï¼ 4 é @⢠ç¢ÂçÂÂé¨å é¡Âå . . . . . . . . . . DVD 系統@VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD 系統åÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³é¿系統 ⢠FM 調諧å¨é¨å 頻çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . 87.5 MHz è³ 108 MHz 天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 é ï¼Â丠平衡张⢠AM 調諧å¨é¨å 頻çÂÂç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ æ²ÂçÂÂå°é¿æÂÂ伯ãÂÂ以è²å ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂãÂÂå ¶ä»Âä¸ÂæÂ±åÂÂå®¶è å Â稠æ©Âå . . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz å° 1602 kH z å ¶ä»Âæ©Â種 æÂ¡ç¨ 9 kHz éÂÂè· . . . . 531 kHz è³ 1602 kH z æÂ¡ç¨ 10 kHz éÂÂè· . . . 530 kHz è³ 1700 kHz 天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ç°åÂÂ天締â¢ å ¶ä» é»æºÂéÂÂæ±Âï¼ æÂ°å å¡ãÂÂå°尼ãÂÂé¦Â港ãÂÂ馬 ä¾Â西äºÂãÂÂè²å¾Âè³Âæ©Â種 . . . . . . AC 220 V è³ 240 V ï¼ 50 Hz/60 Hz å ¶ä»Âæ©Â種 . . . . . . AC 110 V è³ 240 V ï¼ 50 Hz/60 Hz æ¶ÂèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 W å¾ æ©Âæ¶ÂèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180/1 81DVD . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W å ¶ä» KURO LINK ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.73 W KURO LINK OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W 尺寸 . . . 420 mm ï¼Â寬@x 62 m m ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 331 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ ï¼ DVD/CD æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨@éÂÂæÂ§å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AA/R6 ä¹¾é»池ï¼Âç¨以確èªÂ系統æÂÂä½Âï¼ . . . . . . 2 è¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç· ï¼Âé»Âè²æÂÂé Âï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AM ç°åÂÂ天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 FM 天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 黿ºÂç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå æÂÂä½ÂæÂÂå ï¼ÂæÂ¾ÂÂä»¶ï¼ S-DV180 æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 105 mm ï¼Â寬@x 115 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 114 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 115 mm ï¼Â寬@x 105 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 114 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 105 mm ï¼Â寬@x 118 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 114 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ä½Âé³åÂÂå°Âè½ å°å 系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Hz è³ 1 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 190 mm ï¼Â寬@x 360 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 317 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 59 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 60 Zhtw 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 åºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 S-DV585 æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®ï¼Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . 96 mm ï¼Â寬@x 96 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 96 m m ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 W 尺寸 . . . 96 mm ï¼Â寬@x 96 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 96 m m ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ä½Âé³åÂÂå°Âè½å°å 系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz è³ 1 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . 230 mm ï¼Â寬@x 380 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 360 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 æÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 åºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼æÂÂæÂ¶åÂÂåºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . 8 å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 S-DV280T æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼Âè½å°å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨@ä½Âé³ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå é«Âé³ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm Ã¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . . 260 mm ï¼Â寬@x 1097 m m ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 260 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm å éÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 220 mm ï¼Â寬@x 90 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 100 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg ⢠ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . . 100 mm ï¼Â寬@x 100 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 100 m m ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 60 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 61 Zhtw English Español English Español ⢠é Âä»¶ æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 æÂÂè²å¨åº座 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åºÂ座@. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 S-DV282T æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®ï¼Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ è S-DV280T ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ç¸å @å¦Âä¸Âè¿° ï¼Âã â¢ ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ è S-DV280T ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ç¸å @å¦Âä¸Âè¿° ï¼Âã â¢ é Âä»¶ æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 æÂÂè²å¨åº座 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åºÂ座@. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 S-DV5SW æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ä½Âé³åÂÂå°Âè½å°å 系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz è³ 1 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . 230 mm ï¼Â寬@x 380 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 360 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 éÂÂ註 â¢ çºæ±Âç¢åÂÂæÂ¹è¯ ï¼ è¦Âæ ¼åÂÂè¨Âè¨Âå¦ÂæÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ ï¼ æÂÂ丠å¦è¡ÂéÂÂçÂ¥ã ç± Dolby Laboratories æÂÂæ¬Â製é ã ãÂÂæÂÂ毠ã ã ã Dolby ã ã ã Pro Logic ã èÂÂé D æ¨ÂèªÂæÂ¯ Dolby Laboratories çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã æÂ¬æ©Âä¿Âæ ¹æÂÂç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂå°Âå©編è 5,451,942 ã 5,956,67 4 ã 5,974,38 0 ã 5,978,76 2 ã 6,487,53 5 Ã¥ÂÂ已核åÂÂèÂÂç³è«Âä¸Âä¹Âå ¶ ä»Âç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠çÂÂå°Âå©çÂÂæÂÂæ¬Â製é ã DTS å DTS Digital Surround æÂ¯ DTS, Inc. çÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âï¼ DTS 樠èªÂÃ¥ÂÂ符èÂÂæÂ¯ DTS, Inc. çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨ÂãÂÂçÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂæÂ Ã© 1996-2008 DTS, Inc. ãÂÂä¿ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæ¬Âå©ã æÂ¥æÂ¬å ÂéÂÂå ¬å¸åºçÂÂã çÂÂ欠é2009 æÂ¥æÂ¬å  éÂÂå ¬å¸ã çÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂæÂÂã æÂÂ¢åÂÂç¶ NEC堬叿ÂÂæ¬Âï¼Â使ç¨ F ontAvenue î Ã¥ÂÂé«Âã F ontAvenue çº NEC å ¬å¸çÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã æÂÂ¢åÂÂæÂÂ使ç¨çÂÂçÂÂæ¬Âä¿Âè·æÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂå° å©以åÂÂå ¶ä»Â屬æÂ¼ Macrovision Corporation çÂÂçÂ¥èÂÂç¢æ¬Âä¿Âè·ã 使ç¨該ç æ¬Âä¿Âè·æÂÂè¡Âå¿ é ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾ Macrovision Corporation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂä¸Âç¶ Macrovision Corporation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂåª è½ç¨æÂ¼å®¶åºÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè§Âè³Âã åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé åÂÂæÂÂè§£å¯ÂçÂÂ亦屬æÂ¼ç¦ÂæÂ¢ä¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂã DRM( æÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂ) æÂ¯ä¸Â種èÂÂç±éÂÂå¶ å£Â縮é³頻æªÂæ¡Âå è½å¨é»蠦以å¤ÂéÂÂ製æÂ¤ 種æªÂæ¡Âå°Âç¨çÂÂè£Âç½® (æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂéÂÂ製è¨Âå )æÂ æÂ¾ï¼Âå°ÂçºæÂÂæÂÂé Âé²éÂÂæ³ÂæÂ·è²ÂèÂÂè¨Âè¨Âç é²æÂ·æÂÂè¡ÂãÂÂç¸éÂÂ詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±å 人é»蠦åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè»Âé«ÂæÂÂéÂÂçÂÂ使ç¨æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ èªªæÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 61 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
<XRE3233-A> Printed in P ublished by Pionee r Co rpo ration . Co ppy right é 2009 P ionee r Co rpo ration. All rights rese r ved. PIONEER CORPORATION 4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC. P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90801-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404 PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC. 300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R 0P2, Canada TEL: 1-877-283-5901, 905-479-4411 PIONEER EUROPE NV Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11 PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD. 253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 65-6472-7555 PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD. 178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300 PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V. Blvd.Manuel A vila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Me xico ,D .F . 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270 K002_B_En HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 62 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (ser vicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated âÂÂdangerous voltageâ within the productâÂÂs enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. CAUTION: TO PREVENT THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE P ARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN IMPOR T ANT D3-4-2-1-1_A1_En î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ$(îÂÂ# îÂÂ!'îÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂ!"'îÂÂ*îÂÂ'îÂÂ%#%""îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî "îÂÂ#%îÂÂ)îÂÂ!'îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂî "%îÂÂ&îÂÂ"îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ-îÂÂ%îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ"îÂÂ!"'îÂÂ#îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ!,îÂÂîÂÂ"!'îÂÂîÂÂ!îÂÂ%îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî *îÂÂ'îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ$(îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ!îÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂ'îÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ$(îÂÂ# îÂÂ!'îÂÂîÂÂ&(îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ)îÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ"%î îÂÂîÂÂ"*îÂÂ%îÂÂ#"'îÂÂîÂÂ"%îÂÂî #"&îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ'îÂÂ'"îÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂ##îÂÂ!îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ&#îÂÂîÂÂ&îÂÂîÂÂ!îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ%îÂÂîÂÂ!î "%î "îÂÂ&'(%îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ! î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂî î $!)îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ$î îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂî î !îÂÂîÂÂ!î îÂÂ%$,îÂÂ' îÂÂ(*%%!- îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ'( î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ$'î #î îÂÂ)$ îÂÂîÂÂ$*#)'- îÂÂ$' îÂÂ' îÂÂî $# îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ(*'î îÂÂ)îÂÂîÂÂ) îÂÂ)îÂÂî î %$,îÂÂ' îÂÂ(*%%!- î $!)îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ$î îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂ'îÂÂî îÂÂ,îÂÂîÂÂ' î îÂÂ)î ( îÂÂ*# ) î , !! îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂ*(îÂÂî îÂÂ"îÂÂîÂÂ)( îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂ'îÂÂ&* ' îÂÂî î $!)îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî î $' îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂ,' ))îÂÂ# îÂÂ$# îÂÂ)îÂÂî îÂÂ'îÂÂîÂÂ' îÂÂ%îÂÂ#îÂÂ! îÂÂî îÂÂî î î î î î î î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂ# îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î VENTILATION CAUTION When installing this unit, make sure to leave space around the unit for ventilation to improve heat radiation (at least 10 cm at top, 10 cm at rear, and 10 cm at each side). WARNING Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation to ensure reliable operation of the product, and to protect it from overheating. To prevent fire hazard, the openings should never be blocked or covered with items (such as newspapers, table-cloths, curtains) or by operating the equipment on thick carpet or a bed. D3-4-2-1-7b_A_En WARNING To prevent a fire hazard, do not place any naked flame sources (such as a lighted candle) on the equipment. D3-4-2-1-7a_A_En CAUTION The ST ANDB Y/ON switch on this unit will not completely shut off all power from the AC outlet. Since the power cord ser ves as the main disconnect device for the unit, you will need to unplug it from the AC outlet to shut down all power . Therefore, make sure the unit has been installed so that the power cord can be easily unplugged from the AC outlet in case of an accident. To avoid fire ha zard, the power cord should also be unplugged from the AC outlet when left unused for a long period of time (for example, when on vacation). D3-4-2-2-2a_A_En HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 2 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
POWER-CORD CAUTION Handle the power cord by the plug. Do not pull out the plug by tugging the cord and never touch the power cord when your hands are wet as this could cause a short circuit or electric shock. Do not place the unit, a piece of furniture, etc., on the power cord, or pinch the cord. Never make a knot in the cord or tie it with other cords. The power cords should be routed such that they are not likely to be stepped on. A damaged power cord can cause a fire or give you an electrical shock. Check the power cord once in a while. When you find it damaged, ask your nearest PIONEER authorized ser vice center or your dealer for a replacement. S002*_En Operating Environment Operating environment temperature and humidity : 5 ðC to 35 ðC ( 41 ðF to 95 ðF); less than 85 %RH (cooling vents not blocked) Do not install this unit in a poorly ventilated area, or in locations exposed to high humidity or direct sunlight (or strong artificial light) D3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_En If the AC plug of this unit does not match the AC outlet you want to use, the plug must be removed and appropriate one fitted. Replacement and mounting of an AC plug on the power supply cord of this unit should be per formed only by qualified ser vice personnel. If connected to an AC outlet, the cut -off plug can cause severe electrical shock. Make sure it is properly disposed of after removal. The e quipment should be disconnected by removing the mains plug from the wall socket when left unused for a long period of time (for example, when on vacation). D3-4-2-2-1a_A1_En îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî î îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî î î îÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂîÂÂî CAUTION This product is a class 1 laser product, but this product contains a laser diode higher than Class 1. T o ensure continued safety , do not remove any covers or attempt to gain access to the inside of the product. Refer all servicing to qualified personnel. The following caution label appears on your unit. Location: top of the unit CLA SS 1 LA SER PR ODUCT D3-4-2-1-8*_C_En HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 3 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
4 En Thank you for buying this Pioneer product. Please read through th ese operating inst ructions so th at you wi ll know how to oper ate your model properly. Aft er you have finishe d reading the instr uctions, put them in a sa fe place for future re ferenc e. Contents 01 Speaker Setup Guide Home theater sound setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 5 spot/4 spot speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 3 spot/2 spot speaker layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Preparing the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Preparation common to all models . . . . . . . 6 Preparation for the HTZ280DVD/ HTZ280DVD-AP/HTZ282DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Preparation only for the HTZ181DVD . . . . . . 7 Wall mounting the speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Before mounti ng . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Attaching the brackets only for the HTZ180/ 181DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Additional notes on speaker placement . . . . . 8 02 Connecting up Basic connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 03 Controls and displays Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Putting the batteries in the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Using the remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 04 Getting started Setting Speaker Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Setting the ch annel levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Using the on-screen displays . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Playing discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Basic playback controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Resume and Last Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 DVD-Video disc menus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Video CD/Super VCD PBC menus . . . . . . . 19 Listening to the radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Improving poor FM reception . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Reducing AM reception noise . . . . . . . . . . 20 Memorizing stations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Listening to station presets . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Listening to other sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Setting the sleep timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 05 Listening to y our system Selecting Listening mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Auto list ening mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Listening in surround sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Using Front Surround . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Listening in stereo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Listening with headphones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Adjusting the bass and treble . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Using the SFC modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Boosting the bass level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Using the MP3 Expander . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Using the Voice Enhancer mode . . . . . . . . . . 24 Effective Sound (for optimum sound) . . . . . . 24 06 Disc playba ck features Scanning discs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Playing in slow motion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Frame advance/frame reverse . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Playing a JPEG slideshow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Browsing DVD or Vide o CD/Super VCD discs with the Disc Navigator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 Browsing Windows Media TM Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG-4 AAC, Di vX video/ WMV and JPEG files with the Disc Navigator . . . . . . . . 27 Using Playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Programming playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Listening to playlists . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Clearing files from a playlist . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Looping a section of a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Using repeat play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Using random play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Creating a program list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Other functions available from the program menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Searching a disc . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Switching subtit les . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Switching language/au dio channels . . . . . . . 30 Zooming the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Switching camera angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Displaying disc information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 4 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
5 En Engli sh Françai s Deut sch Ne derlan ds Italiano E spañol 07 USB playback and Recording Using the USB interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Recording the tracks of a music CD on a USB device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Recording all the tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Recording specific tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 08 Singing karaoke Singing kar aoke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Changing the vocal mix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 Changing the backing track . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 09 Audio Settings and Video Adjust menus Audio Settings menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Audio DRC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Video Adjust menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 10 Initial Settings m enu Using the Initial Settings men u . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Video Output settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Language settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Display settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Options settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Speakers settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Parental Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 About DivX î VOD content . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Speaker Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 11 Other connections Connecting auxiliary audio components . . . . 40 Connecting using the component video output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 About progressive scan video . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Connecting us ing HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Switching the HDMI audio setting . . . . . . . 41 Resetting the HDMI connection . . . . . . . . . 42 About HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Connecting external antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Bluetooth î ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoyment of Music . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Wireless music play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Remote control operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Connecting Optional Bluetooth ADAPT ER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTER and Bluetooth wireless technology device . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Listening to Music Contents of Bluetooth wireless technology device with Your Sys tem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Clearing Pairing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 12 KURO LI NK Making the KURO LINK connection s . . . . . . . 45 KURO LINK Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Setting the KURO LINK mode . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Before using synchronization . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Synchronized amp mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Synchronized amp mode operations . . . . . . 46 Canceling synchroniz ed amp mode . . . . . . 46 13 Additional information Disc/content format playback compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Disc compatibility table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 About DVD R/DVD RW compat ibility . . . . 48 About DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 About WMV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 About MPEG-4 AAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 About WMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Using and taking care of discs . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 DVD Video regions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Installation and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Hints on installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Cleaning the pickup lens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Problems with condensation . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Moving the system unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Screen sizes and disc formats . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Widescreen TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Standard TV users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 TV system setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Frequency step setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Dimming the Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Setting the Key Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Trouble shooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 DVD/CD/Video CD player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Tuner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 USB connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 HDMI connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Bluetooth connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Resetting the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Using the language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 Language code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Country/Area code list . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 5 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Speaker Setup Guide 01 6 En Chapter 1 Speaker Setup Guide Home theater sound setup Depending on the size and cha racteristics o f your room, you can place your speake rs in one of two ways using this system. For the speaker configuration, see the Setup Guide. 5 spot/4 spot speaker layout This is a standard mult ichannel surrou nd sound speaker setup fo r optimal 5.1 channel home theater sou nd. 3 spot/2 spot speaker layout This setup is ideal when rear surround speaker placement isnâÂÂt possible or you want to avoid running long speaker cabl es in your listening area. Preparing the speakers Preparation common to all models Attaching non-skid pads ⢠Attach the small er non-skid pads to t he base of each of the speakers. The four large non-skid pads are for the subwoof er. U se the supplied adhesive to attach 3 or 4 pads to the base (flat surface) of each speaker. Preparation f or the HTZ2 80DVD/ HTZ280DVD-AP/HTZ 282DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP The layouts of the 5-sp ot speaker and 3-spot speaker are the same : Assembling t he speaker st ands ⢠Attach the speaker stand bases to the stems using the screws provided. Once you have aligned the stem and base, secure with the small screws at the points see the Setup Guide. Note that the speaker should face in the direction of the base of the isosceles triangle. CAUTION ⢠Be careful no t to tig hten scre ws excessively. ⢠If excessive force is used to tighten screws, the threads of screw and/or nut may be damaged. Use a middle-sized manual screwdriver during assembly. ⢠Do not use power screwdrivers or oversized screwdrivers that may exert ex cessive force on the screws and nuts. ⢠Confirm that no foreig n matter is stuck to the stand b ase or the ta ll speaker during assembly. ⢠If the unit is assembled with foreign matt er stuck between the stand base and the tall speaker the unit may not be assembled securely, re sulting i n tipping or f alling. ⢠Do not stand on the speaker stand base of the tall speaker to push or swing the speaker. The speaker may fall and break , or someone may be injured. P ay special attent ion to children. Securing your front and surround speaker s ⢠Secure each of the front and surround speakers using the plastic catch provided. Screw two supportin g hook s into the wall behind the speaker. Pass a thick cord around the hook s and through the plastic ca tch so that the speaker is stabilized (make sure to test t h at it sup ports the weight of the speaker). After installing, make sure the speaker is securely fixed. Plastic catch Sufficiently thick co rd HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 6 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Speaker Setup Guide 01 7 En Engli sh Françai s Deut sch Ne derlan ds Italiano E spañol Engli sh Françai s Deut sch Ne derlan ds Italiano E spañol CAUTION ⢠The plastic catch is not a m ounting fixture, and the speaker should not be hung directly from the wall u sing this cat ch. Always use a cord when stabilizin g the speaker. ⢠Pioneer discl aims all resp onsibility fo r any losses or damage resulting from improper assembly, installation, insufficient strength of the installation materials, misuse, or natural disasters. ⢠When placing this unit, ensure tha t it is firmly secured and avoid areas where it may be likely to fall and cause in jury in the event of a natu ral disaster (such as an earthquake). Preparation only for the HTZ181DVD Stack t he speakers a nd fix the brackets Each speaker is prov ided with a color-coded indicator on the model labe l o n t h e r e a r s i d e t o assist identific a tion. Refer to the color indicators and install the speakers correctly. As shown in the illustrati on, stack the speakers. 1 Align the bracket with the respective upper and lower screw holes as shown in each figure below and fasten the screws securely. 4 spot/3 spot speaker layout: 2 spot speaker layout: CAUTION ⢠Do not attempt to carry the speakers when they are connected with the bracket. D oing so may cause damage to the bracket o r worsen damage to the bracket and speakers in the event th ey are dropped. Wall mounting the speake rs For the HTZ180DVD, the fr ont and surround speaker have mountin g brackets. For the HTZ181DVD, the front, center and surround speaker have mountin g brackets. For the HTZ280DVD/280DVD-AP, the center an d surround speaker have m ounting holes. For the HTZ282DVD/HTZ282DVD-A P, only the center speaker has a mounting hole. Before mounting ⢠Remember th at the speaker system is heavy and that its weight could cause the screws to work loose, or the wall material to fail to s upport it, res ulting in the speaker Note 1 When using the Front S urround mode, do not stack the surround speakers, but place them beside the front speaker and face them about 60 degrees out ward from the front speaker to obtain the best sound effect. Screw Front speaker Bracket Front speaker Center speaker Left Green White Green Red Right 4 spot: Front speaker Surround speaker Left Blue White Gray Red Right 3 spot: Color indicator Model label Color indicator Model label Front speaker Center speaker Surround speaker Left Blue White Green Gray Red Green Right Screw Center speaker Front speaker Surround speaker Bracket HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 7 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Speaker Setup Guide 01 8 En falling. M ake sure that the wa ll you intend to mount the speakers on is strong en ough to support them. Do not mou nt on plywood or soft surface walls. ⢠Mounting screws are not suppli e d. Use screws suitable for the wal l material and support the weight of the speaker. CAUTION ⢠If you are unsure of the qualities and strength of the wall, consult a professional for advice. ⢠Pioneer is not respo nsible for any accidents or damage that result from improper instal lation. Attaching the brackets only for the HTZ180/181DVD ⢠Make sure to tighten the suppli ed screw as securely as possible when attachi n g the bracket to th e back of th e speaker. ⢠Please do n ot attach the brackets to the center speaker. Additional notes on speaker placement ⢠Install the main front left and right speakers at an equal distance from the TV. ⢠When using the 5 spo t speaker layout, install the s urround sp eakers sligh tly above ear level for optimu m effect. Precautions: ⢠When installing the cente r speaker on top of the TV, be sure to secure it with tape or some other s uitable mean s. Otherwise, the speaker may fall from the TV due to external shocks such as earthquakes, endangering those nearby or damaging the speaker. ⢠Make sure that all the bare spea ker wire is twisted together and in serted fully into the speaker terminal. If any of the bare speaker wire to uches the b ack panel it may ca use the power to cut off as a safety measure. ⢠The f ront, cent er and surrou nd speakers supplie d with this sys tem are magnetic ally shielded. However, depending on the installatio n location , color disto rtion may occur if the speaker is installed extremely close to the screen of a television set. If this case happens, turn th e power switch of the television set OFF, and turn it ON after 15 min. to 30 min. If the pro blem persists, place the speaker system away from the television set. ⢠The subwo ofer is not m agnetical ly shielded and so should not be placed nea r a TV or monitor. Magnetic storage media (such as floppy discs and tape or video cassettes) should also not be kept close to the subwo ofer. ⢠Do no t attach the c enter speaker (only of the HTZ180DVD) the fro nt (of the HTZ280/ 282DVD)/surround speaker (only of th e HTZ282DVD) and subwoofer to a wall or ceiling. They ma y fall off and cause injury. ⢠Do not place the surround speaker on the top of the f ront speaker, as it may injure someone in the even t that it falls (only for the HTZ280DVD). 5 mm to 7 mm Mounting screw (not supplied) 5 mm 10 mm B racket sc rew (su pplied) HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 8 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 9 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 2 Connecting up Basic connections For the best surround sound, setup your speakers as below . The front left and right speaker should be about 1.8 m to 2.7 m apart. The speakers in the illustration below are the HTZ180DVD. Important ⢠When connecting this system or changing connections, be sure to switch power off and disconnect the po wer cord from the wall socket. After completing all connec tions, connect the power cords to the wall socket. WARNING ⢠Pioneer bears no responsibi lity for accidents resulting from fault y assembly or installation, insuff icie nt mounti ng strength of walls, mou nting fixtures (or other buildi ng fixtures), mi suse or natura l disa ster s. 1 Assembl e the AM lo op ante nna. a. Bend the stand in the direction indicated by the arrow. b. Clip the loop onto th e stand. c. If you want to fix to a wall or other surface, perform step b after first sec uring the stand with screws. It is recommended that you dete rmine the reception strength before sec uring the stand with the screws. AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R Y P B P R L R FRONT CENTER L R SURROUND SUB WOOFER VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP Surround right (Grey) Front right (Red) Front left (White) Subwoofer (Purple) Center (Green) Surround left (Blue) Listening position TV To video input FM antenna AM loop antenna fig. a fig. b fig. c HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_En.book 9 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 10 En 2 Connect the AM and FM an tennas. 1 a. Pull off the protecti ve shields of both AM antenna wires. Connect one wire o f the AM loop ante nna to each AM antenna terminal. 2 For each terminal, pre ss down on the tab to open; insert the wire, then release to secure. b. Push th e FM antenna 3 plug onto the center pin of the FM antenna socket. 3-1 Connect each speaker. ⢠Connect the wires to the speaker. ⢠Twist and pull off the protective shields on each w ire. ⢠Match the color-cod ed wire with th e color indicato r on the label, t hen insert the c olor- coded wire into the red ( ) side and the other wire into the black (âÂÂ) side. HTZ180DV D only: When you select th e 3 spot speaker layout, follow steps a thr ough c below to set up the speakers. a. The base of each surround speaker fits into the ci rcular gro o ve on the top of the front speakers as shown. Note 1 ⢠Keep antenna cables away fr om the receiver and other cables. ⢠If reception with th e su pplied antenna is poor, see Impr oving poor FM receptio n on page 20 or Connecting external antenn as on page 42. ⢠Do not attach any antenn a other than the provided loop antenna, or an external an tenna as described on page 42. 2 ⢠D onâÂÂt let it come into contact with metal objects and a voi d placing near comp uters, televis ion sets or other electrical appliances. ⢠If radio reception is poor, you may be able improve it by re-inser ting each antenna wire into the opposite terminal. ⢠For best reception, do not untwist the AM loop an tenna wires or wrap them around the loop antenna. 3 To ensure optimum reception, make sure the FM antenna is fully extended and not coiled or hanging at the rear of the unit. 1 2 3 Color-coded wire (Connect to speaker) Color-coded connector (Connect to rear panel) Black (âÂÂ) Color -coded wire Red ( ) HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 10 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 11 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español b. Secure the speaker wire. After test ing for the slac k necessary to tur n the speaker (see the following step), use the groove provided to secure the speaker wire. c. Turn the speakers towards the closest wall, lining the arr ows up for optimal Front Surround. For Front Surro und mode, turn each surrou nd speaker so that the ï¢ arrow at the base is lined up with the ï¡ ( FRONT SURROUND ) arrow on the front speaker. For Extra Power mode, ha ve all the spea kers facing forward. See the Listening to y our system for more on using Front Surround an d Extra Power mo des. CAUTION ⢠To prevent accidents, make sure th e surround speaker is p laced securely on top of the front speaker. ⢠Ple ase donâÂÂt atta ch the speakers to the wall or speaker stands for 3 spot speaker layout. HTZ181DV D only : a. When connecting the center speakers, connect the Y-cable dual end to the two center speakers in the same way. When you select a 4-sp ot, 3-spot or 2-spot layout where the brackets are used for assembling, also follow step b below. b. When connections are compl eted, secure the speaker cables. Fix the cables to the groove in the brackets. 3-2 Connect each speaker terminals on the receiver. ⢠Connect the other end to the color-coded speaker terminals on th e rear of the receiver. Ma ke sure to inse rt comple tely. The small lug at the wire-en d of the speaker p l u g s h o u l d f a c e u p o r d o w n d e p e n d i n g o n whether itâÂÂs being plugged int o one of the upper or lower speaker terminals. Please make sure to co nnect correctly. Y -cable T o Main Unit Upper terminal Lower terminal 02_Connecting_up .fm 11 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂé æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Connecting up 02 12 En CAUTION ⢠These speaker terminals carry HAZARDOUS LIVE voltage . To pr event the risk of electric shock when connecting or disconnecting the spe aker cables, disconnect the power cord before touching any uninsulated parts. ⢠Do not connect any speakers other than those supplied to this system. ⢠Do not connect the su ppli ed speakers to any amplifier other tha n the one supplied with this system. Connection t o any other amplifier may result in malfunct ion or fire. ⢠After connecting the pl ugs, pull lightly on the cables to make sure that the ends of the cables are securely co nnected to the terminals. Poor conne ctions can cr eate noise and interruptions on the sound. ⢠If the cableâÂÂs wires happen to be pushed out of the terminals, allowing the wires to come into contact with each other, it places an excessive additional load on the amp. This may cause th e amp to stop functioning, and m ay even damage th e amp. 4 Connect one end to a video input on your TV. ⢠Use the supplied video cable. 5 Connect the other end to the video output of the receiver. ⢠This unit is equipped with copy protection technology. Do not connect this unit to your TV via a VCR using A V cables, as the picture fro m this unit will not ap pear properly on you r TV. 6 Connect th e power cord. 1 ⢠Connect the power cord to AC inlet on the receiver. Connect the power cord to a wall socke t. Note 1 ⢠Do not use any power cord other than the one supplie d with this system. ⢠Do not use the supplied power cord for any pu rpose other than connecting to this system. AC IN To AC outlet 02_Connecting_up .fm 12 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂé æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 13 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 3 Controls and displays Front panel 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON (page 17, 32, 43, 50, 52 and 54) 2 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE (page 18, 32 and 53) 3 Function 4 ï¦ 5 ï§ 6 VOLUME /â (page 19) 7 Dis c tray (pag e 18) 8 Remote Sens or (page 15) 9D i s p l a y 10 USB interface (page 31) 11 MIC input jacks (page 33) 12 PHONES jack (page 23) Display 1 Decord indicators (pag e 22) DTS lights during playba ck of a DTS source . 2 PL II lights during 2 Dolby Pro Logic II decoding and 2 D li ghts dur ing playba ck of Dolby Digital sources. 2 PRGSVE (page 41) Lights when progressive scan video signal is given from the componen t video output termin al. 3 SOUND (page 23) Lights when the SFC modes, the tone controls (treble, bass or bass boost), MP3 Expander mode, Voice Enhancer mode are active. 4 F.SURR. (page 23) Lights when the Extra Power mode/Front surround mode is selected. 5 RPT and RPT -1 (page 28) RPT lights du ring repeat play. RPT-1 li ghts during repeat one-tr ack play. 6 PGM (page 27 and 29) Lights during program o r playlist playback. 7 Tuner indicators (pag e 20) Lights when a broadc ast is being received, Lights when a stere o FM broadcast is being received, Lights when FM mo no reception is selected. 8 RDM (page 28) Lights during random play. MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES ï¨ï OPEN /CLOSE ïµ ï ST ANDBY/ ON FUNCTION VOLUME ï¦ï§ MAIN SUB MIC PHONES USB 10 12 5 2 1 7 8 9 3 4 6 11 PRGSVE SOUND DTS F .SURR. 2 PL 2 D RPT -1 kHz PGM MHz RDM 6 12 8 9 7 5 11 3 10 2 1 4 HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 13 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 14 En 9 kHz/MHz (page 20) Indicates the frequen cy unit shown in the character disp lay ( kHz for AM, MHz for FM). 10 Character display 11 (page 21) Lights when slee p timer is active. 12 ï¤ Lights during playbac k. Remote control The illustration shows the HTZ280/282DVD-AP. 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON (page 17, 32, 43, 50, 52 and 54) 2 Function select bu ttons 1 3 Number buttons, CLEAR, DISPLAY , SLEEP and DVD controls CLEAR DISPLAY (page 30) SHIFT SLEEP (page 21) SHIFT USB REC (page 31) SHIFT AUDIO (page 30) SHIFT SUBTITLE (p age 30) Note 1 Only the HTZ280/282DVD-AP models are equipped with the adapter port. 1 USB REC CLEAR TOP MENU TUNE ECHO TUNE KARAOKE MENU MIC VOL PLAYLIST OPEN /CLOSE RETURN SETUP AUTO / STEREO MP3 EXP/ V.ENH SURROUND SOUND CLASS VOLUME CHANNEL T V CONTROL INPUT SHIFT VOLU ME MUTE T.EDIT PRESET PRESET AUDIO ANGLE SLEEP SUBTITLE ADAPTER PORT USB LINE TUNER ( FM/AM ) DVD/CD STANDBY /ON ZOOM DISPLAY 23 456 789 0 HOME MENU 1 2 3 ENTER 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 14 HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 14 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 15 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español SHIFT ANGLE (page 30) SHIFT ZOOM (page 30 ) 4 TOP MENU (page 19 and 30) SHIFT SETUP (page 17, 20, 41, 43, 44, 45, 51, 52 and 57) 5 SHIFT KARAOK E (page 33) SHIFT ECHO (page 33 ) SHIFT ï / SHIFT ï (p age 33) Cursor buttons ENTER TUNE (page 20) PRESET (page 20) 6 HOME MENU 7 Sound control s AUTO / STEREO (page 22 and 23) SURROUND (page 22 and 23) SOUND (page 23 a nd 24) MP3 EXP / V.ENH (page 24) 8 Playback controls (page 19 and 25 ) 9 TV CONTROL buttons These control Pioneer flat scree n TVs. 1 10 SHIFT 11 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE (page 18, 32 and 53) 12 PLAYLIST buttons (page 27 ) 13 MIC VOL /â (page 33) 14 MENU (page 19, 26 and 30) 15 RETURN 16 Tuner controls CLASS (page 21) SHIFT T.EDIT (page 20) 17 MUTE 18 VOLUME /â (page 18) Putting the bat teries in the remote control 1 Open the battery compartment cover on the back of th e remote control. 2 Insert two AA/R6 batteries into the battery compartmen t following the indication s ( ï« , ïª ) inside the compartment. 3 Close the cove r. CAUTION Incorrect use of batteries c an result in hazards such as leakage and bursting. Please observe the foll owing: ⢠Always insert batteries into the battery compartment corr ectly matching the positive ï« and nega tive ïª polarities, as shown by the display inside the compartment. ⢠Never mix new and used batteries. ⢠Batteries of the same size may have different volt ages, depending on brand. Do not mix diffe rent brands of batteries. ⢠When disposing of u sed batteries, please comply with governmental regula tions or environment al public in structionâÂÂs rul es that apply in you r country or area. Note 1 Hold down t he number button 1 for over three seconds with the CLEAR pressed. If the TV refuses to respond, hold down the number button 2 . After control is properly switched over, the power to the TV can be operated by directing the TV CONTROL ïµ toward the TV and pressing it. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 15 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Controls and displays 03 16 En ⢠In order to prevent battery lea kage, remove the batteries when not using the remote control for an extended period (one month or more). If leakage o ccurs, carefully wipe away any battery fluid inside the compartment, and replace the batteries with new ones. ⢠Do not allow books or other objects to rest on top of the remote control, since the buttons may be depressed, causing faster exhaustion of the batteries. ⢠Do not use or store batteries in direct sunlight or excessively hot plac es, such as inside a car or near a hea ter. This can cause batteries to leak, overheat, ex plode or catch fire. It can also reduce the life or performance o f batteries. Using the re mote control The remote control can be used within a range of about 7 meter s from the remote sensor on the front panel, and within a 30 degree angle. ⢠The remote control may not wor k if there is an obstacle between the rem ote control and the display unit , or if the remo te control is not directed towards the remote sensor of the di splay unit at the correct angle. ⢠The remote control may not wor k properly if strong light such as direct sunlight or fluorescent light is shining o nto the unitâÂÂs remote se nsor. ⢠The remote control may not work properly when this unit is use d near devices emitting infrared rays, or when r emote controls of other devices which use infrared rays are u sed. Also, the use of this remote control may cau se other devices to work improp erly. ⢠When the operating range of th e remote becomes too short, replace the batteries. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 16 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 17 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 4 Getting started Setting Speaker Layout Select the speaker layout for the speak er setting you arranged to your liste ning area environment. First time you switch on the system, the followin g speaker layout se tting appea rs. If you switch off the system without finishing this setting, the same appear s again next time you switch on the system. 1 Press ïµ STANDBY/ON and confirm WELCOME is shown on the display. 2 SELECT SPEAKER LAYOUT will run on the display for ab out 10 seconds. 3U s e ï©/ïª to sel ect appropriate speaker layout. There are two speaker layout mo des â 5 spot speaker layout and 3 spot spea ker layout. See Setup Guide for more details about speaker layout and mode description. ⢠5 SPOT â Optimal for 5.1 channel h ome theater sound by placing the two surround speakers in the rear of the listening position . ⢠4 SPOT (HTZ181DVD only ) â Th is is the standa rd layout for li stening to the surround sound, which is similar t o the 5 spot speaker layout. The two center speakers are separated to the right and left sides, and ne atly arranged around th e TV. ⢠3 SPOT â This is the classic layout for the Front Surround mode. The two surround speakers are placed in fron t of the liste ning position . ⢠2 SPOT (HTZ181DVD only) â This layout for the Front Surround mode is the same as the 3 spot speaker layout. The two center speakers are separated to the right and left sides, and neatl y arranged around the TV. 4 Press ENTER to confirm. 1 Setting the channel levels Set the relative chann el levels from your main listening p osition. 2 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct SOUNDSET, then press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct CH LEVEL, then press ENTER. 4U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct TESTTONE, then press ENTER. The test ton e is output in the follow ing order (from the speakers a ctive in the current listening mo de): ⢠L â Front left speaker ⢠C â Center speaker ⢠R â Front right speaker ⢠SR â Surround right speaker ⢠SL â Surround left speaker ⢠SW â Subwoofer 3 Note 1 To change the setting, press SHIFT SETUP , use ï«/ï¬ to select SYS SET , then use ï«/ï¬ to select LAYOUT to start setting procedure. 2 ⢠This is only available when DVD /CD is selected and playback is stopped. Also make sure headphones are unplugged. ⢠To adjust the overall balance while liste ning to any sound so urce you want, press SHIFT SETUP , use ï«/ï¬ to select SOUNDSET , then press ENTER . Use ï«/ï¬ to select CH LEVEL , then press ENTER . Use ï«/ï¬ to switch between channels, and ï©/ïª to adjust the channel levels. Press ENTER when youâÂÂre finished. 3 Since the subwoofer produces ultra-low frequencies its sound may seem quieter than it actually is. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 17 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 18 En 5 Use the VOLUME /â to adjust the volume to an appropriate le vel. 1 6U s e ï©/ïª to ad just the channel lev els in turn. You should h ear the test t one at the same volume from each speaker when seated in the main listening position. The channe l level range is ñ10 dB. 7 When youâÂÂre do ne, press ENTER to exit test tone setup. Using the on-screen displays For ease of use, this system makes extensive use of graphical on-scre en displays (OSDs). All the screens are nav igated in basically th e same way, using ï© , ïª , ï« , ï¬ to change the highlighted item and pressing ENTER to select it. 2 Important ⢠Throughout this m anual, âÂÂSelectâ m eans use the cursor buttons to highlight an item on-screen, then pre ss ENTER . Tip ⢠The button guide at the botto m of every OSD screen shows you which buttons youâÂÂll need to use for that screen. Playing discs The basi c playback controls for pla ying DVD, CD, Video CD/Super VCD, DivX video/WMV and WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs a re covered here. Further functions are detailed in chapte r 6. Important ⢠Throughout this manua l, the term âÂÂDVDâ means DVD-Video, DVD-R and DVD-RW. 1 If the player isnâÂÂt al ready on, switch it on. If youâÂÂr e playing a disc wi th video, also turn on your TV and make sure that it is set to the correct video input. 2 Press ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE to load a disc. Load a disc with the label side facing up, using the disc tray guide to align the disc (if youâÂÂre loading a double -sided DVD disc, load it wit h the side you want to play face down). 3 Press ï¤ (play) to start playback. If youâÂÂre playing a DVD or Video CD/Sup er VCD, a menu may appear. See DVD-Video di sc menus and Video CD /Super VCD PBC menus on page 19 to navigate these. If you loaded a disc containing JPEGs, a slideshow will start. See Playing a JPEG slideshow on page 25 for more on this. ⢠If a d isc contain s a mixture of D ivX video/ WMV and other media file types (MP3, for example), fir st select whether to play the DivX video/WMV files ( DivX / WMV ) or the other media f ile types ( MP3 / WMA / JPEG / MPEG-4 AAC ) from the on-scree n display. Note 1 When the volume is set to 51 or more, TEST TONE cannot be selected and the chan nel level setting range is restricted. In ad- dition, if the channel level range of any spea ker is set to the side, the maximum volume is also restricted. 2 The screen saver will appear after five minutes of inactivity. Button What it does HOME MENU Displays/exits the on-screen display . ï«ï©ïªï¬ Changes the highlighted menu item. ENTER Selects the highligh ted menu item. RETURN Returns to the main menu without saving changes. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 18 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 19 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español ⢠Please see Disc/content format playback compatibility on page 47 if you want to play a DualDi sc (DVD/CD hybrid disc) . 4 Adjust the volume. Use the VOLUME /â contro l. Basic playback controls The following table shows the basic controls on the remote for playing discs. 1 You can find other playback fe atures in chapter 6. Resume and Last Memory When you st op playback of a di sc, RESUME shows in the display indicating th at you can resume playback fro m that point. With DVDs and Video CD /Super VCDs, even if ejected, the play position is stored in memory. 2 The next time you load the disc, the display shows LAST MEM and you can resume playback. If you want to clear the resume point, press ï§ (stop) while RESUME is displayed. DVD-Video disc menus Many DVD-Video discs con tain menus from which you can select wh at you want to watch. Sometimes DVD-Video m enus are displayed automatically when you start playback ; others only appear whe n you press MENU or TOP MENU . Video CD/Super VCD PBC m e nus Some Vid eo CD/Supe r VCDs have me nus from which you can choose what you want to watc h. These are PBC (P layback control) menus. Note 1 You may find wit h some DVD discs that some playback controls donâÂÂt wo rk in certain parts of the disc. Button What it does ï¤ Starts/resumes normal playback. ⢠If the display shows RESUME or LAST MEM playback starts from the resume or last memory point (see Resume and La st Memory below). ïÂÂ¥ P auses/unpauses a disc. ï§ Stops playback or cancels the re sume function (if the display shows RESU ME ). ï P ress to start fast reverse scanning. ï® P ress to start fast for ward scanning. ï¯ Skips to the start of the current track or chapter , then previous tracks/chapters. ï° Skips to the next track or chapter . Numbers Use to enter a title/chapter/track number . Press ENTER to select. ⢠If the disc is stopped, playback starts from the selected title (for DV D) or track (for CD/Video CD/Super VCD). ⢠If the disc is play ing, playback jumps to the start of the selected title (VR mode DVD-R /-RW), chapter (DVD - Video) or track (CD/V ideo CD/Super VCD). 2 â¢The Resume and the Last Memory functions may not work with some discs. ⢠For DVD-Video discs ( except VR mode DVD-R/-RW), the play er stores the play position of the last five discs. Button What it does TOP MENU Displays the âÂÂtop menuâ of a DVD disc â this varies with the disc. MENU Displays a DVD disc menu â this varies with the disc and may be the same as the âÂÂtop menuâÂÂ. ï«ï©ïªï¬ Moves the cursor around the screen. ENTER Selects the current menu option. RETURN Returns to the previously displayed menu screen . Numbers Highlights a numbered menu option (some discs only). P ress ENTER to select. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 19 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 20 En You can play a PBC Video CD/Super VCD without having to na vigate the PBC menu by starting playback using a number button to select a trac k, rather th an the ï¤ (play) button. Listening to th e radio The tuner can receive both FM and AM broadcasts, and l ets you memorize your favorite stations so you donâ t have to manually tune in every time you wan t to listen. 1P r e s s TUNER to switch to the tuner, th en press repeatedly to select the AM or FM band. The display shows the band a nd frequency. 2 Tune to a frequency. There are three tuning modes â manual, auto, and high-speed: ⢠Manual tu ning : Press TUNE repeat edly to change the displayed frequency. ⢠Auto tuning : Press and hold TUNE until the frequency display starts to move, then release. The tuner will stop on the next station it finds. Repeat to keep searchin g. ⢠High-speed tu ning : Press and hold TUNE until the frequen cy display starts to move rapidly. Keep th e button held down until you reach the frequency you wa nt. If necessary, fine tune the frequen cy using the manual tuning method. Improving poor FM reception If youâÂÂre listening to an FM station in stereo but the reception is weak, yo u can improve the sound quality by switching to mono. 1 Tune to an FM radio station then press SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose TUNERSET then press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose FM MODE then press ENTER . 4U s e ï©/ïª to select FM MONO then press ENTER . The mono indica tor ( ) lights when the tuner is in mono rec eption mode. Select FM AUTO above to switch back to auto- stereo mode (the stereo indicator ( ) lights when receiving a stereo broadcast). Reducing AM reception noise If AM reception seems particularly poor, or the AM radio station you âÂÂre listening to seems noisy, try using th e Noise Cut feature for b etter sound quality. 1 Tune to an AM radio station then press SHIFT SETUP. 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose TUNERSET then press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose NOISECUT then pres s ENTER. 4U s e ï©/ïª to select the noi se cut mode then press ENTER. Select an effect level between 1 or 2. Memorizing stations This system can memorize up to 30 stations, stored in three banks, or classes (A, B and C) of 10 stations each . 1 Tune to an AM or FM radio station. For the FM band, select mono or auto-stereo reception as necessary. This setting is saved along with the preset. 2 Press SHIFT T.EDIT . 3 Press CLASS to select one of the three classes, then use the PRESET buttons to select the station preset you want. You can also us e the number buttons to selec t a pres et. Button What it does RETURN Displ ays the PBC menu. Numbers Selects numbered menu options. P ress ENTER to select. ï¯ Displays the previous menu page (if there is one). ï° Displays the next menu page (if there is one). HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 20 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Getting started 04 21 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español 4 Press ENTER . After pressing ENTER , the preset class and number stop blinking and the system memorize station. Listening t o station presets You will need to have so me presets stored to do this. 1 Make sure the TUNER function is selected. 2 Press CLASS to selec t the class i n which the channel is s tored. Press r epeatedly to cycle through classes A, B and C. 3U s e t h e PRESET b u t t o n s t o s e l e c t a s t a t i o n preset. ⢠You can also use the num ber buttons to do this. Listening to other sources You can conn ect auxiliary sources (TV, sa tellite receiver, etc.) to this unit for playback thro ugh the speaker system. See Connecting auxiliary audio components on page 40 f or more on this. ⢠To connect a USB device to th e USB terminal, see USB playback and Recordin g on page 31. ⢠HTZ280/282DVD-AP only: Bluetooth ADAPTER is selectable w hen it is plug ged and detected. See Bluetooth î ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoy ment of Mu sic on page 42 for more on this. 1 Make sure that the e x ternal source (TV, satellite recei ver, etc.) is switched on. 2 Press LINE to select the source. 3 If necessary, start playba ck of the source. Setting the sleep ti mer The sleep timer switches off the system after about an hour so you can fall asleep without worrying a bout it. 1 ⢠Press SHIFT SLEEP repeatedly to select an option then press ENTER . Choose between the follo wing options: ⢠SLP ON â Switches off after abou t an hour. The indica tor lights . ⢠SLP OFF â Cancels the sleep timer. After selecting SLP O N , you can p ress SHIFT SLEEP again to check how much time is left. Each line indicates approximately 12 minutes (remaining): Note 1 The display dims when the sleep timer is set. S L P --- -- HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 21 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Listening to your system 05 22 En Chapter 5 Listening to your system Important ⢠This unitâÂÂs audio func ti on may be restricted depending on the sound source, HDMI audio setting (page 41) or karao ke mode with the mi crophone plug ged in (page 33). In this event, the menus m ay not appear, or a message may be displayed instead (page 56). Selecting Listening mode Various listening modes are available for enjoyment of diverse soun d effects and for sound fiel d correctio n according to your preference. Depending on the spea ker layout you have chosen in the Home theater sound setup on page 6, the listening mode y ou can set differs. Read the fo llowing and p roceed with each setting. ⢠5 spot/4 spot speaker layout When you have ch osen 5 spot speaker layout, select one listening mode from the surround sound mode. See Li stening in surround s ound below. ⢠3 spot/2 spot speaker layout When you have ch osen 3 spot speaker layout which places the surround speake rs in front of you, select one listening mode from the front surround mode. See Using Front Surround on page 23. Auto li stenin g mode The Auto listening mode is the simplest way to listen to any source as it was mastered: the output from the speakers mirrors the ch annels in the source material. ⢠Press AUTO / STEREO to select the AUTO listening mode. 1 The listening mode is automa tically allotted accordi ng to the source material as shown in the table below. Listening in surround sound When you set up the system for 5 spot/4 spot speaker layout, the surround sound mode is availa ble. You can listen to stereo or mu ltichannel sources in surround sound. 2 Surround sound is generated from ster eo sources usin g one of the Dolby Pro Logic decoding modes. ⢠Press SURROUND repeatedly to selec t a listening mode. 1 The choices that appear in the display will vary accordin g to th e type of sou rce thatâÂÂs playing. ⢠STANDARD â Standard decoding mode (This mode can be selected only when the source is m ulti cha nnel) ⢠MOVIE (Dolby Pro Logi c II Movie) â Pro Logic II 5.1 channel surround sound, especially suited to movie sou rces (use with any two-channel source) Note 1 If the source is Dolby Digital or D TS, the corres ponding indicator lights in the front panel display. source 5 SPOT 4 SPOT 3 SPOT 2 SPOT two-ch STEREO STEREO multi-ch STANDARD F.SURR 2 Note that the input source must be switched to DVD/CD or USB for multichannel playback. 05_Home_thea ter.fm 22 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼ å¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂç«æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Listening to you r system 05 23 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español ⢠MUSIC (Dol by Pro Logic II Music ) â Pro Logic II 5.1 channel surro und sound, especially suited to music sources (use with an y two-chan nel source) ⢠DOLBY PL (Dol by Pro Logic) â 4.1 channel surround sound (use with any two-channel source) Using Front Surroun d The Front Surround mode and Extra Power mode are effective when DVD/CD or USB is selected as the input source and you a re using 3 spot (/2 spot only for HTZ181DVD ) speaker layout as described in Home t heater sound setup on page 6. ⢠Press SURROUND repeatedly to select a front surround mode. ⢠F.SURR â Use to provide rich surround sound effect. ⢠EXTRAPWR â Ou tputs stereo sound (in the case of multi-channel sources, down- mixed stereo soun d) from the surround speakers for powerful stereo effect. Listening in stereo You can listen to any source â stereo or multichannel â in st ereo. When playing a multichannel sourc e, all channels are downmixed to the front left/right sp eakers and the subwoo fer. â¢P r e s s AUTO/STEREO repeatedly until STEREO shows in the display . Listening with headphones When headpho nes are connected, the STEREO playback mod e starts. The listening mode cannot be changed. 1 Adjusting the bass and treble Use the bass and treble controls to adjust the overall tone. 1P r e s s SOUND . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select BASS/TRE then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to select BASS or TREBLE. 4U s e ï©/ïª to adjust the sound then press ENTER to confirm . ⢠Bass and Treble can be adjusted from âÂÂ6dB to 6dB . Using the SFC modes The SFC (So und Field Control) modes can be used with any multichannel or s tereo source fo r a variety of additional surround sound effects. 1P r e s s SOUND . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select SFC MODE then press ENTER . 3P r e s s ï©/ïª then ENTER to sele ct an SFC Sound mode. Select between OFF , LIVE , HALL , POP , ROCK , DRAMA or ACTION . Surround Speaker This illustration is 3 spot layout. For Front Surr ound mode For Extra Power mode For Front Surr ound mode For Extra Power mode For HTZ180DVD For HTZ181DVD Note 1 When you disconnect the headphones, the system reverts to the previous surround setting mode. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 23 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Listening to your system 05 24 En Boosting the bass level There are two bass modes you can use to enhance the bass in a source. 1P r e s s SOUND . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select BAS SMODE then press ENTER . 3U s e ï©/ïª to adjust the sound then press ENTER to confirm . Select between OFF , MUSIC or CINE MA . Using the MP3 Expander Reproduce the comfortable sound for compressed music (MP3, WMA , MPEG-4 AAC). ⢠Press MP3 EXP/V.ENH repeatedly to select MP3 EXP. 1 Using the Voice Enhanc er mode This mode is used for easy listening to t he spoken lines of the movies or dia logs. ⢠Press MP3 EXP/V.ENH repeatedly to select VOICE E. 2 Effective Sound (for optimum sound) With the uniquely shaped high-quality speakers su pplied with this unit, the Ef fective Sound mode enables the following Pioneer exclusive audio techno logies designed to maximize the real experience of sound original ly inherent in movie s and music. Turn on the Effective Sound mode under normal circumstances to m aximize the capabilities of thi s unit. 3 ⢠Dynamic Rang e Compressi on Resuscitates detailed sound susceptible to ambient noise to create an acoustic environment wh ere you feel as if you are right in the action. ⢠Frequen cy Characteri stic Correc tion Realize s the playback charac teristic optimized for long h ours of list ening in ad dition to th e added features of the supplied speaker unit s. 1 Press SHIFT SETUP and u se ï«/ï¬ to select SOUNDSET, then press ENTER. 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t S.FIELD then press ENTER . 3U s e ï©/ïª to adjust the setting then press ENTER to conf irm. ⢠EFFECT (Effective Sound) â Plays the sound with the characteristics opti mized for the included speakers. ⢠DIRECT (Direct Sound) â Turn s off the Effective Sound mode. Note 1 When turned on, the SFC mode will be turned off. 2 ⢠When turned on, the SFC mode will be turned off. ⢠Not applicable to the HTZ180/181DVD model - Effective only for the center cha nnel when a multi channel source is play ed . 3 The Sound Field will not affect the headphone outputs. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 24 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback features 06 25 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 6 Disc playback features Important ⢠Many of the functions covered in this chapter apply to DVD discs, Video CDs/ Super VCDs, CDs, DivX video/WM V and WMA/M P3/MPEG- 4 AAC/JPE G discs, although the exact operation of some varies sl ightly with th e kind of disc loaded. ⢠Some DVDs restrict the use of some functions (r andom or repeat, for e xample) in some or all parts of the disc . This is not a malfunction . ⢠When playing Video CD /Super VCDs, some of the functions are not available during PBC playba ck. If you want to use them, start the disc playing using a number button to select a t rack. Scanning discs You can fast-scan di scs forward or backward at various different speeds. 1 ⢠During playback, p ress ï or ï® to start scanni ng. Press repeatedly to increa se the scanning speed (shown on-screen). ⢠To resume playback, press ï¤ (play). 2 Playing in slow motion You can play DVDs, Video CD/S uper VCDs and DivX video/WMV at four different for ward slow motion speeds. DVD discs can also be played in reverse slow motion . 1 During playback, p ress ïÂÂ¥ (pause). 2 Press and hold ï³/ï± or ï²/ï´ until slow motion playback starts. Press repeatedly to change the slow motion speed (shown on-screen). ⢠To resume playback, press ï¤ (play). 2 Frame advance/frame re verse You can advance or back up DVD discs fr ame- by-frame. With Video CD /Super VCDs and DivX video/WMV you can only use fram e advance. 1 During playback, p ress ïÂÂ¥ (pause). 2P r e s s ï³/ï± or ï²/ï´ to reverse or advance a frame at a time. ⢠To resume playback, press ï¤ (play). 2 Playing a JPEG slideshow After loading a disc cont aining JP EG pictures, press ï¤ to start a slideshow from the first folder/pict ure on the disc. 3 The player displays the p ictures in each f o lder in al phabetical order. ⢠If the disc contains WMA/MP3/M PEG-4 AAC files, playback of the slideshow an d audio fil es repeats. During au dio playback, you can st ill use the sk ip ( ï¯ /ï° ), scan ( ïÂÂ/ ï® ) and pause ( ïÂÂ¥ ) functions. Pictures are automatically a djusted so that they fill as much of the screen as possible. Note 1 Only one speed is availabl e for DivX video/WMV dis cs. 2 ⢠Depending on the disc, normal playback may automatica lly resume when a new chapter is reached on a DVD disc. ⢠For Video CDs/Super VCDs in PBC mode and WMA/MP3 /MPEG-4 AAC tracks ( in Scan mo de only) normal p layback re sumes when you reach the beginning or the end of track. 3 ⢠The time it takes for the player to lo ad a file increases with large file sizes. ⢠Discs can contain up to 299 folders an d up to 648 folders and files combined. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 25 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback featur es 06 26 En While the slideshow is running: Browsing DVD or Video CD/ Super VCD discs with the Disc Navigator Use the Disc Navigator to browse through the contents of a D VD or Video C D/Super VCD disc to find the part you want to play. 1 During pl ayback, press HOME MENU and select âÂÂDisc Navigatorâ from the on- screen menu. 2 Selec t a view option. The options available depend on the kind of disc loaded and whether the disc is playing o r not, but includ e: ⢠Title â Titles from a DVD-Video disc. ⢠Chapter â Chapters from the current title of a DVD-Video disc. ⢠Track â Tracks from a Video CD /Super VCD disc. ⢠Time â Thumbnails from a Vi deo CD/Super VCD disc at 10 minute interva ls. ⢠Original: Ti tle â Origina l titles from a VR mode DVD-R/-RW disc. ⢠Playlis t: Title â Pl aylist titles from a VR mode DVD-R/-RW disc. ⢠Original: Ti me â Thum bnails from the Original content at 10 minu te intervals. ⢠Playli st: Time â Thumbnails from the Playlist at 10 minute interva ls. The screen shows up to six moving thumbnail images displayed one after a nother. To display the previous/next six thumbnails, press ï¯ / ï° . 3 Select the thumbnail image for what you want to play. You can use either ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to select a thumbnail, or the number buttons. To select using the number buttons, enter a two-digit number then press ENTER . Button What it does ïÂÂ¥ P auses the slideshow (or audio); press again to restart. ï¯ Jumps to the previous picture (or audio file with audio playback). ï° Jumps to the next picture (or audio file with audio playback). ï«/ï¬/ ï©/ïª P auses the slideshow and rotates/flips the displayed picture (P ress ï¤ (play) to restart slideshow). SHIFT ZOOM P auses the slideshow and zooms the picture. P ress again to toggle between 1x, 2x and 4x zoom (P ress ï¤ (play) to restart slideshow). MENU Displays the Disc Nav igator screen (see below). Disc Navigator Disc Navigator Title Chapter 01 04 02 05 03 06 Disc Navigator: Title 01- 49: - - HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 26 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback features 06 27 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Browsing Windows Media TM Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG-4 AAC, DivX video/WMV and JPEG files with the Disc Navigator Use the Disc Navigator to find a particular file or folder b y filename. 1 Press HOME MENU and select âÂÂDisc Navigatorâ from the on-screen menu. 2U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to navigate. Use ï©/ïª t o m o v e u p a n d d o w n t h e f o l d e r / f i l e l i s t . Use ï« to return to the parent folder. 1 Use ENTER or ï¬ to open a highlighted folder. ⢠When a JPEG f ile is highli ghted, a thumbnail image is displayed on the right. 3 To pla y the high lighted t rack or DivX video/WMV file o r displa y the highlighted JPEG fil e, press ENTER. ⢠When a WMA/MP3/M PEG-4 AAC or DivX video/WMV f ile is selected , playback begins from that file, and continues until the end of the folder. ⢠When a JPEG file is select ed, a slideshow begins, starting with th at file, and continues to the end of the folder. Tip ⢠You can also p lay a JPEG slideshow while list ening to WMA/ MP3/MPEG -4 AAC playback. Simply select the audio file you want to listen to follow ed by the JPEG from which you want the slideshow to start. Playback of both the slideshow and the audio file s repeats. Playba ck controls a re effective for the JPEG slideshow o nly. ⢠To play the co ntents of the whole disc rather than just the curren t folder, exit the Disc Naviga tor and start play back using the ï¤ (play) button. Using Playlists With this featu re, you can make up to three playlists of 30 files each for discs containing WMA, MP3, MPEG -4 AAC and JPEG files. Since this u nit will rememb er all playlists f or the last ten discs you have loaded, this is useful if you have a large nu mb er of files that you want to organize quickly and easily. 2 Programming play lists 1 With the disc stoppe d, press HOME MENU and select âÂÂDisc Navigatorâ from the on-screen menu. 2 Select the file you want to add to the playlist. See Browsing Windows Media TM Audio (WMA), MP3, MPEG- 4 AAC, DivX video/WMV and JPEG files with the Disc Navi gator above if yo u donâÂÂt know how to do this. 3P r e s s PLAYLIST 1, 2 or 3. The file is added to the playlist you select. 4 Repeat steps 2 and 3 until youâÂÂr e done. Note 1 You can also do this by going to the â .. â folder at the top, then pressing ENTER . 00:00 / 00:00 0kbps Folder1 Folder2 Folder3 Folder4 File1 File2 File3 File4 File5 Folder 2 00:00 / 00:00 0kbps 2 The dis c must be loaded for th e f iles in your playlist to play back. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 27 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback featur es 06 28 En Tip ⢠To add files without the on-screen display, simply press PLAYLIST 1 , 2 or 3 during normal playback of the file you want (except when a JPEG slideshow is playing at the same time as audio). Listening to playlists ⢠With playback stop ped, p ress PLAYLIST 1, 2 or 3. During playback, PGM lights in the front panel display. If no playlist has been progra mmed, NO LIST shows in the display. ⢠If the playlist contains both JPEG and audio files, pla yback of the slideshow and audio files starts. Clearing files from a playlist 1 Start playback of your playlist. 2 From the âÂÂDisc N avigatorâ screen, highlight the file you want to remove from the playlist and press CLEAR . Looping a section of a disc The A-B Repeat function allows you to specify two points (A and B) withi n a track (CD, Video CD/Super VC D) or title (DVD ) that form a lo op which is played over and over. 1 During playback, press HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂA-B RepeatâÂÂ. 3P r e s s ENTER on âÂÂA(S tart Point)â t o set the loop start point. 4 Press ENTER on âÂÂB(End Point)â to set the loop end point. After pressing ENT ER , playback jumps back to the start point and plays the loop. 5 To resume normal playback, select âÂÂOffâÂÂ. Using repeat play In addition to variou s repeat play options, itâÂÂs also possible to use repeat play t o gether with program play (see Creating a program list on page 29). 1 During playback, press HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂRepeatâ then select a repeat play opti on. 1 If program play is active, select Program Repeat to repeat the program list, or Repeat Off to cancel. ⢠For DVD discs, select Title Rep eat or Chapter Repeat . ⢠For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select Disc Repeat or Track Repeat . ⢠For DivX video/WMV discs, select Title Repeat (or Repeat O ff ). Using random play Use this function to play tit les or chapters (DVD-Video) or tracks (CD and Video CD/Super VCD) in a random order. 2 1 During playback, press HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂRandomâ then select an option. ⢠For DVD discs, select Random Title or Random Cha pter . ⢠For CDs and Video CD/Super VCDs, select On or Off to switch rando m play on or off. Play Mode Note 1 You canâÂÂt use repeat play with WMA/MP3/ M PEG-4 AAC discs. 2 ⢠You can set the random play option when a disc is pla ying or stopped. Ho wever, you canâÂÂt use random play together with program play. ⢠You canâÂÂt use random play with VR form at DVD- R/-RW discs, WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs, DivX video/WMV discs, or while a DVD disc menu is being displayed. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 28 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback features 06 29 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Tip ⢠Use the following contro ls during random play: ⢠Rando m play remains in e ffect until you select Random Off from the r andom play menu options. Creating a program list This feature lets you progra m the play order of titles/chapters/tracks on a disc. 1 1 During playback, press HOME M ENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂProgramâ then select âÂÂCreate/Editâ from the li st of program op tions. 3U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to selec t a title, ch apter or track for the current step in the progr am list. ⢠For a D VD disc, you can add a title or a chapter. ⢠For a CD or Vide o CD/Super VCD, select a track to add to the program list. After pressing ENTER to select the title/ chapter/track, the step number automa tically moves down one. 4 Repeat step 3 to build up a program list. A program list ca n contain up to 24 steps. ⢠You can insert steps by just hi ghlighting the position where you wa nt the new step to appear and entering a title/chapter/track number . ⢠To delete a step, highlight it and press CLEAR . 5 To play the program list , press ï¤ (play). Program play remains a ctive until you turn off program play (see below), erase the progra m list (see below), eject the disc or switch off. Tip ⢠Use the fo llowing con trols during program play: Other functions available from the program menu There are a number of o ther options in the program m enu in addi tion to Crea te/Edit. ⢠Playback Start â St arts playbac k of a saved program list ⢠Playback Stop â Tur ns off program pl ay, but does not erase the program list ⢠Program Delete â Erases the program list and tu rns off program play Searching a disc You can sear ch DVD disc s by title or chapter number, or by time; CD s and Video C D/Super VCDs by tra ck number or time; DivX video / WMV discs by time. 1P r e s s HOME MENU and select â Play Mode âÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂSearch ModeâÂÂ. The search op tions that appea r depend on the kind of disc loaded. 3 Select a search mo de. ⢠The disc must be playing in order to use time search. Button What it does ï° Selects a new track/title/chapter at random. ï¯ Returns to the beginning of the current track/title/chapter; further presses select another random track/title/chapter. Note 1 You canâÂÂt use Program play with VR format DVD-R/-RW discs, WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC discs, DivX video/WMV discs, or while a DVD disc menu is being displayed. Button What it does HOME MENU Save the program list and exit without starting playback. ï° Skip to the next step in the program list. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 29 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Disc playback featur es 06 30 En 4 Use the number b uttons to enter a title, chapter or track number, or a ti me. ⢠For a time search, en ter the numbe r of minutes and seconds into the currently playing title (DVD/DivX video/WMV) or track (CD/Video CD/Supe r VCD) you want playback to resume from. For example, press 4 , 5, 0 , 0 to have playback start from 45 minutes into the disc. For 1 ho ur, 20 minutes and 30 seconds, press 8 , 0 , 3 , 0 . 5P r e s s ENTER to start play back. Switching subtitles Some DVD discs and DivX video discs have subtitles in one or more languag e s; the disc box will usually tell you which subtitle languages are ava ilable. You can switch subtitle language during pl ayback. 1 â¢P r e s s SHIFT SUBTITLE repeatedly to select a subtitle opt ion. ⢠To set subtitle preferences, see Language settings on page 36. â¢S e e Displaying DivX subtitle fil es on page 48 for more on DivX subtitles. Switching language/audio channels When playing discs recorded with dialogue in two or more lan guages, or with dual-mono audio 2 you can switch th ese during playback. 3 When playing a Video CD/Super VCD, you can switch between stereo, just the left channel or just the rig ht channel. â¢P r e s s SHIFT AUDIO repeatedly to select an audio language optio n. ⢠To set audio language preferences, see Language settings on page 36. Zooming the screen Using the zoom fea ture you can magnify a part of the screen by a factor of 2 or 4, wh ile watching a DVD, DivX video/WMV title o r Video CD/Super VCD or playing a JPEG disc . 1 During playback, press SHIFT ZOOM to select the zoom factor (Nor mal, 2x or 4x). 2U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ to change the zoomed area. You can chan ge the zoom factor and the zoomed area freely during pla yback. 4 Switching camera angles Some DVD discs feature scenes shot from two or more angles â check the disc box for details. When a multi-a ngle scene is playing, a icon appears on screen (this can be switched off if you prefer â see Display settings on page 37). ⢠During playb ack (or when paused), press SHIFT ANGLE to switch angle. Displaying disc information Various track, chapter and title information can be displayed on-screen during playback. ⢠To show/switch/hide t he information displayed, press DISPLAY repeatedly. Limited disc information also appears in the front panel display. Press DISPLAY to change the displa yed information . Note 1 Some discs only allow you to change subtitle language from the disc menu. Pr ess TOP MENU or MENU to access. 2 Some Super VCDs have two soundtracks. With these discs you can switch between the two soundtracks as well as individual channels in each. 3 Some discs only allow you to change audio language from the disc menu. Press TOP MENU or MENU to access. 4 ⢠Since DVD, Video CD/Super VCD, DivX video/WMV title an d JPEG pictures have a fixed resolution, picture quality will deteriorate, especially at 4x zoom. This is not a malfunction. ⢠If the navigation square at the top of the screen disappears, press SHIFT ZOOM again to display it. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 30 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
USB playback and Recording 07 31 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 7 USB playback and Recording Using the USB interface It is possible to listen to two-channel audio 1 and watch DivX video/WMV/JPEG file s using the USB interface on th e front of this un it. Connect a USB mass storage device 2 as shown below. 1 With the player switched on, press USB. Make sure your TV is on and set to the correct video inpu t. 2 Connect your U SB device. The USB term inal is located on the front panel. 3 Press ï¤ (play) to start playback. If your USB device contains JPEGs, a slideshow will start. See Playing a JP EG slideshow on page 25 for more on this. â¢M a k e s u r e USB DATA is show ing in the front panel displa y (or the system is in standby) when disconnecting. Important If a USB ERR message lights in the display, it may mean that the power requirements of the USB device are too high for this player, or that the device is incompatib le. Try the fo llowing: ⢠Switch the player o ff, then on again. ⢠Reconnecting the USB device with th e player switched off. ⢠Selecting to another input source (like DVD/CD ), then back to USB . ⢠Using a de dicated AC adap ter (supplied with the de vice) for USB pow er. If this doesnâÂÂt remedy the problem, it i s likely your USB device is inc ompatible. Recording the tracks of a music CD on a USB device The tracks of a music CD load ed in this unit can be recorded on a USB connected to the USB port. Recording all the tracks 1 Load the music CD. Press ï§ to stop playback. Note 1 This includes playback of DivX video/WMV/WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC files (except files with copy-protection or restricted playback). 2 ⢠Compatible USB devices include external magnetic hard driv es, portable flash memory (particularly key drives) and digital audio players (MP3 players) o f format FAT 16/32. It is not possible to connect this unit to a person al computer for USB playback . ⢠Pioneer cannot guarantee compatibility (operation and/or bu s power) with all USB mass storage devices and assumes no responsibility for any loss of data that may occur when connected to this unit. ⢠With la rge amounts of da ta, it may take lo nger for the syste m to read the cont ents of a USB device . ⢠Some USB devices may not be properly recognized. ⢠Even when they are in a s upported format, some files may not play or display depending on the content. USB USB USB mass sto rage device USB (Type A) HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 31 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
USB playback and Recording 07 32 En 2P r e s s SHIFT USB REC to displa y the âÂÂCD -> USB Recâ screen. 3P r e s s ENTER to start r ecording. Recording starts. T h e screen shown below is displayed during recording. 1 Recording specific tracks 1 Load the musi c CD. Press ï§ to stop playback. 2 Press HOME MENU and select âÂÂCD ->USB RecâÂÂ. CD -> USB Rec can onl y be se lected whe n the music CD is stopped. 3 Make setting usin g ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ an d ENTER . 4 Select the track you want to record. ⢠Individu al â Select on e track at a time. ⢠Select All â Select all the track s. ⢠All Clear â Clear all selected tracks. 5 Select the bit rate (transfer rate). Select 128 kbps , 192 kbps or 320 kb ps . 6S e l e c t â Startâ using the ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ , then press ENTER . 2 Recording starts. Note 1 Recording cannot be started if ther e is not enough free space on the USB device. In this case, âÂÂAvailable USB space is lowâ is displayed. CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack To t a l T i m e T rack 1âÂÂ13 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 3 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 4 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 5 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 6 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 7 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 8 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 13 ï¦ï 055:07 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack To t a l T i m e î 13 î 055:07 Cancel î 01:43 î 03:17 î 04:18 î 04:59 î 04:20 î 04:38 î 04:40 î 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î î Tr a ck 0 1 î î Tr a ck 0 2 î î Tr a ck 0 3 î î Tr a ck 0 4 î î Tr a ck 0 5 î î Tr a ck 0 6 î î Tr a ck 0 7 î î Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD â > USB Rec Start Selected T rack To t a l T i m e ï¦ï 00 ï¦ï 000:00 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 Tr a ck 0 1 Tr a ck 0 2 Tr a ck 0 3 Tr a ck 0 4 Tr a ck 0 5 Tr a ck 0 6 Tr a ck 0 7 Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec 2 ⢠When recording is finished, a folder named âÂÂPIONEERâ is cr eated automatically on the USB device. The recorded tra cks are stored in this folder. ⢠Up to 99 âÂÂPIONEERâ folders can be created. ⢠Recording is not possible if t he US B device contains 300 folders or more. ⢠When recording on a USB device is under wa y, all DVD-rela ted key operations are disabled except for the operation of ïµ STANDBY/ON and ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE buttons and switchover of the funct ions. ⢠When the sleep timer is ON, it is cancelled once recording on a USB device is started. Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 01 ï¦ï 003:17 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 Tr a ck 0 3 Tr a ck 0 4 Tr a ck 0 5 Tr a ck 0 6 Tr a ck 0 7 Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Select T rack Bitrate ï§ î 128kbps 192kbps 320kbps ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack To t a l T i m e T rack 1âÂÂ13 î Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 î Tr a ck 0 3 î Tr a ck 0 4 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 5 î Tr a ck 0 6 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 7 î Tr a ck 0 8 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack To t a l T i m e ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Cancel ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î Tr a ck 0 1 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 2 î Tr a ck 0 3 î Tr a ck 0 4 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 5 î Tr a ck 0 6 ï§ î Tr a ck 0 7 î Tr a ck 0 8 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec 07_playing usb.f m 32 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂç« æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ æÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Singing karaoke 08 33 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 8 Singing karaoke Singing karaoke Using the kara oke features you can plug in a microp hone and mix th e sound of your own voice with a backing track. 1 You can sele ct a backing tr ack from audio s ources such as CDs , DVDs, VCDs or USB devices. Adju st the microphone level rela tive to the backing track. 1 Plug in the microp hone(s). If youâÂÂre only using on e mic, plug it into the MIC (MAIN) jack. The MIC (SUB) jack can be used only if MIC (MAIN) is also connected. ⢠If the microphone ha s an on/off switch, make sure itâÂÂs on. 2 Load a karaoke backing di sc. You can al so use track s on a USB device as source material for a bac king track. 3 Adjust KARAOKE mode settings. ⢠Press SHIFT KARAOKE to turn KARAOKE mode on or off for di scs that have vocals on both Left and Right channels: KARAOKE (Vocal Fade) â Vocals in the backing tra ck are partially elimin ated. OFF (default) â Switches the Karaoke mo de off. â¢P r e s s SHIFT AUDIO to switch between audio channels (except Data discs and USB sources) with discs that have vocal tracks on only one channel: Left â Left channel only. Use for tracks that have a vocal recorded in the righ t channel. Right â Right channel only. Use for tracks that have a vocal recorded in the left ch annel. STEREO â Switches the Karaoke mode off. 4 Play the backing track. 5 Adjust the MIC VOL /â to get the sound you want. 2 To avoid unple asant feedback, make su re you donâÂÂt point the micropho ne(s) at the speakers. 3 Changing the vocal mix Adding some effects to the microphone mix can sometimes impro ve the overall sound. 4 You can choose between th ree echo levels. ⢠To add effects to t he microphone mix, press SHIFT ECHO. Pressing repeatedly switches between echo levels 1 to 3 and off. Changing the backing track You may want to lower or raise the pitch of the backing track to match your vocal range. 5 â¢P r e s s SHIFT ï or SHIFT ï to lower or raise the pitch of the backing track. Note 1 ⢠These features are only possible when a microphone is connected. If you try to use SHIFT KARAOKE , SHIFT ECHO , SHIFT ï , SHIFT ï or MIC VOL when no mic is connected, a NO MIC error message is displayed. Also note that during DVD playback, when you connect a mic sound se ttings are automatically switched to STEREO playback and the player downmixes multichannel sources to 2.1 channels. ⢠These features are only a vailab le with the DVD/CD or USB input functions. MAIN SUB MIC 2 MIC VOL is set to 0 when you remove the microp hone, change the function or turn the power off . 3 Depending on the microphone level, the sound of the disc may distort. If this happens, turn down the volume. 4 You cannot adjust SFC modes, tone co ntrols (bass, tr eble, and bass boost), Extr a Power mode, Front Surround mode, MP3 Expander mode or Voice Enhancer mo de when a microphone is plugged in. 5 This feature is not compatible with DTS signals. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 33 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Audio Settings and Video Adjust menus 09 34 En Chapter 9 Audio Settings and Video Adjust menus Audio Sett ings menu The Audio Settings me nu offers features for adjusting the way discs sound. 1P r e s s HOME MENU and select âÂÂAudi o Settingsâ from the on-screen display. 2 Select and change settings u sing ï©/ïª/ ï«/ï¬ and ENTER . Audio DRC â¢S e t t i n g s : High , Medium , Lo w , Off (default) When watching Dolby Digital DVDs at low volume, itâÂÂs easy to lose the quiet e r sounds complete ly â including some of th e dialog. Switching Audio DRC (Dynamic Range Control) to on can help by bringing up the quieter sounds, while control ling loud peaks. How much of a difference yo u hear depends on the material youâÂÂre listening to. I f the material doesnâÂÂt have wide varia tions in volume, you may not noti ce much chang e. 1 Video Adj u st menu From the Video Adjust scre en you can adjust settings that affe ct picture pres entation. 1 Press HOME M ENU and sel ect âÂÂVi deo Adjustâ from th e on-screen display. 2 Make settings usi ng ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER . You can adjust the following settings: ⢠Sharpness â Adjusts the sharpness of edges in the picture ( Fine , Standard , Soft ) ⢠Brightness â Adjusts the o verall brightness ( âÂÂ20 to 20 ) ⢠Contrast â Adjusts the contrast between light and dark ( âÂÂ16 to 16 ) ⢠Gamma â Adjusts the âÂÂwarmthâ of the picture ( High, Medium, Low, Off ) ⢠Hue â Adjusts the red/green balance ( Gree n 9 to Red 9 ) ⢠Chroma Level â Adjusts how saturat ed colors appear ( âÂÂ9 to 9 ) Adjust the Brightne ss, Contrast, Hue an d Chroma Leve l settings using ï«/ï¬ . 3 Press ENTER to return to th e Video Adjust screen, or HOME MENU to exit. Note 1 Audio DRC is only effective wit h Dolby Digital audio sources. Audio Settings Audio Settings Audio DRC High Medium Low Off Video Adjust Sharpness Brightness Contrast Gamma Hue Chroma Level Standard 0 0 Off 0 0 î î î î î î Video Adjust Brightness min max 0 HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 34 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 35 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 10 Initial Settings menu Using the Initial Settings menu The Initia l Setting s menu provid es audio a nd video outp ut settings, pa rental lock settings, and display settings, among others. If an option i s grayed out it means that it cannot be changed at the current time. This is usual ly because a disc is playing. Stop the disc, then change the setting. 1P r e s s DVD/CD . 2 With playback stop ped, press HOME MENU and select âÂÂInitial Setti ngsâÂÂ. 3U s e ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ and ENTER to select the setting and option you want to set. All the settings and op tions are explained on the foll owing pages . 1 Video Output set tings Note 1 ⢠In the table, the default setting is shown in bold : other settings are shown in italics . ⢠Some settings, such as T V Screen , Audio Language and Subtitle Language may be overridden by the DVD disc. Often these settings can also be made fro m the DVD disc menu. ⢠The HDMI Resolution and HDMI Color settings only need to be set if you connected t his player to a n HD MI-compatible component using the HDMI connector. 2 This setting can only be used when you are connect ed via HDMI and have the HDMI resolution set to 1920x1080p, 1920x1080i or 1280x720p. When using this setting, only the HDMI connection is available. Initial Settings Setting Option What it means TV Screen (See also Screen sizes and disc formats on page 51.) 4:3 (Letter Box) Set if you have a conventional 4:3 TV. Widesc reen movies are shown with black bars top and bottom. 4:3 (Pan & Scan) Set if you have a conventional 4:3 TV. Widescreen mov ies are shown with the sides cropped so that the image fills the screen. 16:9 (Wide) Set if you have a widescreen TV. 16:9 (Compressed) Set if you have a widescreen TV. 4:3 material is shown with black bars on either side of the screen. 2 Component Out (See also Connecting auxiliar y audio comp onent s on page 40 .) Interlac e Set if your T V is no t compa tib le with progressive scan video. Progressive Set if yo ur TV is compatible wi th progressive scan video (see your TVâÂÂs instruction manual for details). Press ENTER once more to confirm (or RETURN to cancel). Note that pro gressive s can vide o is on ly output from the component vide o jacks. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 35 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 36 En Language settings HDMI Resolution* (See Connecting using HDMI on page 41.) * Default cha n ges with TV format (PAL/N TSC). 1920x1080p Set if your TV supports 1920 x 1080 pixel progressive-scan video. 1920x1080i Set if your TV supports 1920 x 1080 pi xel interlace video. 1280x720p Set if your TV supports 1280 x 720 pixel progressive-scan v ideo. 720x480p (NTSC)/ 720x576p (PAL) Set if your TV supports 720 x 480 (NTS C)/720 x 576 (PAL) pixel progressive-scan video. 720x480i (NTSC)/ 720x576i (PAL) Set if your TV supports 720 x 480 (NTS C)/720 x 576 (PAL) pixel interlace video. HDMI Color* (See Connecting using HDMI on page 41.) * Default changes dependin g on device connected. Full range RGB If colors are weak, this gives br ighter colors and deeper black (default setting for HDMI-compatible DVI devices). RGB Use this setting if colors appear over ly rich on the Full Range RGB setting. Component Outputs 8-bit component video format (default setting for HDMI-compatible devices). Setting Opt ion Wh at it means Audio Language E n glish If there is an English soundtrac k on the disc, it is played. Languages as displayed If there is a language selected on the disc, it is played. Othe r Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see Using the language code list on page 57). Subtitle Language English If there are English subtitles on the disc they are displaye d. Languages as displayed The subtitle language sele cted on the disc is displayed. Othe r Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see Using the language code list on page 57). DVD Menu Language w/Subtitle La ng. DVD disc menus are displayed in the same language as your selected subtitle language, if possible. Languages as displayed DVD menus are displayed in the selec ted language, if possible. Othe r Language Select to choose a language other than the ones displayed (see Using the language code list on page 57). Subtitle Display On Subtitles are displayed in your selected subtitle language. Off Subtitles are always off by defa ult when you play a DVD disc. Setting Opt ion Wh at it means HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 36 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 37 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Display settings Options settings Speakers settings Parental Lock ⢠Default level: Off ; Default password: none ; Default Coun try/Area code: us (2119) To give you some control ov er what your children watch on your DVD player, some DVD- Video discs feature a Parent al Lock level. If your player is set to a lower level than the disc, the disc wonâÂÂt play. Some discs also supp ort the Country/Area Code feature. The player does not play certain scenes on these discs, depending on th e Country/Area Code yo u set. Registering a new passw ord Register a password to change the Parental Lock level or enter a Country/Area code. 1 1 Select âÂÂPasswordâÂÂ. 2 Use the number butt ons to input a fo ur- digit password then press ENTER . Changing your password To change your password, confirm your existing password then enter a new one. 1 Select âÂÂPassword ChangeâÂÂ, input your existing password, then press ENTER . 2 Enter a new password and press ENTER . Setting Option What it means OSD Language English On-screen displays ar e shown in English. Languages as displayed On-screen displays are shown in the language selected. Angle Indicator On A camera ic on is displayed on-screen during multi-angle scenes on a DVD disc. Off No multi-angle indication is shown. Setting Option What it means Parent al Lock â See Parental Lock below. DivX(R) VOD Display See About DivX î VOD content below. Setting Option What it means Speaker Dista nce â Specify th e distanc e of your sp eakers from your list ening position (see Speaker Distance on page 39). Note 1 ⢠Not all discs use Parental Lock, and will play without requiring the password first. ⢠If you forget your password, youâÂÂll need to reset the player to register a new password (see Res etting the system on page 57). Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD Passw ord Level Change Country Code Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 37 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 38 En Setting/changing the Parent al Lock 1 Select âÂÂLevel ChangeâÂÂ. 2 Use number buttons to ent er your password, then press ENTER . 3 Select a new lev el and press ENTER . ⢠Press ï« repeatedly to l ock more levels (more discs will require the password); press ï¬ to u nlock levels. You canâÂÂt lock level 1. Setting/changing the Country/Area code You can f ind the Country/Area code list on page 58. 1 Select âÂÂCountry Co deâÂÂ, input yo ur password, then press ENTER . 2 Select a Country/Area code then press ENTER . There are two ways yo u can do this: ⢠Select by code let ter: Use ï©/ïª to change the Country/Area code. ⢠Select by code number: Press ï¬ then use the number buttons to enter the four-digit Country/Area code. The new Country/Area code takes effect after ejecting the disc once. About DivX î VOD content In order to play DivX VOD (video on demand) content on this pla yer, you first need to register the player with your DivX VO D content provider. You do this by generating a DivX VOD registration code, which you submit to you r provider. 1 Important ⢠DivX VOD content is protected by a DRM (Digital Rights Management) sy stem. This restricts playback of content to specific, registered devices. ⢠If you load a disc tha t contains DivX VOD content not authorized for your pla yer, the message Authorization Error is displayed and the content will not play. Displaying your Di vX VOD registration code 1 Press HOM E MENU and sele ct âÂÂInitial SettingsâÂÂ. 2 Select âÂÂOptio nsâÂÂ, then âÂÂDivX (R) VODâÂÂ. 3 Select âÂÂDispl ayâÂÂ. Your eight-digit registrati on code is displayed. Make a note of the code as you will need it when you register with a D ivX VOD provider. Playing Di vX î VOD content Some DivX VOD con tent may only be playable for a fixed nu mber of times . When you load a disc containing th is type of DivX VOD content, the remainin g numbe r of plays i s shown on-s creen and you then have the option of playing the disc (thereby using up one of the remaini ng plays), or stopping. If you lo ad a disc that contains exp ired DivX VOD content (for exa mple, content that has zero remain ing pl ays), the message Rental Expired is displayed. If your DivX VOD content allows an un limited number of plays, th en you may load th e disc into your player and pla y the content as often as you like , and no message will be displayed. Note 1 Resetting the player (as described in Resetting th e system on page 57) will not cause you to lose your registration code. Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Display Initial Settings Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 38 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Initial Settings menu 10 39 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Speaker D istance â¢D e f a u l t s e t t i n g : 3.0m To get the best surround sound from your system, you should set up the speakers equal distances from your listening position. 1 Press HOME MENU and select âÂÂInitial SettingsâÂÂ. 2 Select â Speaker sâÂÂ, then âÂÂSpe aker Distance âÂÂ. 3U s e ï©/ïª to select a speak er. 4P r e s s ï¬ to change the speaker distance for the highlighted speaker. 5U s e ï©/ïª to change the distance. ⢠When you change the distance settings of the front left ( L ) or front right (R ) speake rs, all the other speaker distances ch ange relative to it. â¢F r o n t l e f t / r i g h t ( L / R ) speaker di stances ca n be set from 30 cm to 9 m in 30 cm increments. 1 ⢠The center speaker ( C ) can be set from âÂÂ2.1 m to 0 m relative to the front left/right speakers. ⢠Surround left/right ( SL /SR ) speakers can be set from âÂÂ6.0 m to 0 m relative to the front left/right speakers. 2 â¢T h e s u b w o o f e r ( SW ) c a n b e s e t f r o m â 2 . 1 m to 0 m relative to th e front left/right speakers. 6P r e s s ï« to go back to the speaker list if you want to modify a nother speaker, or press ENTER to exit the Speaker Distance screen. Note 1T h e L and R speakers are paired; you canâÂÂt set them differently. 2 Make sure to set them the same distance when using the Ex tr a Power mode (page 23). Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Speaker Distance Initial Settings Video Output Language Display Options Speakers L C R SR SL SW 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 39 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 40 En Chapter 11 Other connections Important ⢠When making or changing co nnections on th e rear panel of this unit, be sure to switch power off and disconnect the power cord from the wall socket. After completing all c onnections, connec t the power cord to the wall socket. Connecting auxiliary audio components Using the stereo analog inputs, you can connect an external c omponent su ch as a tape deck or MD player f or playback through this system. For the connection diagram , see 1 above. ⢠Connect the ANALOG AU DIO IN ( LINE 1) jacks to the analog outputs of an external playback component. Connec t using RCA pin- plug stereo cables. AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R L R FRONT CENTER R SURROUND SUB WOOFER A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP Y P B P R ADAPTER PORT VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO 5 m to 6 m From audio output From audio output To HDMI input To component input P AL connecto r Outdoo r antenna Indoo r antenna (vinyl-coated wi re) Bluetooth î ADAPTER KURO LINK -com p atible P ionee r flat sc reen TV Ta p e deck, etc. TV AM loo p antenna 11_Other con nections.fm 40 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¥ã 水æÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 41 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Connecting usin g the component video out put If your TV has component vi deo inputs, y ou can use these ins tead of the sta ndard video outputs for a better quality picture. 1 For the connection diagr am, see 2 on page 40. ⢠Use a compo nent video cable to connect the COMPONEN T VIDEO OUT to a set of component inputs on you r TV. About progressive scan video Compared to interlace video, progressive scan video effectively doubles the scanning rate of the picture, resulting in a very stable, flicker- free image. Progressive scan video is available only from the co mponent video output. Compatibility of this player with progressive-scan and high-definition TVs. ⢠This player is compatible wit h progressive video Macro Vision System Copy Guard. 2 Connecting usin g HDMI If you have a HDM I or DVI (with HDCP) equipped monitor or display, you can co nnect it to this player usin g a commercially ava ilable HDMI cable for high quality digital video. 3 For the connection diagr am, see 3 on page 40. ⢠Use an HDMI cable to connect the HDMI OUT inte rconnect on this player to an HDMI interconnect on a HDMI-compatible display. ⢠The arrow on the cable con nector body should be face down for correct alignment with the connecto r on the player. You can also adjust the HDMI se ttings for resolution and color. F or more on these settings s ee Video Output settings on page 35. Switching the HDMI audio setting You can sele ct the system speaker o r the TV through t he HDMI to output the audio sound of the DVD/CD or USB fu nction. 4 You cannot use a number of sound func ti ons of this system when HDMI audio is set to TV . 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select HDMI SET then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose HDMI MODE then press ENTER . 4U s e ï©/ïª to choose the setting you want then press ENTER . ⢠AMP â Output Audio sound of th e DVD/CD and USB function signal from this system. Note 1 ⢠The component video outp ut is switchab le between interlaced and progressive formats. See Video Output settings on page 35. ⢠While the player is connected using HDMI cable, the component video output cannot be switched between Interlace and Progressive formats. When H DMI Resolution is set to 720x480i (NTSC)/720x5 76i (PAL) , Interlace format is automatically selected, and Progressive format is automatically selected in other settings. 2 Consumers should note that not all high-definition televisi on sets are fully compatible with this product and may cause artifacts to be displayed in the picture. In case of 525 progressi ve scan picture problems, it is recommended that the user swi tch the connection to the âÂÂstandard definitionâ output (Interlace). If there are questions regarding our TV set compatibility with this model, please contact our customer service center. 3 ⢠An HDMI connection can only be made with DVI-equipped components compatible with both DVI and High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP). If you choose to connect to a DVI connect or, you will need a separate adaptor (DVI ï¤ HD MI) to do so. A DVI connectio n, however, does not support audi o signa ls. Cons ult your local au dio dealer for more informa t ion. ⢠Depending on the component you have connected, using a DV I con nection may result in unreliable signal transfers. ⢠When you change the component connected to the HDMI output , you will also need to change the HDMI settings to match the new component (see Video Output settings on page 35 to do this). 4 It is not possible to switch this setting when KURO LINK setti ng is ON and flat screen TV is in synchronized amp mode. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 41 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 42 En ⢠TV â Output Audio sound of the DVD/CD and USB func tion signal fro m a TV or flat screen TV. 1 Resetting the HDMI co nnection If you get an error message (the d isplay shows HDMI ERR ) or if the screen goes blank (for example, after changin g the resolution), check the troubleshooting guide o n page 53. If this doesnâÂÂt solve the problem, follo w the steps below to reset the HDMI connection. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select INITIAL then pr ess ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose HDMIINIT then press ENTER . 4P r e s s ENTER while INIT O K is blinking. The system will restart and the HDMI settings are automa tically reset to the fact ory defaults. See Video Output settings on page 35 for more on thes e setting s. About HDMI HDMI (High Definition Multimedia Interface) supports bo th video and audi o on a single digital connection for use with DVD players, DTV, set-top boxes, and other AV devices. HDMI was developed to provide the technologies of High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection (HDCP) as well as Digital Visual Interface (DVI) in one specification. HDCP is used to protect digital content transmitte d and received by DVI- compliant displays. HDMI has the capability to support standard, enhanced, or high-defin ition video plus standar d to multichanne l surround-soun d audio. HDMI features include unco mpressed digital video, a bandwidth of up to fi ve gigabytes per second (with HDTV signal s), one connector (instead of several cables and connectors), and commun ication between th e AV source and AV devices suc h as DTVs. HDMI, the HDM I logo and High-De finition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trad emarks of HDMI Lice nsing, LLC. Connecting external antenn as For an external AM antenna, use 5 m to 6 m of vinyl-insulated wire and set up either indoors or outdoors. Leave the loop anten na connected. Only use the included AM loop antenna. For an external FM a ntenna, use a PAL connector to hook up an externa l FM antenna. For the connection dia gram, see 4 on pa ge 40. Blue tooth î ADAPTER for Wireless Enjoyment of Music HTZ280/282DVD- AP models only Wireless music play When the Blue tooth ADA PTER (Pioneer Mode l No. AS-B T100) is conn ected to t his unit, a product equipped with Bluetooth wireless technology (portable cell phone, digi tal music player, etc.) can be used to listen to music wirelessly. 2 Also, by using a commercia lly availa ble transmitter supporting Bluetooth wireless technology, you can listen to musi c on a device not equipped with Bluetooth wireless technology. The AS-BT100 model supports SCMS- T contents protecti on, so mu sic can also be enjoyed on devices equipped with SCMS-T t ype Bluetooth wireless t echnology. Note 1 This mak es it possible to use the TVâÂÂs built-in speake rs to listen to the audio input from a DVD or USB device. Audio output from the HDMI termin al is 2 channel linear PCM only. In this event, no so und will be heard from this unitâÂÂs spea kers (or headphones) . All other audi o sources (includi ng TUNER ) are output from this un it normally. 2 It may be necessary th at the Bluetooth wireless technology enabled device supports A2DP profiles. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 42 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 43 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Remote cont rol operatio n The remote control supplied with this system allows you to play and st op media, and perform other operation s. 1 Connecting Optional Bluetooth ADAPTE R 1 Switch the system into standby and connect Bluetooth ADAPTER to the ADAPTER PORT located in the rear panel. For the connection diagr am, see 5 on page 40. 2P r e s s ïµ STANDBY/O N . 3P r e s s ADAPTER PORT and to switch to BT AUDIO input mode. 2 Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTE R and Bluetooth wireless technology device âÂÂPairingâ m ust be done befo re you start playback of Bluetooth wireless t echnology content u sing Bluetooth ADAPTE R. Make sure to perform pa iring first time you operate the system or any time pa iring data is cleared. âÂÂPairingâ is the step necessary to register Bluetooth wireless technology d evice to enable Bluetooth communications. 3 For more details, see also the operating instructio ns of your Bluetooth wi reless technology device. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP to select BT SETUP , then press ENTER . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select PAIRING , then press ENTER . 3 Select the PIN code to be used from 0000/ 1234/8888 using ï©/ïª , then press ENTER. PAIRING blinks. CAUTION ⢠You can use any of 0000 /1234/8888 PIN codes. Blueto oth wireless technology device using any other PIN code cannot be used with this system. 4 Switch on the Bluetooth wireless technology device that you want to make pairing, place it near the system and set it into the pairing m ode. Note 1 ⢠It may be necessary that the Bl uetooth wireless technology enabled device supports A VRCP profiles. ⢠Remote control operations cannot be guaranteed for all Bl uetooth wireless technology enabled devices. Music data This unit Bluetooth î ADAPTER Remote cont rol o pe ration Bluetooth wi reless technology enabled device: cell phone Bluetooth wi reless technology enabled device: Digital music p layer Device not equi pped with Bluetooth wi reless technology : Digital music p layer Bluetooth audio t ransmitte r (sold comme rcially) 2 When the Blue tooth ADAPTER is not plugged in the ADAPTER PORT , BT AUDIO input mode cannot be entered even if ADAPTER PORT is pressed. 3 ⢠Pairing is required when you first use Bluetooth wireless t echnology device and Bluetoo th ADAPTER. ⢠To enable Bl uetooth communication, pairing should be done with both of your system and Bl uetooth wireless technology device. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 43 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Other connections 11 44 En 5 Check to see that the Bluetooth ADAPTER is detected by the Bluetooth wireles s technology device. When the Bluetooth wireless technology device detects the Bl uetooth ADAPTER, the adapterâÂÂs identification âÂÂAS-BT100â appea rs in the Bluetooth wireless techno logy device list. 1 6F r o m t h e Bluetooth wireless technology device list, select Bluetooth ADAPTER and enter the PIN code selected in the step 3. 2 Listening to Music Contents of Bluetooth wireless technology device with Your System 1P r e s s ADAPTER PORT and to switch to BT AUDIO input mode. 2 Connect th e Bluetooth wireless technology device to the Bluetooth ADAPTER. When Bluetooth wire less technology device i s connected: Bluetoot h wireless techno logy device name appears in the system display. 3 When Bluetooth wire less technology device i s not connected: NODEVICE appears in the system display. 3 Start playback of music contents stored in Bluetooth wireless technology device. The following o perations are now possible for Bluetoot h wireless technology devices, using the button at the top of the system and remote controller. 4 Clearing Pairing 5 1 Press SHIFT SETUP , select BT SETUP , then press ENTER . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t PAIR C LR , then press ENTER . 3 When CLR OK appears, press ENTER . The Bluetooth î word mark and logos are registered trademarks o wned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and any use of such m arks by Pioneer Corporation is un der license. Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners. Note 1 When a Bluetooth wireless technology device does not appear in th e list of detected devices or has no display, the Bluetooth wireless technology device list does not a ppear. In some cases, you may pair the Bl uetooth ADAPTER and that Bluetooth wireless technology device by using the pairing mode. 2 PIN code may in some case be referred to as PA SSKEY. 3 The system can display alphanumeric character s on ly. Other characters may not be displayed correctly. Button What it does ï¤/ïÂÂ¥ (system) Starts normal playback and pauses/unpauses playback. 4⢠Bluetooth wireless technolog y device should be compatible with AVRCP profile. ⢠Depending on Bluetooth wireless technology device you use, operation may differ from what is shown in this table. ï¤ (remote control) Starts normal playback. ïÂÂ¥ (remote control) Pa u s e s p l a y b a c k . ï§ (system/ remote contro l) Stops playback. ï (remote control) P ress to start fast reverse scanning. ï® (remote control) P ress to start fast for ward scanning. ï¯ (remote control) Skips to the start of the current file, then previous files. ï° (remote control) Skips to the next file. 5 ⢠Clearing should be done with Blue tooth wireless technology device being d isconnected. ⢠When you connect Bluetooth wireless technology device again after clearing, repeat the pairing steps referring to Pairing Bluetooth ADAPTER an d Bluetooth wireless technology device on page 43. Button What it does HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 44 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
KURO LINK 12 45 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 12 KURO LINK Not applicable to th e HTZ18 0/181DVD models By connecting this un it to a KURO LINK- compatible Pioneer fl at screen TV with a HDMI cable, you can co ntrol this unit from the remote control of a conn ected flat screen TV, as well as have the conn ected flat screen TV automatically change inputs in response to operations carried ou t on this unit. In addition, when la nguage information is input from th e connected flat screen TV, this unitâÂÂs GUI display la nguage automa tically changes (only when playback is stopped and GUI screen is not displayed, with DVD/CD function onl y). Refer to the operating in structions for your flat screen TV for more in formation about which operations can be carried out by connec ting via HDMI cable. ⢠You cannot use this function with components tha t do not support K URO LINK. ⢠We cannot g uarantee this unit will w ork with KURO LINK-compatible com ponents other than those m ade by Pioneer. Making the KURO LINK connections You can u se synchron ized operati on for a connected flat sc reen TV. Be sure to connect the flat screen TVâÂÂs au dio cable to the audio inpu t of this uni t. For the connection diagr am, see 3 on page 40. ⢠KURO LINK may not operate properly if yo u do not use a High Speed HDM I cable. ⢠Co nnect the flat screen TV directly to this unit. Interr upting a di rect connecti on with other a mps or an A V converter (such as an HDMI switch) c an cause op erational err ors. Important ⢠When connectin g this system or changing connections, be sure to switch the power off and disconnect the power cord fr om the wall socket. After completing all connectio ns, connect the power cords to the wall socket. KURO LINK Set up You must adjust the settings of this unit as well as KURO LINK-compatible c o nnected components in order to make use of the KURO LINK function. For more in formation see the operating instructions f or each compo nent. Setting the KURO LINK mode Choose whether to set this unitâÂÂs KURO LINK function ON or OFF . You will need to set it to LINK ON to use the K URO LINK function. ⢠When using a TV that does not support the KURO LINK function, set this to LINK OFF . MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES HDMI cable HDMI cable HDMI input HDMI output HDMI input HDMI OUT Othe r am p s o r A V conve rte r This unit KURO LINK -com patible P ionee r flat sc reen TV HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 45 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
KURO LINK 12 46 En 1 Press SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select HDMI SET then press ENTER . 3 U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct KURO LINK , then press ENTER . 4 U s e ï©/ïª to select the setting th en press ENTER to confirm . ⢠LINK ON â Enables the KURO LINK function. ⢠LINK OFF â The KURO LINK is disabled. Synchronized op erations cannot be used. Before using synchronization Once you have finished all connections and settings, you must: 1 Put all compo nents into standby mode. 2 Turn the power ON for all compo nents, with the power for the flat screen TV being turned on last. 3 Choose DVD/CD and see i f video output displays properly on the screen or not. Synchronized amp mode The synchronized a mp mode can be set from the KURO LINK-comp atible TVâÂÂs remote control. See th e explanation below for operations in th e synchronized amp m ode. These functions are set from the TVâÂÂs menu screen. For more inf ormation, refer to the operating instructions of the KURO LINK- compatible TV. Synchronized amp mode operations When using the synchron ized amp mode, the KURO LINK-comp atible component connected to th is unit operates in sync as descri bed below . ⢠The unitâÂÂs volume can be set a nd the sound can be muted using the TVâÂÂs remote control. ⢠When the TVâÂÂs power is set to st andby, the unitâÂÂs power is also set to standby. (The unitâÂÂs power is automatically turned off when the TVâÂÂs power is turned off while a video DVD is being played on the unit. However, the unitâÂÂs power may not turn off automatically in some cases, for ex ample, if you are listening to a CD or radio and turn off the output device.) ⢠The unitâÂÂs input switches automa tically when the TVâÂÂs channel is switched. ⢠The synchronized amp mo de remains in effect even if the unitâÂÂs input is switche d to a function o ther than the DVD /CD. The operations below can also be used on Pioneer KURO LINK-compatible flat scree n TVs. ⢠When the unitâÂÂs volu me is adjusted or the sound is muted, the volume status is displayed on the flat screen TVâÂÂs screen. ⢠When the OSD langua ge is switched on the flat screen TV, th e unitâÂÂs lan guage setting also swi tches a ccordin gly. Canceling synchronized amp mode ⢠When the synchron ized amp mode is canceled, the unitâÂÂs power turns off if you were viewing a TV program on th e TV. ⢠When in the synch ronized amp m ode, the synchronized amp mode is canceled when the unitâ s power is turn ed off. To turn the sync hronized amp mode back on, sele ct the s ynchronized a mp mode using the TVâÂÂs remote control. ⢠When in the synch ronized amp m ode, the synchronized amp mode is canceled if an operat ion that prod uces sound fr om the TV is performed from the TVâÂÂs men u screen, etc. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 46 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 47 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Chapter 13 Additional information Disc/content format p layback compatibility This player is co mpatible with a wide range of disc types (media) and formats. Playab le discs will generally feature on e of the following logos on the disc and/or disc pack aging. Note however that some disc types, such as recordable CD and DVD, may be in an unplayable fo rmat. See the Disc compatibili ty table below for more information. ⢠This unit will play DVD R/ RW discs . ⢠is a trademark of FUJIFILM Corporation. ⢠is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo Licens ing Corpo ration. ⢠Also compatib le with KODAK Pic ture CD. This player su pports the IECâÂÂs Super VCD standard for su perior picture quality, dual soundtracks, and widescreen support. About DualDisc playback A DualDisc is a new two -sided disc, one side of which conta ins DVD content video, audio, etc. while the other side contains non -DVD content such as digital audio material. The non-DVD, audio side of the disc is not compliant with the CD Au dio specific ation and therefore may no t play. The DVD side of a D ualDisc plays in this product. DVD-Au dio content will not play. For more detailed information on the DualDisc specification, please refer to the disc manufacturer or disc retailer. Disc compatibility table DVD- Video DVD-R DVD-RW Video CD F ujicolo r CD Audio CD CD-R CD-RW Su pe r Video CD (Su pe r VCD) Media Compatible formats CD-R/-RW ⢠CD-Audio, Video C D/Super VCD, ISO 9660 C D-ROM* containing MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC, JPEG or DivX video/WMV files. * ISO 9660 Level 1 or 2 compliant. CD physical format: Mode1, Mode2 XA Form1. Romeo and Joliet file systems are both compatible. ⢠Multi-session playback: No ⢠Unfinalized disc pla yback: No DVD-R/-RW ⢠DVD - Video (Video mode), Video Record ing (VR)*, UDF Bridge DVD-ROM containing MP3, WMA, MPEG-4 AAC, JPEG or DivX video/WMV files. * Edit points may not play exactly as edited; screen may go momentarily blank at edited points. ⢠Multi Border playbac k: No ⢠Unfinalized playbac k: No PC-cre ated disc ⢠Discs recorded using a PC may not be playable du e to the setting of the software used to create the disc. In th ese instances, check the DVD-R /-RW or CD-R/-RW software manual or disc boxes for more on compatib ility. ⢠Discs recorded in packe t write mode are not compatible. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 47 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 48 En About DVD R/DVD RW compatibility Only DVD R/DVD RW discs recorded in âÂÂVideo Mode (DVD Video Mode)â which have been finalized, can be played back. However, some editing made during the recording may not be played back ac curately. About DivX DivX is a digital video format created by DivX, Inc. This player can play DivX videos recorded on DVDs, CDs, or USB storage devices. Keeping the same term inology as DVD- Video, individual DivX vi deo files are called âÂÂTit lesâÂÂ. DivX video comp atibility ⢠Plays DivX î video 1 ⢠File extensions: .avi a nd .divx (these must be used for the player to recognize DivX video files). Note that all files with the .avi extension are recogni zed as MPEG4, but not all of thes e are necessarily DivX vid eo files and therefore may not be playable on this player. Displaying DivX subtit le files The font sets listed belo w are ava ilable for Di vX external subtitle fil es. You can see the proper font set on-screen by setting the Subtitle Language (in Lang uage settings on page 36) to match the subtitle fil e. 2 Group 1: Albanian (sq), Basque (eu), Catalan (ca), Danish (da), Dutch (nl), English (en), Faroese (fo), Finnish (fi), French (fr), Ge rman (de), Icelandic (is), Irish (ga), Italian (it), Norwegian (no), Portuguese (pt), Rhaeto-Romanic (rm), Sco ttish (gd), Spanish (es), Swedish (sv) Group 2: Albanian (sq), Croatian (hr), Czech (cs), Hungarian (hu), Polish (pl), Romanian (ro), Slovak (sk), Slovenian (sl) Compresse d audio ⢠MPEG-1 Audio Layer 3 (MP3), Windows Media Audio (WMA), MPEG - 4 AAC ⢠Sampling ra tes: 32 kHz/44.1 kHz/ 48 kHz ⢠Bit-rates: Any (128 kbps or higher recommend ed) ⢠VBR (variable bit rate) MP3/WMA/ MPEG -4 AAC playback: No ⢠WMA lossless encoding: No ⢠DRM (Digital Rights Ma nagement) compatible: Y es (D RM-protected audio files will not play in this player .) ⢠File e xtensions: .mp3, .wma, .m4a (these must be used for the pl ayer to recognize MP3/WMA/MPEG-4 AAC files) ⢠File s tructure (may differ): Up to 299 folders on a disc; up to 648 fold ers and files (combi ned) within each f older JPEG file ⢠Baseline JPEG and EXIF 2.2* still image fi les up to a resolu tion of 3072 x 2048 *File format for digital still cameras ⢠Progressive JPEG compatible: No ⢠File extensions: .jpg ( must be used for the player to recognize JPEG files) ⢠File s tructur e (may d iffer): Up to 299 folders on a disc; up to 648 fold ers and files (combi ned) within each f older Media Compatible formats Note 1 Playback of .avi video files larger than 4 GB is not possible. 2 ⢠For external subtitle files the following subtitle format filename extensions are supported (please note that these files ar e not shown within the disc navigation menu): .srt, . sub, .ssa, .smi ⢠Some external subtitle files may be displayed incorrectly or not at all. ⢠The filename of the movie file has to be repeated at th e beginning of the filename for t he external subtitle file. ⢠The number of external subtitle files which can be switch ed for the same movie file is limited to a maximum of 10. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 48 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 49 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Group 3: Bulgarian (bg), Byelorussian (be), Maced onian (m k), Ru ssian (r u), Serb ian (sr), Ukrainian (uk) Group 4: Hebrew (iw), Yiddish (ji) Group 5: Turkish (tr) DivX î is a registered trademark of DivX, Inc., and is used unde r license. About WMV WMV is an acronym fo r Windows Media Video and refers to a video compression te chnology developed by Microsoft Corporation. WM V content can be encoded by using Windows Media Enc oder. ⢠This player is compat ible with WMV9 files that are encoded by using the Windows Media Encoder 9 Series, with .wm v as an extension. ⢠Compatible with size under 720 x 57 6 pixels/ 720 x 480 pixels. ⢠Advanced Prof ile is not s upported. ⢠DRM-protec ted video files will not play in this player. ⢠File extensions .wmv. ⢠Compatible with bit rate under 1 92 kbps. About MPEG-4 AAC Advanced Audio Coding (AAC) is at the core of the MPEG-4 AAC standard, which incorporates MPEG-2 AAC, forming the basis of the M PEG-4 audio compression technol o gy. The fi le format and extension used depend on the application used to encode th e AAC file. Thi s unit plays back AAC files encoded by iTunes î bearing the extensi on â .m4a âÂÂ. DR M-protected fi les will not play, and files encoded with some versions of iTunes î may not play, o r filenames may display incorrectly. Apple and iTun es are trademarks o f Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. About WMA This player can playbac k Windows Media Audio content. WMA is an acron ym for Windows Media Au dio and refers to an audio co mpression technolo gy developed by Microsoft Corporation. WMA content can be encoded by using Windows Media Player version 7.7.1, Win dows Media Player for Windows XP, or Windows Media Player 9 series. Windows Medi a is a trademark of Micros oft Corporation. This product inc ludes technology owned by Microsoft Co rporation and cannot be us ed or distribut ed without a license fr om Microsoft Licensing, Inc. Using and taki ng care of discs Handling discs Hold the disc by i ts edges when handling so as not to leave fingerprints , dirt or scratches on either side of the disc. Damaged or dirty disc s can aff ect playback perf ormance. If a disc becomes marked with fingerprints, dust, etc., clean using a soft, dry c l oth. Wipe lightl y from the ce nt er of the disc usin g straight stroke s. DonâÂÂt wipe the disc surface with circular strokes. If necessary, use a cloth soaked in a lcohol, or a commerciall y available C D/DVD cleaning kit to clean a disc more thoro ughly. Never use benzine, thinner or o ther cleaning agents such as those desi gned for cleaning vinyl r ecords. Storing discs Avoid leaving discs in excessively cold, humid, or hot environments (i ncluding un der direct sunlight). DonâÂÂt glu e paper or put stickers onto the disc, or use a pencil, ball-po int pen or other sharp-tipped writing in strument. These could all damage the disc. 13_Additional_in formation.fm 49 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂç«æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 50 En Discs to avoid Discs spin at high speed inside the player. If a disc is cracked, chipped, warped, or ot herwise damaged, donâÂÂt risk usin g it in your player â you could end up damaging the unit. This unit is desi gned for use with conve ntional, fully circular di scs only . Pioneer disclaims all liability arising in co nnection with t he use of shaped discs. DVD Video regions All DVD Video discs carry a region mark that indicates which regi on(s) of the world the di sc is compatib le with. You r DVD system a lso has a region mark (on the rear panel). Discs fro m incompati ble regions will not play in thi s player. Discs marked ALL play in any player. When you insert a disc tha t cannot be played on this player, on e of the following messages is displayed: Incompatib le disc regio n number CanâÂÂt play disc Installa tion and mainte nance Hints on installation We want you to enjo y using this system for years to come, so please be ar in mind the following p oints wh en choosing a location: Do... ï± Use in a well-ve ntilate d room. ï± Place on a solid, flat, level surfa ce, such as a table, shelf or stere o rack . DonâÂÂt... ï³ Use in a plac e exposed to h igh tempera tures or humidity, incl uding near radia tors and other heat-generating appliances. ï³ Place on a window sill or other place where the system will be exposed to direct sunlight. ï³ Use in an excess ively dusty or damp environment. ï³ Place directly on top of an amplifier, or other component in your stereo system that becomes hot in use . ï³ Use near a television or monitor as you may experience interference â especially if the television uses an in door antenna . ï³ Use in a kit chen or other r oom where th e system may be exposed to sm oke or steam. ï³ Use on a thick rug o r carpet, or cover wi th cloth â this may prevent prope r cooling of the system unit. ï³ Place on an unstable sur face, or one th at is not large enough to support all four of the system unitâÂÂs f eet. Cleaning the pickup lens The DVD playerâÂÂs lens should not beco me dirty in no r ma l u se , b ut if fo r s om e r ea so n it sh ou ld malfunction due to dust or dirt, consult your nearest Pioneer authorized serv ice center. Altho ugh lens cleaners are com mercially available, we do not recommend using them since some may damage the lens. Problems with condensation Condensation may form inside the player if it is brought in to a warm room from outsi de, or if the temperature of the room rises qu ickly. Although the condensation wonâÂÂt damage the player, it may temporaril y impair perf ormance. Leave it to adjust to the warmer temperature for about an hou r before switching on. Moving the system unit If you need to move the main unit, first rem ove a disc if thereâÂÂs one in the player, then pr ess ïµ STANDBY/ON on the front panel to turn the system off. Wait for -OFF- to disappear from the display, then unplug the power co rd. 1 Never lift or move the un it during playback â discs rotate at high speeds and may damage. Note 1 Unplugging the unit before -OFF- disappears from the display may cause the system to return to th e factory settings. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 50 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 51 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Screen sizes and disc formats DVD-Video discs com e in different screen aspects, ra nging from TV prog rams, which are generally 4:3, to CinemaScope widescr een movies 1 , with an aspect ratio of up to about 7:3. Televisions also come in different aspect ratios; âÂÂstandardâ 4:3 and widescreen 16:9. 2 Widescreen TV users If you have a widescreen TV, the TV Scre en setting (page 35) of th is player should be set to 16:9 (Wide) or 16:9 (Compressed) . When you watch discs reco rded in 4:3 format with th e 16:9 (W ide) setting, you can use the TV controls to select how the picture is presented. Your TV may offer various zoom and stretch options; see the i nstructions that came with your TV for details. Please note that some movie aspect ratios are wider than 16:9, so even though you have a widescreen TV, these discs will still play in a âÂÂletter boxâ style with black bars at th e top and bottom of the screen. Standard TV users If you have a standard TV, the TV Screen setting (page 35) of this player should be set to 4:3 (Letter Box) or 4:3 (Pan & Scan), depending on which you prefer. Please note that many widescreen discs override the playerâÂÂs setting so that the disc is shown in le tter box format reg ardless of the setting. TV system setting The defau lt setting of t his system i s AUTO , and unless you notice that th e picture is distorted when playing some discs, you should leave it set to AUTO . If you find picture distortion with some discs, set the TV system to match your country or regionâÂÂs system. However, this m ay restrict the kinds of disc you can watch. See the table for the kinds of discs com patible with each setting ( AUTO , PAL and NTSC ). 3 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select SYS SET then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose TV SYS then press ENTER . The TV system changes as follows: ⢠AUTO ï¤ NTSC ⢠NTSC ï¤ PAL ⢠PAL ï¤ AUTO Note 1 Many widescreen discs override the systemâÂÂs settings so that th e disc is shown in letterbox format regardless of the setting. 2U s i n g t h e 16:9 (W ide) or 16:9 (Compressed) setting with a standard 4:3 TV, or one of the 4:3 settings with a widescreen TV, will result in picture distortion. Set to 4:3 (Letter Box) , widescreen discs are shown with black bars top and bottom. Set to 4:3 (Pan & Scan) , widescreen discs are shown with the left and right sides cropped. Although the picture looks larger, you donâÂÂt actually see the wh ole picture. 3 Most models of the newly developed countdown PAL TV system detect 50 Hz (PAL)/60 Hz (NTSC) and automatically switch vertical amplitude, resulting in a display without vert ical shrinkage. However, in some cases, the image may app ear without color. If your PAL TV does not have a V-Hold cont rol, you may not be able to watch NTSC disc s beca u se of picture roll. If the TV has a V-Hold control, adjust it until the pictur e stops rolling. On some TVs, the picture may shrink vertically, leaving black bands at the top and bottom of the screen. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 51 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 52 En 4 Press ENTER while CHANGE is blinking. The system will automa tically enter standby mode, then turn on again. YouâÂÂll see the new TV system settin g in the displa y after seeing POWER ON . 1 Frequency step setting Not applicable to Saudi Arabia, Israel , South Africa, other middle e astern contries and duty free mo dels If you find that you canâÂÂt tune into stations successfully, the frequency step may n ot be suitable for your co untry/region. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose A M 9K/10K then press ENTER . 3U s e ï©/ïª to select AM 9K or AM 10K then press ENTER . Dimming the Di splay You can adjust the brightness of the text in the front pan el displa y. 1P r e s s SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select SYS SET then press ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to select DIMMER then press ENTER . This is sh own in the fr ont panel dis play. 4U s e ï©/ïª to select LIGHT or DARK t hen press ENTER . Setting the Key Lock You can disable the front panel butto ns by switching the Key Lock feature o n. 1 P ress SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t SYS SET then pr ess ENTER . 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to choose KEYLOCK then press ENTER . 4U s e ï©/ïª to select LOCK ON or LOCK OFF then press ENTER . Player setting Media T ype Format NTSC PAL AUTO DVD/Super VCD/ Video CD/DivX video/WMV NTSC NTSC PAL NTSC PAL NTSC PAL PAL CD/MP3/WMA/ MPEG-4 AAC/ JPEG/no disc â NTSC PAL NTSC or PAL Note 1 You have to switch the player into standby (press ïµ STANDBY/ON ) before each change. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 52 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 53 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Troubleshoot ing Incorrect opera tions are often mistaken f or troubl e an d malfunctions. If you think tha t there is something wrong with this compon ent, check the points below. Som etimes the trouble may lie in another componen t. Investigate the other components and electrical appliances being used. If the trouble cannot be re ctified even after exercising th e ch ecks listed below, ask your nearest Pioneer authorized service center or your de aler to carry o ut repair work. ⢠If the system does not operate normally due to external effects such as static electricit y, disconnect the plug from the outlet and in sert again to return to n ormal operat ing conditio ns. General Problem Remedy The power does not turn on, or switches off suddenly (an error message may be displaye d at startup ). ⢠Wait for one min ute be f ore switching back o n. ⢠Make sure there are no loose stra nds of wire touching the unit. This could cause the system to shut off au tomatically. ⢠Check that the speakers are co nnected correctly. ⢠Make sure the voltage of the mains po wer source is corre ct for the model. ⢠Try reducing th e volume level. ⢠If the problem persists, tak e it to your nearest Pioneer authorized servic e center or your dealer for servicing. No sound is o utput when a functio n is selecte d. ⢠If youâÂÂre using the li ne input, make sure the component is conn ected correctly (see Connecting auxiliary audio components on page 40). ⢠N o a ud io is ou tp ut fr om th e s pe ak er s con n ec te d to th i s u ni t i f HD M I a ud io mo de is set to TV (page 41). ⢠Press MUTE on the rem ote control to turn muting off. ⢠T urn up t he volume. No sound from surround or center speakers. ⢠Refer to Setting the channel levels on page 17 t o check the speaker levels. ⢠When TUNER , ADAPTER PORT or LINE is sel ected, you can only hear the source in stereo. Switch t he input source to DVD/CD or USB for mul tichannel sound. ⢠Check that you ha venâÂÂt selected the ST EREO mode (see Listening in su rround sound on page 22). ⢠Check if a microphone i s connected or not. ⢠Connect the speakers properly (see Basic connections on page 9). CanâÂÂt operate the remote control. ⢠Replace the batteries (see Putting the batteries in the remote control on page 15). ⢠Operate within 7 m, 30ð o f the remote sensor (see Using the remote control on page 16). ⢠Remove any obsta c les or operate f rom another position. ⢠Avoid exposin g the remote sensor on the front p anel to direct light. The microphone can âÂÂt be heard . ⢠Y ou are only using on e microphone and itâÂÂs plugge d into the MIC (SUB) jack. The MIC (SU B) jack can only be used if there is also a microphone plugged int o the MIC (MAIN) jack. ⢠Adjust th e MIC VOL /â . F eedback noise when mic is switched on. ⢠The mic is poin ting toward the speakers. Keep the mic poi nted away from the speakers. ⢠The mic rophone leve l is set too hi gh. T urn down t he mic control level. TRAYLOCK shows in the displ ay and the tray canâÂÂt be ejected. ⢠Press and ho ld ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE on the front panel for about eig ht seconds. The n the tray can be open ed/closed using ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE . HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 53 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 54 En DVD/CD/ Video CD play er Problem Remedy The disc is ejected automatical ly after loadin g. ⢠Clean the disc and al ign the disc properly in the disc guide. ⢠If the region nu mber on a DVD-video disc does not match the number on the player, the disc cannot be used (see DVD Video regions on page 50). In this instance, one of the following messages appears on screen: Incompatible disc region number / CanâÂÂt play disc . ⢠Allow t ime for any co ndensation inside the player to evapor a te. Avoid using the player near an air-con ditioning unit. Playback not p ossible. ⢠If the disc is lo aded upsi de do wn, reload the di sc with label s ide face up. Picture playback stops and buttons cannot b e used. ⢠Press ï§ (stop), the n ï¤ (play) to start playback again. ⢠Switch the power off once, then on again using the fron t panel ïµ STANDBY/ON button. Settings are canceled. ⢠When the power is cut, settings wil l be canceled. No picture/No color. ⢠Check that connect ions are correct and that plugs are inserted full y. ⢠Check th e manual of th e TV/monitor to make sure the settings are correct. ⢠If the Progressiv e setting is selected and you have use d component vide o cables to connect a TV that is not compatible with a progressive scan signal, you will not be able to s ee any picture at all. With yo ur TV connected usin g either the composite or S -video term inals, change th e Component Out se tting to Interlac e (see Video Output settings on page 35). Screen is stretched or aspect doesnâÂÂt change. ⢠The TV Screen setting is incorre ct. Set the TV Scree n option to m atch the TV / monitor youâÂÂre using ( see Video Ou tput settings on page 35). When recorded on a VCR or passed through an AV selector, there is disturbance in the playback picture. ⢠This syst em uses copy-p rotection tech nology whic h may pre vent recording o r cause picture problems whe n connected through a VCR or AV se lector. This is not a malfu nction. Picture disturb ance during playback or dark. ⢠This player is compat ible with Macro- Vision System copy guard. S ome discs include a copy prevention signal , and when th is typ e of disc is played back, stripes etc., may appear on some sect ions of the picture depen din g on the TV. This is not a malfu nction. ⢠Discs respond different ly to particular pl ay er functions. This may result in the screen becoming bl ack for a brief instant or shaking slightly whe n the function is executed. These problems are largel y due to differences between discs and disc content and are not malfunctions of this player. Noticeable diff erence in DVD and CD vo lume. ⢠DVDs and CDs use different reco rding methods. This is not a malf unction. CD-ROM dis c is not recognized. ⢠Make sure that t he CD-ROM was recorded using the ISO 9660 disc format . See Disc com patibilit y table on page 47 fo r more on disc co mpatibility. DVD-ROM disc is not recognized. ⢠Make sure that the DVD-ROM was record ed using the UDF bridge format. See Disc compatibility table on page 47 for mo re on disc compatibility . Files donâÂÂt show up in the Disc Navigator/P hoto Browser. ⢠The files on the d isc must be named with the correct file exte nsion: .mp3 for MP3 files; .wma for WMA files; .m4a for MPEG-4 AAC files; .jpg for JP EG f iles (upp er or lower-case is OK). S ee Disc com patibility table on page 47. CanâÂÂt pl ay WMA or MPEG-4 AAC files. ⢠The files were recorded us ing DRM (digital rights management). This i s not a malfu nction. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 54 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 55 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Tuner USB connection HDMI connection CanâÂÂt play W MV files. ⢠When the bit rate the fil e is more than 192 kbps, t he file cannot be played back. Problem Remedy Problem Remedy Conside rable noise in radio broadcast s. ⢠Connect the AM antenna (see B asic connections on page 9) and adjust the direction and posit ion for best reception. You may al so connect an additional i nternal or external AM antenna ( refer to Conn ecting external antennas on page 42). ⢠Fully extend the FM wire antenna, positi on for best reception, and secure to a wall. You may also connect an o utdoor FM antenna (see Connec ting external antennas on page 42). ⢠Turn off other eq uipment that may be causing th e noise or move it further away. ⢠The tuning i nterval is incorrect for your count ry or region. See Frequency st ep setting on page 5 2 to switch the tu ning interval . Auto tuning does not pick up some statio ns. ⢠The radio signal is weak. Auto tuning will only detect radio stati ons with a good signal. For more sensitive t uning, connect an outdoor antenna. Problem Remedy USB mass storage d evice is not recogn ized by the system. ⢠Make sure you have complet ely inserted the USB connector to th is unit. ⢠Check that the memory format i s FAT16 or FAT32. ⢠USB device s with an in ternal USB hu b are not supp orted. Files donâÂÂt show up in t he Navigator/Phot o Browser. ⢠The files must ha ve the correct file exte nsion: .mp3 for MP3 files; .wma for WMA files; .m4a for MPEG-4 AAC fi les; .jpg for JPEG files (u pper or lower-case is O K). ⢠Make sure the file permi ssion hasnâÂÂt been restricted (t hrough a password, etc.). CanâÂÂt play WM A or MPEG-4 AAC files. ⢠The files were recorded us ing DR M (digital rights ma nagement). This is not a malfunction. Problem Remedy No H DM I vi de o ou tp ut . ⢠Ma ke su re th at yo uâ ve se le ct ed th is pl ay er as th e HD MI in pu t i n t he se tt in gs fo r t he componen t youâÂÂre using (refer to the co mponentâÂÂs in struction man ual). ⢠Check that the HDMI cable is connected properly and isnâÂÂt damaged. ⢠Check that components connect ed using the HDMI interface are switched on and HDMI compatib le (componen ts must be compatible with bo th DVI and High Bandwi dth Digita l Conte nt Protec tion (HD CP)). ⢠Depending o n the component you have connected, u s ing a DVI connection may result in unreliable signal transfers. ⢠Make sure th e resolution o n this play er matches t hat of the com ponent yo u have connected using HDMI. See Video Output settings on page 35 to change the HDMI resolution. ⢠If the screen goes blank aft er changing the resolution, it means the re solution you selected is i ncompatible with your monito r. See Resetting the HDMI connection on page 42 to reset to the factory def aults. Color problems occur with your mo nitor after changing the HDMI Color setting (page 36). ⢠Depending o n the connected equipment, so me HDMI Color settings may cause the picture to be displayed incorrectly. In this case, us e the TVâÂÂs own video input settings to select RGB, if possible. Alternatively, revert to the pre vious HD MI Co lor setting. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 55 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 56 En Bluetooth connection Error Messages No picture or sound. ⢠If the problem still persi sts when connecting your HDMI component d irectly to your monitor, please consult the component or monitor manual or contact the manufacturer for support. No HDMI au dio output. ⢠See Switching the HDMI audio setting on page 41 to make sure that TV is selected. KURO LINK does not function. ⢠Verify that the HDMI ca ble is firmly connected. ⢠Make sure that this unitâÂÂs KURO LINK mode is set to LINK ON (page 45). ⢠Check whether the connected component supports KURO LI N K or not. Fo r more information refer to the operating manual of your flat screen TV. ⢠KURO LINK may not work properly if a SCART cable and an HDMI cable are connected simultaneously. Set KURO LINK mode to LINK OFF when connecti ng SCART and HDMI cables s imultaneously. Your TV automatically change inputs. ⢠The connected TV auto matically may change inputs i n response to this unit st ar ti ng pl ay ba ck DV D o r ha v in g th e GUI sc re en (e x. Di sc Na vi ga to r) dis p la yed , etc . I f you do not want yo ur TV to change inputs in this way, set this unit KURO LINK mode to LINK OFF (page 45). Problem Remedy Problem Remedy The Bluetooth wireless technology device cannot be connected or operated . Sound from the Bluetooth wireless technology device is not emitted or the sou nd is interrupted. ⢠Check that no object that e mits electromag netic waves in th e 2.4 GHz band (microwave oven, wire less LAN device or Bluetooth wireless techno logy appara tus) is near th e unit. If such an object is near the unit, set the unit far from it. Or, stop using the ob j ect emit ting the electromag netic waves. ⢠Check that the Blue tooth wireless tech nology devi ce is not too far f rom the unit and that obstructions are no t set between th e Bluetooth wireless tec hnology devi ce and the unit. S et the Bluetooth wireless technology device a nd the unit so that the distance between them is less than abou t 10 m and no obstructio ns exist betw een them. ⢠Check that the Blue tooth ADAPTER and the ADAPTER PORT of the unit ar e correctly connected. ⢠The Bluetooth wireless tec hnology device may not be set to the communication mode supporting the Bluetooth wireless technology . Che ck the setting of the Bluetooth wireless technology device . ⢠Check that pairing is correc t. The pairing settin g was deleted from this unit or the Bluetooth wireless technology device . Reset the pairing. ⢠Check th at the prof ile is correct. Use a Bluetooth wireless technology device that supports A2DP profile and AVRCP profile. Message Description EXTRAPWR ⢠You cannot adjust SFC modes, tone controls (bass, treble, and bass boost), MP3 Expander mode, Voice Enhancer mode when using Extra Power mode . CANNOT ⢠Operation is p rohibited because DVD/CD or U SB isnâÂÂt selected, or SHIFT KARAOKE , SHIFT ECHO , SH IFT ï or SHIFT ï has been pressed. ⢠Appears when DVD/CD is not selected and SHIFT USB REC is pressed. TRAYLOCK ⢠The tray lock is on. See General in Troubleshooting on page 53. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 56 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 57 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Resetting the system Use this procedure to reset all syst e m settings to the factory default. 1 With th e system o n, press SHIFT SETUP . 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to sele ct INITIAL t hen press ENTER. 3U s e ï«/ï¬ to selec t ALL INIT th en press ENTER . ⢠INIT OK is disp layed. 4 Press ENTER while INIT OK is blinkin g. 1 Using the language code list Some of the language options (see La nguage settings on page 36) allow you to set your preferred language from an y of the 136 languages in the Language code list below. 1 Select âÂÂOther LanguageâÂÂ. 2U s e ï«/ï¬ to select either a code letter or a code number . 3U s e ï©/ïª to se lec t a co de le tter or a code number. See the Language code list below for a complete list of la nguages and codes. STEREO ⢠STEREO appears w hen SURROUND or AUTO/STEREO is pressed in th e TUNER , LINE or ADAPTER PORT input mode. KEYLOCK ⢠The key lo ck is enabled. S ee Setting the Key Lock on page 52. USB ERR ⢠See Important in Using the USB interface on page 31 for more on this. HDMI ERR ⢠See HDMI connectio n above for troubleshooting tips. See also Res etting the HDMI connection on p age 42 if the pro blem persis ts. EEP ERR ⢠Cont act your Pioneer authorized service ce nter or your dealer for servicing. EXIT ⢠Appears when any prohibited si gnal is input or the headphones are connected while the m enu screen i s displayed, an d then the di splay returns to the normal display . NO MIC ⢠Appears when you press SHIFT KARAOKE , SHIFT ECHO , SHIFT ï , SH IFT ï or MIC VOL /â when no mic is inserted. OC ERR 1 OC ERR 2 ⢠Check whether the speaker cab l es are short-ci rcuited. If the error message continues to be displayed , contact your Pioneer authorized service cen ter or your dealer for servicing. OVER TEMP ⢠Try lowering the v olume. If this problem is not fixed by removing and inserting the power cabl e, this unit may be damaged. In s uch an event, please contact a Pi oneer- authorized service cent er or your nearest dealer. BT ERR ⢠Power consumption by Bluet ooth ADAPTER is too high to supply the po wer. Reconnect the Blue tooth ADAPTER. TV AUDIO ⢠Indicator is l it for two seconds if the listening mode is changed while HDMI audio mode is set f or TV. KARAOKE ⢠Appears when you press SURROUND , SOUND , AUTO/ST EREO or MP 3 EXP/ V.ENH when a mic is insert ed. PHONESI N ⢠Appears when you press SURROUND , SOUND , AUTO/STEREO or MP3 EXP/ V.ENH when a headphone is inserted . Message Descrip tion Note 1 Do not operate the unit without reason or pull the power cord because the sys t emâÂÂs power automatically turns on. HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 57 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 58 En Language code list Language (Language code letter), Language code Country/Area code list Country/Area, Country/Area co de , Country/Area code letter Japa nese (j a), 1001 English (en), 0514 French (fr), 0618 German (de), 0405 Italian (it), 0920 Spanish (es), 0519 Dutch (nl), 1412 Russian (ru), 1821 Chinese (zh), 2608 Korean (ko), 1115 Greek (el), 0512 Afar (aa), 0101 Abkhazian (ab), 010 2 Afrikaans (af), 0106 Amharic (am), 0113 Arabic (ar), 0118 Assamese (as), 0119 Aymara (ay), 012 5 Azerbaijani (az), 0126 Bashkir (ba), 0201 Byelorussian (be), 0205 Bulgarian (bg), 0207 Bihari (bh), 0208 Bislama (bi), 0209 Bengali (bn), 0214 Tibetan (bo), 0215 Breton (br), 0218 Catalan (ca), 0301 Corsican (co), 0315 Czech (cs), 0319 Welsh (cy), 0325 Danish (da), 0401 Bhutani (dz), 0426 Esperanto (eo), 0515 Estonian (et), 0520 Basq ue (e u), 0521 Persian (fa), 0601 Finnish (fi), 0609 Fiji (fj), 0610 Faroese (fo), 0615 Frisian (fy), 0625 Irish (ga), 0701 Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704 Galician (gl), 0712 Guarani (gn), 0714 Gujarati (gu), 0721 Hausa (ha), 0801 Hindi (hi), 0809 Croatian (hr), 0818 Hungarian (hu), 0821 Armenian (hy), 0825 Interlingua (ia), 0901 Interlingue (ie ), 0905 Inupiak (ik), 0911 Indonesian (in), 0914 Icelandic (is), 0919 Hebrew (iw), 0923 Yiddish (ji), 1009 Javanese (jw), 1023 Georgian (ka), 1101 Kazakh (kk), 1111 Greenl andic (kl), 1112 Cambodian (km), 1113 Kannada (kn), 1114 Kashmiri (ks), 1119 Kurdish (ku), 1121 Kirghiz (ky), 1125 Latin (la), 1201 Lingala (ln), 1214 Laothian (lo), 1215 Lithuanian (lt), 1220 Latvian (lv), 1222 Malagasy (mg), 1307 Maori (mi), 1309 Macedonian (mk), 1311 Malayalam (ml), 1312 Mongolian (mn), 1314 Moldavian (mo), 1315 Marathi (mr), 1318 Malay (ms), 1319 Maltese (mt), 1320 Burmese (my), 1325 Nauru (na), 1401 Nepali (ne), 1405 Norwegian (no), 1415 Oc cita n (oc), 1503 Oromo (om), 1513 Oriya (or), 1518 Panjabi (pa), 1601 Polish (pl), 1612 Pashto, Pushto (ps), 161 9 Portuguese (pt), 1620 Quechua (qu), 1721 Rhaeto-Romance (rm), 1813 Kirundi (rn), 1814 Romanian (ro), 1815 Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823 Sanskrit (sa), 1901 Sindhi (sd), 1904 Sangho (sg), 1907 Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908 Sinhalese (si), 1909 Slovak (sk), 1911 Slovenian (sl), 1912 Samoa n (sm), 1913 Shona (sn), 1914 Somali (so), 1915 Alba nian (s q), 1917 Serbian (sr), 1918 Siswati (ss), 1919 Sesotho (st), 1920 Sundanese (su), 1921 Swedish (sv), 1922 Swahili (sw), 1923 Tamil (ta), 2001 Telugu (te), 2005 Tajik (tg), 2007 Thai (th), 2008 Tigrinya (ti), 2009 Turkmen (tk), 2011 Tagalo g (tl), 2012 Setswana (tn), 2014 Tonga (to), 2015 Turkish (tr), 2018 Tsonga (ts), 2019 Tatar (tt ), 2020 Twi (tw), 2023 Ukrainian (uk), 2111 Urdu (ur), 2118 Uzbek (uz), 2126 Vietnam ese (v i), 2209 Volapük (vo), 2215 Wolof (wo), 2315 Xhosa (xh), 2408 Yoruba (yo), 2 515 Zulu (zu), 2621 A rgentina, 0118 , ar Australia, 0121, au Austria, 0120, at Belgium, 0205, be Brazil, 0218, br Canada, 0301, ca Chile, 0312, cl China, 0314, cn Denmark, 0411, dk Finland, 0609, fi France, 0618, fr Germany, 0405, de Hong Kong, 0811, hk India, 0914, in Indonesia , 0904, id Italy, 0920, it Japan, 1016 , jp Korea, Republic of, 1118, kr Malaysia, 1325, my Mexico, 1324, mx Netherlands, 1412, nl New Zealand, 1426, nz Norway, 1415, no Pakistan, 1611, pk Philippines, 1608, ph Portugal, 1620, pt Russian Federation, 1821, r u Singapore, 1907, sg Spain, 0519, es Switzerland, 0308, ch Sweden, 1905, se Taiwan, 2023, tw Thailand, 2008, th United Kingdom, 0702, gb United St ates of Americ a, 2119, us HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 58 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 59 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español Specifications ⢠Amplifier section RMS Power Output: Front, Center, Surround . . . 60 W per channel (1 kHz, 10 % T.H.D., 4 é ) Subwoofer . . . 60 W (100 Hz, 10 % T.H.D., 4 é ) ⢠Disc section Type . . . . . . . . D VD system, Video CD/Super VCD system and Compact Disc digital audio system ⢠FM tuner section Frequency range . . . . . . . . 8 7.5 MHz to 108 MHz Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 é , unbalanced ⢠AM tuner section Frequency range: Saudi Arabia, Israel, South Africa, other middle eastern contries and duty free models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz All other models With 9 kHz step . . . . . . . . 531 kHz to 1602 kHz With 10 kHz step . . . . . . . 530 kHz to 1700 kHz Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Loop antenna ⢠Miscellan eous Power requirements: Singapore, Indonesia, Hong Ko ng, Malaysia, Philippines models . . . . . . . . . . . . AC 220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz All other models . . . . . . . . . . . . AC 110 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz Power consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 W Power consumption in standby: For HTZ180/181DVD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W Others KURO LINK ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.73 W KURO LINK OFF. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W Dimensions . . . . . . . . 420 mm (W) x 62 mm (H) x 33 1 mm (D ) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 kg ⢠Accessories (DVD/CD receiver) Remote control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AA/R6 dry cell batter ies (to confirm system operation) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Video cable (yellow plugs) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AM loop antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 FM antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 Setup Guide Operating instructions (This document) S-DV180 Spe aker system ⢠Front speakers Enclosure . . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 105 mm (W) x 115 mm (H) x 114 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠Center speak er Enclosure . . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 115 mm (W) x 105 mm (H) x 114 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠Surround speaker Enclosure . . . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 105 mm (W) x 118 mm (H) x 114 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠Subwoofer Enclosure . . . . . . Bass-reflex flo or standing type System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Hz to 1 kHz Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 190 mm (W) x 360 mm (H) x 317 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠Accessories Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Mounting brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Screws (for mounting brackets) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 13_Additional_in formation.fm 59 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂæ°´æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 60 En S-DV585 Spe aker system ⢠Front/surround speakers Enclosure. . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .(magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensi ons . . . . . . . 96 mm (W) x 96 mm (H) x 96 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠Center speaker Enclosure. . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 W Dimensi ons . . . . . . . 96 mm (W) x 96 mm (H) x 96 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠Subwoofer Enclosure. . . . . Bass-reflex floorstanding type System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz to 1 kHz Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensi ons . . . . 230 mm (W) x 380 mm (H) x 360 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠Accessories Speaker cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Brackets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Mounting brackets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Screws (common use for brackets and mounting brackets) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 S-DV280T Spe aker sys tem ⢠Front speakers Enclosure . . . . Closed-box floorstanding type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .(magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-way system Speakers: Woofer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Tweeter . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm semi-dome type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 62 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . 260 mm (W) x 1097 mm (H) x 260 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠Center speaker Enclosure . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . 72 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W Dimensions . . . . . . 220 mm (W) x 90 mm (H) x 100 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg ⢠Surround speakers Enclosure . . . . . . . Closed-box bookshelf type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (magnetically shielded) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way system Speakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Hz to 20 kHz Maximum input power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensions . . . . . 100 mm (W) x 100 mm (H) x 100 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠Acce ssorie s Speaker cables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Non-skid pads (small) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Speaker stand bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Screws (for bases) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 S-DV2 82T Speaker system ⢠Front/surround speakers Same as S-DV280T Front speakers ( se e above ) ⢠Center speaker Same as S-DV280T Center speaker ( see above ) ⢠Acce ssorie s Speaker cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Speaker stand bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Screws (for bases) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 13_Additional_in formation.fm 60 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂæ°´æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
Additional information 13 61 En English Français Deutsch Nederlands Italiano Español S-DV5SW Speaker system â¢S u b w o o f e r Enclosure . . . . . . . Bass-reflex floorstanding type System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way system Speaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm cone type Impedance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é Frequency range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz to 1 kHz Maximum Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W Dimensions . . . . . . . 2 30 mm (W) x 380 mm (H) x 36 0 mm (D) Weight . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠Acce ssorie s Non-skid pads (large) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Note ⢠Specifications and design subject to possible modification wit hout notice, due to improvements. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. âÂÂDolbyâÂÂ, âÂÂPro Logicâ , and the double -D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #âÂÂs: 5,45 1,942; 5,956, 674; 5,974,380; 5 ,978,762; 6,487,53 5 & other U.S. and worl dwide patents issued & pending . DTS and DTS Digital Surround are registered trademarks and th e DTS logos and Symbol are trademarks of DTS, Inc. é 1996 -2008 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Published by Pioneer Corporation. Copyright é 20 09 Pioneer Corporation. All rights reserved. This product includes F ontAvenue î fonts licenced by NEC Corporation. F ontAvenue is a register ed trademark of NEC Corporation. This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is pr otected by method claims of certain U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights owned by Macrovision Corporation and other rights owners. Use of this copyright protection technology must be authorized by Macrovision Corporation, and is intended for home and other limited viewing uses only unless other wise authorized by Macrovision Corporation. Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited. DRM (digital rights management) copy protection is a technology designed to prevent unauthorized copying by restricting playback, etc. of compressed audio files on devices other than the PC (or other recording equipment) used to record it. F or detailed information, please see the instruction manuals or help files that came with your PC and/or software. 13_Additional_in formation.fm 61 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼ ï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¥ãÂÂæ°´æÂÂæÂÂ¥ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂæÂ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ
à ¹ÂáÂÂîÃÂÃÂòàá¡ÂáÂÂáµÃÂÃ Ã¶à ¶«á»ûãòè à ½ÂÃÂá¡ÃÂÃ¤à ®´ÃÂáÂÂñÃÂá±áÂÂà ¹Âà £»áÂ±à ¥¨à ¥Âá´ ÃÂÃ à ¹ÂáÂÂîÃÂÃÂÃ²à ®´Ã¥áÂÂáÂÂÃ à ¬±áÂ¬à ²ÂáµÃÂÃÂÃÂÃ à £ÂáÂÂÃÂûãòÃÂÃ¨à ½ÂÃÂà ±±à  £áÂ¡à ·§Ã²ÃÂà ¹Âá£àöááÂÂá‡ÂÂ÷ÃÂáÂÂÃ¼à ´ÂÃÂáÂÂá¬àááÂÂÃ Ã¨à ½ à £ÂáÂÂüáÂÂá‡áÂÂÃÂáÂÂý÷äñïáÂÂÃÂÃÂà ¤¨à ¥® ÃÂÃÂÃÂÿáÂÂüáÂÂá¬ÃÂÃ¨à ¼ÂÃÂáÂ¡Ã²à ¸ÂÃÂÃ¥àý áÂ±à ¦Âûãàá®ÃÂÃÂà ¤¸á°áÂ±à ¦ÂÃÂà ÂÂáÂÂáÂÂà ¹Âà ® à ½¿ áÂ±à ¦ÂÃ¢à ¦¸Ã à ¥¨à ¥ ÃÂÃÂàåáÂÂá¬àáá áÂÂýÃÂà »¡ D3-4-2-1-1_A1_Zhtw áÂÂñáÂÂá« áÂÂñáÂÂáÂ«à ¾¤à ¡ÂáÂ à ¾¢à ¡ÂàìöáèáÃÂáìôöáèÃÂìõòáéáÃÂáìúöáéàÃÂÃÂüùöáæà Âà  ÃÂÃ½à ®Âà ¼ÂÃ¿à  ÂÃÂàáÂÂÃ½Ã¶à ³¾à ¥´ÃÂÃÂà ³ÂÃÂá¹áÂªÃ¼à ¬¾à ¾¢à ¡ÂÃÂà »©ÃÂÃ£à §£ÃÂÃÂà ®½à ©© Ã Ã¢à ´ÂÃÂà ¾ÂÃÂÃ à µ ÃÂÃÂáÂÂÃÂá¡àD3-4-2-1-7c*_A1_Zhtw HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 2 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 3 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
4 Zhtw æÂÂè¬ÂæÂ¨è³¼è²·æÂŒÂ°å ÂéÂÂç¢åÂÂã è«Âå¾¹åºÂé±è®ÂæÂ¾ÂÂä½ÂæÂÂå ï¼Â以便æÂ£ç¢ºå°æÂÂä½ÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¢åÂÂãÂÂå¨æÂ¨é±è®Âå®ÂæÂ åÂÂå¾Âï¼Âè«Â妥çºä¿Â管以便å°Âä¾Âå èÂÂä¹Âç¨ã ç®é 01 æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 3 é» /2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 æºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 æÂÂæÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç¸åÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂå·¥ ä½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 HTZ280DVD/HTZ28 0DVD-AP/HTZ282DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP çÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂ工你. . . . . . . . . . . . 6 å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂ工你. . . 7 å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨çÂÂ丠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 å®Âè£Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 å é©ç¨æÂ¼å®Â裠HTZ180 /181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂç æÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âä¹Âå ¶ä»Â注æÂÂäºÂé  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 02 æÂ¥ç· åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 03 æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 Ã¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 顯示幠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 éÂÂæÂ§å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 å®Âè£ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é»池. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 éÂÂç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 04 éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 è¨Âç½®è²éÂÂé³é . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 使ç¨å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢ ï¼ OSD ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 åºæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶æÂ æÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD PBC é¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 èÂÂè½æÂ¶é³橠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 æÂ¹å FM æÂ¥æÂ¶ä¸Âè¯ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 æÂÂå¶ AM æÂ¥æÂ¶éÂÂ訠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 è¨ÂæÂ¶éÂȌ° . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 æÂ¶è½é Âè¨ÂéÂȌ° . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 èÂÂè½堶ä»Âä¾Â溠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 è¨Âç½®ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 05 èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 é¸åÂÂèÂÂè½模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 èªåÂÂèÂÂè½模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 以ç°ç¹Âè²èÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè² . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 以ç«Âé«Âè²èÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 以è³æ©ÂèÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 調æÂ´ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 使ç¨ SFC 模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 å éÂÂä½Âé³é³é . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 使ç¨ MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 使ç¨è²é³強åÂÂå¨模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 æÂÂæÂÂè²é³ ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂä½³è²é³@. . . . . . . . . . 24 06 ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 æ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 æ ¼é²ï¼Âæ ¼éÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂç 秠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂçÂÂ覽 DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 å¯å©ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ覽 Windows Media⢠Audi o (WMA) ã MP3ã MPEG-4 AAC ã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV å JPEG æªÂæ¡ . . . . . 27 使ç¨æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 製ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 èÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 渠餿ÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ段 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 使ç¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 使ç¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 建ç«Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯é¸å®ä¸Âå ¶ä»Âå¯ç¨ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ . . . . . . . . . 29 æÂÂç´¢ç¢Âç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼Âé³頻è² é . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 æÂ¾å¤§ç«é¢ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè§Â度 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 顯示ç¢ÂçÂÂè³Â訠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 4 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
5 Zhtw English Español 07 USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 使ç¨ USB ä»Âé¢ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 å¨ USB è£Âç½®ä¸ÂéÂÂ製é³樠CD çÂÂæÂ² ç® . . . . . . . 31 éÂÂ製æÂÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 éÂÂ製ç¹å®ÂæÂ²ç® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 08 å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 è®ÂæÂ´æ··è²æÂÂæÂ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 è®ÂæÂ´èÂÂæÂ¯é³樠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 09 é³頻è¨Âç½®åÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´é¸å® ãÂÂé³頻è¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 é³頻 DRC ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ§å¶@. . . . . . . . . . . . 34 ãÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´ãÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 10 ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 使ç¨ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 顯示å¹Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 é¸頠è¨Âå®Âå¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 æÂÂ人éÂÂå® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX î VOD 堧容 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 æÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 11 å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻è¨Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 使ç¨è²差è¦Â頻輸åºé£æÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 éÂÂæÂ¼éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé » . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ HDMI é³頻è¨Âç½®å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 éÂÂæÂ¼ HDMI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 ç¨æÂ¼ç¡ç·Â享åÂÂ鳿¨Âç Bluetooth î å³輸å¨ . . . 42 ç¡ç·Â鳿¨ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 éÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂÂä½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 é£æÂ¥é¸購ç Bluetooth å³輸å¨ . . . . . . . . . . 43 é Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å Blueto oth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ è£Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 使ç¨æÂ¨çÂÂ系統èÂÂè½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ç é³æ¨Â堧容 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 渠é¤é Âå° . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 12 KURO LINK 飿ÂÂ¥ KURO LINK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 KURO LINK è¨Âå® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 è¨Âå® KURO LINK 模张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 使ç¨åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂä¹Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂÂä½ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Ã¥ÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 13 å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Â堧容格å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¸容 æÂ§ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 éÂÂæÂ¼ DVD R/DVD RW ç¸容æÂ§ . . . . . . . . . . 48 éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 éÂÂæÂ¼ WMV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 éÂÂæÂ¼ MPEG-4 AAC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 éÂÂæÂ¼ WMA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ使ç¨åÂÂç¶Âè· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 DVD Video é©ç¨å°å . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 å®Âè£ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¿Â餠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 å®Âè£ÂæÂÂ示 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 渠æ½Âè®Â寫é ÂæÂ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 æ°´æ°£åÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 æÂŒÂÂ系統主橠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 ç«é¢大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ格张. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Â使ç¨è . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 æ¨ÂæºÂé»è¦Â使ç¨è . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 é»è¦Â系統è¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 é »çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âç½® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 調æÂÂ顯示å¹Â亮度 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂéµé @Key Lock ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 æÂ éÂÂæÂÂé¤ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 ä¸ÂèÂŒÂÂé¡ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 DVD/CD/VC D æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 調諧å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 USB 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Bluetoot h é£締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57 èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Ã¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼渠å® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 è¦Âæ ¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 5 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 01 6 Zhtw 第 1 ç« æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® è¦ÂæÂ¨æÂ¿éÂÂçÂÂ大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¹æÂ§èÂÂå®Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å¨堩種æÂ¹ å¼Âä¸Âé¸åÂÂå ¶ä¸Âä¾ÂæÂºè¨ÂæÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨以使ç¨æÂ¬ç³» çµ±ãÂÂéÂÂæÂ¼æÂÂè²å¨é Â置@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ãÂÂè¨Âå®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã ã 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ éÂÂæÂ¯ä¸Â種è½æÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂä½³ 5.1 è²éÂÂå®¶åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂ ç æ¨ÂæºÂå¤Âè²éÂÂç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂè² å¨è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¹å¼Âã 3 é» /2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ æÂ¤ç¨®è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¹å¼Âå¨ç¡æ³Âé²è¡Âå¾Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂºè¨ æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¨å¸ÂæÂÂè½é¿å Âå¨èÂÂè½åÂÂå §ä½Âè¨ÂéÂÂé·çÂÂæÂ è²å¨ç·ÂæÂÂï¼Âç¸ç¶çÂÂ實ç¨ ã æºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂÂæÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç¸åÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂå·¥ ä½ å®Âè£Â鲿»Â墠⢠å°Âå°ÂçÂÂ鲿»Âå¢Âè²¼å°æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂåºÂ座丠ã å å¡Â大çÂÂçÂÂ鲿»Âå¢ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Âè²¼ å°éÂÂä½Âé³ä¸Âã 使ç¨ ç¨é¨éÂÂçÂÂè 水尠3 å° 4 çÂÂ鲿»Âå¢Âè²¼å°æ¯Âå æÂ è²å¨çÂÂåºÂ座 ï¼Âå¹³å¦表é¢ï¼Âä¸Âã HTZ280DVD/HTZ280DVD- AP/ HTZ282DVD/HTZ282DVD-AP çÂÂæºÂå 工你5 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨å 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂºè¨Âç¸åÂÂï¼ çµÂè£ÂæÂÂè²å¨蠳æÂ¶ ⢠å©ç¨æÂÂéÂÂè´ÂçÂÂèº絲å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨åºÂ座å®Âè£Âå°æÂ¯ æÂ±ä¸Âã å°ÂæÂ£æÂ¯æÂ±åÂÂ庠座å¾Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ãÂÂè¨Âå®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂå°Âå° èº絲éÂÂå ¥åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèº絲åÂÂå § ã è«Â注æÂÂï¼ æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂæÂ åÂÂçÂÂè °ä¸Âè§Âå½¢çÂÂåºÂ座çÂÂæÂ¹åÂÂã 注æÂ â¢ è«Âå°Âå¿Âä¸Âè¦Âå°Âèº絲éÂÂ太 ç·Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂ太ç¨åÂÂéÂÂç·Âèº絲 ï¼ èº絲åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂèº帽çÂÂèº ç´Âå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂ壠ã 使ç¨ä¸ÂçÂÂ尺寸çÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèº 絲起 Ã¥ÂÂçµÂè£Âã â¢ è«Âå¿使ç¨å¯è½æÂÂå°Âèº絲åÂÂèº帽æÂ½å éÂÂ大å éÂÂçÂÂéÂȌÂÂèº絲起åÂÂæÂÂå°º 寸太大çÂÂèº絲起å ã â¢ çµÂè£ÂæÂ ï¼ ç¢ºèªÂæ²ÂæÂÂç°ç©é»Âå¨蠳æÂ¶åºÂ座æÂ é«Âç æÂÂè²å¨ä¸Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂçµÂè£ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ ï¼ è ³æÂ¶åºÂ座èÂÂé«ÂæÂÂè²å¨ä¹Âé å¡ä½Âç°ç© ï¼ åÂÂå¯è½ç¡æ³Âå®Âå ¨å°çµÂè£ÂæÂ¬æ© ï¼ å° è´æÂ¬æ©Âç¿»è¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂè½ã â¢ è«Âå¿ç«Âå¨é«ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨蠳æÂ¶åºÂ座ä¸ÂæÂ¨ Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã æÂÂè²å¨å¯è½æÂÂè½åÂÂ破裠@æÂÂå°Âè´人å¡åÂÂå·ãÂÂè«Â注 æÂÂå°Âå©ã åºå®ÂæÂ¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®èÂÂç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠使ç¨é¨éÂÂçÂÂå¡Âè é¤åºå®Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®èÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂ è²å¨ã å°Âå ©åÂÂæÂ¯æÂÂé¤éÂÂå ¥æÂÂè²å¨å¾Âé¢çÂÂçÂÂå£Â丠ã å°Âä¸Â梠ç²ÂçºÂç·Âç©¿éÂÂé¤åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¡Âè é¤ä¾Âåºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Â確宠å Â測試å®ÂæÂ¯å¦è½æÂ¯æÂÂæÂ è²å¨çÂÂéÂÂéÂÂï¼ ãÂÂå®Âè£Âå¾Â@確å®Âå·²ç¢ç¢åºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨ãÂ à ¼®á³áÂ à ®Âà ²ÂàᤠHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 6 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 01 7 Zhtw English Español English Español 注æÂ â¢ å¡Âè é¤ä¸ÂæÂ¯åºå®Âé Âä»¶ ï¼ èÂÂä¸Âä¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ使ç¨æÂ¤é¤ Ã¥ÂÂç´æÂ¥å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂå¨çÂÂå£Â丠ã ä¸Âå¾Â使ç¨çºÂç· ä¿ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂç©©å®Âã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼å ä¸Âç¶çµÂè£ÂãÂÂå® è£ÂãÂÂå®Âè£ÂæÂÂæÂÂ強度丠足 ã 誤ç¨æÂÂ天ç¶ç½害é æÂÂçÂÂä»» ä½ÂæÂÂ失æÂÂæÂ å£Âï¼Âå ÂéÂÂæ¦Âä¸ÂæÂÂè² ä»»ä½Â責任ã â¢ æÂ¾ç½®æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ ï¼ è«Â確å®Âå·²ç¢ç¢åºå®ÂæÂ¬æ© ï¼ ä¸¦é¿ å ÂæÂ¾ç½®å¨å¯è½å 天 ç¶ç½害 ï¼ ä¾Âå¦Âå°é ï¼Âè æÂÂè½並é æÂÂ人å¡åÂÂå·çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂ工你å ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨並使ç¨æÂÂæÂ¶åº宠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨èÂÂé¢çÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Â籤ä¸Â齿ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå©èÂÂå¥ç é¡Âè²æ¨Â示æÂÂ示ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂç §é¡Âè²æÂÂ示並æÂ£ç¢ºå®Âè£ÂæÂ è²å¨ã å¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ示å ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã 1 å¦Â以ä¸Âæ¯Âå¼µåÂÂçÂÂæÂÂ示 ï¼ å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¶å°Âé½ÂÃ¥ÂÂèªçÂÂä¸Âå´èÂÂä¸Âå´èº絲åÂÂï¼Âç¶å¾Âå® å ¨å°åºå®Âèº絲ã 4 é» /3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨é Â置@2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨é Â置@注æÂ â¢ é£æÂ¥æÂÂæÂ¶æÂ ï¼ ä¸Âå¯åÂÂ試æÂ¿èÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã éÂÂ樣 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂé æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶æÂÂ壠ï¼ÂæÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶åÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂÂè½æÂÂå°Âè´å®ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂå£ÂæÂ´ å å´éÂÂã å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨çÂÂ丠HTZ180DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç°繠æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂåºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ã HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½® ãÂÂä¸Âç½®åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂÂåºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ã HTZ280DVD/280D VD-AP æ©Âå çÂÂä¸Âç½®åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂåºå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂã HTZ282 DVD/ HTZ282DVD-AP æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂåªæÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂ åº宠åÂÂã å®Âè£Âå â¢ è«Âè¨Âå¾ÂæÂÂè²å¨å¾Âé @åÂÂæÂÂå ¶éÂÂéÂÂå¯å°Âè´èº絲 é¬Âè« ï¼ æÂÂçÂÂå£Âç¨æÂÂæÂÂå£Âé£以æÂ¯æÂ ï¼ èÂÂé æÂÂæÂ è²å¨æÂÂè½ ã è«Â確å®ÂæÂ¨è¦Âå®Âè£ÂçÂÂé£é¢çÂÂçÂÂ強度 足以æÂ¯æÂ´éÂÂäºÂæÂÂè²å¨ ã è«Âå¿å®Âè£Âå¨è åÂÂæÂ¿æÂ è»Â質çÂÂçÂÂå£Âä¸Âã éÂÂ註 1 使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âè« å¿çÂÂèµ·ç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂè²å¨ï¼ÂèÂÂæÂ¯å°Âå®Âå æÂ¾å¨åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ夠60 ð é¢åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨以åÂÂå¾ÂæÂ ä½³é³æÂÂãÂ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂá£ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÿá áÂ§Ã à ¤Âàâá 4 áÂÂû à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÿá áÂ£Ã ÃªÃ Ã¹Ã à ¤Âàâá 3 áÂÂû á ÃÂà ¡¿Ã±á¸ á¡áÂÂáÂÂá¡ á§àêàáÂ´à ¹ ÃÂà ¢ á ÃÂà ¡¿Ã±á¸ á¡áÂÂáÂÂá¡ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÿá á£àêàáÂ§Ã Ã¹Ã à ¤Âàá§àâá áÂ´à ¹ ÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂá£ à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂà ¢ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 7 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå 01 8 Zhtw ⢠å®Âè£Âèº絲æÂªé ã è«Â使ç¨é©åÂÂçÂÂå£ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå å¯ 以æÂ¯æÂÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂèº絲ã 注æÂ â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä¸Â確å®ÂçÂÂå£ÂçÂÂæÂÂ質 Ã¥ÂÂ強度 ï¼ è«Â洽詢尠æ¥Â人å¡çÂÂæÂÂè¦Âã â¢ å ÂéÂÂå°ÂæÂ¼å ä¸ÂæÂ£ç¢ºå®Âè£ÂæÂÂé æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂå¤ÂæÂÂæÂ å£Âï¼Âä¸Âæ¦Âä¸Âè² ä»»ä½Â責任ã å é©ç¨æÂ¼å®Â裠HTZ180/181 D VD æ©Âå çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶ ⢠å¨å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¶å®Âè£Âå°æÂÂè²å¨è é¢æÂ ï¼ è«Â確實åÂÂé å°Â鍿©ÂéÂÂè´ÂçÂÂèº絲ä¸Âç·Âåº å®Âã â¢ è«Âå¿å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¶å®Âè£Âå°ä¸Âç½®æÂ è²å¨ã æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âä¹Âå ¶ä»Â注æÂÂäºÂ頠⢠å°Â主è¦ÂçÂÂå·¦åÂÂç½®åÂÂå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨é» è¦Âæ©Âå ©å´åÂÂçÂÂçÂÂè·Âé¢丠ã â¢ 使ç¨ 5 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂæÂ ï¼ å°Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Â裠å¨ç¨Âé«ÂæÂ¼è³æÂ悮Â度çÂÂ你置以å¾Âå°æÂÂä½³æÂÂæÂ ã é Âé²äºÂ頠@⢠å°Âä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå¨é» è¦Âæ©Âä¸ÂæÂ¹æÂ ï¼ è«Â確實 ç¨è 帶æÂÂå ¶ä»Âé©ç¶çÂÂæÂ¹ æ³Âå°Âå ¶åº宠ã å¦å @æÂÂè²å¨å¯è½æÂÂå å°éÂÂçÂÂå¤ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèÂÂå¾Âé»覠æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂè½ ï¼ å±åÂÂé°è¿ÂçÂÂ人塿ÂÂé æÂÂæÂÂè² å¨æÂ å£Âã â¢ è«Â確å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂ裸é²çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ç·Âå·²æÂ²ç¹Âå¨ä¸Âèµ· 並å®Âå ¨æÂÂå ¥æÂÂè²å¨端å ã èÂ¥æÂÂä»»ä½Â裸é²çÂÂå° ç·Â碰觸å°èÂÂé¢æÂ¿ ï¼ åÂÂ黿ºÂå¯è½æÂÂå æÂ¤åÂÂæÂ·ä»¥ çÂÂå®Âå ¨ã â¢ æÂŒÂÂç½® ã ä¸Âç½® ã ç°ç¹ÂæÂ è²å¨åÂÂç¶ÂéÂÂé²ç£Âè ç ã ç¶è @éÂÂè¦Âå®Âè£Âä½Âç½®èÂÂå® ï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ å®Âè£Â太éÂÂé è¿Âé»è¦Âæ©Âç« é¢æÂ ï¼ ä»ÂæÂÂå¯è½ç¼ç è²彩失çÂÂçÂÂç¾象 ã å¦ÂæÂÂç¼çÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®æÂ å½¢ ï¼ è«Âå° é»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂï¼ 15 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂè³ 30 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂå¾ åÂÂæÂÂé ã å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âä»Âç¶åÂÂå¨ ï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂÂè²å¨宠è£Âå¨é é¢é»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂå°æÂ¹ ã â¢ éÂÂä½Âé³æÂªç¶Âé²ç£ÂèÂÂç @å æÂ¤ä¸Âå¯æÂºå¾Â太éÂÂé è¿Âé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂ顯示å¨ãÂÂç£ÂæÂ§å²åÂÂåªÂé« ï¼Âå¦Â磠ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂé³帶æÂÂéÂÂå½± 帶ç ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂºæÂ¾çÂÂä½Âç½® 亦ä¸ÂæÂÂ太éÂÂæÂ¥è¿ÂéÂÂä½Âé³ ã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½® ï¼ HTZ280/ 282DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âï¼Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Âå HTZ282DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä½Âé³ æÂÂè²å¨å®Â裠å¨çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂ天è±æÂ¿ä¸ ã å®ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂè½èÂÂ使人 Ã¥ÂÂå·ã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¾å¨ Ã¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨çÂÂä¸Âé¢ ï¼ å¦åÂÂæÂÂè½æÂÂå¯è½å°Âè´人 å¡åÂÂå· ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ280DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã 5 mm à7 mm ÿâáÂ´à ¹ ÃÂÃÂäà5 mm 10 mm áÂ´à ¹ÂÃÂáÂÂäàHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 8 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 9 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 2 ç« æÂ¥ç· åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ çºäºÂå¾Âå°æÂÂ好çÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼ è«Âå¦Âä¸ÂæÂÂ示è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ãÂÂå·¦åÂÂç½®åÂÂå³ Ã¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂ該ç¸è·Âç´ 1.8 m è³ 2.7 m ã ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨åÂÂè HTZ180DVD ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠å¨é£æÂ¥æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ è«Â確實尠黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂ並å¾ÂçÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座æÂÂä¸Âé» æºÂç·Âã å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âå¾ ï¼ è«Âå°Â黿ºÂç·Âé£æÂ¥è³çÂÂå£ÂæÂ åº§ä¸Âã è¦å â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼é¯誤çµÂè£ÂæÂÂå®Â裠ã çÂÂå£Âå®Âè£Â強度ä¸Âè¶³ ã å®Âè£Âåºå®Âé Âä»¶ï¼ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂ¿å±Âåº宠é Âä»¶ï¼ ãÂÂ使 ç¨é¯誤æÂÂ天ç¶ç½害é æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂ夠äºÂä»¶ ï¼ å ÂéÂÂ榠ä¸ÂæÂÂè² ä»»ä½Â責任ã 1 çµÂ裠AM ç°åÂÂ天ç·Âã a. å°Âè ³æÂ¶æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç®Âé ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¹åÂÂã b. æÂÂç°åÂÂ夾å°蠳æÂ¶ä¸Âã c. å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³åºå®Âå°çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Â表é¢ 丠@è«Âå¨å© ç¨èº絲å Âåºå®Âè ³æÂ¶ä¹Âå¾ ï¼ÂæÂÂ¥ èÂÂå·è¡ÂæÂ¥é© b ã 建è°æÂ¨å Âå©ç¨èº絲åºå®Âè ³æÂ¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¾Â決å®ÂæÂÂ¥ æÂ¶å¼·åº¦ã AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R Y P B P R L R FRONT CENTER L R SURROUND SUB WOOFER VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP âáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂùÃÂÃ Ã¢à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂà ¤ÂÃÂÃ Ã¿à  ÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂêÃÂÃ à ¥¨Ã´à ¥²à ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂà ¹ÂÃÂàÃÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂá§ÃÂàÿáÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠÃÂá£ÃÂÃ à ²°á ÂÃÂá áÂ¬à ºÂá¡ ÃÂà ºÂáÂÂá°ä FM ÃÂᤠAM áÂÂà  ¯ÃÂᤠᨠa ᨠb ᨠc HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 9 Friday, March 20, 2009 1 :03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 10 Zhtw 2 飿ÂÂ¥ AM å FM 天ç·Âã 1 a. è«ÂæÂÂé¤ AM 天ç·ÂéÂÂ屬ç·Âä¸ÂçÂÂä¿Âè·夠ç® ã é£æÂÂ¥ AM ç°åÂÂ天ç·ÂçÂÂæ¯Âè¡éÂÂ屬ç·Âè³åÂÂå AM 天 ç·Â端åÂÂä¸Âã 2 å¨åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ端åÂÂ丠@å°Âåºå®ÂçÂÂå¾Âä¸Âå£ÂæÂ é @ç¶徠æÂÂå ¥éÂÂ屬ç·Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂãÂÂé ä¸Âåºå®Âã b. æÂ FM 天締3 æÂÂé Âå£Âå ¥ FM 天ç·ÂæÂÂ座çÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂæÂÂ¥ 蠳堧ã 3-1 é£æÂ¥æ¯ÂåªæÂ è²å¨ã â¢ é£æÂ¥éÂÂ屬ç·Âè³æÂÂè²å¨ä¸Âã â¢ æÂÂè½Â並æÂ¯ä¸Âæ¯Âæ¢ÂéÂÂ屬ç·Â丠çÂÂä¿Âè·å¤Âç®ã â¢ å°Âé¡Âè²æ¨Â示ç·Âé Â好æ¨Â籤 ä¸ÂçÂÂé¡Âè²æÂÂ示 ï¼ ç¶徠å°Âé¡Âè²æ¨Â示ç·ÂæÂÂ堥素è² ï¼ ï¼Â端ï¼Âè å¦ 丠æ¢Âç·ÂæÂÂå ¥é»Âè² ï¼ âÂÂï¼Â端ã å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180DVD æ©Â種@é¸æÂ 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â侠砧以ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ¥é© a å° c ä¾ÂæÂ¾ç½®æÂ è²å¨ã a. æ¯ÂåªæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂåºÂ座è¦Âå°ÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ä¸ÂæÂ¹ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ§½è£Âä¸Âï¼Âå¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ示ã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠å°Â天ç·ÂæÂ¾ç½®å¨é é¢æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨æÂÂå ¶ ä»Âé£æÂ¥ç·ÂçÂÂä½Âç½®ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂ使ç¨æÂÂéÂÂ天 ç·ÂçÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ä¸Âè¯ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 20 é Âç æÂ¹å FM æÂ¥æÂ¶ä¸Âè¯ æÂÂ第 42 é Âç é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締ä¾ÂæÂ¹åÂÂã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âå®Âè£Âé¨é çÂÂç°形天ç·Â以å¤ÂçÂÂä»»ä½Â天ç·Âï¼ÂæÂÂå¦Â第 42 é ÂæÂÂè¿°çÂÂå¤Âé¨天ç·Âã 2 ⢠è«Âå¿è®Âå ¶æÂ¥è§¸å°éÂÂ屬ç©é«Â並é¿ å ÂæÂºå¨é»蠦ãÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Âé»氣è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé è¿Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¶é³æ©ÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ ä¸Âè¯ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å°Âæ¯Âæ¢Â天ç·ÂéÂÂ屬ç·ÂéÂÂæÂ°æÂÂå ¥ ç¸å°ÂçÂÂ端åÂÂå §æÂÂ坿ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¹åÂÂã â¢ çºäºÂè½æÂÂæÂÂä½³ç æÂ¥æÂ¶æ¢Âä»¶ï¼Âè«Âå¿尠AM ç°åÂÂ天ç·ÂéÂÂ屬ç·Âè§£éÂÂæÂÂå°Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂ´ Ã¥ÂÂç°åÂÂ天ç·Âã 3 欲確ä¿ÂæÂÂä½³çÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æ¢Âä»¶ï¼Âè«Â確實尠FM 天ç·Âå®Â堨伸å±ÂéÂÂä¾Âï¼Âä¸Âå¯æÂ²æÂ²æÂÂæÂ¸æÂ æÂ¼æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂå¾ÂæÂ¹ã 1 2 3 á ÃÂáÂÂñᤠÃÂà ´Âà ¯¦ÃÂà ¶µáÂÂá£àá ÃÂáÂÂÃ±à ¯¦á ÃÂà ´Âà ¯¦ÃÂà ¡¤à ¥®ÃÂÃÂá à ¼Âà(âÂÂ) á ÃÂáÂÂñá¤ à ¤Âà( ) HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 10 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 11 Zhtw English Español English Español b. åºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨ç·Âã å¨測å®ÂæÂÂè²å¨è½ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂçÂÂ鬠ç·Â度徠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鱿ÂÂ¥ ä¸Âä¾Âä¹ÂæÂ¥é©Âï¼ ï¼Âè«Âå©ç¨æÂÂæÂÂä¾ÂçÂÂå¹槽 ä¾Âåºå®ÂæÂ è²å¨ç·Âã c. å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨è½ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè¿ÂçÂÂçÂÂ壠@令ç®Âé Âå°Âé½Â以宠æÂÂæÂÂä½³ç ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ãÂÂè¨Âç½® ã éÂÂæÂ¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã 模å¼Âï¼Âè«Âè½Âå æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ 使åºÂ座ä¸Âç ï¢ ç®Âé Âè½å°Âé½ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ä¸Âç ï¡ ï¼ FRONT SURROUND ï¼Âç® é ÂãÂÂé æÂ¼ ã å 大 Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂã 模å¼Âï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢ ãÂÂå¦Âé æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã è ãÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂã 模张çÂÂ詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 ã 注æÂ â¢ çºäºÂé¿å Âç¼çÂÂæÂÂ夠@è«Â確å®Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¯æÂ£ 確åºå®ÂæÂ¼åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ä¹Âä¸Âã â¢ è«Âå¿å°ÂæÂÂè²å¨å®Âè£Âå°çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²å¨蠳æÂ¶ä¸ ä¾Âå®ÂæÂ 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©Â種@a. é£æÂ¥ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨æÂ ï¼Â以ç¸åÂÂæÂ¹æ³Âå° Y æÂ¥ç· å ©ç«¯é£æÂ¥è³堩åÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè² å¨ã é¸æÂÂç¨æÂÂæÂ¶çµÂè£Âç 4 é»ÂãÂÂ3 é»ÂæÂ 2 é»ÂæÂºè¨ÂæÂÂï¼ è«Âä¾Âç §ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ¥é© b ã b. å®ÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ ï¼ è«Âåºå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· ã å°Âé£ æÂ¥ç·Âåºå®Â卿ÂÂæÂ¶çÂÂæºÂ槽丠ã 3-2 é£æÂ¥æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ä¸ÂçÂÂæ¯Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨端åÂÂã â¢ é£æÂ¥å¦ä¸Â端è³æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ èÂÂé¢ä¸ÂæÂÂæ¨Â示é¡Âè²ç æÂÂè²å¨端åÂÂä¸ÂãÂÂ確å®Â已宠堨æÂÂå ¥ã æÂÂè²å¨æÂÂé Âå¨éÂÂ屬締端èÂÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ端åÂÂæÂÂ覠é£æÂ¥çÂÂæÂ¯ä¸ÂæÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂè² å¨端åÂÂä¾Â颿ÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ ä¸ÂãÂÂè«Â確實æÂ£ç¢ºå°é£æÂ¥ã Y à ´Âà ¯¦á¤ ÃÂÃȇ¡ ñàáÂÂàïàáÂÂàHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 11 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ¥ç· 02 12 Zhtw 注æÂ â¢ éÂÂäºÂæÂÂè²å¨端åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ帶æÂ å± éªé»壠ã çºé¿å Âå¨ é£æÂ¥æÂÂè«é¢æÂÂè²å¨ç·ÂæÂÂç¼ çÂÂéÂȾÂÂå±éª ï¼ å¨觸 æÂ¸ä»»ä½ÂæÂªçµÂç·£é¨åÂÂä¹Âå @è«Âå Âå°Â黿ºÂç·ÂæÂÂé  æÂÂé¢ã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Â鍿©ÂéÂÂè´Â以å¤ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬ç³» çµ±ä¸Âã â¢ è«Âå¿å°Âé¨éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥è³ä¸ÂæÂ¯é¨æÂ¬ç³»çµ± ä¸Âèµ·éÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤§å¨ ã é£æÂ¥è³堶ä»ÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤§å¨丠å¯è½æÂÂå°Âè´æÂ éÂÂæÂÂèµ·ç«ã â¢ é£æÂ¥æÂÂé Âå¾ ï¼ è¼ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥ç·Â以確å®Âé£æÂ¥ç·Â端 ç¢ ç¢é£æÂ¥è³端å ã é£æÂ¥ä¸Âè¯å¯è½é æÂÂéÂÂè¨Âå è² é³ä¸ÂæÂ·ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥ç·ÂçÂÂç·Âè·¯æÂ£å¥½é åº端åÂÂ夠@è®Âç·Âè·¯ äºÂç¸æÂ¥è§¸ ï¼ é æÂÂæÂ´å¤§å¨éÂÂ大çÂÂé¡Â夠負輠ã é 樣å¯è½å°Âè´æÂ´å¤§å¨åÂÂæÂ¢ä½ ç¨ ï¼ çÂÂè³å¯è½æÂÂ壠æÂ´å¤§å¨ã 4 å°Âå ¶ä¸Âä¸Â端é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂè¦Â頻輸堥 æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ è«Â使ç¨éÂÂè´ÂçÂÂè¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç· ã 5 å°Âå¦ä¸Â端é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ç è¦Â頻輸åºæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Âé ÂÃ¥ÂÂé²æÂ·æÂÂè¡ ã è«Âå¿使ç¨影é³é£æÂ¥ç·Âé éÂÂéÂÂæÂ¾å½±æ©Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé£æÂ¥è³ æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ© ï¼ å¦å æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂå½±åÂÂç¡æ³Âå¨æÂ¨çÂÂé» è¦Âæ©Âä¸ÂæÂ£å¸¸é¡¯ç¤º ã 6 é£æÂ¥é»æºÂç·Âã 1 â¢ é£æÂ¥é»æºÂç·Âè³æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ä¸Âç AC æÂÂ座 ã é£æÂ¥é» æºÂç·Âè³çÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座ã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠è«Âå¿使ç¨éÂÂé¨æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂéÂÂè´Âç 堶ä»Â黿ºÂç·Âã â¢ 鍿©ÂéÂÂè´ÂçÂÂé»溠ç·Âé¤äºÂé£æÂ¥æÂ¬ç³»çµ±å¤Âï¼Âè«Âå¿åÂÂå ¶ä»Âç¨éÂÂã AC IN àAC à ¶©à §µ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 12 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 13 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 3 ç« æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 Ã¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼Â第 17 ã 32 ã 43 ã 50 ã 52 以å 54 é Âï¼ 2 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE ï¼Â第 18 ã 32 以å 53 é Âï¼ 3 Ã¥ÂÂè½ 4 ï¦ 5 ï§ 6V O L U M E / â ï¼Â第 19 é Âï¼ 7 ç¢Âç¤ ï¼Â第 18 é Âï¼ 8 éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ ï¼Â第 15 é Âï¼ 9 顯示幠10 USB ä»Âé¢ ï¼Â第 31 é Âï¼ 11 MIC 輸堥æÂÂå ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ 12 PHONES æÂÂå ï¼Â第 23 é Â@顯示幠1 解碼æÂÂ示ç ï¼Â第 22 é Âï¼ DTS å¨ DTS ä¾ÂæºÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 2 PL II å¨ 2 Dolby Pro Logic II 解碼æÂÂ亮起 ï¼ 2 D 卿ÂÂæÂ¾ æÂÂæ¯ÂæÂ¸ä½Â鳿ºÂæÂÂ亮起ã 2P R G S V E ï¼Â第 41 é Âï¼ è²差影åÂÂ輸åº端åÂÂ輸åºéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¨ÂèÂÂæÂ ï¼Â便æÂ äº®èµ·ã 3S O U N D ï¼Â第 23 é Âï¼ SFC 模张ã é³調æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âé«Âé³ ã ä½Â鳿ÂÂéÂÂä½Âé³@ã MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨模张ã è²é³強åÂÂå¨模å¼Âèµ·åÂÂæÂ æÂÂ亮 èµ·ã 4F . S U R R . ï¼Â第 23 é Âï¼ é¸å ãÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂã 模å¼Âï¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã 模张æÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 5R P T å RPT-1 ï¼Â第 28 é Âï¼ RPT å¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé æÂÂ亮起ã RPT-1 å¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾å®æÂ²æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 6P G M ï¼Â第 27 以å 29 é Âï¼ æÂ¤çÂÂæÂ¼ç¯Âç®æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®æÂ æÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 7 調諧卿ÂÂ示ç ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ æÂ¶è½å°廣æÂÂç¯Âç®æÂÂæÂÂ亮起@æÂ¶è½å°章é«Âè² FM 廣æÂÂç¯Âç®æÂÂæÂÂ亮起 ï¼ å¨é¸å FM å® è²éÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æÂÂæÂÂ亮起ã 8R D M ï¼Â第 28 é Âï¼ æÂ¤çÂÂå¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮 èµ·ã MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES ï¨ï OPEN /CLOSE ïµ ï ST ANDBY/ ON FUNCTION VOLUME ï¦ï§ MAIN SUB MIC PHONES USB 10 12 5 2 1 7 8 9 3 4 6 11 PRGSVE SOUND DTS F .SURR. 2 PL 2 D RPT -1 kHz PGM MHz RDM 6 12 8 9 7 5 11 3 10 2 1 4 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 13 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 14 Zhtw 9 kHz/MHz ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ çºæÂÂ示åÂÂå Â顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示çÂÂé »çÂÂå®你@kHz é©ç¨æÂ¼ AM ï¼ MHz é©ç¨æÂ¼ FM ï¼Âã 10 Ã¥ÂÂå Â顯示幠11 ï¼Â第 21 é Âï¼ æÂ¤çÂÂå¨ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ æÂÂ亮起ã 12 ï¤ æÂ¤çÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ亮起 ã éÂÂæÂ§å¨ ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示 HTZ280/282DVD-AP ã 1 ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼Â第 17 ã 32 ã 43 ã 50 ã 52 以å 54 é Âï¼ 2 Ã¥ÂÂè½é¸åÂÂæÂÂéµ 1 3 æÂ¸åÂÂéµ ã CLEAR ã DISPLAY ã SLEEP å DVD æÂ§å¶ CLEAR DISPLAY ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT SLEEP ï¼Â第 21 é Âï¼ SHIFT USB RE C ï¼Â第 31 é Âï¼ SHIFT AUDIO ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ éÂÂ註 1 åªæÂ HTZ280/282DVD- AP æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂé ÂÃ¥ÂÂå³輸 å ã 1 USB REC CLEAR TOP MENU TUNE ECHO TUNE KARAOKE MENU MIC VOL PLAYLIST OPEN /CLOSE RETURN SETUP AUTO / STEREO MP3 EXP/ V.ENH SURROUND SOUND CLASS VOLUME CHANNEL T V CONTROL INPUT SHIFT VOLU ME MUTE T.EDIT PRESET PRESET AUDIO ANGLE SLEEP SUBTITLE ADAPTER PORT USB LINE TUNER ( FM/AM ) DVD/CD STANDBY /ON ZOOM DISPLAY 23 456 789 0 HOME MENU 1 2 3 ENTER 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 2 11 12 13 15 16 17 18 14 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 14 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 15 Zhtw English Español English Español SHIFT SUBTITLE ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT ANGLE ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT ZOOM ï¼Â第 30 é Âï¼ 4T O P M E N U ï¼Â第 19 以å 30 é Âï¼ SHIFT SETUP @第 17 ã 20 ã 41 ã 43 ã 44 ã 45 ã 51 ã 52 以å 57 é  ï¼ 5 SHIFT KARAOKE ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ SHIFT ECHO ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ SHIFT ï / SHIFT ï ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ éÂÂæ¨ÂæÂÂéµ ENTER TUNE ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ PRESET ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ 6H O M E M E N U 7 鳿ÂÂæÂ§å¶ AUTO / STEREO ï¼Â第 22 以å 23 é Âï¼ SURROUND ï¼Â第 22 以å 23 é Âï¼ SOUND ï¼Â第 23 以å 24 é Âï¼ MP3 EXP / V.ENH ï¼Â第 24 é Âï¼ 8 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ ï¼Â第 19 以å 25 é Âï¼ 9T V C O N T R O L æÂÂéµ å¯ç¨æÂ¼æÂ§å¶å ÂéÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Âã 1 10 SHIFT 11 ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE ï¼Â第 18 ãÂÂ32 以å 53 é Âï¼ 12 PLAYLIST æÂÂéµ ï¼Â第 27 é Âï¼ 13 MIC VOL /â ï¼Â第 33 é Âï¼ 14 MENU ï¼Â第 19 ã 26 以å 30 é Âï¼ 15 RETURN 16 調諧å¨æÂ§å¶éµ CLASS ï¼Â第 21 é Âï¼ SHIFT T.EDIT ï¼Â第 20 é Âï¼ 17 MUTE 18 VOLUME /â ï¼Â第 18 é Âï¼ å®Âè£ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é»池1 æÂÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨èÂÂé¢ä¸ÂçÂÂé»池室èÂÂã 2 å°Âç §é»池室堧çÂÂæ¨Â示 ï¼ ï« ï¼Âïª ï¼Âå°Âå ©é¡ AA/R6 é»池æÂÂå ¥é»池室堧ã 3 éÂÂä¸Âé»池室èÂÂã 注æÂ é»池使ç¨ä¸Âç¶æÂÂå°Âè´å¦Âé» æ± æ¶²å¤Âæ¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè£ÂçÂÂå± éªç¼çÂÂãÂÂè«Âéµå®Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂäºÂ頠@⢠å°Âé»池æÂÂå ¥é»池槽æÂÂï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿ ä¾Âé»池槽堧 çÂÂæÂÂ示ï¼Âå°Âé»池çÂÂ極æÂ§å° æºÂæÂ£æ¥µ ï« èÂÂ負極 ïª 極æÂ§ã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂå¿å°ÂæÂ°èÂÂé»池混ç¨ã â¢ ç¸åÂÂé¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé»池å¯è½æÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé»壠ï¼Âè¦Âå çÂÂèÂÂå®ÂãÂÂè«Âå¿混ç¨ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂå çÂÂçÂÂé»池ã â¢ èÂÂçÂÂ廢èÂÂé»池æÂ ï¼ è«Âéµå®ÂæÂ¿åºÂæ¢Âä¾ÂæÂÂé©ç¨æÂ¼ è²´åÂÂæÂÂå°åÂÂçÂÂç°å¢Â堬報æÂ ä»¤è¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 æÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂéµ 1 è¶ éÂÂä¸Âç§Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠CLEARãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦ÂæÂÂçµÂå æÂÂï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂéµ 2ãÂÂæÂ£ç¢ºåÂÂæÂÂæÂ§å¶å¾Âï¼Âå° TV CONTROL ïµ æÂ åÂÂé»è¦Â並æÂÂä¸Âå®Â坿ÂÂä½ å°é»è¦Âæ©ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 15 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
æÂ§å¶èÂÂ顯示 03 16 Zhtw ⢠çºäºÂé¿å Âé»池æ¼Âæ¶²ï¼Âé·æÂÂé @ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ æÂÂæÂ´ ä¹ ï¼ ä¸Â使ç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂåºéÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂé» æ± ã å¦ÂæÂÂæ¼Âæ¶² ï¼ è«Âå°Âå¿ÂæÂ¦æÂÂé»池槽堧çÂÂä»» ä½ é»池液ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂç¨æÂ°é»池ã â¢ è«Âå¿è®ÂæÂ¸æÂ¾ÂÂå ¶ä»Âç©é«Â壠å¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨丠@å çº éÂÂ樣å¯è½å£Âä½ÂæÂÂéµ ï¼ é æÂÂé»池çÂÂéÂȎÂÂæÂ´å¿«è ç¡ã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂå¿å¨è»Âå §æÂÂå ç±å¨éÂÂè¿ÂçÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°é½å Âç´ å°ÂæÂÂéÂÂç±çÂÂç°å¢Âä¸Â使ç¨æÂ åÂÂæÂ¾é»池ã éÂÂç±ç ç°å¢Âå¯è½å°Âè´é»池破æ¼Âã éÂÂç± ã çÂÂç¸æÂÂèµ· ç«ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¸Âå°Âé»池çÂÂ使ç¨ 壽彿ÂÂæÂÂè½ã éÂÂç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨ éÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂ使ç¨ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂçº跠é¢åÂÂé¢æÂ¿æÂÂæÂÂå¨ç 7 m å §ï¼ÂèÂÂä¸Âå¨ 30 ð å §ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨åÂÂ顯示è£Â置习éÂÂæÂÂéÂÂç¤Âç© ï¼ æÂÂ妠æÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂªä»¥æÂ£ç¢ºè§Â度æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示è£Âç½®çÂÂé æÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯è½ ç¡æ³Âä½Âç¨ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂé½å Âç´å°ÂæÂÂè¢å ÂçÂÂçÂÂå¼·å¶砧å°æÂ¬æ©Âç éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ä¸Âï¼ åÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ 常你ç¨ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂå¨é è¿ÂæÂÂç¼å°Âç´ å¤Âç· çÂÂè£Âç½® ï¼ æÂÂå ¶ä»Â裠置çÂÂç´ å¤Âç·ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂä½Âç½® 使ç¨æÂ¬æ© ï¼ åÂÂéÂÂæÂ§ å¨å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸ä½Âç¨ ã æÂ¤å¤ ï¼ ä½¿ç¨æÂ¤éÂÂæÂ§å¨ å¯è½é æÂÂå ¶ä»Âè£Âç½®çÂÂéÂÂä½ ç°常ã â¢ éÂÂæÂ§å¨çÂÂæÂÂä½Âç¯Âå è®Âå¾Â太çÂÂæÂ ï¼Âè«ÂæÂ´æÂÂé» æ± ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 16 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 17 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 4 ç« éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ é¸æÂÂæÂ¨çºæÂ¨çÂÂèÂÂè½åÂÂç°å¢Âå®ÂæÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨è¨Âå®Âç æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã 第ä¸Â次éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ系統黿ºÂæÂÂï¼Â顯示ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂº è¨Âè¨Âå® ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂªå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®Âå³éÂÂéÂÂç³» çµ±é»溠@ä¸Â次éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ系統黿ºÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ次 顯示ç¸åÂÂ堧容ã 1 æÂ ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼ ç¶å¾Â確èªÂ顯示å¹Â顯示 WELCOME ï¼ÂæÂ¡è¿Â使ç¨@ã 2 SELECT SPEAKER LAYOUT å°Âå¨顯示å¹Â丠å·è¡Âç´ 10 ç§ÂéÂÂã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸åÂÂé©ç¶çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã æÂÂ堩種æÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Â模å¼Âï¼ 5 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âå 3 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨Âã å¦ÂéÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂèÂÂ模å¼Â說æÂÂçÂÂ詳細è³ÂæÂÂï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ãÂÂè¨Âå®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã ã â¢ 5 SPOT ï¼ å°Âå ©åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¾ç½®å¨èÂÂè½你置å¾Âé¢ï¼ÂæÂÂé©ç¨æÂ¼ 5.1 è²éÂÂå®¶åºÂé»影é¢ç è²é³ã â¢ 4 SPOT ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD ï¼ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ¯ ç¨æÂ¼èÂÂè½ç°ç¹Âè²çÂÂæ¨ÂæºÂæÂºè¨Âï¼ é¡Âä¼¼ 5 é»ÂæÂ è²å¨æÂºè¨ÂãÂÂå ©åÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨å åÂ¥æÂ¾å¨å³å´ Ã¥ÂÂå·¦åÂÂï¼Â並æÂ´é½Âå°æÂºæÂ¾å¨é»覠æÂÂéÂÂã â¢ 3 SPOT ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ¯ç¨æÂ¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ã 模å¼Âç 堸åÂÂæÂºè¨ ãÂÂå ©åÂÂç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂ¾å¨èÂÂè½ä½Âç½® Ã¥ÂÂé¢ã â¢ 2 SPOT ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD ï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¤é  ç½®é©ç¨æÂ¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²ãÂÂ模张ï¼Âå 3 é»ÂæÂ è²å¨æÂºè¨Âç¸å ãÂÂå ©åÂÂä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨åÂÂå¥æÂ¾å¨ å³å´åÂÂå·¦åÂÂï¼Â並æÂ´é½Âå°æÂº æÂ¾å¨é»è¦ÂæÂÂéÂÂã 4 æÂÂ丠ENTER 確èªÂ調æÂ´ã 1 è¨Âç½®è²éÂÂé³é è¨Âç½®æÂ¨ä¸»è¦ÂèÂÂè½ä½Âç½®çÂÂç¸ å°Âè²éÂÂé³éÂÂã 2 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SOUNDSET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å CH LEVEL ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å TESTTONE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 測試é³調æÂÂæÂÂ以ä¸Âé ÂåºÂ輸 åº ï¼Âå¾Âç®åÂÂèÂÂè½模张ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨@@⢠L ï¼ å·¦åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠C ï¼Âä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠R ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ⢠SR ï¼Âå³ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ⢠SL ï¼Âå·¦ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ ⢠SW ï¼ÂéÂÂä½Âé³ 3 éÂÂ註 1 èÂ¥è¦Âè®ÂæÂ´è¨Âå®Âï¼Âè«ÂæÂ SHIFT SETUP ï¼Â使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å SYS SETï¼Âç¶å¾Â使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å LAYOUT 以éÂÂå§Âè¨Âå®Âç¨ÂåºÂã 2 ⢠æÂ¤é  å å¨é¸å DVD/CD ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½使ç¨ãÂÂå¦è«Â確å®Âè³橠å°ÂæÂªæÂ¥ä¸Âã â¢ è¦Â調æÂ´æÂÂè è½é³æÂÂä¾ÂæºÂçÂÂæÂ´é«Â平衡ï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUPï¼Â使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å SOUNDSETï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERãÂÂ使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å CH LEVEL ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERãÂÂ使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂè²éÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ以 ï©/ïª 調æÂ´è²éÂÂä½ÂæºÂã å¨æÂ¨å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENT ERã 3 ç±æÂ¼éÂÂä½Â鳿ÂÂç¢çÂÂè¶ ä½ÂéÂÂé » çÂÂï¼Âå æÂ¤å ¶é³æÂÂè½起ä¾ÂæÂÂè¼Â實éÂÂ丠çÂÂé³éÂÂå®ÂéÂÂä¸ÂäºÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 17 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 18 Zhtw 5 使ç¨ VOLUME /â 以調æÂ´é³éÂÂè³ é©度çÂÂ篠åÂÂã 1 6 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以輪æµÂ調æÂ´è²éÂÂçÂÂé³éÂÂã ç¶åÂÂå¨主è¦ÂèÂÂè½ä½Âç½®ä¸Âï¼ÂæÂ¨æÂÂ該æÂÂè½å°ä¾Âèª毠åÂÂæÂÂè²å¨åÂÂ樣é³éÂÂçÂÂ測試é³調ãÂÂè²éÂÂé³éÂÂç¯Âå çº ñ 10 dB ã 7 å¨æÂ¨å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以éÂÂåº測試é³調 è¨Âç½®ã 使ç¨å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢ ï¼ OSDï¼ çºäºÂ使ç¨æÂ¹ä¾¿ï¼ÂæÂ¬ç³»çµ± æÂ¡ç¨äºÂ大éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå½¢åÂÂçÂÂå¨ å±Â顯示ç«é¢ ï¼ OSD ï¼Âã æÂÂæÂÂç«é¢çÂÂå°Â覽æÂ¹å¼ÂåºæÂ¬ä¸Â並ç¡ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«Â使ç¨ ï© ã ïª ã ï« ã ï¬ è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂç½頠ç® @並æÂÂ丠ENTER å®ÂæÂÂé¸åÂÂã 2 éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠æÂ´æÂ¾ÂÂå @ãÂÂé¸åÂÂã æÂ¯æÂÂ使ç¨游æ¨ÂæÂÂéµåÂÂç½ å¨å±Âç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂé  ç®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ ä¸ ENTER ä¹ÂæÂÂã æÂÂ示 â¢ å¨ OSD ç«é¢ä¸ÂæÂ¹çÂÂæÂÂéµæÂ åÂÂå¯åÂÂ訴æÂ¨æÂÂä½ ç«é¢æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨çÂÂæÂÂéµã ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ã CDã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã DivX 覠頻 /WMV å WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC çÂÂ碠çÂÂçÂÂåºæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âå¨æÂ¤åÂÂé©ç¨ ã æÂ´å¤ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ æÂÂå¨第 6 ç« ä¸Â詳細說æÂÂã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 â¢ å¨æÂ´æÂ¾ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠@ã DVD ã ä¸Âè©ÂæÂÂçÂÂæÂ¯ DVD- Video ã DVD-R å DVD-RWã 1 å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨å°ÂæÂªéÂÂæ©Âï¼Âè«Âå°Âå® éÂÂæ©Âã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾å«æÂÂå½±åÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå°Âé» è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂéÂÂ並確å®Âè¨Âç½®çÂÂæÂ¯æÂ£ 確çÂÂè¦Â頻輸堥ã 2 æÂÂ丠ï¨ OPEN /CLOSE 以置堥ç¢ÂçÂÂã æ¨Â籤颿ÂÂä¸Â置堥ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âå©ç¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âæ§½å°ÂæºÂç¢Âç ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç½®å ¥çÂÂæÂ¯éÂÂé¢ DVD ç¢Âç @置堥æÂÂè«Âå° æÂ³è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂä¸Â颿ÂÂä¸Âï¼ ã 3 æÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Â以éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂæÂ¯ DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼Â便 æÂÂåºç¾ä¸Âé¸å®ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 19 é Âç DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD PBC é¸å® 堧容@以çÂÂçÂ¥å°Â覽çÂÂæÂ¹æ³Âã èÂ¥æÂ¯æÂ¨ç½®å ¥çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂç¶ä¸Âå«æÂ JPEG ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå§Âå¹» çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã èÂÂå ¶ç¸éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 25 é  ç æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã â¢ èÂ¥ç¢ÂçÂÂå §å« DivX è¦Âé » /WMV Ã¥ÂÂå ¶ä»ÂåªÂé«Â檠æ¡Âé¡Âå @ä¾Â妠MP3 ï¼ ï¼Âé¦Âå Âè«Âå¾Âè¢å¹ÂæÂÂä½ ç«é¢ ï¼ OSD ï¼Âä¸Âé¸åÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DivX è¦Âé » / WMV æªÂæ¡ ï¼ DivX / WMVï¼ÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂåªÂé«Â檠æ¡Âé¡Âå @MP3 / WMA/ JPEG/ MPEG-4 AAC ï¼Âã éÂÂ註 1 é³ éÂÂè¨Âå®Âçº 51 æÂÂ以ä¸ÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ç¡æ³Âé¸æÂ TESTTONE ä¸Âè²éÂÂé³éÂÂè¨Âå®Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°éÂÂå¶ãÂÂæÂ¤ å¤Âï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂä»»ä½ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂè²é é³éÂÂç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂ訠å®Âå¨ 端ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ大 é³éÂÂä¹ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°éÂÂå¶ã 2 è¢ å¹Âä¿ÂèÂ፬ÂåºÂæÂÂå¨系統éÂÂ置亠åÂÂéÂÂå¾Âåºç¾ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ HOME MENU 顯示ï¼ÂéÂÂåºå¨å±Â顯示 ç«é¢ ï¼ OSDï¼ ã ï«ï©ïªï¬ è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂç½çÂÂé¸å®頠ç® ã ENTER é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½çÂÂé¸å®頠ç® ã RETURN è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂ主é¸å®ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ任你è®ÂæÂ´ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 18 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 19 Zhtw English Español English Español ⢠å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DualD isc ï¼ DVD/CD æ··å 碠çÂÂï¼ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Â堧容格å¼ÂæÂ æÂ¾ç¸容æÂ§ ã 4 é³éÂÂ調æÂ´ã è«Â使ç¨ VOLUME /â ä¾ÂæÂ§å¶é³éÂÂã åºæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶ 以ä¸Â表格æÂÂ示çºéÂÂæÂ§å¨ä¸Âç¨以æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂåºæÂ¬ æÂ§å¶ã 1 æÂ¨å¨第 6 ç« ä¸Âå¯以æÂ¾å°堶ä»ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å è½ã æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ¨åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ ï¼ RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ åÂÂ樣æÂ åºç¾å¨è¢å¹Âä¸Â@表示æÂ¨å¯以å¾Â該é»Âä½Âç½®ä¾ÂæÂ¢å¾© æÂÂæÂ¾ã å°ÂæÂ¼ DVD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD è è¨Âï¼Âå³ 使 é åº@æÂÂæÂ¾ä½Â置亦æÂÂå²åÂÂå¨è¨ÂæÂ¶é«Â裠ã 2 ä¸Â次æÂ¨ç½®å ¥ ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ ï¼ è¢å¹Âä¸Â峿ÂÂ顯示 LAST MEM ï¼ÂæÂÂçµÂ訠æÂ¶ï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè®ÂæÂ¨å¾ÂæÂ¤æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³è¦Â渠é¤æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂä½Âç½®ï¼Âè«Âå¨è¢å¹Â丠顯示 RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣æÂ ï¼ æÂ ä¸ ï§ ï¼Âå æÂ¢ï¼ ã DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® 許夠DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂå §å«æÂ¨å¯以é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Âè§ è³Â堧容çÂÂé¸å®ã æÂÂæÂ ï¼ DVD-Video é¸å®æÂÂèªåÂÂå¨æÂ¨éÂÂå§ÂæÂ æÂ¾æÂ é¡¯ç¤ºå¨è¢å¹Â丠@堶ä»Âç¢ÂçÂÂåªæÂÂå¨æÂ¨æÂÂ丠MENU æÂ TOP MENU æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ顯示ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD PBC é¸å® æÂÂ亠VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD å ·æÂÂæÂ¨å¯å¾Âä¸Âé¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Âè§ è³Â堧容çÂÂé¸å® ã éÂÂäºÂ便æÂ¯ PBC ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶@é¸ å®ã éÂÂ註 1 å¨æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂ亠DV D ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¨æÂÂç¼ç¾æÂÂäºÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶å¯è½ç¡æ³Âç¨ ä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂäºÂé¨å ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ï¤ éÂÂå§Âï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂè¢å¹Âä¸Â顯示 RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ æÂ LAST MEM ï¼ æÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶ï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣 ï¼ åÂÂæÂ æÂ¾ä½Âæ¥Â便æÂÂå¾ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ æÂÂæÂÂå¾Âè¨ÂæÂ¶çÂÂä½ ç½®éÂÂå§ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂÂçµ è¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼Âã ïÂÂ¥ æÂ«åÂÂï¼Âç¹¼çºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂã ï§ å¯åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ÂæÂ¢å¾© æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂ è¢å¹Âä¸Â顯示 RESUME ï¼ÂæÂ¢å¾©ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣@ã ï æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âå¿«è½Âã ï® æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿«è½Âã ï¯ å¯跳è³ç®åÂÂæÂ²ç®æÂÂ章篠çÂÂéÂÂé Âï¼Â以åÂÂå ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Âç« ç¯Âã ï° å¯跳è³ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ²ç®æÂÂç« ç¯Âã æÂ¸åÂÂéµ å¯ç¨以輸 å ¥æ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç®çÂÂç·¨è ã æÂÂ丠ENTER æÂÂéµ以ä½Âåºé¸åÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ å¾ÂæÂÂ鏿¨Âé¡ ï¼ DVD ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD/VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂçÂÂéÂÂé ÂèÂÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂ鏿¨Âé¡ ï¼ VR 模张DV D-R/-R W ï¼Âã 章篠@DVD-Video ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD/VC D/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂçÂÂéÂÂé Âè éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 2 ⢠ãÂÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂå ãÂÂæÂÂçµÂè¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¯è½ä¸Âé© ç¨æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ DVD-Video ç¢Âç ï¼Âé¤ VR 模张DVD- R/-RW å¤Âï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¬æ©Âå¯å²åÂÂæÂÂå¾ÂäºÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä½Âç½® ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ TOP MENU 顯示 DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂç ãÂÂä¸Â層 é¸å®ã @æÂ¤é  åÂÂè½æÂÂè¦Â碠çÂÂèÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂã MENU å¯顯示 DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸ å®ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂÂä¾Â碠çÂÂèÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¯ è½è ãÂÂ丠層é¸å®ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ç¸åÂÂã ï«ï©ïªï¬ å¨ç«é¢ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢移åÂÂ游樠ã ENTER é¸åÂÂç®åÂÂé¸å®ä¸ÂçÂÂé¸頠ã RETURN è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示çÂÂé¸å® ç«é¢ã æÂ¸åÂÂéµ å¯é¸åÂÂç·¨æÂÂèÂÂ碼çÂÂé¸å®é¸頠ï¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ ãÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTER æÂÂéµ以ä½Âåºé¸åÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 19 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 20 Zhtw æÂ¨å¯以ç´æÂ¥å©ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ é¸åÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Âä¸Âç¨æÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ æÂÂéµä¾ÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂèÂÂç¡ é Âå°Â覽 PBC é¸å®ï¼Â便坿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ´å¼µ P BC VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã èÂÂè½æÂ¶é³橠調諧å¨å¯以æÂ¥æÂ¶ FM å AM 堩種廣æÂÂï¼Â並è®ÂæÂ¨ è¨ÂæÂ¶åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¶è½çÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Â使æÂ¨ç¡é Âæ¯Â次è¦ÂæÂ¶è½æÂ éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調諧ã 1 æÂÂ丠TUNER 以åÂÂæÂÂ調諧å¨ ï¼ ç¶å¾Âé£çºÂæÂÂ以 é¸å AM æÂ FM 波段ã è¢å¹ÂæÂ¤æÂÂæÂÂ顯示波段å 頻çÂÂã 2 調é¸éÂÂè¦ÂçÂÂé »çÂÂã éÂÂ裡æÂÂä¸Â種調諧模å¼Âï¼ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé«ÂéÂÂ@⢠æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調諧 ï¼ é£çºÂæÂ TUNE 以æÂ¹è®ÂæÂÂ顯示çÂÂé » çÂÂã â¢ èªåÂÂ調諧 ï¼ æÂÂä½ TUNE ï¼ ç´å°æÂÂ顯示çÂÂé »ç éÂÂå§Âè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂçºæÂ¢ ï¼ ç¶å¾Âå°ÂæÂÂéµæÂ¾é ã ä¸ÂæÂ¦æÂ¾å° ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂȌ° @調諧å¨å³æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢åÂÂä½ ã éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂ¥ é©Â以繼çºÂæÂÂç´¢ã â¢ é«ÂéÂÂ調諧 ï¼ æÂÂä½ TUNE ï¼ ç´å°顯示çÂÂé »çÂÂé å§Âå¿«éÂÂè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂçºæÂ¢ ã å¦ÂæÂÂ忠覠@å¯使ç¨æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調 è«§åÂÂè½ä¾Â微調頻çÂÂã æÂ¹å FM æÂ¥æÂ¶ ä¸Âè¯ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£å¨以ç«Âé«Âè²æÂ¶ è½ FM éÂȌ°ï¼Âä½ÂæÂ¥æÂ¶å» å¾Â微弱ï¼Âé£麼æÂ¨å¯以å°Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå®è²éÂÂä¾ÂæÂ¹å è²é³çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ質ã 1 調é¸è³ FM 廣æÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å TUNERSET ï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å FM MOD E ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸å FM MONO ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 調諧å¨å¨å®è²éÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æ¨¡å¼Â丠@å®è²éÂÂæÂÂ示ç @ï¼ÂæÂÂ亮起ã é¸åÂÂä¸Âè¿°ç FM AUTO 以åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂèªåÂÂç«Âé«Âè²模 å¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¶è½ç«Âé«Âè²廣æÂÂæÂ ï¼ ç«Âé«Âè²æÂÂ示ç @@æÂÂ亮起@ã æÂÂå¶ AM æÂ¥æÂ¶éÂÂ訠èÂÂ¥ AM æÂ¥æÂ¶æÂ æ³ÂéÂÂ常丠好ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ£å¨æÂ¶è½ç AM éÂȌ°太éÂÂåµé ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ試使ç¨ ãÂÂéÂÂè¨ÂæÂÂå¶ã å è½調æÂ´è³è¼Âä½³çÂÂé³質ã 1 調諧è³ AM 廣æÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å TUNERSET ï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å NOISECUT ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸åÂÂéÂÂè¨ÂæÂÂå¶模å¼Âï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã é¸å 1 æÂ 2 ä¹ÂéÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæºÂã è¨ÂæÂ¶éÂȌ° æÂ¤ç³»çµ±å¯以è¨ÂæÂ¶æÂÂ夠30 Ã¥ÂÂéÂȌ°ï¼Âå²åÂÂå¨ä¸Âå é¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂ¥ ï¼ A ã B å C @丠@æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âå¥å¯å²å 10 å éÂȌ°ã 1 調諧è³ AM æÂ FM 廣æÂÂéÂȌ°ã å°ÂæÂ¼ FM 波段ï¼Âå¯è¦ÂéÂÂè¦Âä¾Âé¸åÂÂå®è²éÂÂæÂ èªå ç«Âé«Âè²çÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶æÂ¹å¼ÂãÂÂæÂ¤é  è¨Âå®Â弿ÂÂé£åÂÂé Âè¨Âé» å°ä¸Âä½µåÂÂã 2 æÂÂ丠SHIFT T.EDIT ã 3 æÂÂ丠CLASS å¯é¸åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âå¥çÂÂå ¶ä¸Âä¹Â丠@ç¶å¾Â使ç¨ PRESET æÂÂéµé¸ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂçÂÂé Âè¨ÂéÂȌ°ã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµä¾Âé¸å é Âè¨ÂéÂȌ°ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ RETURN 顯示 PBC é¸å®ã æÂ¸åÂÂéµ é¸åÂÂç·¨æÂÂèÂÂ碼çÂÂé¸å®é¸頠ãÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTER æÂ éµ以ä½Âåºé¸åÂÂã ï¯ 顯示åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸å®頠ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ話@ã ï° 顯示ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸å®頠ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ話@ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 20 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂä½ 04 21 Zhtw English Español English Español 4 æÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂ ENTER å¾ ï¼ é Âè¨Âé¡Âå¥åÂÂç·¨èÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ éÂÂç @ç¶徠系統è¨ÂæÂ¶éÂȌ°ã æÂ¶è½é Âè¨ÂéÂȌ° æÂ¨å¿ é Âå Âå²åÂÂä¸ÂäºÂé Âè¨Âå¼æÂ è½å·è¡ÂæÂ¤æÂÂä½Âã 1 確å®Âå·²é¸å TUNER Ã¥ÂÂè½ã 2 æÂÂ丠CLASS 以é¸åÂÂå²åÂÂé »éÂÂæÂÂå¨çÂÂé¡Âå¥ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂä¸Âå¯åÂÂæÂ A ãÂÂB å C é¡Âå¥ã 3 使ç¨ PRESET æÂÂéµ以é¸åÂÂä¸Âé Â訠éÂȌ°ã â¢ æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ ä¾Âé¸åÂÂé Âè¨ÂéÂȌ°ã èÂÂè½堶ä»Âä¾Â溠å¯å°Âè¼Âå©ä¾Â溠ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ© ãÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶å¨çÂÂï¼ é£æÂÂ¥ è³æÂ¬æ©Âä¸Âï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂÂè²å¨系統æÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂèÂÂå ¶ç¸éÂÂç æÂ´å¤Âè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âç é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻訠å ã â¢ è¦Âå°Â丠USB è£Âç½®é£æÂ¥è³ US B 端åÂÂ丠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 31 é Âç USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 ã â¢ å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ280/282DVD-AP ï¼ÂæÂÂå ¥å åµ測å° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å¾Âï¼ å³å¯é¸æÂ Bluetooth å³輸å¨ãÂÂèÂÂå ¶ç¸ éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³ è¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç ç¨æÂ¼ç¡ç·Â享åÂÂé³樠ç Bluetooth î å³輸å¨ ã 1 確å®Âå¤Âé¨ä¾Â溠@é»è¦Âæ© ã è¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶å¨ç @已ç¶ÂéÂÂæ©Âã 2 æÂÂ丠LINE 以é¸åÂÂä¾ÂæºÂã 3 å¦ÂæÂÂå¿ è¦Âï¼Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¾ÂæºÂã è¨Âç½®ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨å¯å¨æÂ¨ç¡ èÂÂç´Âä¸Âå°ÂæÂÂå¾Âå°Â系統é æ©Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å®Âå ¨ç¡é ÂæÂÂå¿Âã 1 ⢠é£çºÂæÂ SHIFT SLEEP以é¸åÂÂé¸頠@ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã é¸åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸頠@⢠SLP ON ï¼Âç´Âå¨ä¸Âå°ÂæÂÂå¾ÂéÂÂæ© ã æÂÂ示çÂÂæÂ äº®èµ·ã â¢ SLP OFF ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶Âç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ ã å¨é¸å SLP ON å¾ ï¼ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SLEEP 以確èªÂä¸Âä¸Âå©é¤ÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂã æ¯Âæ¢Âç·Â代表素12 å é ï¼Âå©é¤ÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼ éÂÂ註 1 顯示å¹Âå¨ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂè¨Â置好æÂ æÂÂè®ÂæÂÂã S L P --- -- HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 21 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 05 22 Zhtw 第 5 ç« èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠æÂ¬æ©Âé³頻åÂÂè½æÂ¯å¦åÂÂéÂÂ覠é³溠ã HDMI é³頻 è¨Âç½® ï¼Â第 41 é Âï¼ æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ堥麥å Â風çÂÂä¼´å±模 å¼Â@第 33 é Âï¼ èÂÂå® ã æÂ¤æÂÂé¸å®å¯è½ä¸ÂæÂÂ顯 示ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¹çº顯示è¨ÂæÂ¯ ï¼Â第 56 é Âï¼ ã é¸åÂÂèÂÂè½模张æÂ¨å¯以使ç¨åÂÂ種èÂÂè½模å¼Â享åÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ鳿ÂÂï¼Âå 根æÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ好修æÂ£é³場ãÂÂæÂ¨å¯以è¨Âå®Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè è½模张@è¦ÂæÂ¨å¨第 6 é Âç 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® é¸ æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂèÂÂå®ÂãÂÂè«Âé±è®Â以ä¸Â堧容並é²衠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¨Âå®Âã â¢ 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂºè¨ ç¶æÂ¨å·²é¸æÂ 5 é» æÂÂè²å¨é Âç½®æÂÂï¼Âè«Âå¾Âç°ç¹Âè²模 å¼Âä¸Â鏿ÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂèÂÂè½模å¼ÂãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå 以ç°ç¹Âè² èÂÂè½ ã â¢ 3 é» /2 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨ æÂºè¨ ç¶æÂ¨å·²é¸æÂÂå°Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè² å¨æÂ¾å¨æÂ¨åÂÂé¢ç 3 é»ÂæÂ è²å¨é Âç½®æÂÂï¼Âè«Âå¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼Âä¸Â鏿ÂÂä¸Âå èÂÂè½模张ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 23 é Âç 使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè² ã èªåÂÂèÂÂè½模张èªåÂÂèÂÂè½模å¼ÂæÂ¯èÂÂè½主è¦ÂæÂ§å¶çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ種ä¾ÂæºÂæÂÂç°¡ å®çÂÂæÂ¹æ³Âï¼ èªæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂ輸åºåÂÂæÂ åºä¾ÂæºÂé¡ÂæÂÂ丠çÂÂéÂÂéÂÂã â¢ æÂÂ丠AUTO/STEREO 以é¸å AUTO èÂÂè½模 å¼Âã 1 èÂÂè½模å¼Âæ ¹æÂÂä¸Â表æÂÂ示çÂÂä¾ÂæºÂåªÂé«ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé Âè² é³ã 以ç°ç¹Âè²èÂÂè½ ç¶æÂ¨å°Â系統æÂºè¨Âçº 5 é» /4 é»ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ÂæÂ ï¼ å¯ 使ç¨ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼Âã æÂ¨å¯以ç°ç¹Âè²ä¾Âè è½ç«Âé«Âè²æÂÂå¤Âè²éÂÂä¾Â溠ã 2 ç°ç¹Âè²ä¾ÂèªæÂ¼æÂ¡ç¨æÂÂ種 Dolby Pro Logic 解碼 模å¼ÂçÂÂç«Âé«Âè²ä¾ÂæºÂã â¢ é£çºÂæÂ SURROUND 以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種èÂÂè½模张ã 1 顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂåºç¾çÂÂé¸åÂÂæÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂä¾ÂæºÂé¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂè æÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ STANDARD ï¼Âæ¨ÂæºÂ解碼模张ï¼ÂåªæÂÂå¨ä¾Â溠çºå¤Âè²éÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½é¸æÂ æÂ¤æ¨¡å¼Â@⢠MOVIE (Dolby Pro Log ic II Movie ï¼ ï¼ Pro Logic II 5.1 è²éÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼Âç¹åÂ¥é©å é»影 ä¾Â溠ï¼Âå¯ç¨æÂ¼ä»»ä½Âä¸Â種é è²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂï¼ éÂÂ註 1 èÂÂ¥ ä¾ÂæºÂçº Dolby Di gital æÂ DTS ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤ºå¹Âä¸ÂçÂÂç¸å°ÂæÂÂ示ç æÂÂ亮起ã ä¾Â溠5 SPOT 4 SPOT 3 SPOT 2 SPOT éÂÂè²é STEREO STEREO å¤Âè²é STANDARD F.SURR 2 注 æÂÂéÂÂå°Â輸堥ä¾ÂæºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè³ DVD/CD æÂ USBï¼ÂæÂÂè½é²è¡Âå¤Âè²éÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 22 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 05 23 Zhtw English Español English Español ⢠MUSIC (Dolby Pro Logic II Music ï¼ ï¼ å¯ ç¢ç Pro Logic II 5.1 è²éÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼Âç¹åÂÂ¥ é©åÂÂ鳿¨Âä¾Â溠ï¼Âé©ç¨æÂ¼éÂÂè²éÂÂä¾ æºÂ@⢠DOLBY P L (Dolby Pro Logi c ï¼ ï¼ å¯ç¢ç 4.1 è²éÂÂç°ç¹Âé³æÂ ï¼Âé©ç¨æÂ¼ éÂÂè²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂ@使ç¨åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè² é¸å DV D/CD æÂ USB ä½Âçº輸堥ä¾ÂæºÂ並å¦Â第 6 é Âç 家åºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢é³æÂÂè¨Âç½® ä¸ÂæÂÂ述使ç¨ 3 é»Âï¼ /2 é»Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ181DVD æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂºè¨ æÂ ï¼ åÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂ模å¼Âç¼ æÂ®ä½Âç¨ ã â¢ éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ SURROUND 以é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°ç¹Âè²模 å¼Âã â¢ F.SURR ï¼Âå¯ç¨æÂ¼æÂÂä¾Âè±Âå¯ÂçÂÂç°ç¹Âé³ æÂÂã â¢ EXTRAPWR ï¼Âå¾Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨輸åºç«Âé« è²é³ æÂ ï¼ÂèÂ¥çºå¤Âè²éÂÂä¾Â溠@åÂÂä¸Âæ··åÂÂç«Âé«Â鳿ÂÂ@@以ç²å¾Â強大çÂÂç«Âé«Âè²æÂÂæÂÂã 以ç«Âé«Âè²èÂÂè½ æÂ¨å¯以å¨ç«Âé«Âè²é³æÂÂä¸Âè è½任ä½Âä¸Â種ä¾ÂæºÂâÂÂç« é«Âè²æÂÂå¤Âè²éÂÂãÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾å¤Âè²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂæÂ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂè² éÂÂæÂÂç¶Â縮混å¾Âå³éÂÂè³åÂÂç½® å·¦ï¼Â峿ÂÂè²å¨åÂÂéÂÂä½ é³ä¹Âä¸Âã â¢ é£çºÂæÂÂ丠AUTO/STEREO ç´å°顯示å¹Âä¸Âåº ç¾ STEREO çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樣çºæÂ¢ã 以è³æ©ÂèÂÂè½ æÂÂå ¥è³æ©ÂæÂÂï¼ STEREO æÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂèÂÂè½模 å¼Âç¡æ³Âè®ÂæÂ´ã 1 調æÂ´ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³ 使ç¨ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³æÂ§å¶å¯調 æÂ´å ¨é¢çÂÂé³調ã 1 æÂÂ丠SOUND ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å BA SS/TRE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å BASS æÂ TREBLE ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 調æÂ´è²é³ ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 確誠ã â¢ ä½Âé³åÂÂé«Âé³çÂÂ調æÂ´ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¨ â 6dB è³ 6dB ä¹ éÂÂã 使ç¨ SFC 模张SFC ï¼Âé³場æÂ§å¶@模å¼Âå¯以é©ç¨æÂ¼ä»»ä½ÂçÂÂå¤Âè²é æÂÂç«Âé«Âè²ä¾Â溠@以æÂÂä¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¼Âå ¶ä»ÂçÂÂç°ç¹Âè²æÂÂæÂ ã 1 æÂÂ丠SOUND ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SF C MODE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 æÂÂ丠ï©/ïª ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以é¸å SFC é³ æÂÂ模å¼Âã è«Âé¸å OFF ã LIVE ã HALL ã POP ã ROCK ã DRAMA æÂ ACTIONã áÂÂáÂÂà ¶µáÂÂᣠëáÂ¨à £ î 3îÂÂáÂÂøÃÂÃ Ã£Ã¼à  ÂáÂÂáÂÂáÂÂá áÂÂàãüÃÂÃÂÃÂà ±¦ áÂÂÃ Ã£Ã¼à  ÂáÂÂáÂÂáÂÂá áÂÂàãüÃÂÃÂÃÂà ±¦ áÂÂàãü HTZ180DVD ãü HTZ181DVD éÂÂ註 1 å¨æÂ¨æÂÂä¸Âè³æ©ÂæÂÂï¼Â峿ÂÂæÂ¢å¾© æÂÂå ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç°ç¹Âè²è¨Âå®Â模å¼Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 23 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
èÂÂè½æÂ¨çÂÂ系統 05 24 Zhtw å éÂÂä½Âé³é³é æÂ¬æ©Âå ±æÂÂäºÂ種ä½Âé³模å¼Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯ç¨ä¾Âå¢Âå¼·ä¾ÂæºÂ丠çÂÂä½Âé³é³éÂÂã 1 æÂÂ丠SOUND ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å BASSMODE ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 調æÂ´è²é³ ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 確誠ã é¸å OFFï¼ MUSIC æÂ CINEMAã 使ç¨ MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨ éÂÂç¾å£Â縮鳿¨ÂçÂÂç¾Âè² ï¼ MP3 ã WMAã MPEG-4 AAC ï¼Âã â¢ éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH é¸å MP3 EXPã 1 使ç¨è²é³強åÂÂå¨模张æÂ¤æ¨¡å¼Âå¯ç¨æÂ¼èÂÂè½é»影 æÂÂå°Âç½ä¸ÂçÂÂå°è©Âã â¢ éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH é¸å VOICE Eã 2 æÂÂæÂÂè²é³ ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂä½³è²é³@æÂ¬æ©Âé¨éÂÂç¹æ®Âå½¢ç çÂÂé«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ質æÂÂè²å¨@ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè² é³ãÂÂ模å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂå°Âé»影åÂÂ鳿¨ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ鳿ÂÂä½³ çÂÂ實é«Âé©ÂçÂÂå ÂéÂÂç¨家é³頻æÂ è¡ÂèÂÂè¨Âè¨Âã å¨æÂ£å¸¸æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè²é³模å¼Â坿ÂÂä½³åÂÂæÂ¬ æ©ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ã 3 ⢠åÂÂæ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂå£Â縮 éÂÂç¾容æÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç°å¢Âåªé³影é¿çÂÂç´°é¨è²é³æÂÂåµé åºä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè®ÂæÂ¨æÂÂ覺身æÂ·å ¶å¢Âç åÂÂé³ç°å¢Âã â¢ é »çÂÂç¹æÂ§ä¿®æÂ£ çÂÂè§£é¤äºÂé¨éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨è£Âç½®çÂÂæÂ°å¢ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¤Âï¼Âé å°Âé·æÂÂéÂÂèÂÂè½èÂÂæÂÂä½³åÂÂçÂÂæÂ æÂ¾ç¹æÂ§ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP 並使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å SOUNDSET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å S.FIELD ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以調æÂ´è¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTE R 確èªÂã â¢ EFFECT ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂè²é³@ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¹æÂ§å·²éÂÂå°Âé¨ éÂÂæÂÂè²å¨æÂÂä½³åÂÂçÂÂè²é³ ã â¢ DIRECT ï¼Âç´æÂ¥è²é³@ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂ æÂÂè²é³模张ã éÂÂ註 1 é åÂÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂï¼ SFC 模å¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂã 2 ⢠éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¤ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂï¼ SFC 模å¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂã â¢ ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180/181DVD æ©Âå ï¼Âå å°ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¤Âè²éÂÂä¾ÂæºÂç ä¸Âç½®è²éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂã 3 é³ å ´ä¸ÂæÂÂå½±é¿è³æ©Â輸åºã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 24 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 25 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 6 ç« ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠å³使æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ實éÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂå 置堥çÂÂç¢Âç 種é¡ÂèÂÂæÂÂäºÂ許ä¸ÂçÂÂå·®ç° ï¼ æÂ¬ç« æÂÂæ¶µèÂÂçÂÂ許夠åÂÂè½ä»Âå¯é©ç¨æÂ¼ DVD ç¢Âç ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã CD ã Di vX è¦Âé » /WMV 以å WMA/ MP3/MPEG-4 AAC/JPEG ç¢ÂçÂÂã â¢ æÂÂ亠DVD æÂÂéÂÂå¶æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ ï¼Âä¾Âå¦Â鍿©ÂæÂÂé è¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂé¨åÂÂæÂÂå ¨ é¨çÂÂ使ç¨ ã éÂÂ並 ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã â¢ 卿ÂÂæÂ¾ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂ ï¼ æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¨ PBC æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸Âé©ç¨ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³ è¦Â使ç¨éÂÂ亠åÂÂè½ï¼Âè«Â使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµé¸åÂÂæÂ²ç® ä¾ÂéÂÂå§Âç¢Âç çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂ種çÂÂéÂÂ度åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå å¾Âå¿«éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂç¢Âç ã 1 ⢠æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï æÂ ï® 以éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂÂã é£çºÂæÂÂä¸Â以å¢Âå æÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ度 ï¼Âå¦Âå¨å±Â顯示@ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂ種栢åÂÂä½ÂéÂÂ度ä¾ÂæÂ æÂ¾ DVD ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD å DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ãÂÂDVD ç¢ÂçÂÂéÂÂå¯ 以åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ïÂÂ¥ ï¼ÂæÂ«åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æÂÂä½ ï³/ï± æÂ ï²/ï´ æÂÂéµ ï¼ ç´å°éÂÂå§Âæ ¢å ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çºæÂ¢ã é£çºÂæÂÂ以è®ÂæÂ´æ ¢åÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ éÂÂ度 ï¼Âå¦Âå¨å±Â顯示@ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æ ¼é²ï¼Âæ ¼éÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ¨å¯以éÂÂæ ¼åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¾ÂéÂÂç æÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢Âç ã å°ÂæÂ¼ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD å DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ï¼ÂæÂ¨ åªå¯以使ç¨格鲿ÂÂæÂ¾ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ïÂÂ¥ ï¼ÂæÂ«åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æÂÂ丠ï³/ï± æÂ ï²/ï´ æÂÂéµ以å¾ÂéÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé²ç æÂ¹å¼Âä¸Â次ä¸Âæ ¼æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµã 2 æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ å¨置堥堧å« JPEG Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¾Âï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ 以 éÂÂå§Âå¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂ第ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ æÂÂ夾ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂéÂÂå§Âå¹»ç çÂÂç§ ã 3 æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Âé ÂåºÂä¾Â顯示æ¯Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂ å¤¾ä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂã â¢ è¥該è£Â置堧å«æÂ WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂÃ¥ÂÂé³頻 æªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂä¸ÂæÂ· éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã é³頻æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé @æÂ¨ä»Âç¶å¯以使 ç¨跳é @ï¯ / ï° ï¼ ãÂÂæÂ æÂ ï¼ ï /ï® ï¼Âå æÂ«å @ïÂ¥ï¼ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé  åÂÂè½ã åÂÂçÂÂæÂÂèªåÂÂ調æÂ´ä»¥ç¡éÂÂå¡« 滿æÂ´åÂÂè¢å¹Âç«é¢ã éÂÂ註 1D i v X è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂå é©ç¨ä¸Â種éÂÂ度ã 2 ⢠è¦Âç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼ÂæÂ£å¸¸ çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂå¨è®ÂÃ¥ÂÂå° DVD ç¢Âç ä¸ÂæÂ°çÂÂç« ç¯ÂæÂÂï¼ÂèªåÂÂæÂ¢å¾©ã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ PBC 模张ä¸Âç VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD 以å WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC æÂ²ç® ï¼Âé ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ模å¼ÂãÂÂä¸Âï¼ ï¼Âå°éÂÂæÂ²ç®çÂÂéÂÂé ÂæÂÂçµ å°¾æÂÂå°ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ã 3 ⢠æÂ¬æ©Âå°Âä¸Â份æªÂæ¡Âè¼ å ¥çÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂÂé¨èÂÂæªÂæ¡Â容éÂÂæÂ å¤§èÂÂå¢Âå ã â¢ ä¸Âå¼µç¢ÂçÂÂå¯ å å«å¤Âé 299 Ã¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂ å¤¾å 648 Ã¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä½µçÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾èÂÂæªÂæ¡ ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 25 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 26 Zhtw å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂ@使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂçÂÂ覽 DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç 使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂå¯çÂÂ覽æÂ´ å¼µ DVD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ堧容 ï¼ æÂ¾å°æÂ¨æÂ³è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂé¨å ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé @æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並 å¾Âå¨å±Âé¸ å®ä¸Âé¸å ã Disc Na vigator ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âå @ã ã 2 é¸åÂÂ檢è¦Âé¸頠ã å¯以使ç¨çÂÂé¸頠è¦Â置堥çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ種é¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯å¦è¦ÂæÂ æÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼Âç¶èÂÂä»Âå å«@⢠Title ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âç æ¨Âé¡Âã â¢ Chapter ï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ DVD-Video ç¢Âç ç®åÂÂæ¨Âé¡Âä¸ÂçÂÂç« ç¯Âã â¢ Track ï¼ÂæÂ²ç®@@æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ²ç®ã â¢ Time ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼ æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ç¢Âç ä¸Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮å ã â¢ Original: Ti tle ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ VR 模张DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âæ¨Âé¡Âã â¢ Playlis t: Title ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼ ï¼ æÂ VR 模张DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂç¶ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®樠é¡Âã â¢ Original: Ti me ï¼ÂæÂ éÂÂï¼ ï¼ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Â堧容丠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮åÂÂã â¢ Playli st: Time ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼ æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®丠æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮åÂÂã æÂ´åÂÂè¢å¹Âç«é¢åÂÂå¾Âä¸Â次æÂÂå¤Âå¯æÂ¥é£顯示å Â張縮 Ã¥ÂÂå½±åÂÂãÂÂè¦Â顯示åÂÂä¸ÂçµÂï¼Âä¸Âä¸ÂçµÂå Â張縮åÂÂï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ ï¯ / ï° ã 3 é¸åÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂ縮åÂÂå½±åÂÂã æÂ¨å¯使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å EN TER é¸åÂÂ縮åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¸ Ã¥ÂÂéµã è¦Â使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµé¸åÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â輸堥堩ä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂï¼Âç¶徠æÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ïÂÂ¥ å¯æÂ«åÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ï¼ÂæÂÂé³頻ï¼ÂçÂÂæÂ æÂ¾ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯åÂÂ度éÂÂå§ÂæÂ æÂ¾ã ï¯ å¯跳è³åÂÂä¸Âå¼µåÂÂç ï¼ÂæÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡ çÂÂé³頻æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ã ï° å¯跳è³ä¸Âä¸Âå¼µåÂÂç ï¼ÂæÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡ çÂÂé³頻æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ã ï«/ï¬/ ï©/ïª å¯æÂ«åÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ä¸¦æÂÂè½ ï¼Âç¿»åÂÂæÂÂ顯示çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµå¯éÂÂæÂ°éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âï¼ ã SHIFT ZOOM å¯æÂ«åÂÂå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ä¸¦å°Âå çÂÂæÂ¾å¤§ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯åÂÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂãÂÂ亠åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ¾å¤§åÂÂæÂ¸ ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµå¯éÂÂæÂ°éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âï¼ ã MENU å¯顯示 ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂç«é¢ ï¼Âè« åÂÂé±以ä¸Â說æÂÂï¼ ã Disc Navigator Di sc Navigator Title Chapter 0 1 04 02 05 03 0 6 Di s c Navigator: Title 0 1 - 49: - - HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 26 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 27 Zhtw English Español English Español å¯å©ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ覽 Windows Media ⢠Audio (WMA) ã MP3ã MPEG-4 AAC ã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV å JPEG æªÂ桠使ç¨ ãÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂæÂ ç §æªÂÃ¥ÂÂå°ÂæÂ¾ä¸Âç¹å®ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ æÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並徠å¨å±Â顯示é¸å®ä¸Âé¸ Ã¥ÂÂã Disc Navigator ï¼Âç¢Âç å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ãÂÂã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER ä¾ÂçÂÂ覽ã 使ç¨ ï©/ïª å¯ä¸Âä¸Âç§»åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ï¼ÂæªÂæ¡Â渠å®ã 使ç¨ ï« 以åÂÂå°根è³ÂæÂÂ夾ã 1 使ç¨ ENTER æÂ ï¬ å¯éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½çÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾 ã â¢ ç¶åÂÂç½ JPEG æªÂ桠@便æÂÂä¸Â縮åÂÂå½±åÂÂ顯示å¨ è¢å¹Âå³å´ã 3 è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂç½çÂÂæÂ²ç®æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV 檠æ¡ÂæÂÂ顯示åÂÂç½ç JPEG 檠桠æÂÂï¼Âå¯ æÂ ä¸ ENTER ã â¢ ç¶已é¸å WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV æªÂæ¡ ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂèª該æªÂæ¡ÂéÂÂå§ æÂÂæÂ¾å°æÂ´åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾çµÂæÂÂçºæÂ¢ã â¢ ç¶é¸åÂÂ亠JPEG æªÂæ¡Âï¼Âå¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âå³ æÂÂéÂÂå§Â@並å¾ÂæÂÂ鏿ªÂæ¡ÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ ä¸Âç´å°æÂ´åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾 æÂÂæÂ¾å®ÂçºæÂ¢ã æÂÂ示 ⢠å¨èÂÂè½ WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ æÂ ï¼ ä¹Âå¯以åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã åªé é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦ÂèÂÂè½çÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡Âï¼ åÂÂé¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦ÂæÂ æÂ¾å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âç JPEG æªÂæ¡Âå³å¯ ã æÂ¤æÂÂå¹»çÂÂç ç§ÂÃ¥ÂÂé³頻æªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂæÂ·éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã åÂÂé  æÂÂæÂ¾æÂ§å¶å é©ç¨æÂ¼ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âã â¢ è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ´å¼µç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂ丠æÂ¯åªæÂÂç®åÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ç 堧容 ï¼ è«Âå ÂéÂÂåº ã ç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âå ã @ç¶å¾Â使ç¨ ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµä¾ÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 使ç¨æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® é ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¤é  åÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å°Âå« æÂ WMA ã MP3ã MPEG-4 AAC å JPEG æªÂæ¡ÂçÂÂç¢Âç @製ä½ÂæÂÂ丠份æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® ï¼Âæ¯Â份 30 Ã¥ÂÂæªÂæ¡Âï¼ ãÂÂç±æÂ¼æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ è¨Âä½ÂæÂÂå¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂ張置堥ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® ï¼ÂéÂÂå¨ æÂ¨æÂ³è¦Âå¿«éÂÂä¸Âè¼Âé¬Âå°æÂ´çÂÂ大éÂÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂ ï¼Âç¸ç¶ æÂÂç¨ã 2 製ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® 1 å¨ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂ ï¼ æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並å¾Âè¢ å¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½é¸å®ä¸Âé¸å ã Disc Navigator ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂå° åÂÂï¼ ã ã 2 é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Âå å°æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®丠çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã èÂ¥ä¸ÂçÂ¥éÂÂæÂÂ麼åÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± ä¸Âè¿° å¯å©ç¨ ãÂÂç¢Âç å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½çÂÂ覽 Windows Media⢠Aud io (WMA) ã MP3 ã MPEG-4 AAC ã DivX è¦Âé » / WMV å JPEG æªÂæ¡ ã 3 æÂÂ丠PLAYLIST 1 ãÂÂ2 æÂ 3 ã æÂ¤æÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂå å°æÂÂé¸åÂÂç æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ä¸Âã 4 éÂÂè¤ÂæÂ¥é© 2 å 3 ï¼Âç´å°æÂ´åÂÂæÂÂä½Âå®ÂæÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以é²堥æÂÂä¸Â層ç ã ..ãÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ä¾Âå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¤é  åÂÂä½Âã 00:00 / 00:00 0kbp s Folder 1 Folder2 Folder3 Folder4 File 1 File2 File3 File4 File5 Folder 2 00:00 / 00:00 0kbp s 2 該ç¢ÂçÂÂå¿ é Â置堥æÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ç¶ä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 27 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 28 Zhtw æÂÂ示 ⢠è¦Â卿²ÂæÂÂå¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢ç æÂ æ³Âä¸Âå 堥檠æ¡Âï¼ÂåªéÂÂå¨æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé æªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ丠PLAYLIST 1 ãÂÂ2 æÂ 3 å³å¯ ï¼Âé¤å¨æÂÂæÂ¾é³頻 çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âå¤Âï¼ ã èÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠PLAYLIST 1 ã 2 æÂ 3ã æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤º å¹Âä¸Âç PGM æÂÂ示çÂÂæÂ èµ·ãÂÂèÂ¥æÂªè¨Âå®Âä»»ä½ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯 示 NO LISTã â¢ èÂ¥æÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®堧å«æÂ JPEG Ã¥ÂÂé³頻堩種æªÂæ¡Âï¼ åÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§Âå é³頻æªÂæ¡Âã 渠餿ÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ 1 éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å®ã 2 å¾Âã Disc N avigator ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âå @ãÂÂç«é¢ ä¸Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç½æÂ³å¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¸ å® ä¸Â渠é¤çÂÂæªÂæ¡Â並æÂÂ丠CLEAR ã 循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ段 ã A-B éÂÂ褠ã åÂÂè½å¯è®ÂæÂ¨æÂÂå®Âä¸ÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ æ¨ é¡ ï¼ DVD ï¼ ä¸ÂçÂÂå ©é» ï¼ A å B ï¼ ï¼Âä¾Âä¸Âç´ä¸ÂæÂ·å°循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã 2 é¸å ã A-B Repeat ï¼ A-B éÂÂè¤Âï¼ ã ã 3 å¨ã A(Start Point) ï¼ÂéÂÂå§Âé»Âï¼ ãÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以è¨Â置循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂéÂÂå§Âé»Âã 4 å¨ã B(End Point) ï¼ÂçµÂæÂÂé»Âï¼ ãÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 以è¨Â置循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ç çµÂæÂÂé»Âã å¨æÂÂ丠ENTER å¾ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä½Âæ¥ÂæÂÂè·³å è³éÂÂå§Âé»Âï¼ ç¶å¾ÂéÂÂå§Â循ç°æÂÂæÂ¾ã 5 è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Âè«Âé¸å ã Off ï¼ é ï¼ÂãÂÂã 使ç¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ é¤äºÂÃ¥ÂÂ種çÂÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾é¸頠å¤Âï¼Âä¹Âå¯以å°ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾åÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¸Â起使ç¨ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 29 é ÂçÂʌȼ ç«Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® ï¼Âã 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mo de ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã 2 é¸å ã Repea t ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤Âï¼ ã ï¼Âç¶å¾Âé¸åÂÂéÂÂ褠æÂÂæÂ¾é¸頠ã 1 å¦ÂæÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âå¯ é¸å Program Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¨Âå¼Âï¼ ä¾ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯 渠å® ï¼ æÂÂé¸å Repeat Off ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å æ¶ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD 碠ç æÂÂï¼Âå¯ é¸ å Title Repeat ï¼Âé è¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡Âï¼ æÂ Chapter Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾ç« ï¼ ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂ ï¼ å¯é¸å Disc Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å®ç¢Âï¼ æÂ Track Repeat ï¼ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ²ç®@ã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âå¯é¸å Title Repeat ï¼Âé 褠æÂ æÂ¾ 樠é¡Âï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ æÂ¯ Repeat Off ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ ï¼Âã 使ç¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ å¯使ç¨æÂ¤é  åÂÂè½以鍿ÂÂçÂÂé ÂåºÂä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡ÂæÂÂç« ç¯Âï¼ DVD-Video ï¼ æÂÂæÂ²ç® ï¼ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼Âã 2 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mo de ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã Play Mode éÂÂ註 1 æÂ¨ ç¡æ³Â使ç¨éÂÂè¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾ WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC ç¢ÂçÂÂã 2 ⢠æÂ¨å¯以 å¨ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ è¨Âç½®é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂé¸頠ãÂÂç¶èÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ç¡ æ³Âå°Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé Âç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ä¸Â起使ç¨ã â¢ æÂ¨ä¸Âè½使ç¨é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¾ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ VR 格张DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂã WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AAC ç¢ÂçÂÂã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂå¨ DVD 碠çÂÂé¸å®已顯示çÂÂæÂ æ³Âä¸Â使ç¨ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 28 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 29 Zhtw English Español English Español 2 é¸å ã Rando m ï¼Â鍿©Âï¼ ã @ç¶å¾Âé¸åÂÂé¸頠ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯é¸å Random Title ï¼Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡Âï¼ æÂ Random Ch apter ï¼Âé¨ æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç« ï¼ ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂÂï¼Âå¯ é¸ å On ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ æÂ Off ï¼ÂéÂÂ@以éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂ鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ Ã¥ÂÂè½ã æÂÂ示 â¢ é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨以 ä¸ÂæÂ§å¶åÂÂè½@â¢ é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂç¹¼çºÂå·衠@ç´å°æÂ¨å¾Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾é¸ å®é¸頠ä¸Âé¸åÂÂ亠Random Off ï¼Â鍿©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ éÂÂéÂÂï¼ çºæÂ¢ã 建ç«Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® æÂ¬é  åÂÂè½å¯è®ÂæÂ¨ç·¨è¼¯ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç® çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾é ÂåºÂç¨ÂåºÂã 1 1 æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã 2 é¸å ã Program ï¼Âç¨ÂåºÂ編輯@ã @ç¶å¾Âå¾Â稠å¼Âé¸頠渠å®ä¸Âé¸å ã Create/Ed it ï¼Âç·¨åºÂåµ建ï¼Â編輯@ã ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER 以é¸åÂÂ丠æ¨Âé¡ ã 章ç¯ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç®ä½Âçºç®åÂÂå¨ç¯Âç® 渠å®ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ¥é©Âã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ DVD ç¢Âç @æÂ¨éÂÂå¯以å¢Âå æ¨Âé¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¯ç« ç¯Âã â¢ å°ÂæÂ¼ CD æÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ å¯é¸åÂÂæÂ²ç®å å°ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å®ä¹Âä¸Âã å¨æÂÂ丠ENTER é¸åÂÂæ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç®徠@編庠æÂ¥é©Âç·¨èÂÂæÂÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âç§»åÂÂ丠ä½Âã 4 è«ÂéÂÂè¤ÂæÂ¥é© 3 以建ç«Âä¸Âç·¨åºÂÃ¥ÂÂ表ã ä¸Â份編åºÂÃ¥ÂÂ表ä¸Âå¯å å«夠é 24 Ã¥ÂÂç·¨åºÂæÂ¥é©Âã â¢ æÂ¨åªéÂÂå°ÂæÂ¨æÂ³é¡¯ç¤ºæÂ° ç·¨åºÂæÂ¥é©ÂçÂÂä½Âç½®åÂʊȴ Ã¥ÂÂç½åÂÂ輸堥æ¨Âé¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âï¼ÂæÂ²ç®編èÂÂ@便å¯ æÂÂ堥編åºÂæÂ¥é©Âã â¢ è¦Âåªé¤編åºÂæÂ¥é©Âï¼Âè«Âå°Âå ¶ Ã¥ÂÂç½å¾ÂæÂÂ丠CLEAR å³å¯ã 5 è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç·¨åºÂÃ¥ÂÂ表 ï¼ è«ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ æÂÂéµ ã ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠宿ÂÂç¹¼çºÂÃ¥ÂÂå¨@ç´å°æÂ¨éÂÂéÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂ æÂ¾ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±以ä¸Â說æÂÂï¼ ã åªé¤ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® ï¼Âè« åÂÂé±以ä¸Â說æÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂéÂÂåºç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæ©ÂçºæÂ¢ã æÂÂ示 ⢠ç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨以ä¸ÂæÂ§ å¶åÂÂè½@ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯é¸å®ä¸Âå ¶ä»Âå¯ç¨ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ å¨ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯é¸å®ä¸Âå°ÂæÂÂé¤ äºÂç·¨åºÂåµ建ï¼Â編輯以 å¤ÂçÂÂå ¶ä»Âé¸頠ã â¢ Playback Start ï¼Âç·¨åºÂæÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂå§ ï¼ ï¼ å¯é å§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å²åÂÂçÂÂç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® â¢ Playback Stop ï¼Âç·¨åºÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂ¢ ï¼ ï¼ å¯é éÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Âä½Âä¸ÂæÂÂåªé¤ ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å® â¢ Program Delete ï¼Âç·¨åºÂåªé¤@@å¯åªé¤稠åºÂ編輯渠å®並éÂÂéÂÂç¨ÂåºÂæÂ æÂ¾ æÂÂç´¢ç¢Âç æÂ¨å¯以æÂÂæ¨Âé¡ÂæÂÂç« ç¯Âç·¨è @æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂç´¢ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ CD å VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD 坿ÂÂæÂ²ç® ç·¨èÂÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ坿ÂÂæÂ éÂÂä¾ÂæÂÂç´¢ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã Play Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨¡å¼Âï¼ ã ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ï° é¨æ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¸Âé¸åÂÂä¸ÂæÂ° çÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Â樠é¡Âï¼Âç« ç¯Âã ï¯ å¯è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ç®åÂÂæÂ²ç®@æ¨Âé¡Âï¼Â章篠çÂÂéÂÂé Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯é¨ æ©Âé¸åÂÂå ¶ä» çÂÂæÂ²ç®ï¼Âæ¨Âé¡Âï¼Â章篠ã éÂÂ註 1V R æ ¼å¼Âç DVD-R/-RW ç¢ÂçÂÂã WMA/MP 3/MPEG-4 AAC ç¢ÂçÂÂã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å®顯示æÂÂï¼Âç¡æ³Â使ç¨ ç¨ÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ HOME MENU å¯å²åÂÂç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å®並 éÂÂåºä½Â丠æÂÂæÂ¾ã ï° å¯跳è³ç¨ÂåºÂ編輯渠å®丠çÂÂä¸Âä¸Âå 編åºÂæÂ¥é©Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 29 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂè½ 06 30 Zhtw 2 é¸å ã Search Mode ï¼ÂæÂÂ索模å¼Âï¼ ã ã æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾çÂÂæÂÂç´¢é¸頠æÂÂ覠置堥çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ種é¡ÂèÂÂå®Âã 3 é¸åÂÂæÂÂ索模å¼Âã â¢ ç¢ÂçÂÂå¿ é ÂæÂÂåºÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä»¥ä¾¿ä½¿ ç¨æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂç´¢åÂÂè½ ã 4 使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ輸堥æ¨Âé¡ ã 章ç¯ÂæÂÂæÂ²ç®編è @æÂ æÂÂéÂÂã â¢ 使ç¨æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂç´¢æÂ ï¼ è«ÂæÂÂç §æÂ¨æÂ³è¦ÂæÂ¢å¾©æÂÂæÂ¾ ç ä½Âç½®ä¾Â輸堥ç®åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æ¨Âé¡ ï¼ DVD/Di vX 覠頻 /WMV ï¼ æÂ æÂ²ç® ï¼ CD/VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCDï¼ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂ¸åÂÂç§ÂæÂ¸ãÂÂä¾Âå¦Âï¼ æÂÂ丠4 ãÂÂ5 ãÂÂ0 ãÂÂ0 峿ÂÂå¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂ第 45 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂä½Âç½®éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã æÂ³è¦Â輸堥 1 å°ÂæÂÂã 20 Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂå 30 ç§ÂæÂÂï¼ å¯ æÂÂ丠8 ãÂÂ0 ãÂÂ3 ãÂÂ0 ã 5 æÂÂ丠ENTER éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ æÂÂ亠DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂå DivX è¦Âé »ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä¸Â種以丠èªÂè¨ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Âï¼Âå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå è£Âä¸ÂæÂÂ渠æ¥ÂÃ¥ÂÂ訴æÂ¨å¯以 使ç¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Â種é¡ÂãÂÂæÂ¨å¯以卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂä¾Âå æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âã 1 ⢠é£çºÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SUBTITLE 以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種å å¹Âé¸頠ã â¢ è¦Âè¨Âç½®åÂÂå¹ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ好è¨Âå® ï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã â¢ æÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ DivX Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂçÂÂè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 48 é  ç 顯示 DivX Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ ã åÂÂæÂÂå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼Âé³頻è²é å¨æÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂæÂÂ堩種æÂÂæÂ´å¤ÂèªÂè¨Âå°Âç½堧容ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂ éÂÂå®è²éÂÂ鳿ÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ 2 ï¼ æÂ¨å¯以卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂä¾ åÂÂæÂÂéÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ã 3 æÂÂæÂ¾ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD æÂ ï¼ æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂæÂÂç«Âé«Âè² ã å 左è²éÂÂæÂÂå å³è²éÂÂã â¢ é£çºÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT AUDIO 以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種å°Âç½誠è¨Âé¸頠ã â¢ è¦Âè¨Âç½®å°Âç½èªÂè¨ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ好 è¨Âå®Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã æÂ¾å¤§ç«é¢ 使ç¨æÂ¾å¤§åÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å¨觠賠DVD ã DivX 覠頻 /WMV æ¨Âé¡ÂæÂ VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ï¼ÂæÂ æÂ æÂ¾ JPEG ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå°Âç«é¢æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¨ä½ÂæÂ¾ 大äºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã 1 æÂ æÂ¾ æÂ éÂÂï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ SHIFT ZOOM 以é¸å æÂ¾å¤§ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¸ ï¼ÂæÂ£å¸¸ã 2 x æÂ 4 x ï¼Âã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ ä¾Âè®ÂæÂ´ç¸®æÂ¾åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã æÂ¨å¯以卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂèªç±åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¤§åÂÂæÂ¸ï¼Â以åÂÂæÂ¾ 大åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã 4 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè§Â度 æÂÂ亠DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂÂ堩種æÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè§Â度æÂÂæÂÂè æÂÂç 場æÂ¯ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ç¢ÂçÂÂå è£Âä¸Âç 詳細說æÂÂã å¨æÂÂæÂ¾å¤Âè§Â度場æÂ¯æÂ ï¼ å±Âå¹Â丠æÂÂåºç¾ çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ示 ï¼ÂæÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以é¸åÂÂå°Âå®ÂéÂÂé ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 37 é Âç 顯 示å¹Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼Âã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂé ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ«åÂÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ SHIFT ANGLE 以åÂÂæÂÂè§Â度ã 顯示ç¢ÂçÂÂè³Â訠æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂï¼Âå¯å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ種æÂ²ç®ãÂÂç« ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âé¡ÂçÂÂè³Â訠顯示å¨å±Âå¹Âä¸Âã â¢ è¦Â顯示ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼Âé±èÂÂ顯 示çÂÂè³Â訠@å¯é£çºÂæÂ ä¸ DISPLAYã æÂÂéÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂè³Âè¨Â亦æÂÂåºç¾åÂÂé¢æÂ¿çÂÂè¢å¹Âä¸ÂãÂÂæÂ ä¸ DISPLAY 以è®ÂæÂ´æÂÂ顯示ç è³Âè¨Âã éÂÂ註 1 æÂ äºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå å Â許æÂ¨å¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® ä¸Âä¾ÂæÂ¹è®ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨ÂãÂÂæÂÂ丠TOP MENU æÂ MENU å³å¯é²堥é¸å®ã 2 æÂ äºÂè¶ ç´ VC D éÂÂæÂÂ堩種 é³è»ÂãÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ堩種é³è»Âï¼Â以åÂÂæ¯Âå é³è»Âç¨æÂÂçÂÂè²éÂÂã 3 æÂ äºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå å Â許æÂ¨å¾Âç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® ä¸Âä¾ÂæÂ¹è®Âå°Âç½èªÂè¨ÂãÂÂæÂÂ丠TOP MENU æÂ MENU å³å¯é²堥é¸å®ã 4 â¢ ç±æÂ¼ DVD ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VC D ã DivX è¦Âé » /WMV æ¨Âé¡Âå JPEG Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂåªæÂÂåºå®ÂçÂÂè§£æÂ åº¦ï¼Âå æÂ¤ç«質ç¹åÂ¥å¨æÂ¾å¤§å åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ失 çÂÂçÂÂæÂ å½¢ãÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç«é¢ä¸ÂæÂ¹çÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¹å¡Â涠失ï¼Â坿ÂÂ丠SHI FT ZOOM Ã¥ÂÂå°Âå®Â顯示 å¨è¢å¹Âä¸Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 30 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 07 31 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 7 ç« USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 使ç¨ USB ä»Âé¢ å©ç¨æÂ¬æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢ç USB ä»Âé¢就å¯以èÂÂè½éÂÂè² éÂÂé³ é » 1 並è§Âç DivX è¦Âé » /WMV/JPEG æªÂæ¡ ã æÂÂ丠åÂÂæÂ¹å¼Âé£æÂ¥ä¸ USB 大éÂÂå²åÂÂè£Âç½® 2 ã 1 éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂ丠USB ã 確å®Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå·²éÂÂ並è¨Âå®ÂçºæÂ£ 確çÂÂè¦Â頻輸堥ã 2 é£æÂ¥æÂ¨ç USB è£Âç½®ã USB 端åÂÂçÂÂä½Â置就å¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸ ã 3 æÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Â以éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã èÂ¥æÂ¯æÂ¨ç USB è£Âç½®ç¶ä¸Âå«æÂ JPEG ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå§ å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã èÂÂå ¶ç¸é çÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 25 é Âç æÂÂæÂ¾ JPEG å¹»çÂÂçÂÂç§ ã â¢ 確å®Âå¨è«é¢æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ系統å¨ å¾ æ©ÂçÂÂæ Âä¸Âï¼ ï¼Âå é¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤ºå¹Âä¸Â顯示 USB D ATA ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 è¥顯示å¹Âä¸Âç USB ERR è¨ÂæÂ¯æÂÂ示çÂÂ亮起 ï¼ åÂÂ表 示該 USB è£Âç½®çÂÂ黿ºÂéÂÂæ±Âå°ÂæÂ¼æÂ¬æ©Âä¾Â說太髠@æÂÂ該è£Âç½®ä¸Âç¸容ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ試 以ä¸ÂæÂ¹æ³Â@⢠éÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂå ã â¢ éÂÂæÂ°å¨æÂÂæÂ¾å¨éÂÂéÂÂæÂÂå° USB è£Âç½®æÂ¥ä¸Âã â¢ é¸åÂÂå ¶ä»Â輸堥ä¾Â溠ï¼Â妠DVD/CD ï¼ ï¼Âç¶ å¾ å é Âé¸å USB ã â¢ 使ç¨åÂÂå» å°Âç¨ç AC 黿ºÂè®Âå£Âå¨ ï¼Âé¨è£Âç½®é è´Âï¼Âä¾ÂæÂ USB 黿ºÂã èÂ¥ä¸Âè¿°æÂ¹å¼Âç¡æ³Â解決åÂÂé¡ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ該æÂ¯æÂ¨ç USB è£Âç½®ä¸Âç¸容ã å¨ USB è£Âç½®ä¸ÂéÂÂ製é³樠CD çÂÂæÂ² ç® å¨é£æÂ¥è³ USB å ç US B ä¸Âå¯以éÂÂ製è¼Âå ¥æÂ¬æ© ä¸ÂçÂÂé³樠CD æÂ²ç®ã éÂÂ製æÂÂæÂÂæÂ²ç® 1 è¼Âå ¥é³樠CD ã æÂÂ丠ï§ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ã éÂÂ註 1 éÂÂå æÂ¬ Di vX è¦Âé » /WMV/WMA/MP3/MPEG-4 AA C æªÂæ¡ ï¼Âé¤å«é²æÂ·å §å®¹æÂÂéÂÂå¶æÂ æÂ¾å §å®¹çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âå¤Âï¼ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 2 ⢠ç¸容ç USB è£Âç½®å æÂ¬å±¬æÂ¼ FAT16/32 æ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂç£Âç¢Âæ©ÂãÂÂ坿ÂÂå¼Âå¿« éÂÂè¨ÂæÂ¶é« ï¼Âç¹æ®Âé¨ 身ç¢Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³頻æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ ï¼ MP3 æÂÂæÂ¾ å¨@ãÂÂæÂ¬æ© ä¸Âè½é£æÂ¥è³åÂÂ人é»蠦ä¸Âé²衠USB æÂÂæÂ¾ ã â¢ å ÂéÂÂæ¦Âä¸Âä¿ èÂÂæÂÂæÂ USB 大é å²åÂÂè£Âç½®çÂÂç¸容æÂ§ ï¼ÂæÂÂä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ坿µÂæÂÂ黿ºÂï¼ ï¼Â亦ä¸ÂæÂ¿æÂÂé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ© æÂÂå¯è½é æÂÂè³ÂæÂÂéº失ç ç¸éÂÂ責任ã â¢ è³ÂæÂÂå«éÂÂ徠大æÂÂï¼Â系統æÂÂéÂÂè¦Âè¼Âé·çÂÂæÂÂéÂÂä¾Âè® å USB è£Âç½®çÂÂ堧容ã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Âå¯è½ç¡ æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢ºèÂÂ奿ÂÂ亠USB è£Âç½®ã â¢ å³使æÂ¯æÂ¯æÂ´ çÂÂæ ¼å¼Âï¼Âä»ÂæÂÂå 堧容èÂÂç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾æÂ é¡¯ç¤ºæÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡Âã USB ÃÂà » á¾ÃÂáÂÂá USB àA à  ¯Ã USB HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 31 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
USB æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂéÂÂ製 07 32 Zhtw 2 æÂ SHIFT USB REC 以顯示 ã CD -> USB Rec ï¼ CD -> USB è½ÂéÂÂï¼ ãÂÂç«é¢ã 3 æÂÂ丠ENTER éÂÂå§ÂéÂÂ製ã éÂÂå§ÂéÂÂ製ãÂÂéÂÂ製æÂÂï¼Â顯 示以ä¸ÂæÂÂ示çÂÂç«é¢ã 1 éÂÂ製ç¹å®ÂæÂ²ç® 1 è¼Âå ¥é³樠CD ã æÂÂ丠ï§ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ã 2 æÂ HOME MENU ï¼Âç¶å¾Âé¸æÂ ã CD -> USB Rec ï¼ CD -> USB è½ÂéÂÂï¼ ã ã åªæÂÂå¨åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾é³樠CD æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½é¸æÂ CD -> US B Rec ï¼ CD -> USB è½ÂéÂÂï¼ ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER å®ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé  è¨Âå® å¼ã 4 é¸åÂÂæÂ¨è¦ÂéÂÂ製çÂÂæÂ²ç®ã â¢ Individu al ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ¥ é¸åÂÂï¼ â ä¸Â次é¸åÂÂä¸Âå æÂ²ç®ã â¢ Select All ï¼Â鏿ÂÂå ¨é¨@â é¸åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ²ç®ã â¢ All Clear ï¼Â渠é¤堨é¨@â 渠餿ÂÂé¸åÂÂçÂÂæÂ æÂÂæÂ²ç®ã 5 鏿ÂÂä½Âå Âç ï¼Âå³輸çÂÂï¼ ã é¸æÂ 128 kbps ã 192 kb ps æÂ 320 kb ps ã 6 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ é¸æÂ ã Start ï¼ÂéÂÂå§Âï¼ ã @ç¶å¾ÂæÂ ENTER ã 2 éÂÂå§ÂéÂÂ製ã éÂÂ註 1 å¦ÂæÂ USB è£Âç½®æ²ÂæÂÂè¶³ 夠çÂÂ空éÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¡æ³ÂéÂÂå§Âé 製ãÂÂå¨éÂÂ種æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼Â顯示 ãÂÂå¯ç¨ USB 空éÂÂä¸Âè¶³ã ã CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack T otal Time T rack 1âÂÂ13 ï§ î T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 ï§ î T rack03 ï§ î T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 ï§ î T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 ï§ î T rack08 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 13 ï¦ï 055:07 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack T otal Time î 13 î 055:07 Cancel î 01:43 î 03:17 î 04:18 î 04:59 î 04:20 î 04:38 î 04:40 î 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î î T rack01 î î T rack02 î î T rack03 î î T rack04 î î T rack05 î î T rack06 î î T rack07 î î T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD â > USB Rec Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 00 ï¦ï 000:00 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 T rack05 T rack06 T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec 2 ⢠å®ÂæÂÂé 製æÂÂï¼Âå¨ USB è£Âç½®ä¸ÂæÂÂèªåÂÂ建ç«Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçº ãÂÂå ÂéÂÂãÂÂçÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ãÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ製ç æÂ²ç®å²åÂÂå¨æÂ¤è³ÂæÂÂ夾ä¸Âã â¢ æÂÂå¤Âå¯建章99 å ãÂÂå ÂéÂÂãÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾 ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂ USB è£Âç½®å å« 300 Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂ以 ä¸ÂçÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¡æ³Âé²è¡Âé 製ã â¢ å¨ USB è£Âç½® ä¸Âé²è¡ÂéÂÂ製æÂÂï¼Âé¤äºÂæÂÂä½ ïµ STANDBY/ON å ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE æÂÂéµèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¤Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂÂè DVD ç¸éÂÂç 主è¦ÂæÂÂä½Âã â¢ ç¡ç å®ÂæÂÂå¨ ON ï¼ÂéÂÂå ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂå§Âå¨ US B è£Âç½®éÂÂ製徠å³å°Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 01 ï¦ï 003:17 Select T rack Bitrate Individual Select All All Clear ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 T rack05 T rack06 T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Start Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Select T rack Bitrate ï§ î 128kbps 192kbps 320kbps ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 T rack03 T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec CD âÂÂ> USB Rec Select T rack Bitrate Start Selected T rack T otal Time T rack 1âÂÂ13 î T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 î T rack03 î T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 î T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 î T rack08 ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 ï¦ï 128kbps ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 T rack Progress T otal Progress Selected T rack T otal Time ï¦ï 03 ï¦ï 012:17 Cancel ï¦ï 01:43 ï¦ï 03:17 ï¦ï 04:18 ï¦ï 04:59 ï¦ï 04:20 ï¦ï 04:38 ï¦ï 04:40 ï¦ï 04:11 T rack 1âÂÂ13 î T rack01 ï§ î T rack02 î T rack03 î T rack04 ï§ î T rack05 î T rack06 ï§ î T rack07 î T rack08 CD âÂÂ> USB Rec HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 32 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± 08 33 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 8 ç« å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± å¡æÂ OK ä¼´å± 使ç¨伴å±åÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以å°Â麥å Â風æÂÂä¸Âå¾Âï¼Âå°Âèª å·±çÂÂè²é³溶堥èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âç¶ä¸Âã 1 æÂ¨å¯以é¸åÂÂä¾ èª CD ã DVD ã VCD æÂ US B è£Âç½®çÂÂ鳿ºÂçÂÂèÂÂæÂ¯ 鳿¨ÂãÂÂè«Â調æÂ´éº¥å Â風èÂÂèÂÂæÂ¯ ç¸å°ÂçÂÂé³éÂÂã 1 æÂÂ堥麥å Â風ã å¦ÂæÂÂåªæÂÂ使ç¨ä¸Âé»麥å Â風 ï¼ è«Âå°Âå®ÂæÂÂ丠MIC (MAIN) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã MIC (SUB) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂåªè½å¨æÂÂæÂ¥ä¸ MIC (MAIN) çÂÂæÂ æ³Âä¸ÂæÂÂè½使ç¨ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂ麥å Â風ä¸ÂæÂÂéÂÂé ï¼Âè«ÂæÂ¥è³éÂÂçÂÂä½Âç½®ã 2 置堥æÂÂä¼´å±èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨ÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以å©ç¨ USB è£Âç½®çÂÂæÂ²ç®ä½Âçº èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âç ä¾ÂæºÂåªÂé«Âã 3 調æÂ´ KARAOKE 模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âã â¢ æÂ SHIFT KARAOKE å¯éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂé éÂÂç¢Âç ï¼Âå·¦å³置è²éÂÂæÂÂ人è²ï¼Âç KAR AOKE 模å¼Âï¼ KARAOKE @人 è²æ¶Âé³@ï¼ÂèÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âä¸Âç 人è² æÂÂé¨åÂÂæÂÂæ¶Âé³ã OFF ï¼Âé Âè¨Âå¼ï¼Âï¼Âå¯å°Âä¼´å±模张éÂÂéÂÂã â¢ æÂ SHIFT AUDIO å¯åÂÂæÂÂç¢Âç ï¼Âå å®è²éÂÂæÂ äººè²æÂ²ç®@çÂÂé³頻è²é ï¼Âé¤è³ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå USB ä¾ æºÂå¤Âï¼ ï¼ Left ï¼Âå 左è²éÂÂãÂÂç¨æÂ¼å³è²éÂÂä¸Âé 製æÂÂ人è²é çÂÂæÂ²ç®ã Right ï¼Âå å³è²éÂÂãÂÂç¨æÂ¼å·¦è²éÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂ製æÂÂ人è² éÂÂçÂÂæÂ²ç®ã STEREO ï¼Âå¯å°Âä¼´å±模å¼Âé éÂÂã 4 æÂÂæÂ¾èÂÂæÂ¯é³æ¨Âã 5 調æÂ´ MIC VOL /â æÂÂéÂÂè³æÂ¨æÂ³è¦ÂçÂÂè²é³ ã 2 çºé¿å Âç¢çÂÂæÂ±äººçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¥Âä¿¡è ï¼Âè«Â確å®ÂæÂ¨æ²ÂæÂÂ尠麥å Â風æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ã 3 è®ÂæÂ´æ··è²æÂÂæÂ å¨麥å Â風混è²ä¸Âå 堥ä¸Â亠æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¯以æÂ¹åÂÂæÂ´ é«Âè²é³çÂÂæÂÂ覺ã 4 æÂ¨å¯以é¸åÂÂä¸Â種迴é³ä½ÂæºÂã â¢ è¦Âå¨麥å Â風ä¸Âå 堥æÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT ECHO ã é£çºÂæÂÂä¸Â以åÂÂæÂÂé³é 1 å°é³é 3 Ã¥ÂÂé ã è®ÂæÂ´èÂÂæÂ¯é³樠æÂ¨å¯è½éÂÂè¦ÂéÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂÂé«Âè æÂ¯é³æ¨ÂçÂÂé³éÂÂ以é Âå æÂ¨çÂÂè²é³ã 5 ⢠æÂÂ丠SHIFT ï æÂ SHIFT ï 以éÂÂä½ÂæÂÂæÂÂé«Âè æÂ¯é³æ¨ÂçÂÂé³éÂÂé«Âä½Âã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠éÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½åªæÂÂ卿ÂÂ¥ ä¸Â麥å Â風æÂÂæÂÂå¯使ç¨ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂ æÂ¨åÂÂ試å¨æÂªæÂ¥ä¸Â麥å Â風æÂÂ使ç¨ SHIFT KARAOKEã SHIFT E CHOã SHIFT ï ã SHIFT ï æÂ MIC VOLï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¢ å¹ÂæÂÂ顯示 NO MIC ï¼ÂæÂªæÂ¥ä¸Â麥å Â風ï¼Âè¨ÂæÂ¯ãÂÂå¦è«Â注 æÂÂï¼Â卿ÂÂæÂ¾ DVD çÂÂæÂÂé ï¼Âç¶æÂ¨æÂ¥ä¸ éº¥å Â風æÂÂï¼Âè²é³è¨Âå®Âèª Ã¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ STEREO æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼Â並å°Âå¤Âè²éÂÂä¾ æºÂ縮混æÂ 2.1 è²éÂÂã â¢ éÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½åª è½æÂÂé  DVD/CD æÂ USB 輸堥åÂÂè½使ç¨ã MAIN SUB MIC 2M I C V O L å¨æÂ¨åÂÂä¸Â麥 å Â風ï¼Âè®ÂæÂ´åÂÂè½æÂÂéÂÂéÂÂ黿ºÂæÂÂè¨Âå® çº 0ã 3 è¦Â麥å Â風é³éÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂç è²é³å¯è½æÂÂ失çÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂç¼çÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®æÂ å½¢ï¼Âè«Âå°Âé³éÂÂ調ä½Âã 4 æÂÂ堥麥å Â風æÂÂï¼Âç¡æ³Â調æÂ´ SFC 模å¼ÂãÂÂé³調æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âä½Âé³ãÂÂé«Âé³åÂÂä½Âé³å éÂÂï¼ ãÂÂå 大åÂÂçÂÂ模å¼ÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç½®ç°繠è²模å¼Âã MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨ 模å¼ÂæÂÂè²é³強åÂÂå¨模张ã 5 æÂ¤åÂÂè½è DTS è¨ÂèÂÂ丠ç¸容ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 33 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
é³頻è¨Âç½®åÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´é¸å® 09 34 Zhtw 第 9 ç« é³頻è¨Âç½®åÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´é¸å® ãÂÂé³頻è¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® ãÂÂé³頻è¨Âç½®ã é¸å®å¯æÂÂä¾Â調 æÂ´ç¢ÂçÂÂè²é³çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並å¾Âå¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢é¸ å ã Audio Se ttings ï¼Âé³頻è¨Â置@ã ã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER ä¾Âé¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ è¨Âå®Âå¼ã é³頻 DRC ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ§å¶@⢠è¨Â置@High ï¼Âé« ï¼ ã Medi um ï¼Âä¸Âï¼ ã Low ï¼Âä½Âï¼ ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼Âé Âè¨Âå¼@å¨以ä½Âé³éÂÂè§Âè³ Dolby Digital DVD æÂÂï¼Âå¾Â容 æÂÂå®Â堨失å»è¼ÂéÂÂçÂÂè²é³ï¼Âå æÂ¬ä¸ÂäºÂå°Âç½å¨堧ã å°Âé³頻 DRC ï¼Âå æ Âç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ§å¶@åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ坿ÂÂå©æÂ¼çª é¡¯è¼Âè¼ÂçÂÂè²é³ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ æÂÂæÂ§å¶è¼ÂéÂÂçÂÂè²é³ã æÂÂè½å°è²é³çÂÂå·®åÂÂ¥ ï¼ è¦ÂæÂ¨èÂÂè½çÂÂåªÂ髠堧容èÂÂå® ã å¦ÂæÂÂåªÂé«Â堧容å¨é³éÂÂä¸Âæ²ÂæÂÂ太å¤Âè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âé£æÂ¨ä¾¿ ä¸ÂæÂÂ注æÂÂæÂÂä½Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã 1 ãÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´ãÂÂé¸å® å¾ ãÂÂè¦Â頻調æÂ´ãÂÂç åÂÂè½ç«é¢ä¸Âï¼ æÂ¨å¯以調æÂ´è½ å½±é¿影åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並å¾Âå¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢é¸ å ã Video Adju st ï¼Âè¦Â頻調æÂ´ï¼ ã ã 2 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ï¬ å ENTER ä¾Âå®ÂæÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã æÂ¨å¯以調æÂ´ä»¥ä¸ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼@⢠Sharpness ï¼Âé³ 度@ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´ç«é¢éÂÂç·£ç é³å©度 ï¼ Fine ï¼Â精細@ã Standard ï¼Âæ¨ÂæºÂï¼ ã Soft ï¼ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ@@⢠Brightness ï¼Â亮度@ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´æÂ´é«ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ç 亮度 ï¼ â 20 è³ 20@⢠Contrast ï¼Âå°Â毠度 ï¼ ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´äº®èÂÂæÂÂä¹Âé çÂÂå°Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ ï¼ â 16 è³ 16@⢠Gamma ï¼Âä¼½çª@ï¼Âå¯調 æÂ´å½±åÂÂç ãÂÂæÂÂ度ã @High ï¼Âé«Âï¼ ã Medium ï¼Âä¸Âï¼ ã Low ï¼Âä½Âï¼ ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂ@@⢠Hue ï¼ è²調@ï¼Âå¯調æÂ´ç´ ï¼Â綠平衡 ï¼ Green 9 ï¼Âç¶ è² 9 ï¼ è³ Red 9 ï¼Âç´ è² 9 @@⢠Chroma Level ï¼Âè²度çÂÂç´Âï¼ ï¼ å¯調è²彩å ç¾çÂÂ飽åÂÂ度 ï¼ â 9 è³ 9 @使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ ä¾Â調æÂ´äº®åº¦ãÂÂå°Âæ¯Â度ãÂÂè²調åÂÂè²度 çÂÂç´ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ã 3 æÂÂ丠ENTER 以è¿Âå ã Vide o Adjust ï¼Â覠頻調æÂ´ï¼ ã åÂÂè½ç«é¢ ï¼ æÂÂæÂÂ丠HOME MENU é åºåÂÂè½ç«é¢ã éÂÂ註 1 é³頻 DRC å 尠Dolby Digital é³頻ä¾ÂæºÂè½ç¼æÂ®æÂÂç¨ã Audio Settings Audio Settings Audio DRC High Medium Low Off Video Adjust Sharpness Brightness Contrast Gamma Hue Chroma Level Standard 0 0 Off 0 0 î î î î î î Video Adjust Brightness min max 0 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 34 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 35 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 10 ç« ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 使ç¨ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ã é¸å®æÂÂä¾Âé³ é »åÂÂè¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã æÂÂ人éÂÂå®Âï¼Â以åÂÂ顯示è¨Âå®Âå¼ çÂÂã å¦ÂæÂÂé¸頠åÂÂç¾淡åºçÂÂç°è²ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ表示æÂ¤æÂÂç¡æ³ÂæÂÂ¥ Ã¥ÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ãÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®æÂ å½¢éÂÂ常æÂ¯å çºç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾çÂʍ᣾ ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ åÂÂè®ÂæÂ´è¨Âå®Âå¼ã 1 æÂÂ丠DVD/CD ã 2 Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠HOME ME NU 並é¸å ã Initia l Settings ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Â置@ã ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª/ï«/ ï¬ å ENTER 以é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦Â訠å®ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂé¸頠ã æÂÂæÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂé¸頠å°ÂæÂÂå¨ å¾ÂçºÂçÂÂ堧容ä¸Â詳å 說 æÂÂã 1 è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ éÂÂ註 1 ⢠å¨表ä¸Âï¼Âé Âè¨Â弿Âʊȴ ç²Âé«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ顯示@堶仠çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂæÂÂ以 æÂÂé«Âå 顯示å¨è¢å¹Âä¸Âã â¢ æÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯ TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ ã Audio La nguage ï¼Âå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼Âå Subtitle Language ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼Âå¯è½ å° DVD 碠çÂÂ並ä¸Âå ·æÂÂç¨ãÂÂéÂÂ常éÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼亦 å¯徠DVD çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å® ä¸Âä¾Âå®ÂæÂÂè¨Âç½®ã â¢ HDMI Resolution ï¼ HDMI è§£æÂÂ度@è HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼åªæÂÂå¨æÂ¨å©ç¨ HDMI æÂ¥é Âå°ÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨é£æÂ¥è³ HDMI ç¸容è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂ忠覠é²è¡Âè¨Âå®Âã 2 ç¶æÂ¨ç¶Âç± HDMI é£æÂ¥æÂ¹å¼ÂãÂÂ並尠HDMI è§£æÂÂ度è¨Âçº 1920 x 1080p ã 1920 x 10 80i æÂ 1280 x 720p æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè½ 使ç¨æÂ¤è¨Âå®Âã 使ç¨æÂ¤è¨Âå®Â弿ÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨åª è½使ç¨ HDMI é£æÂ¥æÂ¹å¼Âã Initial Settings è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ ï¼Âå¦è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 51 é Âç ç« é¢大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæ ¼ å¼ ãÂÂï¼ 4:3 (Letter Box) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å³統 4:3 é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ã 寬è¢å¹Âé» å½±å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂï¼Âä¸Âä¸Âå ©å´æÂÂæÂ é»Âè²æ¢ÂéÂÂã 4:3 (Pan & Scan) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å³統 4:3 é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ãÂÂ寬è¢å¹Âé» å½±å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂæÂÂè£ÂæÂÂå·¦å³堩å´ ä¸Âé¨åÂÂï¼Â以å©填滿æÂ´åÂÂè¢å¹Âã 16:9 (W ide) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å¯¬è¢å¹Âé»覠æ©ÂæÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ã 16:9 (Compressed) å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂæÂ¯å¯¬è¢å¹Âé»覠æ©ÂæÂÂï¼ éÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ãÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ 4:3 çÂÂå § 容æÂÂï¼Âç«é¢堶ä¸Âä¸Âå´å°Â顯示 é»Âè²æ¢ÂéÂÂã 2 Component Out ï¼Âè²差è¦Â頻輸åº@ï¼Âå¦è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âç é£ æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻è¨Âå ãÂÂï¼ Interlac e ï¼Âé è¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂèÂ¥ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »æÂÂï¼ éÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ã Progressive ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âå¦ÂæÂÂé©ç¨æÂ¼éÂÂè¡ æÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »æÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¨Âç½®æÂ¤é  ï¼Âè«Âå é±æÂ¨é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂ詳 細說æÂÂï¼ ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂä¸Â次 ENTER 確誠ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠RETURN Ã¥ÂÂæ¶Âè¨Â置@ã è«Â注æÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂ覠頻å å¯ç¶Âç±è²差è¦Âé »æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ輸åºã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 35 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 36 Zhtw èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ HDMI Resolution ï¼ HDMI è§£æÂÂ度 ï¼ * ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 41 é Âç 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ãÂÂï¼ * é Âè¨Â弿ÂÂé ÂÃ¥ÂÂé»è¦Âæ ¼ å¼Âï¼ PAL/NTSC ï¼ÂæÂ¹è®Âã 1920 x 1080p å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 1920 x 1080 ç«素éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Â訠å®ÂæÂ¤é  ã 1920 x 1080i å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 1920 x 1080 ç«素éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ ï¼ åÂÂè«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã 1280 x 720p å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 1280 x 720 ç«素éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Âè¨Âå® æÂ¤é  ã 720 x 480p (NTSC)/ 720 x 576p (PAL) å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 720 x 480 (NTSC)/720 x 576 (PAL) ç«素é è¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã 720 x 480i (NTSC)/ 720 x 576i (PAL) å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ 720 x 480 (NTSC)/72 0 x 576 (PAL) ç«素é è¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@* ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 41 é Âç 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ãÂÂï¼ * é Âè¨Â弿ÂÂè¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂ訠åÂÂæÂ¹è®Âã Full range RGB ï¼Âé²é RGB ï¼ è²彩微弱æÂÂï¼Â坿ÂÂä¾ÂæÂ´äº® éºÂçÂÂè²彩åÂÂæÂ´æ·±çÂÂé»Âè² ï¼ÂæÂ¤é Âè¨Âå¼ é©ç¨æÂ¼ HDMI ç¸容ç DV I è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã RGB 使ç¨ ãÂÂé²é RGB ã è¨Âå®Âå¼æÂ ï¼ÂèÂ¥è² 彩太éÂÂ飽滿@è«Âè¨Âå®ÂæÂ¤é  ã Component ï¼Âè²差 ï¼ å¯輸åº 8-bit çÂÂè²差è¦Â頻格张ï¼ÂæÂ¤é Âè¨Âå¼é©ç¨æÂ¼ HDMI ç¸容 è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ Audio Language ï¼Âå°Âç½èªÂè¨Âï¼ English ï¼Âè±èªÂï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂæÂ è± èªÂçÂÂé³è»Âï¼Â峿ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠å¦ÂæÂÂé¸åÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼ å³æÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã 堶ä»ÂèªÂ訠é¸åÂÂæÂÂ顯示以å¤ÂçÂÂèªÂ訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼Âã Subtitle Language ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼ English ï¼Âè±èªÂï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂæÂ è± èªÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Âï¼Â峿ÂÂ顯示ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠æÂÂ顯示å¨ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âé¸åÂÂçÂÂå å¹ÂèªÂè¨Âã 堶ä»ÂèªÂ訠é¸åÂÂæÂÂ顯示以å¤ÂçÂÂèªÂ訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼Âã DVD Menu Language ï¼ DVD èÂÂå®èªÂ訠@w/Subtitle La ng. ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âé£åÂÂï¼ å¯è½çÂÂ話@DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂé¸å®æÂÂ以åÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂé¸åÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âç¸å çÂÂèªÂ訠顯示ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠å¯è½çÂÂ話@DVD é¸å®æÂÂ以æÂÂé¸çÂÂèªÂè¨Â顯 示ã 堶ä»ÂèªÂ訠é¸åÂÂæÂÂ顯示以å¤ÂçÂÂèªÂ訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼Âã Subtitle Display ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Â顯示@On ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ åÂÂå¹ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂé¸çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Â誠è¨Â顯示ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ å¨æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢Âç æÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂæÂÂä¾Âé Âè¨ÂæÂ¹å¼Âä¿ÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂçÂÂçÂÂæ Âã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 36 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 37 Zhtw English Español English Español 顯示å¹Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠è¨Âå®Âå¼ æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® æÂÂ人éÂÂ宠⢠é Âè¨ÂçÂÂç´Âï¼ Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ ï¼Âé Âè¨Âå¯Â碼@ç¡ ï¼ é Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼@us (2119) çºäºÂè®ÂæÂ¨å¯以æÂ§å¶ä¸Âè®ÂæÂ¨ç å°Âå©使ç¨æÂ¨ç DVD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨è§Âè³Âå½±çÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ亠DVD-Vi deo ç¢ÂçÂÂçµÂå æÂÂæÂÂ人éÂÂå®ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç´ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨è¨Âç½® çÂÂçÂÂç´Âè¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂçºä½Âï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂ便 ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¹ÂæÂÂæÂ¯æÂ´åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼åÂÂè½ãÂÂæÂ¬æ© ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂäºÂå ´æÂ¯ï¼Âè¦ÂæÂ¨è¨Âç½®ç åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼èÂÂå®Âã çÂȎÂÂæÂ°å¯Â碼 è«Â輸堥å¯Â碼以è®ÂæÂ´æÂÂ人éÂÂå®ÂçÂÂç´ÂæÂÂ輸堥åÂÂå®¶ï¼ å°åÂÂ代碼ã 1 1 é¸å ã Password ï¼Âå¯Â碼@ã ã 2 使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ輸堥åÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸å å¯Â碼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂ´æÂÂå¯Â碼 è¦ÂæÂ´æÂ¹å¯Â碼ï¼Âè«Âå Â確èªÂç¾æÂÂå¯Â碼ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ輸堥æÂ°ç å¯Â碼ã 1 é¸åÂÂã Passwo rd Change ï¼ÂæÂ´æÂÂå¯Â碼@ã @輸堥ç¾è¡ÂçÂÂå¯Â碼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ ä¸ ENTER ã 2 輸堥æÂ°å¯Â碼並æÂÂ丠ENTER ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ OSD Language ï¼Âå¨å±Â顯示èªÂè¨Âï¼ English ï¼Âè± èªÂï¼ å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢æÂÂæÂÂè±èªÂ顯示ã åÂÂ顯示çÂÂèªÂ訠å¨å±Â顯示ç«é¢æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂé¸çÂÂ誠è¨Â顯示ã Angle Indicator ï¼Âè§Â度æÂÂ示çÂÂï¼ On ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ å¨æÂÂæÂ¾ DVD ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂå¤Âè§Â度場æÂ¯æÂÂé ï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示ç¸橠åÂÂ示ã Off ï¼ÂéÂÂï¼ ä¸Â顯示å¤Âè§Â度æÂÂ示åÂÂ示ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ Parent al Lock ï¼ÂæÂÂ人éÂÂå®Âï¼ â è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå æÂÂ人éÂÂå® ã DivX(R) VOD Display è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX î VOD 堧容 ã è¨Âå®Âå¼ é¸頠說æÂ Speaker Dista nce ï¼ÂæÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢@â å¯æÂÂå®ÂæÂÂè²å¨èÂÂèÂÂè½ä½Âç½®ç è·Âé¢ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 39 é Âç æÂÂè² å¨è·Âé¢ ï¼Âã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠並éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ種é¡ÂçÂÂ碠çÂÂé½é©ç¨æÂÂ人éÂÂå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ï¼Âè ä¸Â亦ç¡é Âå Â輸堥å¯Â碼æÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨å¿Â訠å¯Â碼ï¼ÂæÂ¨æÂÂéÂÂè¦Âå°ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨éÂÂç½®æÂÂè½ ç»è¨ÂæÂ°çÂÂå¯Â碼 ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 ï¼Âã Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD Passw ord Level Change Country Code Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 37 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 38 Zhtw è¨Âç½®ï¼ÂæÂ¹è®ÂæÂÂ人éÂÂå® 1 é¸å ã Level Chang e ï¼ÂæÂ¹è®Âç´Âå¥@ã ã 2 使ç¨æÂ¸åÂÂéµ輸堥æÂ¨çÂÂå¯Â碼 ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 é¸åÂÂæÂ°çÂÂçÂÂç´Â並æÂÂ丠ENTER ã â¢ é£çºÂæÂ ï« 以éÂÂå®Âå¨æÂ´é«ÂçÂÂ層次 ï¼ÂæÂ´å¤Âç¢Âç éÂÂè¦Â使ç¨å¯Â碼@ï¼ÂæÂ ä¸ ï¬ 以åÂÂæ¶ÂéÂÂå®Â層次 ã æÂ¨ä¸Âè½éÂÂå¨çÂÂç´ 1 ã è¨Âç½®ï¼Âè®ÂæÂ´åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼 æÂ¨å¯以å¾Â第 58 é Âç åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼渠å® ç¶丠æÂ¾å°ã 1 é¸å ã Country Code ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ家代碼@ã ï¼Â輸 å ¥å¯Â碼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTE R ã 2 é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã å¨æÂ¤æÂÂä¾Â堩種è¨Âç½®çÂÂæÂ¹ æ³Â@⢠æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼é¸å @使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂå®¶ï¼ å°åÂÂ代碼ã â¢ æÂÂæÂ¸åÂÂ代碼é¸åÂÂï¼ æÂÂ丠ï¬ï¼Âç¶å¾Â使ç¨æÂ¸å éµ輸堥åÂÂä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼ å°åÂÂ代碼ã å¨éÂÂåºç¢ÂçÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂ°çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼便ç«Âå³ç æÂÂã éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX î VOD 堧容 çºäºÂè® DivX VOD ï¼Âé¨é¸è¦Âé »ï¼ÂçÂÂ堧容è½å¨æÂ¬ æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¿ é Âå Âå æÂ¨ç DivX VOD 堧容侠æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂȎÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂè³ÂæÂ ã æÂ¨å¯以èÂÂç±ç¢çÂÂä¸Âçµ DivX VOD çÂȎÂÂ代碼ï¼Âç¼éÂÂ給æÂ¨çÂÂä¾ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¾Âå® æÂÂçÂȎÂÂä½Âæ¥Âã 1 éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠DivX VOD 堧容å DRM ï¼ÂæÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂ@系統æÂÂä¿Âè· ã éÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå¶åªæÂÂä¸ÂäºÂç¹ å® ã 已ç» éÂÂçÂÂè£Âç½®æÂÂè½æÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨å¨æÂ¬æ©Â堧置堥ä¸Âç æÂªç¶ÂæÂÂæ¬Â使ç¨ ï¼ å § å« DivX VOD 堧容çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸Â峿ÂÂ顯 示 Authorization Error ï¼ÂæÂÂæ¬Âé¯誤@çÂÂ訠æÂ¯ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ堧容亦ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã 顯示æÂ¨ç DivX VOD çÂȎÂÂ代碼 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸å ã In itial Settings ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Â置@ã ã 2 é¸å ã Options ï¼Âé¸頠@ã ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ¯ ã DivX (R) VOD ãÂÂã 3 é¸å ã Display ãÂÂã è¢å¹Âä¸Â顯示æÂ¨çÂÂå «ä½ÂæÂ¸åÂÂç» éÂÂ代碼ã è«Âè¨Âä¸Â代碼ï¼Âå çºå¨åÂÂæÂ¨ç DivX VOD ä¾ÂæÂÂå çÂȎÂÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂè¦Âç¨å°ã æÂÂæÂ¾ DivX î VOD 堧容 æÂÂ亠DivX VOD å § 容å è½ä½Âä¸Âå®ÂæÂÂéÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã å¨ æÂ¨ç½®å ¥å«æÂÂæÂ¤ç¨® DivX VOD 堧容çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ ï¼ å©餠æÂÂæÂ¾æ¬¡æÂ¸ä¾¿æÂÂ顯示å¨è¢å¹Â丠@ç¶å¾ÂæÂ¨ 便å¯以é¸å è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢Âç ï¼Âå æÂ¤ å¯以ç¨ä¸Âå ¶ä¸Âä¸Â種å©é¤ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ 次æÂ¸ï¼ ï¼ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç½®å ¥çÂÂæÂ¯å«æÂÂæÂÂé 已éÂÂç DivX VOD 堧容 ï¼Âä¾Âå¦Âï¼Â堧容çÂÂå©é¤ÂæÂ æÂ¾æ¬¡æÂ¸æÂ¯é¶@ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¢å¹Âä¸Â便æÂÂ顯示 Rent al Expired ï¼Âç§ÂæÂÂå·²éÂÂï¼ çÂÂè¨ÂæÂ¯ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç DivX VOD 堧容å Â許ä¸ÂéÂÂ次æÂ¸çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ é£æÂ¨ä¾¿å¯以å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂ置堥æÂ¬æ©Âï¼Â並æÂÂæÂ¾æÂ¨å¸¸çÂÂç 堧容ï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸Â亦ä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示任 ä½Âè¨ÂæÂ¯ã éÂÂ註 1 é 置æÂ¬æ© ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 57 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 ï¼Âä¸Âè´使æÂ¨å¤±åÂȾ¨çÂÂçÂȎÂÂ代 碼ã Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Display Initial Settings Parental Lock DivX (R) VOD HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 38 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Âç½®ãÂÂé¸å® 10 39 Zhtw English Español English Español æÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢ â¢ é Âè¨Âå¼@3.0m æÂ³è¦Âå¾ÂæÂ¨çÂÂ系統ä¸Âç¢çÂÂæÂÂä½³çÂÂç°ç¹Â鳿ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂå° ç¸è·ÂèÂÂè½ä½Â置堩å´çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ è¨Âå®ÂçºåÂÂçÂÂè·Âé¢ã 1 æÂÂ丠HOME MENU 並é¸ å ã Initia l Settings ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå§Âè¨Â置@ã ã 2 é¸å ã Speaker s ï¼ æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼ ã ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ¯ ã Speaker Dis tance ï¼ æÂÂè²å¨è·Âé¢ ï¼ ã ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸åÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂè²å¨ã 4 æÂÂ丠ï¬ 以è®ÂæÂ´åÂÂç½æÂÂè²å¨çÂÂæÂÂè²å¨éÂÂè·Âã 5 使ç¨ ï©/ïª è®ÂæÂ´éÂÂè·Âã â¢ å¨æÂ¨è®ÂæÂ´å·¦åÂÂç½® ï¼ L ï¼ÂæÂÂå³åÂÂç½® ï¼ÂR ï¼ÂæÂÂè² å¨çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âå®Âå¼æÂ ï¼ æÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂè²å¨çÂÂéÂÂ跠亦æÂÂç¸å°Âè®ÂæÂ´ã â¢ å·¦ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½® ï¼ L / R ï¼ÂæÂÂè²å¨éÂÂè·Âå¯以毠30 cm çºå¢Âå å®你@徠30 cm å¢Âè³ 9 m ã 1 ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼ C ï¼Âå¯ 以 â 2.1 m è³ 0 m çÂÂè·Âé¢ ç¸å°ÂæÂ¼å·¦ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® ã â¢ å·¦ï¼Âå³ç°繠@SL / SR ï¼ æÂ è²å¨å¯以è¨Âç½®å¾Âå¯ 以 â 6.0 m è³ 0 m çÂÂè·Âé¢ç¸å°ÂæÂ¼å·¦ï¼Âå³å 置æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½®ã 2 ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ ï¼ SWï¼ å¯以è¨Âç½®å¾Âå¯以 â 2.1 m è³ 0 m çÂÂè·Âé¢ç¸å°ÂæÂ¼å·¦ï¼Âå³åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨è¨Âç½® ã 6 å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ³è¦Âè®ÂæÂ´å ¶ä»ÂçÂÂæÂ è²å¨éÂÂè·Âå¼ï¼Âè« æÂÂ丠ï« 以è¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè²å¨渠å®ï¼ÂæÂ æÂÂ丠ENTER 以éÂÂåºæÂÂè²å¨éÂÂè·Âç«é¢ã éÂÂ註 1 L å R æÂÂè²å¨åÂÂæÂ¯æÂÂå°ÂçÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ ç¡æ³ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂä¾Âè¨Âç½®ã 2 å¨使ç¨å 大åÂÂçÂÂ模张ï¼Â第 23 é Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â確實è¨Â置以ç¸ Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂéÂÂè·Âã Video Output Language Display Options Speakers Speaker Distance Initial Settings Video Output Language Display Options Speakers L C R SR SL SW 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m 3.0m Initial Settings HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 39 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 40 Zhtw 第 11 ç« å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 â¢ å¨æÂ¬æ©Âå¾Âé¢æÂ¿é£æÂ¥æÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Â確實å°Â黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂ並å¾ÂçÂÂ壠æÂÂ座æÂÂä¸Â黿ºÂç·Âã å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âå¾Âï¼Âè«Âå°Âé» æºÂç·Âé£æÂ¥è³çÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座ä¸Âã é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³頻è¨Âå 使ç¨ç«Âé«Âè²é¡Âæ¯Â輸堥å¯é£æÂ¥å¡å¼ÂéÂÂé³座æÂ MD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨çÂÂå¤Âé¨è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âç¶Âç±æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂæÂ¾ã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±丠述ç 1 ã â¢ 飿ÂÂ¥ (LIN E 1) AUDIO IN æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè³å¤Âé¨æÂ æÂ¾è¨ åÂÂçÂÂé¡Âæ¯Â輸åºä¸Âã å¯使ç¨ RCA éÂÂé ÂÃ¥ÂÂç«Âé«Âè²é£æÂ¥ç·Âä¾Âé£æÂ¥ã AC IN HDMI OUT ANALOG AUDIO IN SPEAKERS (4 é ) LINE 1 L R L R FRONT CENTER R SURROUND SUB WOOFER A N T E N N A FM UNBAL 75 é AM LOOP Y P B P R ADAPTER PORT VIDEO OUT VIDEO(TV) COMPONENT VIDEO 5 m à6 m ÿÃÂà ¥²áÂÂá°àÿÃÂà ¥²á á°ààî HDMI á°ä ÃÂÃÂà §°á°ä PA L à ´Âà ¯¦áÂ à ¡ÂõÃÂá¤ à ¡ÂòÃÂᤠÃÂÃÂà ±Âà ®Âà ¼°à ¨ ÃÂáµá¤àBluetooth î à ¼Âá°á£ KURO LINK à £»à §¡Ã ÃÂá£ÃÂà ¥®áÂ¬à º ÃÂÃÂáÂÂà ¥²à §µà ¹ áÂ¬à ºÂá¡ AM áÂÂà  ¯ ÃÂᤠHTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 40 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 41 Zhtw English Español English Español 使ç¨è²差è¦Â頻輸åºé£æÂÂ¥ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂè² å·®è¦Â頻輸堥@æÂ¨å¯以使ç¨ éÂÂäºÂ輸堥åÂÂ代æ¨ÂæºÂè¦Â頻輸åº以å¾Âå°æÂ´å¥½çÂÂç« 質ã 1 éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 2 ã â¢ 使ç¨è²差è¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç·Â飿ÂÂ¥ COMPONENT VIDEO OUT è³æÂ¨é»è¦Âæ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂè²差輸堥絠ã éÂÂæÂ¼éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé » ç¸è¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »æÂ´è½æÂÂæÂÂç å åÂÂå½±åÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂé »çÂÂï¼Âç¢çÂÂç¸ç¶穩å®Âï¼Âç¡跳å çÂÂå½±åÂÂãÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé »å å¯éÂÂéÂÂè²差è¦Â頻輸åº 端åÂÂ輸åºã æÂ¬æ©ÂèÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé«Âå³çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âä¹Âç¸容æÂ§ã â¢ æÂ¬æ©ÂèÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¦Âé » Macro Vision System Copy Guard ç¸容ã 2 使ç¨ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ èÂ¥é Âå HDMI æÂ DVI ï¼ÂçµÂå HDCP ï¼ çÂÂ顯示å¨ æÂÂ顯示è£Âç½®ï¼Âå¯ å©ç¨ä¸Âè¬å¸Âé¢ä¸Âç HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ç·Âå°Âå®Âé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ï¼Â以æÂÂä¾Âé«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ質çÂÂæÂ¸ä½ è¦Âé »ã 3 éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 3 ã â¢ 使ç¨ HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âå°ÂæÂ¬ æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ç HDMI OUT é£æÂ¥ç«¯å é£æÂ¥è³ HDMI ç¸ 容顯示å¨ä¸Âç HDMI é£æÂ¥ç«¯åÂÂã â¢ é£æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¥é ÂçÂÂç®Âé ÂæÂ æÂÂä¸Â精確å°ÂæºÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ çÂÂæÂ¥é Âã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以調æÂ´è§£æÂÂ度åÂÂè² 彩ç HDMI è¨Âå®Âå¼ã 欲äºÂè§£èÂÂéÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ç¸éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´å¤Âè³Â訠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã åÂÂæÂ HDMI é³頻è¨Âç½® å¼ æÂ¨å¯以鏿ÂÂ系統æÂÂè²å¨æÂ é»è¦Âï¼ éÂÂé HDMI 輸 åº DVD/CD æÂ USB Ã¥ÂÂè½çÂÂè²é³ ã 4 HDMI é³頻 è¨Âå®Âçº TV æÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ç¡æ³Â使ç¨æÂ¬ç³»çµ±çÂÂå¤Âå è²é³ Ã¥ÂÂè½ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å HDMI SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å HDMI MODE ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ ä¸ ENTERã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸åÂÂæÂ³è¦ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂ ä¸ ENTER ã â¢ AMP â å¾ÂæÂ¬ç³»çµ±è¼¸åº DVD/CD çÂÂè²é³è USB Ã¥ÂÂè½è¨ÂèÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠è²差è¦Â頻輸åº å¯å¨éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂæ ¼å¼Âä¹ÂéÂÂä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂãÂÂè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã â¢ 使ç¨ HDMI ç·Âé£æÂ¥æÂÂæÂ¾å¨æÂÂï¼Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂå½±åÂÂ輸åºä¸Âå¯å¨ Interlace ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè Progressiv e ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âæ ¼å¼Âä¹ éÂÂå æÂÂã HDMI è§£æÂÂ度è¨Âçº 720x480i (NTSC)/720x576i(PAL) æ ¼å¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âå°ÂèªåÂÂé¸å Interlace ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âæ ¼å¼Âã ä½Âå¨堶ä»Âè¨Âå® ä¸Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯èªåÂÂé¸å Progressive ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âæ ¼å¼Âã 2 æ¶Âè²»è æÂÂ注æÂÂï¼Â並éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂç é«Âå³çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½èÂÂæÂÂ¢åÂÂå®Âå ¨ç¸ 容ï¼Âä¸Âå¯è½å°Âè´ç«é¢ä¸Âåº ç¾人çºé æÂÂçÂÂç¾象ãÂÂå°ÂæÂ¼ 525 éÂÂè¡ æÂÂæÂÂç«é¢åÂÂé¡Âï¼Â建è°使 ç¨è å¯å°Âé£æÂ¥ç«¯åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè³ ãÂÂæ¨ÂæºÂè§£æÂÂ度ãÂÂ輸åº ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ ä¾Âå 以æÂ¹åÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂç¼çÂÂé»覠æ©ÂèÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âå¨ç¸ 容æÂ§æÂ¹é¢çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âï¼Âè«Âè æÂ¬å ¬å¸çÂÂ客æÂÂä¸Âå¿Âè¯繫ã 3 ⢠HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ æÂ¹å¼Âå é©ç¨æÂ¼è DVI å HDCP ï¼ High Bandwidth Digi tal Content P rotection ï¼Âç¸ 容 ç DVI å 訠åÂÂãÂÂèÂÂ¥ é¸ å é£ æÂ¥è³ DVI æÂ¥é Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨å¦å¤ÂçÂÂè½ÂæÂ¥é  ï¼ DVI ï¤ HDMI ï¼Âå®ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥ãÂÂç¶èÂÂï¼ DVI é£æÂ¥æÂ¹ å¼Â並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´é³頻信èÂÂãÂÂ欲äºÂè§£æÂ´å¤ ç¸é è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«Âæ´½ç¶å°é³é¿綠é·åÂÂã â¢ è¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂ訠åÂÂèÂÂå®Âï¼Â使ç¨ DVI é£ æÂ¥å¯è½å°Âè´信èÂÂå³輸ä¸Âç©©ã â¢ èÂ¥æÂ¹è®Â飿ÂÂ¥ è³ HDMI 輸åºçÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âä¹Âå¿ é Âè® æÂ´ HDMI è¨Âå®Âå¼以符åÂÂæÂ°çÂÂè¨Âå ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ å®ÂæÂÂæÂ¤ é  æÂÂä½Âï¼ ã 4 KURO LINK è¨Âå®Âçº ON ä¸Âå¹³é¢é»è¦Âå¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾åÂÂ模å¼Âä¸ÂæÂ ï¼Âç¡æ³ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 41 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 42 Zhtw ⢠TV â å¾Âé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Âæ© åº DVD/CD ç è²é³è USB Ã¥ÂÂè½è¨ÂèÂÂã 1 éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ èÂ¥åºç¾é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯ ï¼Â顯示å¹Âå±Â示 HD MI ERR ï¼ÂæÂ èÂ¥ç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂ空ç½ ï¼Âå¦Âå¨è®ÂæÂ´è§£æÂ åº¦å¾Âï¼ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 53 é  çÂÂæÂ éÂÂæÂÂ餿ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂèÂ¥ä»Âç¡æ³Â解決 Ã¥ÂÂé¡Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«Âä¾Âä¸Âè¿°æÂ¥é© éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI é£æÂ¥ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å INITIAL ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å HDMIINIT ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4I N I T O K éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 系統æÂÂéÂÂæÂ°åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠HDMI è¨Âå®Â弿ÂÂèªåÂÂéÂÂæÂ°è¨ åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» é Âè¨Âå¼ãÂÂ欲äºÂè§£èÂÂéÂÂäºÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ç¸éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´ å¤Âè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ã éÂÂæÂ¼ HDMI HDMI ï¼ High Definition Multimedia Interface ï¼Âå¯æÂ¯æÂ´ä»¥å®ä¸ÂæÂ¸ä½Âé£æÂ¥ç·Â飿ÂÂ¥ DVD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ã DTV ãÂÂæ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå ¶ä» å½±é³è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂ@並åÂÂæÂÂæÂÂä¾Âè¦Âé »åÂÂé³頻ã HDMI çÂÂç Âç¼æÂ¯çº亠æÂÂä¾Âè½尠HDCP ï¼ High Bandwidth Digital Content Protection ï¼Âè DVI ï¼ Digital Visual Interface ï¼Âå ©é  æÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂèÂÂçºä¸ÂçÂÂè¦Âæ ¼ã HD CP æÂ¯ç¨ä¾Âä¿Âè·ç± DVI ç¸容顯示卿ÂÂå³輸åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ç æÂ¸ä½Â堧容ã HDMI æÂÂæÂÂè½æÂ¯æÂ´æ¨Â溠ãÂÂå¢Âå¼·æÂÂé«Âç«質è¦Âé »å å¤Âè²éÂÂç°ç¹Âè²é³æÂÂæ¨Â溠çÂÂè½åÂÂã HDMI çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ å æÂ¬ï¼ÂæÂªå£Â縮æÂ¸ä½Âè¦Âé » ãÂÂæ¯Âç§Âå¯é 5 GB 頻寬 ï¼Âå« HDTV ä¿¡èÂÂï¼ ãÂÂå®ä¸ÂæÂ¥é  ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ代æÂ¸æ¢ÂæÂÂ¥ ç· åÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âï¼ ï¼Â以 Ã¥ÂÂè½å¨影é³ä¾ÂæºÂå DTV çÂÂå½±é³訠åÂÂéÂÂé²è¡ÂéÂÂè¨ÂçÂÂã HDMI ã HDMI æ¨ÂèªÂå High- Definit ion Multimedia Interface Ã¥ÂÂçº HDMI Licensing, LLC çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨ÂæÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨ AM 天ç·ÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯使ç¨ 5 m è³ 6 m ä¹ ç¯åºéÂÂ屬ç·Â並å®Âè£ÂæÂ¼å®¤å §æÂÂ室å¤ÂãÂÂä¿ÂçÂÂé£æÂ¥ç ç°åÂÂ天ç·ÂãÂÂéÂÂ使ç¨é¨éÂÂç AM ç°形天ç·Âã é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨ FM 天ç·ÂæÂ ï¼ å¯使ç¨ PAL é£æÂ¥é ÂæÂ¥ä¸ ä¸Âçµ FM 天ç·Âã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 4 ã ç¨æÂ¼ç¡ç·Â享åÂÂ鳿¨Âç Bluetooth î å³輸å¨ å é©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ280/282DVD-A P æ©Âå ç¡ç·Â鳿¨ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ Bluetooth å³輸å¨ ï¼Âå ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè AS-BT100 ï¼Âé£ æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯使ç¨æÂÂè¼ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ ï¼ è¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂé»話ã æÂ¸ä½Â鳿¨ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨çÂÂï¼ çÂÂç¢åÂÂä¾Âç¡ ç·ÂèÂÂè½é³樠ã 2 æÂ¤å¤ ï¼ ä½¿ç¨å¸Âå®çÂÂæÂ¯æÂ´ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂç¼å°Âå¨ ï¼ å¯以èÂÂè½æÂªé Âå Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂè£Âç½®ä¸ÂçÂÂ鳿¨Âã AS-BT100 æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯ æÂ´ SCMS-T 堧容ä¿Âè· ï¼ å æÂ¤å¨é Âå SCMS-T å Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂç¢å ä¸Âä¹Âå¯以享åÂÂé³樠ã éÂÂ註 1 Ã¥ÂÂ樣å¯以使ç¨é»è¦Âæ©Â堧建çÂÂæÂÂè² å¨ä¾ÂèÂÂè½èª DVD æÂ USB è£Â置輸堥çÂÂé³è¨Âã HDMI 端åÂÂçÂÂé³頻輸åºå å é©ç¨æÂ¼ éÂÂè²éÂÂç·Âå PCM ãÂÂæÂ¤æÂÂï¼Âè½ä¸Âå°ä¾ÂèªæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂè² å¨ ï¼ÂæÂÂè³æ©Âï¼ÂçÂÂ任你è²é³ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Âé³頻 ï¼Âå æÂ¬ TUNERï¼Âå¾ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ£å¸¸è¼¸ åºã 2 Bl uetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨裠置å¯è½é ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ A2DP è¨Âå®Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 42 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 43 Zhtw English Español English Español éÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂÂä½ æÂ¬ç³»çµ±é¨éÂÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å Â許æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢åªÂé«Â@以åÂÂå·è¡Âå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂä½Âã 1 é£æÂ¥é¸購ç Bluetooth å³輸å¨ 1 å°Â系統åÂÂæÂÂè³徠æ©ÂçÂÂæ  ï¼ ç¶å¾Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨é£æÂ¥è³ä½ÂæÂ¼å¾Âé¢æÂ¿ç ADAPTER PORT ã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 5 ã 2 æÂÂ丠ïµ STANDBY/ON ã 3 æÂ ADAPTER PORT ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå° BT AUDIO 輸堥模å¼Âã 2 é Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® å¨使ç¨ Bluetooth å³輸å¨éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Â堧容ä¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âå¿ é Âå®ÂæÂ ãÂÂé Âå°Âã ãÂÂ第丠次æÂÂä½Â系統æÂÂä»»ä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ渠é¤é Âå°Âè³ÂæÂÂæÂ ï¼Âè«Â確 å®Âå·è¡Âé Âå° ã ãÂÂé Âå°Âã æÂ¯çÂȎ Bluetoot h ç¡締æÂÂè¡Âè£Â置以åÂÂç¨ Bluetooth éÂÂè¨ÂçÂÂå¿ è¦ÂæÂ¥é© ã 3 å¦ÂéÂÂ詳細è³ÂæÂÂï¼Âå¦è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± æÂ¨ç Bluetooth ç¡締æÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP 以é¸å BT SETUP ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å PA IRING ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª ï¼Âå¾ 0000/1234/8888 ä¸Âé¸ æÂÂ覠使ç¨ç PIN 碼@ç¶å¾ÂæÂ ENTER ã PAIRING éÂÂçÂÂã 注æÂ â¢ æÂ¨å¯以使ç¨任ä¸Âå 0000/123 4/8888 PIN 碼ã Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置使 ç¨é¤æÂ¬ç³»çµ± 使ç¨çÂÂä»»ä½Âå ¶ä» PIN 碼ã 4 éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¨è¦Âé Âå°Âç Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ï¼ å°Âå®ÂæÂ¾å¨é è¿Â系統çÂÂä½Âç½® @並è¨Âå®Âå¨é Âå°Â模张ã éÂÂ註 1 ⢠Bluetooth ç¡ ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨è£Âç½®å¯è½é ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ AVRCP è¨Âå®Âã â¢ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âä¿Âè 使ç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯以æÂÂä½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âå ç¨çÂÂè£Âç½®ãÂ à ¥²áÂÂáÂ¦à ¨ ÃÂá¡ Bluetooth î à ¼Âá°á£ áÂÂà ¯¢á£áÂÂñ á£ò á à ¸ÂáÂ¤Ã à ³Âà °Âã áÂÂáÂÂàÃÂà ÂÂáÂ‡Â à ¸ÂáÂ¤Ã à ³Âà °Âã áÂÂáÂÂàá¶ÃÂà ¥²áÂÂáÂÂúᣠáÂÂáÂÂÃÂà ¬ªà ´± Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡à ¸ÂᤠÃÂà ³ á¶ÃÂà ¥²á áÂÂúá£ Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡Ã¡à ¥²à ¬ à ¸¶à §£á£ ÃÂÃÂà ¶àá£ò á£ò á£ò 2 å¨ Bluetooth å³輸å¨å°ÂæÂªæÂÂå ¥ ADAPTER PORT æÂÂï¼Âå³使æÂÂ丠ADAPTER PORT ä¹Âç¡æ³Âé²堥 BT AUDIO 輸堥模å¼Âã 3 ⢠第ä¸Â次使ç¨ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Â裠置å Blue tooth å³輸卿ÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂè¦Âé Âå°Âã â¢ èÂ¥è¦ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ Blueto oth éÂÂè¨Âï¼ÂæÂ¨çÂÂ系統å Blueto oth ç¡ç·ÂæÂ è¡Âè£Âç½®é½æÂÂ該å®ÂæÂÂé Âå°Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 43 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»ÂæÂ¥ç· 11 44 Zhtw 5 檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·Âè£Âç½®æÂ¯å¦åµ測å° Bluetooth å³輸å¨ã ç¶ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®åµ測å° Bluetooth å³輸å¨æÂ ï¼ å³輸å¨çÂÂèÂÂå¥編 è ã AS-BT100 ã 顯示å¨ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置渠å®ä¸Âã 1 6 å¾ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置渠å®ä¸Âï¼Âé¸å Bluetooth å³輸å¨ï¼Âç¶å¾Âå¨æÂ¥é© 3 輸堥æÂÂé¸å ç PIN 碼ã 2 使ç¨æÂ¨çÂÂ系統èÂÂè½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂ è¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂ鳿¨Â堧容 1 æÂ ADAPTER PORT ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå° BT AUDIO 輸堥模å¼Âã 2 å° Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®é£ æÂ¥è³ Bluetooth å³輸å¨ã é£æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂï¼ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®å 稱顯示å¨系統顯示 å¹Âä¸Âã 3 æÂªé£æÂÂ¥ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂï¼ NODEVICE 顯示å¨系統顯示å¹Âä¸Âã 3 éÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å²åÂÂå¨ Blue tooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ä¸ÂçÂÂ鳿¨Â堧容ã 使ç¨系統é Â端åÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨ ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂéµ ï¼ å° Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®é²è¡Âä¸Âå æÂÂä½Âã 4 渠é¤é Âå° 5 1 è«ÂæÂ SHIFT SETUP ï¼Âé¸å BT SETUP ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂ ENTER ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å PAIR CLR ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 顯示 CLR OK æÂ ï¼Âè«ÂæÂ ENTER ã Bluetooth î Ã¥ÂÂæ¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âçº Bluetoo th SIG, Inc. æÂÂæÂÂï¼ å ÂéÂÂå ¬å¸使ç¨éÂÂ亠æ¨ÂèªÂçÂÂéÂÂç²å¾ÂæÂÂæ¬Âã 堶ä»ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ稱åÂÂ屬堶 Ã¥ÂÂèªçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè æÂ æÂÂã éÂÂ註 1 ç¶ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂªé¡¯ç¤ºå¨åµ測å°ç è£Â置渠å®ä¸ÂæÂÂæÂªé¡¯ç¤ºæÂÂï¼Âå ä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示 Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Â置渠å®ãÂÂ卿ÂÂ亠æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以使ç¨é Âå°Â模 å¼Âä¾Âé Âå° Bluetooth å³ 輸å¨åÂÂ該 Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ã 2 æÂ äºÂæÂ æ³Âç PI N 碼ä¹Â稱çº ãÂÂéÂÂè¡Â碼ã ã 3 ç³» çµ±åªè½顯示è±æÂ¸åÂÂå ÂãÂÂå ¶ä» åÂÂå Âå¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢ºé¡¯ç¤ºã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ ï¤/ïÂÂ¥ ï¼Â系統@éÂÂå§ÂæÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂæÂ«åÂÂï¼Âå 涠æÂ«åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ï¤ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@éÂÂå§ÂæÂ£å¸¸æÂÂæÂ¾ã ïÂÂ¥ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@å¯æÂ«åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ï§ ï¼Â系統ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@åÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾ã 4 ⢠Blue tooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂè AVRCP è¨Âå®Âç¸容ã â¢ è¦ÂæÂ¨ä½¿ç¨ç Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®èÂÂå®Âï¼ÂæÂÂä½Âå¯è½èÂÂæÂ¤ 表æÂÂ示æÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã ï ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âå¿«è½ ã ï® ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@æÂÂä¸Âå¯éÂÂå§ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿«è½ ã ï¯ ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@å¯跳è³ç®åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾æªÂæ¡ çÂÂæÂÂå é¢ä½Âç½®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè·³è³åÂÂ丠åÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã ï° ï¼ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨@å¯跳è³ä¸Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã 5 ⢠ä¸ÂæÂ·é£ æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®å³å¯å®ÂæÂ æ¸ é¤ã â¢ ç¶æÂ¨å¨渠é¤å¾ÂéÂÂæÂ°é£æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®æÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 43 é Âç é Âå° Bluetooth å³輸å¨å Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ä¾ÂéÂÂè¤Âé Âå°ÂæÂ¥é©Âã æÂÂéµ æÂÂéµåÂÂè½ HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 44 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
KURO LINK 12 45 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 12 ç« KURO LINK ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180/181 DVD æ©Âå 使ç¨ HDM I é£æÂ¥ç·Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé£æÂ¥è³ KURO LINK ç¸容å ÂéÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Âå¾Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以使ç¨æÂÂé£æÂ¥å¹³é¢ é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨æÂ§å¶æÂ¬æ©Âï¼Â並ä¸Âè®ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥çÂÂå¹³é¢ é»è¦ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ輸堥ï¼Â以åÂÂæÂ æÂ¬æ©Âå·è¡ÂçÂÂæÂÂä½Âã æÂ¤å¤Âï¼Âå¾Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦Â輸堥èªÂè¨Âè³Âè¨ÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¬ æ©ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ形使ç¨è ä»Âé¢顯示誠è¨ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ ï¼Âå å¨ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¢æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ形使ç¨è ä»Âé¢çÂÂç«é¢æÂªé¡¯ç¤ºï¼Âåª è½使ç¨ DVD/CD å è½æÂÂï¼ ã å¦ÂéÂÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂé HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âå¯å·è¡ÂåªäºÂæÂ ä½Âç 詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±平é¢é»覠çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ æÂ¨ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂé Âä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ KURO LINK çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¾Â使 ç¨æÂ¤åÂÂè½ã â¢ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âä¿ÂèÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âè½æÂÂé Âå ÂéÂÂ以å¤ÂæÂÂ製é ç KURO LINK ç¸容è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂ使ç¨ã é£æÂÂ¥ KURO LINK æÂ¨å¯以åÂÂæÂ¥æÂÂä½ÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥çÂÂå¹³ é¢é»è¦Âã 確å®Âå°Âå¹³é¢é»è¦ÂçÂÂé³頻ç·Âé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂé³頻輸 å ¥æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã éÂÂæÂ¼æÂ¥ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âä¸Âç 3 ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂä¸Â使ç¨é«Âé HDMI é£æÂ¥ç· ï¼ KURO LINK å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸éÂÂä½Âã â¢ å°Âå¹³é¢é»è¦Âç´æÂ¥é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ© ã ä¸ÂæÂ·èÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂ´ 大卿ÂÂå½±é³è½ÂæÂÂå¨ ï¼Âä¾Â妠HDMI éÂÂéÂÂï¼Âç ç´æÂ¥é£æÂ¥æÂÂå°Âè´æÂÂä½Âç¼çÂÂé¯誤ã éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ⢠å¨é£æÂ¥æÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂÂè®ÂæÂ´æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂï¼ è«Â確實 å°Â黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂ並å¾ÂçÂÂå£ÂæÂÂ座 æÂÂä¸Â黿ºÂç·Âã å®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ç·Âå¾ ï¼Âè«Âå°Â黿ºÂç·Âé£æÂ¥è³çÂÂ壠æÂÂ座ä¸Âã KURO LINK è¨Âå® çºäºÂ堠份éÂÂç¨ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½ï¼ÂæÂ¨å¿ é Â調æÂ´ æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Âå KURO LINK ç¸容çÂÂé£æÂ¥è¨Âå ã 妠éÂÂ詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鱿¯Âå è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã è¨Âå® KURO LINK 模张é¸åÂÂæÂ¯å¦å°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½è¨Âå®Âçº ON æÂ OFF ã æÂ¨å¿ é Âå°Âå®Âè¨Âå®Âçº LINK ON æÂÂè½使ç¨ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½ã â¢ 使ç¨ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½çÂÂé»è¦ÂæÂ ï¼ è« å°ÂæÂ¤è¨Âå®Âçº LINK OFF ã MAIN USB SUB MIC PHONES HDMI à ´Âà ¯¦á¤ HDMI à ´Âà ¯¦á¤ HDMI á°ä HDMI á°àHDMI á°ä HDMI á°àÃÂÃÂáÂÂÃÂᣠÃÂáÂÂà ¥²áÂ¾à ¶³á£ ÃÂá¡ KURO LINK à £»à §¡Ã ÃÂá£ÃÂà ¥®áÂ¬à º HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 45 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
KURO LINK 12 46 Zhtw 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å HDMI SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å KURO LINK ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸åÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ丠ENTER 確èªÂã â¢ LINK ON ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ KURO LINK Ã¥ÂÂè½ã â¢ LINK OFF ï¼Âå·²åÂÂç¨ KURO LINK ã ç¡æ³Â使ç¨ Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂÂä½Âã 使ç¨åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂä¹Âå ä¸Âå®ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂé£æÂ¥èÂÂè¨Âå® å¾Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å¿ é Âï¼ 1 è®ÂæÂÂæÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂé²堥徠æ©Â模张ã 2 éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé»溠@æÂÂå¾ÂæÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹³é¢é»覠çÂÂ黿ºÂã 3 é¸æÂ DVD/CD ï¼Â並æÂ¥çÂÂç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂè¦Âè¨Â輸åº 顯示æÂ¯å¦æÂ£å¸¸ã åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ ä½¿ç¨ KURO LINK ç¸容é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯以è¨Âå® åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂãÂÂæÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂçÂÂå¾Âé»è¦Âç é¸å®ç«é¢ä¸Âå¯以è¨Âå®Âé äºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ã å¾Âé»è¦ÂçÂÂé¸å®ç«é¢ä¸Âå¯以è¨Âå®ÂéÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ãÂÂå¦Âé 詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± KURO LINK ç¸容é»è¦ÂçÂÂæÂ ä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã åÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂÂ你使ç¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ é£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK ç¸容è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¦Âä¸ÂæÂÂè¿°åÂÂæÂÂ¥ éÂÂä½Âã â¢ 使ç¨é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨å¯以è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé³éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå° è²é³éÂÂé³ã â¢ é»è¦ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂè¨Âå®Âçº徠橠æÂ ï¼ æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂä¹ÂæÂ è¨Âå®Âçº徠橠ã ï¼ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ£å¨æÂÂæÂ¾è¦Âé » DVD æÂÂï¼ éÂÂéÂÂé»è¦ÂçÂÂ黿ºÂä¹ÂæÂÂèª Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂéÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂé»溠ã ä½ÂæÂÂäºÂæÂ æ³Â丠@æÂ¬æ©Â黿ºÂç¡æ³ÂèªåÂÂéÂÂé @侠妠@ç¶æÂ¨æÂ£å¨èÂÂè½ CD æÂÂ廣æÂÂ並éÂÂéÂÂ輸åº裠置æÂÂãÂÂ@⢠æÂ¬æ©Â輸堥å¨åÂÂæÂÂé»è¦Âé » éÂÂæÂÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂã â¢ å³使æÂ¬æ©Â輸堥åÂÂæÂÂè³ DVD/CD 以å¤ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ ï¼ åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼Âä»Âç¶æÂÂæÂ ã å¨å Âé KURO LINK ç¸容平é¢é»è¦Âä¸Âä¹Âå¯以使 ç¨以ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂä½Âã â¢ 調æÂ´æÂ¬æ©Âé³éÂÂæÂÂè²é³é é³æÂ ï¼ é³éÂÂçÂÂæ ÂæÂÂ顯 示å¨平é¢é»è¦ÂçÂÂç«é¢丠ã â¢ å¨平é¢é»è¦Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ OSD èªÂè¨ÂæÂÂï¼ æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂ誠è¨Âè¨Âå®Âä¹ÂæÂÂé¨èÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂã åÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥åÂÂæÂ´å¤§æ¨¡å¼ â¢ Ã¥ÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£å¨è§ÂçÂÂé»覠ä¸ÂçÂÂé»è¦Âç¯Âç®ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¬æ© é»æºÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂã â¢ å¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ æÂ¬æ©Â黿ºÂèÂ¥éÂÂé @åÂÂæÂÂ¥ æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ ã èÂ¥è¦ÂéÂÂæÂ°éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡ å¼ ï¼Âè«Â使ç¨é»è¦ÂçÂÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾ 大模 å¼Âã â¢ å¨åÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾å¤§æ¨¡å¼ÂæÂ ï¼ å¦ÂæÂÂå¾Âé»è¦Âé¸å®ç«é¢å· è¡Âå¾Âé»è¦Âç¢çÂÂè²é³çÂÂæÂ ä½ ï¼ åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¶ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¥æÂ¾ 大模å¼Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 46 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 47 Zhtw English Español English Español 第 13 ç« å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼Â堧容格å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¸容æÂ§ æÂ¬æ©Âé©åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾åÂÂ種é¡Âå ï¼ÂåªÂé«Âï¼ åÂÂæ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂç¢Âç ã å¯æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âèάç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå è£Âä¸ÂæÂ æÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂå ¶ä¸Âä¸Â種æ¨ÂèªÂãÂÂç¶èÂÂè«Â注æÂÂæÂÂäºÂé¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç ç¢Âç ï¼Âå æÂ¯å¯çÂÂéÂÂå¼ CD å DVD ï¼ å¯è½ä»Â屬æÂ¼ ä¸Â坿ÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂæ ¼å¼Âã æÂ´å¤Âè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Â坿ÂÂæÂ¾ DVD R/ RW ç¢ÂçÂÂã â¢ æÂ¯ FUJIFILM Corporation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã â¢ æÂ¯ DVD Format/Logo Licensing Corpor ation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã â¢ æÂ¬æ©Â亦è KODAK Picture CD ç¸容ã æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¯æÂ¯æÂ´è½ç¢çÂÂåªç° ç«質 ã éÂÂè²éÂÂç IEC çÂÂè¶ ç´ VCD æ¨ÂæºÂï¼Â並å¯æÂ¯æÂ´å¯¬å±Âå¹Âç« é¢ã éÂÂæÂ¼ DualDisc çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DualDisc æÂ¯ä¸Â種堨æÂ° ã éÂÂé¢çÂÂç¢Âç @ä¸Âé¢å¯容 ç´ DVD æ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂå½±å ã è²é³ç @å¦ä¸Âé¢åÂÂå¯容素é DVD æ ¼å¼ÂçÂÂ堧容ï¼Âå¦ÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³頻 åªÂé«Â堧容ã èÂÂæÂ¤ç¨®ç¢ÂçÂÂ容ç´Âé DVD é³頻çÂÂä¸Âé¢å ä¸Â符 CD-Audio çÂÂè¦Â格@æÂ å¯è½æÂÂç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã DualDisc ç DVD é¢å¯å¨æÂÂ¢åÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã DVD-Audio 堧容ä¸Âè½ æÂÂæÂ¾ã æÂÂé DualDi sc è¦Âæ ¼çÂÂæÂ´å¤Â詳ç¡è³Â訠@è«Â洽詢碠çÂÂ製é åÂÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂé¶å®åÂÂã ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 DVD- Video DVD-R DVD-RW VCD F ujicolor CD à ¥²á CD CD-R CD-RW Super Video CD ( à º»à ª¼ VCD) åªÂé« ç¸ 容格张CD-R/-RW ⢠CD-Audi o ã VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD ã ISO 9660 CD-ROM* ï¼Âå å« MP3 ã WMA ã MPEG- 4 AAC ã JPEG æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /W MV æªÂæ¡Âã * 符å ISO 9660 Level 1 æÂ 2 ä¹Â樠æºÂã CD 實é«Âæ ¼å¼Âï¼ Mode1 ã Mode2 XA Form1 ãÂÂè Romeo å Joliet 堩種æªÂæ¡Â系統ç¸容ã â¢ å¤ÂÃ¥ÂÂ段æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ â¢ æÂªæÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ DVD-R/-RW ⢠DVD-Vide o ï¼Âè¦Â頻模å¼Âï¼ ãÂÂ覠頻 é 製@VR ï¼ * ã UDF Brid ge DVD-ROM ï¼ å å« MP3 ã WMA ã MPEG-4 AAC ã JPEG æÂ DivX è¦Âé » /WMV æªÂæ¡Âã * 編輯é»Âå¯è½ç¡æ³Âå®Âå ¨æÂÂç §ç·¨ 輯ç æÂ¹å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ æÂÂæÂ¾å°編輯é»ÂæÂÂç«é¢ å¯è½ æÂÂæÂÂçÂÂæÂ«ç©ºç½çÂÂæÂ å½¢ ã â¢ å¤ÂéÂÂéÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ â¢ æÂªæÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ PC 製ä½Âç¢Âç â¢ 使ç¨ PC éÂÂ製çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¯è½æÂÂå çºç¨ 以製ä½Âç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂè»Âé«ÂæÂ¬ 身çÂÂè¨Âç½®èÂÂç¡ æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂæÂ¤æÂÂï¼Âè«Â檢 æÂÂ¥ DVD-R/ -RW æÂ CD-R/- RW è»Âé«ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ ç¢Âç å è£Âä¸ÂæÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ç¸容 æÂ§çÂÂ說æÂÂã â¢ 以å°Âå ç éÂÂæÂ¹å¼ÂéÂÂ製çÂÂç¢Âç ä¸Âç¸ 容ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 47 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 48 Zhtw éÂÂæÂ¼ DVD R/DVD RW ç¸容æÂ§ å å¯æÂÂæÂ¾ä»¥ ãÂÂè¦Â頻模张@DVD-Video 模å¼Âï¼ ã éÂÂ製並已å®ÂæÂÂå°ÂçÂÂç DVD R/DVD RW ãÂÂç¶ èÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂäºÂå¨éÂÂå½±æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂå®ÂæÂÂçÂÂ編輯堧容å¯è½æÂ ç¡æ³Â精確å°æÂÂæÂ¾ã éÂÂæÂ¼ DivX DivX æÂ¯ DivX, Inc. ç¼æÂÂçÂÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³è¨Â格张ã æÂ¾Â æÂ¾å¨å¯以æÂÂæÂ¾éÂÂ製å¨ DVD ã CD æÂ USB å²åÂÂ裠置ä¸Âç DivX è¦Âè¨Âã ä¿ÂæÂÂè DVD-Video ç¸åÂÂçÂÂè¡ÂèªÂï¼Âç¨ç¹ ç DivX è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂ稱你ãÂÂæ¨Âé¡Âã ã DivX è¦Âé »ç¸容æÂ§ ⢠æÂÂæÂ¾ DivX î è¦Â訠1 â¢ å¯æªÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ .avi å .divx ï¼Âå¿ é Â使ç¨éÂÂäºÂå¯檠åÂÂï¼Â以å©æÂ¬æ©Â辨è DivX è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡ ï¼ ã è«Â注 æÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¡ç¨ .avi 坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ辨è æÂ MPEG4 ï¼ ä½ÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡Â並éÂÂä¸Âå® æÂ¯ DivX è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡Âï¼Â亦å æÂ¤ä¸Âè¦Âå¾ è½å¨æÂ¬æ©Â丠æÂÂæÂ¾ã 顯示 DivX Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂ桠以ä¸ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçº DivX å¤Âé¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂÂé©ç¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå 絠ã æÂ¨å¯以èÂÂç±è¨Âå®Âè½符åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ ç S ubtitle Language ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹ÂèªÂè¨Âï¼ ï¼Âå¨第 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Â訠å®Âå¼ ï¼ ï¼ÂæÂ¼è¢å¹Âä¸Âè¦Âå°æÂ£ç¢ºçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂã 2 å°Âçµ 1 ï¼ Albanian ( é¿ç¾巴 å°¼äºÂ誠) (sq) ï¼ Basque ( å·´æÂ¯å Â誠) (eu) ï¼ Catalan ( Ã¥ÂÂæ³°ç¾ å°¼äºÂ誠) (ca) ï¼ Danish ( 丹麥誠) (da) ï¼ Dutch ( è·èÂÂ誠) (nl) ï¼ English ( è±誠) (en)ï¼ Faroese ( æ³Â羠誠) (fo)ï¼ Finnish ( èÂÂ誠) (fi) ï¼ French ( æ³Â誠) (fr ) ï¼ German ( 德誠) (de) ï¼ Icelandic ( å°島誠) (is)ï¼ Irish ( æÂÂç¾èÂÂ誠) (ga)ï¼ Itali an ( 義大å©誠) (it) ï¼ Norwegian ( æÂªå¨Â誠) (no) ï¼ Portuguese ( è¡èÂÂçÂÂ誠) (pt) ï¼ R haeto-Romanic ( éÂÂæÂÂç¾ æÂ¼æÂ¯èª ) (rm) ï¼ Scottish ( èÂÂæ ¼èÂÂ誠) (gd) ï¼ Spanish ( 西çÂÂçÂÂ誠) (es) ï¼ Swedish ( çÂÂ堸誠) (sv) é³頻å£Â縮 ⢠MPEG-1 Audi o Layer 3 (MP3) ã W indows Media A udio (WMA) ã MPEG-4 AAC ⢠åÂÂ樣頻çÂÂï¼ 32 kHz/44.1 kHz/ 48 kHz ⢠ä½Âå Âç @任ä½Âå³輸ç @建è°æÂ¡ç¨ 128 kbps 以ä¸Â@⢠VBR ï¼Âå¯è®Âä½ å ÂçÂÂï¼ MP3/WMA/ MPEG-4 AAC æÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ å¦ â¢ WMA ç¡失çÂÂ編碼@å¦ â¢ DRM ï¼ æÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管ç @ç¸容æÂ§ ï¼ ç¸容 ï¼Âå DRM ä¿Âè·ä¹Â鳿¨ÂæªÂæ¡Âå° ç¡ æ³ å¨æÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ãÂÂï¼ â¢ å¯æªÂå @.mp3 ã .wma ã .m4a ï¼Âé 使ç¨éÂÂäºÂ坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂ以å©æÂ æÂ¾å¨辨è MP3/WMA/MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡Â@⢠æªÂæ¡ÂçµÂæ§ ï¼Âå¯è½æÂÂæÂ ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ï¼ ä¸Âå¼µ ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå¤Âå¯å²å 299 Ã¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾@æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ä¸ÂæÂÂå¤Âå¯å æÂ¾ 648 è³ÂæÂ å¤¾åÂÂæªÂæ¡ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂä½µå¾Âï¼ JPEG æªÂ桠⢠Baseline JPEG å EXIF 2.2* éÂÂæ Âå½± Ã¥ÂÂæªÂæ¡Âå¯é 3072 x 2048 è§£æÂÂ度ç« ç´ * çºæÂ¸ä½Âç¸æ©Âå°Âç¨ä¹ÂæªÂ桠格张⢠éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ JPEG ç¸容æÂ§ï¼ å¦ â¢ å¯æªÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ .jpg ï¼Âå¿ é Â使ç¨éÂÂ亠å¯ æªÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Â以å©æÂ¬æ©Â辨è JPEG æªÂæ¡Â@⢠æªÂæ¡ÂçµÂæ§ ï¼Âå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂ@@丠張ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå¤Âå¯å²å 299 Ã¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂ å¤¾ï¼Âæ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè³ÂæÂÂ夾ä¸ÂæÂÂ夠å¯åÂÂæÂ¾ 648 è³ÂæÂÂ夾åÂÂæªÂæ¡ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂä½µå¾Âï¼ åªÂé« ç¸容格张éÂÂ註 1 ç¡ æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å®¹éÂÂ大æÂ¼ 4 GB ç .avi è¦Âé »æªÂæ¡Âã 2 ⢠å¨å¤Âé¨ Ã¥ÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡Âé¨åÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¬æ©Âå¯æÂ¯æÂ´ 以ä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¹Âæ ¼å¼ÂæªÂæ¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂ稱 ï¼Âè«Â注æÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡Â丠æÂÂå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¸å®ä¸Â顯示@@.srt ã .sub ã .ssa ã .smi ⢠æÂÂäºÂå¤Âé¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡Âå¯è½ç¡泠æÂ£ç¢ºé¡¯ç¤ºæÂÂå®Âå ¨ç¡æ³Â顯示ã â¢ å½±çÂÂæªÂæ¡ÂçÂÂæªÂÃ¥ÂÂå¿ é ÂéÂÂè¤Âåº ç¾å¨å¤Âé¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ÂæªÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂé é ÂèÂÂã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂä¸Âå½±çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âè½夠åÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ夠é¨åÂÂå¹ÂæªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¸éÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂå¤ÂéÂÂå® çº 10 ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 48 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 49 Zhtw English Español English Español å°Âçµ 2 ï¼ Albanian ( é¿ç¾巴尼äºÂ誠) ( sq) ï¼ Croatian ( å Âç¾ åÂÂ西äºÂ誠) (hr) ï¼ Czech ( æÂ·å Â誠) (cs) ï¼ Hungarian ( Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂå©誠) (hu) ï¼ Polish ( æ³¢èÂÂ誠) (pl) ï¼ Romanian ( 羠馬尼äºÂ誠) (ro ) ï¼ Slovak ( æÂ¯æ´Âä¼Âå Â誠) (sk) ï¼ Slovenian ( æÂ¯æ´Âç¶Âå°¼äºÂ誠) ( sl) å°Âçµ 3 ï¼ Bulgarian ( ä¿Âå å©äºÂ誠) (bg) ï¼ Byelorussian ( ç½ä¿Âç¾ æÂ¯èª ) (b e) ï¼ Macedonian ( 馬堶頠誠) (mk) ï¼ Russian ( ä¿Â誠) (ru) ï¼ Se rbian ( å¡Âç¾ç¶ÂäºÂ誠) (sr) ï¼ Ukrainian ( çÂÂå ÂèÂÂ誠) (uk) å°Âçµ 4 ï¼ Hebrew ( å¸Â伯ä¾Â誠) (i w) ï¼ Yiddi sh ( æÂÂ第ç·Â誠) ( ji) å°Âçµ 5 ï¼ Turkish ( Ã¥ÂÂè³堶誠) ( tr) DivX î æÂ¯ DivX, In c. çÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ樠@並ç²æÂÂæ¬Â使ç¨ ã éÂÂæÂ¼ WMV WMV æÂ¯ Windows Media Video çÂÂ縮寫ï¼Â丠çº Microsoft Corporation æÂÂç Âç¼åºä¾ÂçÂÂè¦Âé » å£Â縮æÂÂè¡ÂãÂÂå¯使ç¨ Window s Media Encoder å° WMV 堧容å 以編碼ã â¢ æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¯æÂÂæÂ¾ä½¿ç¨ Windows Media Encoder 9 Series 編碼ãÂÂ使ç¨ .wmv å¯檠åÂÂç WMV9 æªÂæ¡Âã â¢ å¯使ç¨ 720 x 576 ç«素/720 x 480 ç«素以丠çÂÂ大å°Âã â¢ ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´ Advanced Profile ã â¢ å DRM ä¿Âè·ä¹Âè¦Âé »æªÂæ¡Âå°Âç¡æ³Âå¨æÂ¬æ© ä¸ÂæÂ æÂ¾ã â¢ æªÂæ¡Â坿ªÂå .wmv ã â¢ å¯使ç¨ 192 kbps 以ä¸ÂçÂÂä½Âå ÂçÂÂã éÂÂæÂ¼ MPEG-4 AAC AAC (Advanced Audio Coding) æÂ¯ MPEG-4 AAC æ¨ÂæºÂçÂÂæ ¸å¿ÂæÂÂ衠@主è¦ÂçµÂå MPEG-2 AAC ï¼ æÂ¯æ§ÂæÂ MPEG-4 é³頻å£Â縮æÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂåº礠ã æÂÂ使ç¨çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âæ ¼å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ坿ªÂå éÂÂè¦Âç¨以é²衠AAC æªÂæ¡Â編碼çÂÂæÂÂç¨ç¨Âå¼ÂèÂÂå® ã æÂ¬æ©Â坿ÂÂæÂ¾ç± iTunes î æÂÂ編碼ï¼Â坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂçº ã .m4a ãÂÂç AAC æªÂæ¡ ã DRM æÂÂä¿Âè·çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âä¸Âè½æÂÂæÂ¾ @以åÂÂç±æÂ äº iTunes î çÂÂæÂ¾ÂÂ編碼çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âä¹Âå¯ è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ï¼ æÂÂæªÂÃ¥ÂÂå¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢ºé¡¯ç¤ºã Apple å iTunes Ã¥ÂÂæÂ¯ Apple Inc. æÂ¼ç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå ¶ ä»ÂÃ¥ÂÂ家註åÂÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã éÂÂæÂ¼ WMA æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨å¯æÂÂæÂ¾ Windo ws Media Audio çÂÂå § 容ã WMA æÂ¯ Windows Media Audi o ç 縮 寫ï¼Â丠çº Microsoft Corporation æÂÂç Âç¼åºä¾ÂçÂÂé³頻 å£Â縮æÂÂè¡Âã WMA 堧容坿ÂÂç¨ Windows Media Player versi on 7.7.1 ï¼ Windows Media Player ç¨亠Wind ows XP ï¼ÂæÂ Windows Media Pla yer 9 Series çÂÂè»Âé«Âé²衠編碼ã Windows Media æÂ¯ Microsoft Cor poration ç åÂÂæ¨Âã æÂÂ¢åÂÂæÂ¡ç¨ Microsoft Corporation éÂÂç¼ä¹ÂæÂ è¡Âï¼ÂæÂªç² Micr osoft Licens ing, Inc. æÂÂæ¬Âä¸Â徠使ç¨æÂÂæÂ£å¸ÂæÂ¾ÂÂè¡Âã ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ使ç¨åÂÂç¶Âè· æÂÂæÂ¿ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ æÂ¿åÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ è«ÂæÂ¡ä½Âå ¶éÂÂ緣以å Âå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂä»»ä½Â丠é¢çÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂç´ÂãÂÂç°塵æÂÂå®ç ãÂÂå·²ç¶ÂæÂÂå£ÂæÂÂé«Â污ç ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂå½±é¿æÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂæÂÂè½ã å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂç´ÂãÂÂç°塵çÂÂä¸Âæ½Âç© ï¼Âè«Â使ç¨ æÂÂè»ÂãÂÂä¹¾çÂ¥çÂÂå¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¦æÂÂä¹¾ æ·¨ã è«Âç´åÂÂè¼Âè¼Âç±ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Â央åÂÂå¤ÂæÂ¦æÂÂãÂÂè«Âå¿以ç«å çÂÂæÂ¹å¼ÂæÂ¦æÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂ表é¢ã å¦ÂæÂÂå¿ è¦Âï¼Âè«Âç¨æÂÂå¸Âæ²¾ä¸Âé Âç²¾ï¼ÂæÂÂå¸Â颿ÂÂ購買 ç CD/DVD 渠æ½Â工堷ä¾ÂæÂ´å¾¹åºÂ渠æ½Â碠ç ã çµÂ丠使ç¨æÂ®ç¼åÂÂãÂÂç¨ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»Âè¨Âè¨Âç¨ä¾Â渠æ½Âé»Âè å±çÂÂçÂÂ渠æ½ÂÃ¥ÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 49 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 50 Zhtw å²æÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ é¿å Âå°Âç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂå¨太å· ãÂÂ太æ¿ÂæÂ å¤ªç± ï¼Âå æÂŒÂÂå° é½å Âç´å°Âï¼ÂçÂÂç°å¢Âä¸Âã ä¸Âè¦Âå°Âç´ å¼µæÂÂè²¼ç´Âé»Âå¨ ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âï¼ÂæÂÂç¨éÂÂçÂÂã é¼ç çÂÂæÂÂå ¶ ä»Âå°Âé³çÂÂæÂ¸å¯« ç¨堷å¨ä¸Âé¢æÂ¸å¯«ãÂÂéÂÂ樣 æÂÂæÂÂå£Âç¢ÂçÂÂã ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂé¿å ÂäºÂé  ç¢ÂçÂÂä¿Â以é«ÂéÂÂå¨æÂ¬æ©Âå §æÂÂè½ÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂç¼çÂÂç è£Âã ç¢Âè£Âã æÂÂæÂ²æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂå£ÂæÂ å½¢ ï¼Âè«Âå¿åÂÂéª置 æÂ¼æÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ â æÂÂçµÂæÂ¨å¯è½æÂ ä½¿æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂå£Âã æÂ¬æ©Âå¨è¨Âè¨Âä¸Âçºå å¯ 使ç¨å³統ã 堨åÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂã å ÂéÂÂè²æÂÂï¼Âå°ÂæÂ¼å 使ç¨è®Âå½¢çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂå¼Âèµ·çÂÂæÂ æÂÂ責任ï¼Âæ¦Âä¸Â負責ã DVD Video é©ç¨å°å æÂÂæÂÂç DVD Video ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå°ä¸Âå°åÂÂæ¨Â示 @以æÂÂåº該ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ¼å ¨çÂÂé© ç¨çÂÂå°å ã æÂ¨ç DVD ç³» 統亦æÂÂä¸Âå°åÂÂæ¨Â示 ï¼Âå°±å¨èÂÂé¢æÂ¿ ä¸Âï¼ ãÂÂä¾Âèª丠ç¸容å°åÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âç¡æ³Âå¨æÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ ã æ¨Â示 ALL çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¯å¨任ä½ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ ä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã ç¶æÂ¨æÂÂå ¥ä¸ÂçÂÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå° æÂÂåºç¾以ä¸Âè¨ÂæÂ¯ï¼ Incompatib le disc regio n number ï¼ÂéÂÂ堼容ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ碼@Can't play disc ï¼Âç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ å®Âè£ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¿Â餠å®Âè£ÂæÂÂ示 æÂ¬å ¬å¸å¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂªä¾Â幾年堧é½è½ç¡æÂ çÂÂ享ç¨æÂ¬ç³» çµ±ï¼Âå æÂ¤å¨é¸åÂÂå®Âè£Âé¨ä½ÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¬è«Âç¢è¨Â以ä¸Âå é»Âï¼ åÂÂå¿ ... ï± å¨éÂÂ風è¯好çÂÂ室堧使ç¨ã ï± ç½®æÂ¼å¹³å¦ãÂÂæ°´å¹³çÂÂ表é¢ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¸æ¡ÂãÂÂæÂ±æÂ¶æÂÂé³é¿æÂ¶ 丠ã åÂÂå¿ ... ï³ å¨é«Â溫æÂÂ極æ¿ÂçÂÂå°é»Â使ç¨ï¼Âå æÂ¾ÂÂçÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂç¢ çÂÂé«Âç±çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂè¿Âã ï³ ç½®æÂ¼çªÂ檯æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂ使系統åÂÂå°é½å Âç´å°ÂçÂÂå°é»Âã ï³ å¨å¤Âç°æÂÂ極æ¿ÂçÂÂç°å¢Âä¸Â使ç¨ã ï³ ç´æÂ¥æÂºå¨æÂ´å¤§å¨æÂÂé³é¿ 系統裡使ç¨æÂÂæÂÂéÂÂ漸 è® ç±çÂÂå ¶ä»Âå Âä»¶ä¸Âã ï³ å¨é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂ顯示å¨éÂÂè¿Â使ç¨ï¼Âå çºæÂÂå¯è½æÂÂç¢ç 干æÂ¾ ï¼ ç¹åÂ¥æÂ¯å¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂ使ç¨室堧天ç·ÂæÂÂã ï³ å¨å»ÂæÂ¿æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂæÂÂ使系統 æÂ´é²å¨æ¿Âç ÂæÂÂè¸氣习丠çÂÂå°é»Âã ï³ å¨åÂÂæ¯Â毯æÂÂå°毯ä¸Â使ç¨ï¼ÂæÂÂè¦ÂèÂÂå¸ÂæÂ ï¼ éÂÂ樣å¯ è½æÂÂ妨ç¤Â系統主æ©ÂçÂÂæÂ£ç¢ºæÂ£ç±æÂÂæÂÂã ï³ ç½®æÂ¼ä¸Â平穩çÂÂ表é¢ï¼ÂæÂÂé¢ç©Âä¸Â足以æÂ¯æÂÂ系統主橠åÂÂè ³çÂÂ表é¢ä¸Âã 渠æ½Âè®Â寫é ÂæÂ DVD æÂÂæÂ¾ å¨çÂÂè®Â寫é Âä¸Âè¬使ç¨æÂ¯ä¸ÂæÂÂå¼Âé«ÂçÂÂï¼ ä½Âå¦Âå æÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂå ç©Âç°æÂÂé«Â污æÂÂï¼Âè«Â洽詢æÂ¨æÂÂå¨ å°çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ÂãÂÂéÂÂç¶è®ÂÃ¥ÂÂé Â渠æ½ÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠è¬å¸Âé¢ä¸Âé½å¯買å¾Âå°ï¼Âä½ÂæÂ¬å ¬å¸ä¸Â建è°使ç¨以 å Âå¯è½é æÂÂè®ÂÃ¥ÂÂé ÂæÂÂå£Âã 水氣åÂÂçµÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ å¦ÂæÂÂå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç±溫æÂÂçÂÂ室堧æÂŒÂ°å®¤å¤Âï¼ÂæÂÂ室堧溫 度é½ç¶ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå §é¨便å¯è½æÂÂæÂÂæ°´æ°£åÂÂçµÂãÂÂé ç¶åÂÂçµÂçÂÂæ°´æ°£ä¸ÂæÂÂå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âé æÂÂæÂÂå£Âï¼Âä½Âå¯è½æÂ ä½¿æÂÂè½çÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå §åÂÂå°影é¿ãÂÂè«Âè®Âå ¶æÂÂ大ç´Âä¸Âå° æÂÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂæÂ¢å¾©è³è¼ÂæÂÂç±çÂÂ溫 度ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¡ÂéÂÂæ©Âã æÂŒÂÂ系統主橠å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂÂå¿ è¦Âç§»åÂÂå°主橠@ä¸ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨堧æÂ ç¢Âç @è«Âå Âå°Âå ¶åÂÂåºï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂä¸Âå é¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç ïµ STANDBY/ON å°Â系統éÂÂæ©ÂãÂÂçÂÂå°è¢å¹Â丠ç -OFF- Ã¥ÂÂ樣æ¶Â失徠ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂå°Â黿ºÂæÂÂé ÂæÂÂ丠ã 1 çµÂ丠å¯å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂå°Â主æ©ÂèÂÂèµ·æÂÂæÂŒÂ â å¯è½æÂÂ使 é«ÂéÂÂæÂÂè½Âä¸ÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂå£Âã éÂÂ註 1 å¦Âå¨ -OFF- Ã¥ÂÂ樣èªè¢å¹Âä¸Â涠失åÂÂ便å°Â主æ©ÂæÂÂé ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå¯ è½æÂÂ使系統æÂ¢å¾©æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» çÂÂè¨Âç½®ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 50 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 51 Zhtw English Español English Español ç«é¢大å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ格张DVD-Video ç¢ÂçÂÂè½æÂ¶éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ種çÂÂç«é¢ æ¯Âä¾ ï¼ ç¯Âä¾ å¾Âä¸Â荺 4:3 çÂÂé»è¦Âç¯Âç®å°ç«é¢æ¯Âä¾Âé«Âé 7:3 ç CinemaScope 寬è¢å¹Âé» å½± 1 é½å¯以ã é»è¦Âæ©Âä¹ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ種ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç«é¢æ¯Âä¾ ï¼ ã æ¨ÂæºÂã ç 4:3 以åÂÂ寬å±Âå¹ 16:9 ã 2 寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Â使ç¨è å¦ÂæÂÂ使ç¨寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¬ æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ç TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂè¨Âçº 16:9 (Wide) æÂ 16:9 (C ompressed) ï¼Â第 35 é Âï¼ ã ç¶æÂ¨ä½¿ç¨ 16:9 (Wide) è¨Âå®Âè§Âè³Â以 4:3 æ ¼å¼ÂæÂ éÂÂ製çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨å¯以使ç¨é»è¦ÂæÂ§å¶åÂÂè½ä¾Âé¸å 影åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾çÂÂæÂ¹å¼ÂãÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âå¯è½æÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ縮 æÂ¾åÂÂ伸å±ÂÃ¥ÂÂè½ï¼Âç´°ç¯Âé¨åÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±æÂ¨é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂÂé çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã è«Â注æÂÂï¼Âé¨åÂÂé»影çÂÂç«é¢毠ä¾Â大æÂ¼ 16:9 ï¼Âå æÂ¤å³便使ç¨寬è¢å¹Âé»è¦Âè§Âè³ ï¼Âä»ÂæÂÂ以 ã Letter Box ãÂÂ樣å¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾è©²ç¨®ç¢Âç ï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸Â丠堩å´åºç¾ é»Âè²æ¢ÂéÂÂï¼ ã æ¨ÂæºÂé»è¦Â使ç¨è å¦ÂæÂÂ使ç¨æ¨ÂæºÂé»è¦Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¾Â æÂ¾å¨ç TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ©Âå±Âå¹Âï¼ è¨Âå®Âå¯ä¾ÂæÂ¨çÂÂå 好è¨Âçº 4:3 (Letter B ox) æÂ 4:3 (Pan & Scan) ï¼Â第 35 é Âï¼ ã è«Â注æÂ ï¼ å¤ æÂ¸å¯¬è¢å¹Âç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂç¡è¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨çÂÂè¨Âå® ï¼ å æÂ¤ç¡è«Âè¨Âå®Âçº你@ç¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂæÂÂ以 ã Letter Box ã 格å¼Â顯示ã é»è¦Â系統è¨Âç½® æÂ¬ç³»çµ±çÂÂé Âè¨Âå¼çº AUTO ï¼Âé¤éÂÂæÂ¨å¨æÂÂæÂ¾ é¨å ç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂ注æÂÂå°影åÂÂæÂÂ失çÂÂç¾象 ï¼Âå¦åÂÂè«Âå°Â堶訠置çº AUTO ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç¼ç¾å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂÂç« é¢åºç¾失çÂÂçÂÂæÂ å½¢ï¼ è«Âå°Âé»è¦Â系統è¨Âç½®æÂÂ符å æÂ¨æÂÂå¨åÂÂå®¶æÂÂå°åÂÂçÂÂ系統ãÂÂ丠éÂÂï¼ÂéÂÂ樣ä¸Âä¾Âå¯ è½æÂÂéÂÂå¶æÂ¨å¯以è§ÂçÂÂçÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ種é¡ÂãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå å°Â砧表ï¼Â以äºÂè§£åÂÂ種ç¢Âç æÂÂé©ç¨çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼ AUTO ã PAL å NTSC ï¼Âã 3 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SYS SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å TV S YS ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã é»è¦Âæ©Â系統æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¦Âä¸Â@⢠AUTO ï¤ NTSC ⢠NTSC ï¤ PA L ⢠PAL ï¤ AUTO éÂÂ註 1 許å¤Â寬è¢å¹Âç¢ÂçÂÂ齿ÂÂç¡è¦Âç³» çµ±çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼Âå æÂ¤ä¸Â管è¨Âå®Âå¼çº你ï¼Âç¢ÂçÂÂ齿ÂÂ以 ã Letterbox ãÂÂçÂÂæ ¼å¼Â顯示ã 2 å¦ÂæÂÂ卿¨Â溠4:3 çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Â丠æÂ¡ç¨ 16:9 (Wide) æÂ 16:9 (Compressed) çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ï¼ÂæÂÂ寬è¢幠é»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ¡ç¨任ä½Âä¸Â種 4:3 è¨Âå®Âå¼@便æÂÂå°Âè´ç«é¢失çÂÂã è¨Âç½®æÂ 4:3 (Letter Box) æÂÂï¼Â寬è¢幠ç¢ÂçÂÂå¨顯示ç«é¢æÂÂï¼Âä¸Âä¸Âé½ æÂÂåºç¾黠è²æ¢ÂéÂÂã è¨Âç½®æÂ 4:3 (Pan & Scan) æÂÂï¼Â寬è¢幠ç¢ÂçÂÂå¨顯示ç«é¢æÂÂï¼Âå·¦å³é æÂÂæÂÂæÂªç çÂÂæÂ å½¢ãÂÂéÂÂç¶ç«é¢çÂÂèµ·ä¾Â大 äºÂï¼Âä½ÂæÂ¨ çÂÂå°çÂÂä¸ÂæÂ¯å¯¦éÂÂçÂÂæÂ´åÂÂç«é¢ ã 3 å¤ÂæÂ¸æÂ°åÂÂç PAL é» è¦Âæ©Â系統å¯åµ測 50 Hz (PAL )/60 Hz (NTSC) ï¼Â並å¯èªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç´ æÂ¯å¹ ï¼Â以æ¶Âé¤顯示ç«é¢ä¸Âç åÂÂç´æÂ¶ç¸®ç¾ 象ãÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂäºÂæÂ æ³ÂæÂ¯ å½±åÂÂ丠åÂÂç¾ä¸Âåºè²彩 ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç PAL TV æ²ÂæÂ V-Hold æÂ§å¶åÂÂè½ ï¼Â便æÂÂå çº NTSC ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸Âç« é¢æÂÂæÂÂèÂÂç¡ æ³Âè§ÂçÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂæÂ V-Hold æÂ§å¶åÂÂè½ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ調æÂ´ç´å°ç«é¢åÂÂæÂ¢æ»¾åÂÂçº æÂ¢ãÂÂé¨åÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âä¸Âï¼Âç«é¢æÂ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç´æÂ¶ç¸®çÂÂç¾象ï¼Âè´ 使è¢å¹Âä¸Âä¸Âå ©å´çÂÂæÂÂé» è²æ¢ÂéÂÂã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 51 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 52 Zhtw 4 CHANGE é çÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè«ÂæÂ ENTER ã 系統å°ÂèªåÂÂé²堥徠æ©Â模å¼Âï¼Âç¶å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂ°éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé» æºÂãÂÂçÂÂå° POWER ON å¾Âï¼ÂæÂ¨å°Âå¨顯示å¹Âä¸Âç å°æÂ°çÂÂé»è¦Â系統è¨Âå®Âã 1 é »çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âç½® ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¼æ²ÂçÂÂå°é¿æÂÂ伯ãÂÂ以è²åÂÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂæÂÂå ¶ä» ä¸ÂæÂ±åÂÂå®¶èÂÂå Â稠æ©Âå å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ç¼ç¾æÂ¨ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ調é¸å°éÂȌ°ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ表示頻 çÂÂéÂÂè·Âå¯è½ä¸Âé©ç¨æÂ¨æÂ å¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å AM 9K/10K ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸å AM 9K æÂ AM 10K ï¼Âç¶ å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTERã 調æÂÂ顯示å¹Â亮度 æÂ¨å¯以調æÂ´åÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤º å¹ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ亮度ã 1 æÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å SYS SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸å DIMMERï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã éÂÂæÂÂ顯示å¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿é¡¯ç¤º å¹Âä¸Âã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸å LIGHT æÂ DARK ï¼Âç¶ å¾ æÂ ä¸ ENTERã è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂéµé @Key Lockï¼ å°ÂæÂÂéµéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½æÂÂéÂÂï¼Âå³å¯åÂÂç¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé  æÂÂéµã 1 æÂ ä¸ SHIFT SETUPã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å SYS SET ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸ å KEYLOCK ï¼Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 4 使ç¨ ï©/ïª é¸å LOCK ON æÂ LOCK OFF ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã æÂÂæÂ¾å¨è¨Âå®Âå¼ åªÂé«Âé¡Âå 系統 格张NTSC PAL AUTO DVD/ è¶ ç´ VCD/ VCD/DivX è¦Âé » / WMV NTSC NTSC PAL NTSC PAL NTSC PAL PAL CD/MP3/WMA/ MPEG-4 AAC/ JPEG/ ç¡ç¢Âç â NTSC PAL NTSC æÂ PAL éÂÂ註 1 é² è¡Âæ¯Âé  è¨Âå®Âå¼è®ÂæÂ´ä¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂ¨ å¿ é Âå Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂæÂÂå¾ æ© ï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ïµ STANDBY/ON ï¼Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 52 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 53 Zhtw English Español English Español æÂ éÂÂæÂÂé¤ 人åÂÂç¶Â常é¯å°Âä¸ÂæÂ£ç¢ºä¹ÂæÂÂä½ ç¶æÂÂ系統æÂ éÂÂæÂÂç°常ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨èª çºæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂä»»ä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âï¼Âè«ÂæÂÂ砧以丠åÂÂé» é²è¡Â檢æÂ¥ãÂÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ å¯è½æÂ¯ä¾Âèª堶ä»Âè£Âç½®ãÂÂè«Âä»Â細檢æÂ¥å ¶ ä»Â使ç¨ä¸ÂçÂÂè£Âç½®åÂÂéÂȌ¨è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂå¦ÂæÂ å¨æÂÂ¥ èÂÂéÂÂ以ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂé»Âå¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ÂéÂÂæÂ¯ç¡ æ³ÂæÂ¹å @è«Âå°±è¿Â洽詢æÂ¨çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ æÂÂç¶Âé·å @åÂÂä¾Â代çºç¶Âä¿® ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¬ç³»çµ±æÂ¯å çºåÂÂå°éÂÂéÂȍÂÂå¤Âä¾ÂæÂÂæÂÂè´使ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸ æÂÂä½Âï¼Âè«Âå°Â黿ºÂæÂÂé Âå¾Â輸åºæÂÂ座ä¸ÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå»ï¼Â以åÂÂ復æÂ£å¸¸çÂÂæÂÂä½ çÂÂæ Âã ä¸ÂèÂŒÂÂé¡ åÂÂ顠解決辦泠黿ºÂæ²ÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂçªÂç¶ é 橠ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå¯è½æÂÂæÂÂ丠é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯é¡¯ç¤ºï¼ ã â¢ éÂÂéÂÂæ©ÂÃ¥ÂÂè«ÂçÂÂå¾ ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂã â¢ 確å®Â主æ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂç· æÂÂç¡é¬Âè«çÂÂæÂ å½¢ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂé¬Âè«ï¼Âå¯è½æÂÂé æÂ ç³»çµ±èªåÂÂéÂÂæ©Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂÂ¥ æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢ºã â¢ 確å®Â主黿ºÂçÂÂé» å£Â確實é©ç¨æÂ¼æÂŒÂÂæ©Â種ã â¢ Ã¥ÂÂ試éÂÂä½Âé³éÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âä»Âç¶å å¨ï¼Âè«Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂè³æÂÂè¿ÂçÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠å¿ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂèÂÂæÂ¥å ç¶Âä¿®ã é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂè½å¾Âï¼Âæ²ÂæÂÂè²é³ 輸 åºã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨æÂ£ä½¿ç¨締路輸堥@è«Â確å®Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂé£æÂ¥æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 40 é Âç é£æÂ¥è¼Âå©é³ é »è¨Âå ï¼Âã â¢ å¦ÂæÂ HDMI é³è¨Â模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âçº TV ï¼Â第 41 é Âï¼ ï¼ åÂÂä¸ÂæÂÂå¾Âé£æÂ¥è³æÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ä¸Â輸 åº ä»»ä½Âè²é³ã â¢ æÂÂä¸ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨ä¸Âç MUTE 以éÂÂéÂÂéÂÂé³åÂÂè½ã â¢ 調é«Âé³éÂÂã æ²ÂæÂÂè²é³ä¾Âèªç°ç¹Âè²æÂ ä¸ ç½®æÂÂè²å¨ã â¢ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 17 é Âç è¨Âç½®è²éÂÂé³é 以檢æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨ä½ÂæºÂã â¢ ç¶é¸å TUNER ã ADAPTER PORT æÂ LINE æÂ ï¼ æÂ¨åªè½以ç«Âé«Âè²è½åÂÂä¾Â溠ã å°Â輸堥侠æºÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂè³ DVD/CD æÂ USB ç¢ çÂÂå¤Âè²éÂÂ鳿ÂÂã â¢ 確å®ÂæÂ¨ä¸¦æÂªé¸å STEREO çÂÂ鳿ÂÂ模张ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 22 é Âç 以ç°ç¹Âè²èÂÂè½ ï¼Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥æÂ¯å¦æÂ¥ä¸Â麥 å Â風ã â¢ æÂ£ç¢ºé£æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 9 é Âç åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ ï¼Âã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂä½ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨ã â¢ æÂ´æÂ°é»池ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 15 é Âç å®Âè£ÂéÂÂæÂ§å¨é»池ï¼Âã â¢ è«Âå¨éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨ ç 7 m ã 30 ð ç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂå §æÂÂä½ ï¼Â第 16 é Âç éÂÂç¨éÂÂæÂ§å¨ ï¼Âã â¢ ç§»é¤éÂÂç¤Âç©æÂÂå¾ å ¶ä»Âä½Âç½®æÂÂä½Âã â¢ é¿å ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç éÂÂæÂ§æÂÂæÂÂå¨åÂÂå°é½å Âç´å°Âã 麥å Â風çÂÂè²é³è½ä¸Âå°ã â¢ æÂ¨åªè½使ç¨ä¸Âé»麥å Â風並é Âå°Âå ¶æÂÂå ¥ MIC (SUB) æÂÂå ã MIC (SUB) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂåª æÂÂå¨å¦夠æÂÂä¸Âé»麥å Â風æÂÂå ¥ MIC (MAIN) æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ æ³Âä¸ÂæÂÂè½ 使ç¨ã â¢ 調æÂ´ MIC VOL / âÂÂã 麥å Â風æÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¥Âé é³ã â¢ 麥å Â風æÂ£å°ÂèÂÂæÂ è²å¨ãÂÂç§»éÂÂ麥å Â風ä¸Âç´å°ÂèÂÂæÂÂè²å¨ã â¢ 麥å Â風é³éÂÂ調太 é«ÂãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âè½ÂÃ¥ÂÂ麥å Â風é³éÂÂæÂ§å¶éÂÂã 顯示å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂ顯示 TRAYLOCK ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂç¡泠éÂÂåºç¢Âç¤ã â¢ æÂÂä½ÂÃ¥ÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç ï¨ OPEN/CLOSE æÂÂéµä¸ÂæÂ¾ç´Âå «ç§ÂéÂÂãÂÂæÂ¥è 便å¯使ç¨ ï¨ OPEN/C LOSE æÂ éµä¾ÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂéÂÂéÂÂç¢Âç¤ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 53 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 54 Zhtw DVD/CD/VCD æÂÂæÂ¾å¨ Ã¥ÂÂ顠解決辦泠ç¢ÂçÂÂå¨置堥å¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂèªåÂÂé åºã â¢ 渠æ½Âç¢ÂçÂÂ並å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ£ 確å°ÂæºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âæ§½ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂ DVD-video ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂå°åÂÂ代碼èÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âä¸ÂçÂÂ代 碼ä¸Âç¸符 @該ç¢ÂçÂÂ便ä¸Âè½使ç¨ ï¼Âè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 50 é Âç DVD Video é©ç¨å°å @ãÂÂå¨æÂ¤æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼Âè¢å¹Âä¸ÂæÂÂåºç¾ä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂè¨ÂæÂ¯ï¼ Incompatible disc region number / Can' t play disc ï¼ÂéÂÂ堼容ç¢ÂçÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ碼ï¼Âç¡ æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ç¢ÂçÂÂï¼ ã â¢ è®ÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨堧é¨çÂÂæ°´æ°£ æÂÂæÂÂéÂÂè¸ç¼ãÂÂé¿å Âå¨空調è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂè¿Â使ç¨æÂ¬ æ©Âã ç¡æ³Âé²è¡ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂå¨置堥æÂÂæÂ¾ Ã¥ÂÂï¼Âè«ÂéÂÂæÂ°å°Âç¢ÂçÂÂæ¨Â籤颿ÂÂä¸ÂæÂ¾å ¥ã 影åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä¸ÂæÂ¢ï¼Âä¸ÂæÂÂéµç¡ æ³Â使ç¨ã â¢ æÂÂ丠ï§ ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ï¼ÂæÂÂéÂ括Âç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ï¤ ï¼ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ï¼ÂæÂÂéµéÂÂå§ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ å Âå°Â黿ºÂéÂÂéÂÂï¼Âç¶徠åÂÂ使ç¨åÂÂé¢æÂ¿ä¸Âç ïµ STANDBY/ON æÂÂéµå°Â黿ºÂæÂÂéÂÂã è¨Âå®Âå¼堨鍿¶Âé¤ã â¢ 黿ºÂç¼çÂÂä¸ÂæÂ·æÂÂï¼Âå° æÂÂæ¶Âé¤è¨Âå®Âå¼ã æ²ÂæÂÂå½±åÂÂï¼Âæ²ÂæÂÂè²彩ã â¢ 檢æÂ¥é£æÂ¥æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢ºä»¥åÂÂæÂÂé ÂæÂ¯å¦å®Âå ¨æÂÂå ¥ ã â¢ æÂ¥é±é»è¦Âæ©Âï¼Â顯示å¨ çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Â以確å®Âè¨Âå®Âå¼æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢ºã â¢ èÂ¥æÂ¯é¸å Progressive ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼Âè¨Âå®Âå¼å»已ç¨è²差 è¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç·Âä¾Âé£æÂ¥éÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂ ä¿¡èÂÂä¸Âç¸容çÂÂé»è¦Âæ© ï¼ å°Âå®Âå ¨ç¡æ³ÂçÂÂå°任ä½Âç«é¢ ã 使ç¨åÂÂæÂÂæÂ S-video 端åÂÂæÂ¥ä¸Âé»覠橠å¾Âï¼Âè« å° Compone nt Out ï¼Âè²差è¦Â頻輸åº@è¨Âå®Âå¼è®ÂæÂ´çº Interlace ï¼ÂéÂÂè¡ÂæÂÂæÂÂï¼ ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼Âã è¢å¹Âç«é¢æÂÂé·æÂÂæ¯Âä¾Âæ² è®Âã â¢ TV Screen ï¼Âé»è¦Âæ© å±Âå¹Âï¼ çÂÂè¨Âå®Âå¼ä¸ÂæÂ£ç¢ºãÂÂéÂÂæÂ°è¨Âç½®é»è¦Âæ© è¢å¹ÂçÂÂé¸頠ï¼Â使堶è æÂ¨ä½¿ç¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Âï¼Â顯示å¨ç¸ 符 ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åºè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼Âã ç¶å¨ VCR ä¸ÂæÂÂéÂÂé AV é¸åÂÂå¨é²è¡ÂéÂÂ製ï¼Â便æÂÂå¹² æÂ¾å°影åÂÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾ã â¢ æÂ¬ç³»çµ±çºæÂ¡ç¨é²æÂ·æÂÂ衠@以é¿å ÂéÂÂé VCR æÂ AV é¸åÂÂå¨ç¼çÂÂéÂÂ製æÂÂå½±åÂÂæÂ¹é¢çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ ã éÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã ç«é¢å¨æÂÂæÂ¾æÂÂéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå°干æÂ¾ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ä¸ÂçÂÂæ¼Âé»Âã â¢ æÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨è Macr o-Vision System é²æÂ·ç³»çµ±ç¸容 ã æÂÂäºÂç¢ÂçÂÂå §å«é²æÂᏬÂè @èÂÂä¸ÂæÂ¤ 種ç¢ÂçÂÂ卿ÂÂæÂ¾æÂ ï¼Âå¨ç«é¢ä¸Âä¸Â亠å°æÂ¹æÂÂåºç¾å¦Âç·Âæ¢ÂçÂÂçÂÂéÂÂ訠ï¼Âè¦Â使ç¨ç é»è¦Âæ©Âé¡Âå èÂÂå®Âï¼ ãÂÂé 並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã â¢ ç¢ÂçÂÂå°Âç¹åÂ¥çÂÂæÂÂæÂ¾å¨ Ã¥ÂÂè½åÂÂæÂÂä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂã éÂÂå¯è½æÂÂå°Âè´ç«é¢ å¨åÂÂè½å·è¡Âç¶æÂ ï¼ÂçÂÂæÂÂéÂÂå ç¾æ¼Âé»ÂæÂÂè¼Âå¾®æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂç¾象 ãÂÂéÂÂäºÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Â便å çºç¢ÂçÂÂèÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂ堧容 ä¹ÂéÂÂçÂÂå·®ç°èÂÂæÂ´å çªÂ顯@ä½Â並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ éÂÂæÂÂè´ã DVD è CD é³éÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ顯 å·®ç°ã â¢ DVD è CD 使ç¨çÂÂé 製æÂ¹å¼Âä¸ÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã CD-ROM ç¢ÂçÂÂç¡æ³Â辨 èÂÂã â¢ 確宠CD-ROM æÂ¯ä½¿ç¨ ISO 9660 çÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæ ¼å¼ÂéÂÂ製 ã æÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§çÂÂè³Â訠@諠åÂÂéÂ񇪪 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã ç¡æ³Â辨è DVD-ROM 碠çÂÂã â¢ 確宠DVD-ROM æÂ¯æÂ¡ç¨ UDF bridge æ ¼å¼ÂéÂÂ製 ã æÂ´å¤ÂéÂÂæÂ¼ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§çÂÂè³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã æªÂæ¡Âç¡æ³Âå¨ç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼Âç¸ çÂÂçÂÂ覽å¨ç¶ä¸Â顯示ã â¢ ç¢ÂçÂÂä¸ÂçÂÂæªÂæ¡Âå¿ é Â以 æÂ£ç¢ºçÂÂ坿ªÂÃ¥ÂÂå½å @è¬妠@MP 3 æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .mp3 ï¼ WMA æªÂæ¡ æÂ¡ç¨ .wma ï¼ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .m4a ï¼ JPEG æÂ¡ç¨ .jpg ï¼Â大寫æÂÂå°Â寫é½å¯以@ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 47 é Âç ç¢ÂçÂÂç¸容æÂ§åÂÂ砧表 ã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ WMA æÂ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡ ã â¢ éÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡ÂçºæÂ¡ç¨ DRM ï¼ÂæÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂ製çÂÂãÂÂéÂÂ並ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ WMV æªÂæ¡Âã â¢ ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ä½Âå ÂçÂÂè¶ é 192 kbps çÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 54 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 55 Zhtw English Español English Español 調諧å¨ USB 飿ÂÂ¥ HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ Ã¥ÂÂ顠解決辦泠æÂ¶è½éÂȌ°廣æÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂÂ顯 ç éÂÂé³ã â¢ 飿ÂÂ¥ AM 天締ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 9 é Âç åºæÂ¾Â¥ç·ÂæÂ¹å¼ ï¼ ä¸¦èª¿æÂ´å ¶æÂ¹åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä½Â置以徠å°æÂÂä½³ç æÂ¥æÂ¶æ¢Âä»¶ ã æÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以å¦å¤ÂæÂ¥ä¸Âæ¢Â堧鍿ÂÂå¤Âé¨ AM 天ç·Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天 ç· ï¼Âã â¢ å®Â堨伸å±Âé FM ç·ÂÃ¥ÂÂ天ç·Â@調æÂ´è³æÂÂä½³æÂ¥æÂ¶çÂÂä½Âç½® ï¼Âç¶å¾Âåºå®ÂæÂ¼çÂÂ丠ãÂÂæÂ¨ä¹Âå¯以å¦ å¤ÂæÂ¥ä¸ÂçµÂå¤Âé¨ FM 天締ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç é£æÂ¥å¤Âé¨天締ï¼Âã â¢ éÂÂéÂÂå ¶ä»Âå¯è½é æÂÂéÂÂè¨ÂçÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå°Â堶移走ã â¢ 調諧éÂÂè·Âä¸Âé©ç¨ æÂ¨æÂÂå¨çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶æÂÂå°å ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 52 é Âç 頻çÂÂéÂÂè·Âè¨Âç½® çÂÂ說æÂÂ以å æÂÂ調諧éÂÂéÂÂã èªåÂÂ調諧åÂÂè½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ¥æÂ¶ å° æÂÂäºÂéÂȌ°ã â¢ éÂȌ°è¨ÂèÂÂ微弱 ã èªåÂÂ調諧åÂÂè½å è½åµ測å°è¨ÂèÂÂç¼尠è¯好çÂÂç¡ç·ÂéÂȌ°ã æÂ³è¦Âç²å¾ÂæÂ´å éÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ調諧æ¢Âä»¶ï¼Âå¯æÂ¥ä¸ ä¸ÂçµÂ室å¤Â天ç·Âã åÂÂ顠解決辦泠æÂ¬ç³»çµ±ç¡æ³Â辨è USB 大 éÂÂå²åÂÂè£Âç½®ã â¢ 確å®Â已尠USB æÂ¥é Âå®Âå ¨æÂÂå ¥æÂ¬æ©Âå §ã â¢ 確èªÂè¨ÂæÂ¶é«Â格张çº FAT 1 6 æÂ FAT 3 2 ã â¢ ä¸ÂæÂ¯æÂ´å §å»ºæÂ USB éÂÂç·Âå¨ç USB è£Âç½® ã æªÂæ¡Âç¡æ³Âå¨å°Â覽å¨ï¼Âç¸ ç çÂÂ覽å¨ä¸Â顯示ã â¢ æªÂæ¡Âå¿ é Âè¦ÂæÂÂæÂ£ 確çÂÂ坿ªÂå @è¬妠@MP3 æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .mp3 ï¼ WMA æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .wma ï¼ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡ÂæÂ¡ç¨ .m4a ï¼ JPEG æÂ¡ç¨ .jpg ï¼Â大寫æÂÂå°Â寫é½å¯以@ã â¢ 確å®ÂæªÂæ¡Â許å¯欠æÂªåÂÂéÂÂå¶ ï¼ÂéÂÂéÂÂå¯Â碼çÂÂï¼ ã ç¡æ³ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ WMA æÂ MPEG-4 AAC æªÂæ¡Âã â¢ éÂÂäºÂæªÂæ¡ÂçºæÂ¡ç¨ DRM ï¼ÂæÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂéÂÂ製çÂÂãÂÂéÂÂ並丠æÂ¯æÂ éÂÂã åÂÂ顠解決辦泠ç¡ HDMI è¦Â頻輸åºã â¢ 確å®Âå¨éÂÂå°Â使ç¨è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè¨Âå®Â丠@已é¸åÂÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ä½Âçº HDMI 輸堥ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂæÂ ä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã â¢ 確誠HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âå·²æÂ£ç¢ºæÂ¥ä¸ ä¸ÂæÂªæÂÂå£Âã â¢ 確èªÂ使ç¨ HDMI ä»Âé¢æÂ¥ä¸ÂçÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂå·²éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âè HDMI ç¸容 ï¼ÂéÂÂäºÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂé Âè DVI å HDCP ï¼ High B andwidth Digita l Co ntent Protec tion ï¼Âç¸容@ã â¢ è¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂè å®Âï¼Â使ç¨ DVI é£æÂ¥å¯è½å°Âè´信 èÂÂå³輸ä¸Âç©©ã â¢ 確å®ÂæÂ¾ÂÂæÂ¾å¨ä¸ÂçÂÂè§£æÂÂ度èÂÂ使ç¨ HDMI é£æÂ¥çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âè´ ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 35 é Âç è¦Â頻輸åº è¨Âå®Âå¼ è®ÂæÂ´è§£æÂÂ度ã â¢ èÂ¥è®ÂæÂ´è§£æÂÂ度徠ç«é¢ä¸ÂçÂÂ空ç½ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ表示é¸åÂÂçÂÂè§£æÂÂ度èÂÂæÂ¨ çÂÂ顯示å¨ä¸Â符ãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 42 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨Âå® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ éÂÂæÂ°è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» é Âè¨Âå¼ã å¨è®ÂæÂ´ HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼ å¾Âï¼Â顯示å¨çÂÂè²彩åºç¾ å é¡Â@第 36 é Âï¼ ã â¢ è¦Âé£æÂ¥çÂÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂè 宠@æÂÂ亠HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼å¯è½é æÂÂç«é¢ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£ç¢º 顯示ãÂÂæÂ¤æÂ ï¼Âè«Âè¦ÂçÂÂæ³Â使ç¨é»è¦Âæ©Âç è¦Â頻輸堥è¨Âå®Âå¼é¸å RGB ãÂÂæÂÂè å¯æÂ¢å¾©å ÂÃ¥ÂÂç HDMI Color ï¼ HDMI è²彩@è¨Âå®Âå¼ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 55 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 56 Zhtw Bluetooth é£締é¯誤è¨ÂæÂ¯ æ²ÂæÂÂå½±åÂÂæÂÂè²é³ã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡Âä»Âç¶åÂÂå¨ ï¼ å¨å°ÂæÂ¨ç HDMI è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂç´æÂ¥é£æÂ¥è³顯示å¨æÂ ï¼ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ顯示 å¨çÂÂæÂÂä½ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ洽詢製é åÂÂ以å°Âæ±ÂÃ¥ÂÂå©ã ç¡ HDMI é³頻輸åºã â¢ è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 41 é Âç åÂÂæÂ HDMI é³頻è¨Âç½®å¼ ï¼Â確å®Âå·²é¸å TV ã KURO LINK ä¸Âä½Âç¨ã â¢ 確èªÂæÂ¯å¦已ç¢ç¢é£æÂÂ¥ HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·Âã â¢ 確å®ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK 模å¼Âå·²è¨Âå®Âçº LINK ON ï¼Â第 45 é Âï¼ ã â¢ 檢æÂ¥æÂÂé£æÂ¥è¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¯å¦ æÂ¯æÂ´ KURO LINK ã å¦ÂéÂÂ詳細è³Â訠@è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±æÂ¨çÂÂå¹³é¢é»è¦ÂçÂÂæÂÂä½ æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂã â¢ å¦ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ飿ÂÂ¥ SCAR T é£æÂ¥ç·Âå HDMI é£ æÂÂ¥ ç·Âï¼Âå KURO LINK å¯è½ç¡æ³ÂæÂ£å¸¸ ä½Âç¨ ã å æÂÂ飿ÂÂ¥ SCART å HDMI é£æÂ¥ç·ÂæÂÂï¼Âè«Âå° KURO LINK 模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âçº LINK OFF ã æÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ輸 å ¥ã â¢ é£æÂ¥é»è¦Âæ©ÂèªåÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ è¼¸å ¥ä»¥åÂÂæÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂéÂÂæ©ÂæÂÂæÂ¾ DVD æÂÂ顯示åÂÂ形使ç¨è ä»Âé¢ç«é¢ ï¼Âä¾Âå¦Âç¢ÂçÂÂå°ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ç ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂ¨ä¸Âè¦ÂæÂ¨çÂÂé»è¦Âæ©Â以éÂÂ種æÂ¹å¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂ輸堥 ï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©Âç KURO LINK 模å¼Âè¨Âå®Âçº LINK OFF ï¼Â第 45 é Âï¼ ã åÂÂ顠解決辦泠åÂÂ顠解決辦泠ç¡æ³Âé£æÂ¥æÂÂæÂÂä½ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Â裠置ãÂÂä¾Âèª Blueto oth ç¡締æÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂè²é³æÂªç¼åº@æÂÂè²é³ä¸ÂæÂ·ã â¢ 檢æÂ¥é è¿ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂçÂÂä½Âç½® æÂ¯å¦æ²ÂæÂÂä»»ä½Âç¼尠2.4 GHz 頻段é»池波çÂÂç©髠ï¼Â微波ç ã ç¡締LAN è£Âç½®æÂ Blue tooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂé¡Âç©é«Âé è¿ÂæÂ¬æ© ï¼ è«Âå°ÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ¾å¨é é¢å®ÂçÂÂä½Âç½®ãÂÂæÂÂè ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ¢ 使ç¨ç¼åºé»ç£Âæ³¢çÂÂç©é«Âã â¢ 檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth ç¡ç·Âè£Âç½®æÂ¯å¦æ²ÂæÂÂé¢æÂ¬æ© å¤ªé @èÂÂ丠Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®èÂÂæÂ¬æ© ä¹ÂéÂÂæÂ¯å¦æ²ÂæÂÂä»»ä½ÂéÂÂç¤Âç©ã 尠Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®åÂÂæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ¾ç½®å¨彼æÂ¤ä¸Âè¶ é 10 m çÂÂè·Âé¢堧ï¼ÂèÂÂä¸Âä¸Âé ä¸Âå¯以æÂÂä»»ä½ÂéÂÂç¤Âç©ã â¢ 檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth å³輸å¨èÂÂæÂ¬æ©Âç ADAPTER PO RT æÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º é£æÂ¥ã â¢ Blueto oth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ç¡æ³Âè¨Âå®ÂçºæÂ¯æÂ´ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡ÂçÂÂéÂÂè¨Â模å¼ÂãÂÂ檢æÂÂ¥ Bluetoo th ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®çÂÂè¨Âå®Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥é Âå°ÂæÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º ã é Âå°Âè¨Âå®Âå·²èªæÂ¬æ©ÂæÂ Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½®ä¸Â被åªé¤ ã éÂÂ訠é Âå°Âã â¢ 檢æÂ¥è¨Âå®ÂæÂ¯å¦æÂ£ç¢º ã 使ç¨æÂ¯æÂ´ A2DP è¨Âå®Âå AV R C P è¨Âå®Âç Bluetooth ç¡ç·ÂæÂÂè¡Âè£Âç½® ã è¨ÂæÂ¯ 說æÂ EXTRAPWR ⢠使ç¨å 大åÂÂçÂÂ模å¼ÂæÂ ï¼Âç¡æ³Â調æÂ´ SFC 模å¼Âã é³調æÂ§å¶ ï¼Âä½Âé³ã é«Âé³åÂÂä½Âé³å éÂÂï¼ ã MP3 æÂ´å±Âå¨模å¼ÂãÂÂè²é³強åÂÂå¨模张ã CANNOT â¢ ç±æÂ¼ æÂªé¸æÂ DVD/CD æÂ USB ï¼ æÂÂå¨已æÂÂ丠SHIFT KARAOKE ã SHIFT ECHOã SHIFT ï æÂ SHIFT ï æÂÂç¦ÂæÂ¢æÂÂä½Âã â¢ å¨æÂªé¸å DVD/CD Ã¥ÂÂæÂÂ丠SH IF T USB REC æÂÂ顯示ã TRAYLOCK ⢠ç¢Âç¤éÂÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂãÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé± 第 53 é Âç æÂ éÂÂæÂÂé¤ ç ä¸ÂèÂŒÂÂé¡ ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 56 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 57 Zhtw English Español English Español éÂÂæÂ°è¨Â置系統 è«ÂéÂÂç¨æÂ¤ç¨ÂåºÂå°ÂæÂÂæÂÂçÂÂ系統è¨Âå®Âå¼åÂÂ復æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå» çÂÂé Âè¨Âå¼ã 1 系統éÂÂæ©Âå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂ丠SHIFT SETUP ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å INITIAL ï¼ ç¶å¾ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 3 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ é¸å ALL IN IT ï¼Âç¶ å¾ æÂ ENTER ã â¢ 顯示 INIT OK ã 4I N I T O K éÂÂçÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂ丠ENTER ã 1 使ç¨èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® æÂÂäºÂèªÂè¨Âé¸頠ï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 36 é Âç èªÂè¨Âè¨Âå®Âå¼ ï¼ è½è®ÂæÂ¨å¾Âä¸Âå èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ç 136 種èªÂè¨Âç¶ ä¸Âè¨Âå®ÂÃ¥ÂÂ人åÂÂ好çÂÂèªÂè¨Âã 1 é¸å ã Other Languag e ï¼Âå ¶ä» èªÂè¨Âï¼ ã ã 2 使ç¨ ï«/ï¬ 以é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼æÂÂæÂ¯æÂ¸ Ã¥ÂÂ代碼 ã 3 使ç¨ ï©/ïª 以é¸åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼æÂÂæÂ¯æÂ¸åÂÂ代 碼ã è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âå èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® ï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂå®ÂæÂ´èªÂè¨Â種顠åÂÂ代碼çÂÂ渠å®ã STEREO â¢ å¨ TUNER ã LINE æÂ ADAPTER PORT 輸堥模å¼Âä¸ÂæÂÂ丠SURROUND æÂ AUTO /STEREO æÂÂï¼Â顯示 STEREO ã KEYLOCK ⢠æÂÂéµéÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç¨ãÂÂè« åÂÂéÂ񇪪 52 é Âç è¨Âå®ÂæÂÂéµé @Key Lock ï¼ ã USB ERR ⢠å¦ÂéÂÂæÂ´å¤ÂèÂÂæÂ¤ç¸ éÂÂçÂÂè³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 31 é Âç 使ç¨ USB ä»Âé¢ ç éÂÂè¦ÂæÂÂ示 ã HDMI ERR ⢠è«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±ä¸Âè¿° HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ çÂÂæÂ éÂÂæÂÂ餿ÂÂ示 ã èÂ¥ä»ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé¡ ï¼ åÂÂè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂ񇪪 42 é Âç éÂÂæÂ°è¨ å® HDMI 飿ÂÂ¥ ã EEP ERR ⢠ç¶Âä¿®äºÂå®Âè«Â洽詢 æÂ¨çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂã EXIT ⢠輸堥ç¦ÂæÂ¢çÂÂè¨Âè æÂÂå¨顯示é¸å®ç«é¢æÂÂæÂ¥ä¸Â麥å Â風峿ÂÂ顯示 ï¼ ç¶å¾Âç«é¢æÂÂè¿ÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ£å¸¸ç« é¢ã NO MIC â¢ å¨æÂªæÂÂ堥麥堠風æÂÂï¼ÂæÂ SHIFT KARAOKEã SHI FT ECHO ãÂÂSHIFT ï ã SHIF T ï æÂ MIC VOL /â å³æÂÂ顯示ã OC ERR 1 OC ERR 2 ⢠檢æÂ¥æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂÂ¥ ç·ÂæÂ¯å¦çÂÂè·¯ã å¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂçºÂ顯示é¯誤訠æÂ¯ï¼ è«Â洽詢æÂ¨çÂÂå ÂéÂÂæÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠å¿ÂæÂÂæÂ¨çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂé²è¡Âç¶Âä¿® ã OVER TEMP ⢠åÂÂ試éÂÂä½Âé³é ãÂÂå¦ÂæÂÂæÂÂ丠åÂÂæÂÂ堥黿ºÂç·Âç¡æ³Âä¿®æÂ£æÂ¤åÂÂé¡ ï¼Â表示æÂ¬æ©Âå¯è½已æÂ å£ÂãÂÂå¨ æÂ¤æÂ æ³Âä¸Âï¼Âè«Â洽詢å ÂéÂÂæÂ æ¬ÂæÂÂÃ¥ÂÂä¸Âå¿ÂæÂÂé¢æÂ¨æÂÂæÂ°çÂÂç¶Âé·åÂÂã BT ERR ⢠Bluetooth å³輸å¨çÂÂæ¶ÂèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂ太髠@以è´æÂ¼ç¡æ³Âä¾ÂæÂÂé»溠ã éÂÂæÂ°é£ æÂÂ¥ Bluetooth å³輸 å¨ã TV AUDIO å¦ÂæÂÂèÂÂè½模å¼Âå¨è¨Âå®Âä¾Âé» è¦Â使ç¨ç HDMI é³è¨Â模å¼ÂæÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ï¼ åÂÂ顯示çÂÂæÂÂ亮起堩ç§Âã KARAOKE ⢠æÂÂä¸Â麥å Â風æÂ ï¼ å¨æÂ¨æÂÂ丠SURROUND ã SOUND ã AUTO/STE REO æÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH æÂÂ顯示ã PHONESI N ⢠æÂÂä¸Âè³æ©ÂæÂ ï¼ å¨æÂ¨æÂÂ丠SURROUND ã SOUND ã AUTO/STER EO æÂ MP3 EXP/V.ENH æÂÂ顯示ã è¨ÂæÂ¯ 說æÂ éÂÂ註 1 è«Âå¿å çº系統黿ºÂèªåÂÂéÂÂå ï¼Â就鍿ÂÂäºÂ使ç¨æÂ¬æ©ÂæÂÂæÂÂæÂ¯é»æºÂç· ã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 57 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 58 Zhtw èªÂè¨Â代碼渠å® èªÂ訠ï¼ÂèªÂè¨ÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼@ã èªÂè¨Â代碼 Ã¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂ代碼渠å® Ã¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂã åÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå° Ã¥ÂÂ代碼 ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå®¶ï¼Âå°åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¯Â代碼 Japanese (ja), 1001 Englis h (en), 0514 French (fr), 0 618 German (de), 0405 Italian ( it), 0920 Spanish (es), 0519 Dutch (nl), 1412 Russian (ru), 1821 Chinese (zh), 2608 Korean (ko), 1115 Greek (el), 0512 Afar (aa), 0101 Abkhazian (ab), 0102 Afrikaans (af), 0106 Amharic (am), 0113 Arabic (ar) , 0118 Assamese (as), 0119 Aymara (ay), 0125 Azerb aijani (az) , 0126 Bashkir (ba), 0201 Byelorussian (be), 0205 Bulgarian (bg) ï¼ 0207 Bihari (bh), 0208 Bislama (bi), 0209 Bengal i (bn), 0214 Tibetan (bo), 0215 Breton (br), 0218 Catalan (ca), 0301 Corsican ( co), 0315 Czech (cs) , 0319 Welsh (cy), 0325 Danish (da), 0401 Bhutani (dz), 0426 Esperant o (eo), 0515 Estonia n (et), 0520 Basque (eu), 0521 Persian (fa), 0601 Finnish (fi), 0609 Fiji (fj) , 0610 Faroese (fo), 0615 Frisian (fy ), 0625 Irish (ga) , 0701 Scots-Gaelic (gd), 0704 Galician (gl) , 0712 Guarani ( gn), 0714 Gujarat i (gu), 0721 Hausa (ha), 0801 Hindi (hi), 0809 Croatian (hr), 081 8 Hungarian (hu), 0821 Armenian (hy), 0825 Interlingua (ia), 0901 Interlingue (ie), 0905 Inupiak (ik), 0911 Indonesian (in), 0914 Icelandic (is), 0919 Hebrew ( iw) ï¼ 0923 Yiddish (ji ), 1009 Javanese (jw), 1023 Georgian (ka), 1101 Kazakh (kk), 1111 Greenlandic (kl ), 1112 Cambodian (km), 1113 Kannada (kn), 1114 Kashmiri (ks), 1119 Kurdish (ku), 1121 Kirghiz (ky), 1125 Latin (la), 1201 Lingala (ln), 1214 Laothian (lo), 1215 Lithuanian (lt) , 1220 Latvi an (lv), 1222 Malagasy (m g), 1307 Maori (mi), 1309 Macedonian (mk), 1311 Malayalam (ml), 1312 Mongolian (mn), 1314 Moldavian (mo), 1315 Marathi (mr), 1318 Malay (ms), 1319 Maltese (mt), 1320 Burmese (my), 1325 Nauru (na), 1401 Nepali (ne), 1405 Norwegian (no ), 1415 Occitan (oc), 1503 Oromo (om), 1513 Oriya (or), 1518 Panjabi (pa), 1601 Polish (p l), 1612 Pashto, Pushto (ps), 1619 Portuguese (pt), 1620 Quechua (qu), 1721 Rhaeto-Romance (rm), 1813 Kirund i (rn), 1814 Romanian (ro), 1815 Kinyarwanda (rw), 1823 Sanskrit (sa), 1901 Sindhi (sd), 1904 Sangho (sg), 1907 Serbo-Croatian (sh), 1908 Sinhalese (si), 1909 Slovak (sk), 1911 Slovenian (sl), 1912 Samoan (sm), 1913 Shona (sn), 1914 Somali ( so), 1915 Albanian (sq) ï¼ 1917 Serbian (sr), 1918 Siswati (ss), 1919 Sesotho (st), 1920 Sundanese (su), 1921 Swedish (sv), 1922 Swahili (sw) , 1923 Tamil (ta), 2001 Telugu (te), 2005 Tajik (tg), 2007 Thai (th), 2008 Tigrinya ( ti), 2009 Turkmen (tk), 2011 Tagalog (tl), 2012 Setswana (tn) , 2014 Tonga (to), 2015 Turkish (tr), 2 018 Tsonga (ts), 2019 Tatar (tt) , 2020 Twi (tw), 2023 Ukrainian (uk), 2111 Urdu (ur), 2118 Uzbek (uz), 2126 Vietname se (vi), 2209 Volap ü k (vo), 2215 Wolof (wo), 2315 Xhosa (xh), 2408 Yoruba (yo), 2 515 Zulu (zu), 26 21 é¿根廷 , 0118, ar 澳洲 , 0121, au 奧å°å© , 0120, at æ¯Âå©æÂ , 0205, be 巴西 , 0218, br å æÂ¿å¤§ , 0301, ca æÂºå© , 0312, cl ä¸Âå , 0314, cn 丹麥 , 0411, dk 菠, 0609, fi æ³Âå , 0618, fr å¾·å , 0405, de é¦Â港 , 0811, hk å°度 , 0914, in å°尼 , 0904, id 義大å© , 0920, it æÂ¥æÂ¬ , 1016, jp éÂÂå , 1118, kr 馬ä¾Â西亠, 1325, my 墨西åÂÂ¥ , 1324, m x è·è , 1412, nl ç´Â西è , 1426, nz æÂªå¨ , 1415, no å·´åºæÂ¯å¦ , 1611, pk è²å¾Âè³ , 1608, ph è¡èÂÂç , 1620, pt ä¿Âå ï¼Âä¿Âç¾ æÂ¯è¯é¦@, 1821, ru æÂ°å å¡ , 1907, sg 西çÂÂç , 0519, es çÂÂ士 , 0308, ch çÂÂå ¸ , 1905, se å°ç£ , 2023, tw æ³°å , 2008, th è±å , 0702, gb ç¾Âå , 2119, us HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 58 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 59 Zhtw English Español English Español è¦Âæ ¼ ⢠æÂ´å¤§å¨é¨å RMS Ã¥ÂÂçÂÂ輸åº@åÂÂç½®ãÂÂä¸Âç½®ãÂÂç°ç¹Âè² . . . . . æ¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂè²é 60 W ï¼ 1 kHzï¼ 10 % T.H.D.ï¼ 4 é@éÂÂä½Âé³ . . . 60 W ï¼ 10 0 Hz ï¼ 10 % T.H.D. ï¼ 4 é @⢠ç¢ÂçÂÂé¨å é¡Âå . . . . . . . . . . DVD 系統@VCD/ è¶ ç´ VCD 系統åÂÂç¢ÂçÂÂæÂ¸ä½Âé³é¿系統 ⢠FM 調諧å¨é¨å 頻çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . 87.5 MHz è³ 108 MHz 天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 é ï¼Â丠平衡张⢠AM 調諧å¨é¨å 頻çÂÂç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂï¼ æ²ÂçÂÂå°é¿æÂÂ伯ãÂÂ以è²å ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂéÂÂãÂÂå ¶ä»Âä¸ÂæÂ±åÂÂå®¶è å Â稠æ©Âå . . . . . . . . . . . 531 kHz å° 1602 kH z å ¶ä»Âæ©Â種 æÂ¡ç¨ 9 kHz éÂÂè· . . . . 531 kHz è³ 1602 kH z æÂ¡ç¨ 10 kHz éÂÂè· . . . 530 kHz è³ 1700 kHz 天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ç°åÂÂ天締â¢ å ¶ä» é»æºÂéÂÂæ±Âï¼ æÂ°å å¡ãÂÂå°尼ãÂÂé¦Â港ãÂÂ馬 ä¾Â西äºÂãÂÂè²å¾Âè³Âæ©Â種 . . . . . . AC 220 V è³ 240 V ï¼ 50 Hz/60 Hz å ¶ä»Âæ©Â種 . . . . . . AC 110 V è³ 240 V ï¼ 50 Hz/60 Hz æ¶ÂèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 W å¾ æ©Âæ¶ÂèÂÂÃ¥ÂÂç ç¨æÂ¼ HTZ180/1 81DVD . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W å ¶ä» KURO LINK ON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.73 W KURO LINK OFF . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.48 W 尺寸 . . . 420 mm ï¼Â寬@x 62 m m ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 331 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.8 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ ï¼ DVD/CD æÂ¥æÂ¶å¨@éÂÂæÂ§å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AA/R6 ä¹¾é»池ï¼Âç¨以確èªÂ系統æÂÂä½Âï¼ . . . . . . 2 è¦Âé »é£æÂ¥ç· ï¼Âé»Âè²æÂÂé Âï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 AM ç°åÂÂ天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 FM 天締. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 黿ºÂç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 å®Âè£ÂæÂÂå æÂÂä½ÂæÂÂå ï¼ÂæÂ¾ÂÂä»¶ï¼ S-DV180 æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 105 mm ï¼Â寬@x 115 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 114 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 115 mm ï¼Â寬@x 105 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 114 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 105 mm ï¼Â寬@x 118 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 114 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.6 kg ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ä½Âé³åÂÂå°Âè½ å°å 系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Hz è³ 1 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 190 mm ï¼Â寬@x 360 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 317 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 59 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 60 Zhtw 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 åºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 S-DV585 æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®ï¼Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . 96 mm ï¼Â寬@x 96 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 96 m m ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.6 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 W 尺寸 . . . 96 mm ï¼Â寬@x 96 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 96 m m ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ä½Âé³åÂÂå°Âè½å°å 系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz è³ 1 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . 230 mm ï¼Â寬@x 380 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 360 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 æÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 åºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼æÂÂæÂ¶åÂÂåºå®ÂæÂÂæÂ¶ï¼ . . . . . . . . . . 8 å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 S-DV280T æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼Âè½å°å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨@ä½Âé³ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå é«Âé³ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.6 cm Ã¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . . 260 mm ï¼Â寬@x 1097 m m ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 260 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.8 kg ⢠ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm å éÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 W 尺寸 . . . 220 mm ï¼Â寬@x 90 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 100 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.7 kg ⢠ç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . å°ÂéÂÂå¼ÂæÂ¸æÂ¶å ï¼Âé²ç£Â@系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.7 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Hz è³ 20 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . . 100 mm ï¼Â寬@x 100 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 100 m m ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.5 kg HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 60 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
å ¶ä»Âè³Â訠13 61 Zhtw English Español English Español ⢠é Âä»¶ æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 å°ÂÃ¥ÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 æÂÂè²å¨åº座 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åºÂ座@. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 S-DV282T æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠åÂÂç½®ï¼Âç°ç¹ÂæÂÂè²å¨ è S-DV280T ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ ç¸å @å¦Âä¸Âè¿° ï¼Âã â¢ ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ è S-DV280T ä¸Âç½®æÂÂè²å¨ç¸å @å¦Âä¸Âè¿° ï¼Âã â¢ é Âä»¶ æÂÂè²å¨é£æÂ¥ç· . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 æÂÂè²å¨åº座 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 èº絲 ï¼Âç¨æÂ¼åºÂ座@. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 S-DV5SW æÂÂè²å¨系統 ⢠éÂÂä½Âé³ å¤Âç®± . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ä½Âé³åÂÂå°Âè½å°å 系統 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm 1-way 系統 æÂÂè²å¨ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 cm Ã¥ÂÂéÂÂé«Âå éÂȾ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 é é »çÂÂç¯Âå . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Hz è³ 1 kHz æÂÂ大輸堥åÂÂç . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 W 尺寸 . . . 230 mm ï¼Â寬@x 380 mm ï¼Âé«Âï¼ x 360 mm ï¼Â深@éÂÂé . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.4 kg ⢠é Âä»¶ 大åÂÂ鲿»Â墠. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 éÂÂ註 â¢ çºæ±Âç¢åÂÂæÂ¹è¯ ï¼ è¦Âæ ¼åÂÂè¨Âè¨Âå¦ÂæÂÂè®ÂæÂ´ ï¼ æÂÂ丠å¦è¡ÂéÂÂçÂ¥ã ç± Dolby Laboratories æÂÂæ¬Â製é ã ãÂÂæÂÂ毠ã ã ã Dolby ã ã ã Pro Logic ã èÂÂé D æ¨ÂèªÂæÂ¯ Dolby Laboratories çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã æÂ¬æ©Âä¿Âæ ¹æÂÂç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂå°Âå©編è 5,451,942 ã 5,956,67 4 ã 5,974,38 0 ã 5,978,76 2 ã 6,487,53 5 Ã¥ÂÂ已核åÂÂèÂÂç³è«Âä¸Âä¹Âå ¶ ä»Âç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂÃ¥ÂÂ丠çÂÂå°Âå©çÂÂæÂÂæ¬Â製é ã DTS å DTS Digital Surround æÂ¯ DTS, Inc. çÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âï¼ DTS 樠èªÂÃ¥ÂÂ符èÂÂæÂ¯ DTS, Inc. çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨ÂãÂÂçÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂæÂ Ã© 1996-2008 DTS, Inc. ãÂÂä¿ÂçÂÂæÂÂæÂÂæ¬Âå©ã æÂ¥æÂ¬å ÂéÂÂå ¬å¸åºçÂÂã çÂÂ欠é2009 æÂ¥æÂ¬å  éÂÂå ¬å¸ã çÂÂæ¬ÂæÂÂæÂÂã æÂÂ¢åÂÂç¶ NEC堬叿ÂÂæ¬Âï¼Â使ç¨ F ontAvenue î Ã¥ÂÂé«Âã F ontAvenue çº NEC å ¬å¸çÂÂ註åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæ¨Âã æÂÂ¢åÂÂæÂÂ使ç¨çÂÂçÂÂæ¬Âä¿Âè·æÂÂè¡ÂÃ¥ÂÂç¾ÂÃ¥ÂÂå° å©以åÂÂå ¶ä»Â屬æÂ¼ Macrovision Corporation çÂÂçÂ¥èÂÂç¢æ¬Âä¿Âè·ã 使ç¨該ç æ¬Âä¿Âè·æÂÂè¡Âå¿ é ÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾ Macrovision Corporation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼Âå¦ÂæÂÂä¸Âç¶ Macrovision Corporation çÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂÂï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂåª è½ç¨æÂ¼å®¶åºÂæÂÂæÂÂéÂÂç¯ÂÃ¥ÂÂçÂÂè§Âè³Âã åÂÂÃ¥ÂÂé åÂÂæÂÂè§£å¯ÂçÂÂ亦屬æÂ¼ç¦ÂæÂ¢ä¹ÂÃ¥ÂÂã DRM( æÂ¸ä½ÂçÂÂæ¬Â管çÂÂ) æÂ¯ä¸Â種èÂÂç±éÂÂå¶ å£Â縮é³頻æªÂæ¡Âå è½å¨é»蠦以å¤ÂéÂÂ製æÂ¤ 種æªÂæ¡Âå°Âç¨çÂÂè£Âç½® (æÂÂå ¶ä»ÂéÂÂ製è¨Âå )æÂ æÂ¾ï¼Âå°ÂçºæÂÂæÂÂé Âé²éÂÂæ³ÂæÂ·è²ÂèÂÂè¨Âè¨Âç é²æÂ·æÂÂè¡ÂãÂÂç¸éÂÂ詳細è³Âè¨Âï¼Âè«ÂÃ¥ÂÂé±å 人é»蠦åÂÂï¼ÂæÂÂè»Âé«ÂæÂÂéÂÂçÂÂ使ç¨æÂÂÃ¥ÂÂæÂ èªªæÂÂæªÂæ¡Âã HTZ180_181_280_2 82DVD_Zhtw.book Page 61 Friday, March 20, 2009 1:03 PM
<XRE3233-A> Printed in P ublished by Pionee r Co rpo ration . Co ppy right é 2009 P ionee r Co rpo ration. All rights rese r ved. PIONEER CORPORATION 4-1, Meguro 1-Chome, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-8654, Japan PIONEER ELECTRONICS (USA) INC. P.O. BOX 1540, Long Beach, California 90801-1540, U.S.A. TEL: (800) 421-1404 PIONEER ELECTRONICS OF CANADA, INC. 300 Allstate Parkway, Markham, Ontario L3R 0P2, Canada TEL: 1-877-283-5901, 905-479-4411 PIONEER EUROPE NV Haven 1087, Keetberglaan 1, B-9120 Melsele, Belgium TEL: 03/570.05.11 PIONEER ELECTRONICS ASIACENTRE PTE. LTD. 253 Alexandra Road, #04-01, Singapore 159936 TEL: 65-6472-7555 PIONEER ELECTRONICS AUSTRALIA PTY. LTD. 178-184 Boundary Road, Braeside, Victoria 3195, Australia, TEL: (03) 9586-6300 PIONEER ELECTRONICS DE MEXICO S.A. DE C.V. Blvd.Manuel A vila Camacho 138 10 piso Col.Lomas de Chapultepec, Me xico ,D .F . 11000 TEL: 55-9178-4270 K002_B_En HTZ180_181_280_282DVD_En .book 62 ãÂÂã¼ã¸ ï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âï¼Âå¹´ï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ æÂ¥ãÂÂéÂÂæÂÂæÂ¥ãÂÂÃ¥ÂÂå¾Âï¼ÂæÂÂï¼Âï¼ÂÃ¥ÂÂ